diff options
Diffstat (limited to 'gnu/usr.bin/texinfo/doc/texinfo.texi')
-rw-r--r-- | gnu/usr.bin/texinfo/doc/texinfo.texi | 17289 |
1 files changed, 0 insertions, 17289 deletions
diff --git a/gnu/usr.bin/texinfo/doc/texinfo.texi b/gnu/usr.bin/texinfo/doc/texinfo.texi deleted file mode 100644 index 5ffef5da409..00000000000 --- a/gnu/usr.bin/texinfo/doc/texinfo.texi +++ /dev/null @@ -1,17289 +0,0 @@ -\input texinfo.tex @c -*-texinfo-*- -@c $Id: texinfo.texi,v 1.3 2002/06/10 13:51:02 espie Exp $ -@c %**start of header - -@c All text is ignored before the setfilename. -@setfilename texinfo -@settitle Texinfo @value{edition} - -@set edition 2.24 -@set update-month July 1997 -@set update-date 25 @value{update-month} - -@c Define a new index for options. -@defcodeindex op -@c Put everything except function (command, in this case) names in one -@c index (arbitrarily chosen to be the concept index). -@syncodeindex op cp -@syncodeindex vr cp -@syncodeindex pg cp - -@footnotestyle separate -@paragraphindent 2 -@finalout -@comment %**end of header - -@c Before release, run C-u C-c C-u C-a (texinfo-all-menus-update with a -@c prefix arg). This updates the node pointers, which texinfmt.el needs. - -@dircategory Texinfo documentation system -@direntry -* Texinfo: (texinfo). The GNU documentation format. -* install-info: (texinfo)Invoking install-info. Updating info/dir entries. -* texi2dvi: (texinfo)Format with texi2dvi. Printing Texinfo documentation. -* texindex: (texinfo)Format with tex/texindex. Sorting Texinfo index files. -* makeinfo: (texinfo)makeinfo Preferred. Translate Texinfo source. -@end direntry - -@c Set smallbook if printing in smallbook format so the example of the -@c smallbook font is actually written using smallbook; in bigbook, a kludge -@c is used for TeX output. Do this through the -t option to texi2dvi, -@c so this same source can be used for other paper sizes as well. -@c smallbook -@c set smallbook -@c @@clear smallbook - -@c Currently undocumented command, 5 December 1993: -@c -@c nwnode (Same as node, but no warnings; for `makeinfo'.) - -@ifinfo -This file documents Texinfo, a documentation system that can produce -both on-line information and a printed manual from a single source file. - -Copyright (C) 1988, 90, 91, 92, 93, 95, 96, 97 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - -This is the second edition of the Texinfo documentation,@* -and is consistent with version 2 of @file{texinfo.tex}. - -Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of -this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice -are preserved on all copies. - -@ignore -Permission is granted to process this file through TeX and print the -results, provided the printed document carries copying permission -notice identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph -(this paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual). - -@end ignore -Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this -manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided that the entire -resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a permission -notice identical to this one. - -Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual -into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions, -except that this permission notice may be stated in a translation approved -by the Free Software Foundation. -@end ifinfo - -@setchapternewpage odd - -@shorttitlepage Texinfo - -@titlepage -@c use the new format for titles -@title Texinfo -@subtitle The GNU Documentation Format -@subtitle Edition @value{edition}, for Texinfo Version Three -@subtitle @value{update-month} - -@author Robert J.@: Chassell -@author Richard M.@: Stallman - -@c Include the Distribution inside the titlepage so -@c that headings are turned off. - -@page -@vskip 0pt plus 1filll -Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 90, 91, 92, 93, 95, 96, 97 -Free Software Foundation, Inc. - -@sp 2 -This is the second edition of the Texinfo documentation,@* -and is consistent with version 2 of @file{texinfo.tex}. -@sp 2 - -Published by the Free Software Foundation @* -59 Temple Place Suite 330 @* -Boston, MA 02111-1307 @* -USA @* -Printed copies are available for $15 each.@* -ISBN 1-882114-64-7 -@c ISBN 1-882114-63-9 is for edition 2.20 of 28 February 1995 -@c ISBN 1-882114-64-7 is for edition 2.23 of 1 October 1996. - -Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of -this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice -are preserved on all copies. - -Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this -manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided that the entire -resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a permission -notice identical to this one. - -Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual -into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions, -except that this permission notice may be stated in a translation approved -by the Free Software Foundation. -@sp 2 -Cover art by Etienne Suvasa. -@end titlepage - -@ifinfo -@node Top, Copying, (dir), (dir) -@top Texinfo - -Texinfo is a documentation system that uses a single source file to -produce both on-line information and printed output.@refill - -The first part of this master menu lists the major nodes in this Info -document, including the @@-command and concept indices. The rest of -the menu lists all the lower level nodes in the document.@refill - -This is Edition @value{edition} of the Texinfo documentation, -@w{@value{update-date},} for Texinfo Version Three. -@end ifinfo - -@c Here is a spare copy of the chapter menu entry descriptions, -@c in case they are accidently deleted -@ignore -Your rights. -Texinfo in brief. -How to use Texinfo mode. -What is at the beginning of a Texinfo file? -What is at the end of a Texinfo file? -How to create chapters, sections, subsections, - appendices, and other parts. -How to provide structure for a document. -How to write nodes. -How to write menus. -How to write cross references. -How to mark words and phrases as code, - keyboard input, meta-syntactic - variables, and the like. -How to write quotations, examples, etc. -How to write lists and tables. -How to create indices. -How to insert @@-signs, braces, etc. -How to indicate results of evaluation, - expansion of macros, errors, etc. -How to force and prevent line and page breaks. -How to describe functions and the like in a uniform manner. -How to write footnotes. -How to specify text for either @TeX{} or Info. -How to print hardcopy. -How to create an Info file. -How to install an Info file -A list of all the Texinfo @@-commands. -Hints on how to write a Texinfo document. -A sample Texinfo file to look at. -Tell readers they have the right to copy - and distribute. -How to incorporate other Texinfo files. -How to write page headings and footings. -How to find formatting mistakes. -All about paragraph refilling. -A description of @@-Command syntax. -Texinfo second edition features. -A menu containing commands and variables. -A menu covering many topics. -@end ignore - -@menu -* Copying:: Your rights. -* Overview:: Texinfo in brief. -* Texinfo Mode:: How to use Texinfo mode. -* Beginning a File:: What is at the beginning of a Texinfo file? -* Ending a File:: What is at the end of a Texinfo file? -* Structuring:: How to create chapters, sections, subsections, - appendices, and other parts. -* Nodes:: How to write nodes. -* Menus:: How to write menus. -* Cross References:: How to write cross references. -* Marking Text:: How to mark words and phrases as code, - keyboard input, meta-syntactic - variables, and the like. -* Quotations and Examples:: How to write quotations, examples, etc. -* Lists and Tables:: How to write lists and tables. -* Indices:: How to create indices. -* Insertions:: How to insert @@-signs, braces, etc. -* Breaks:: How to force and prevent line and page breaks. -* Definition Commands:: How to describe functions and the like - in a uniform manner. -* Footnotes:: How to write footnotes. -* Conditionals:: How to specify text for either @TeX{} or Info. -* Macros:: Defining new Texinfo commands. -* Format/Print Hardcopy:: How to convert a Texinfo file to a file - for printing and how to print that file. -* Create an Info File:: Convert a Texinfo file into an Info file. -* Install an Info File:: Make an Info file accessible to users. -* Command List:: All the Texinfo @@-commands. -* Tips:: Hints on how to write a Texinfo document. -* Sample Texinfo File:: A sample Texinfo file to look at. -* Sample Permissions:: Tell readers they have the right to copy - and distribute. -* Include Files:: How to incorporate other Texinfo files. -* Headings:: How to write page headings and footings. -* Catching Mistakes:: How to find formatting mistakes. -* Refilling Paragraphs:: All about paragraph refilling. -* Command Syntax:: A description of @@-Command syntax. -* Obtaining TeX:: How to Obtain @TeX{}. -* Command and Variable Index:: A menu containing commands and variables. -* Concept Index:: A menu covering many topics. - -@detailmenu - - --- The Detailed Node Listing --- - -Overview of Texinfo - -* Using Texinfo:: Create a conventional printed book - or an Info file. -* Info Files:: What is an Info file? -* Printed Books:: Characteristics of a printed book or manual. -* Formatting Commands:: @@-commands are used for formatting. -* Conventions:: General rules for writing a Texinfo file. -* Comments:: How to write comments and mark regions that - the formatting commands will ignore. -* Minimum:: What a Texinfo file must have. -* Six Parts:: Usually, a Texinfo file has six parts. -* Short Sample:: A short sample Texinfo file. -* Acknowledgements:: - -Using Texinfo Mode - -* Texinfo Mode Overview:: How Texinfo mode can help you. -* Emacs Editing:: Texinfo mode adds to GNU Emacs' general - purpose editing features. -* Inserting:: How to insert frequently used @@-commands. -* Showing the Structure:: How to show the structure of a file. -* Updating Nodes and Menus:: How to update or create new nodes and menus. -* Info Formatting:: How to format for Info. -* Printing:: How to format and print part or all of a file. -* Texinfo Mode Summary:: Summary of all the Texinfo mode commands. - -Updating Nodes and Menus - -* Updating Commands:: Five major updating commands. -* Updating Requirements:: How to structure a Texinfo file for - using the updating command. -* Other Updating Commands:: How to indent descriptions, insert - missing nodes lines, and update - nodes in sequence. - -Beginning a Texinfo File - -* Four Parts:: Four parts begin a Texinfo file. -* Sample Beginning:: Here is a sample beginning for a Texinfo file. -* Header:: The very beginning of a Texinfo file. -* Info Summary and Permissions:: Summary and copying permissions for Info. -* Titlepage & Copyright Page:: Creating the title and copyright pages. -* The Top Node:: Creating the `Top' node and master menu. -* Software Copying Permissions:: Ensure that you and others continue to - have the right to use and share software. - -The Texinfo File Header - -* First Line:: The first line of a Texinfo file. -* Start of Header:: Formatting a region requires this. -* setfilename:: Tell Info the name of the Info file. -* settitle:: Create a title for the printed work. -* setchapternewpage:: Start chapters on right-hand pages. -* paragraphindent:: An option to specify paragraph indentation. -* End of Header:: Formatting a region requires this. - -The Title and Copyright Pages - -* titlepage:: Create a title for the printed document. -* titlefont center sp:: The @code{@@titlefont}, @code{@@center}, - and @code{@@sp} commands. -* title subtitle author:: The @code{@@title}, @code{@@subtitle}, - and @code{@@author} commands. -* Copyright & Permissions:: How to write the copyright notice and - include copying permissions. -* end titlepage:: Turn on page headings after the title and - copyright pages. -* headings on off:: An option for turning headings on and off - and double or single sided printing. - -The `Top' Node and Master Menu - -* Title of Top Node:: Sketch what the file is about. -* Master Menu Parts:: A master menu has three or more parts. - -Ending a Texinfo File - -* Printing Indices & Menus:: How to print an index in hardcopy and - generate index menus in Info. -* Contents:: How to create a table of contents. -* File End:: How to mark the end of a file. - -Chapter Structuring - -* Tree Structuring:: A manual is like an upside down tree @dots{} -* Structuring Command Types:: How to divide a manual into parts. -* makeinfo top:: The @code{@@top} command, part of the `Top' node. -* chapter:: -* unnumbered & appendix:: -* majorheading & chapheading:: -* section:: -* unnumberedsec appendixsec heading:: -* subsection:: -* unnumberedsubsec appendixsubsec subheading:: -* subsubsection:: Commands for the lowest level sections. -* Raise/lower sections:: How to change commands' hierarchical level. - -Nodes - -* Two Paths:: Different commands to structure - Info output and printed output. -* Node Menu Illustration:: A diagram, and sample nodes and menus. -* node:: How to write a node, in detail. -* makeinfo Pointer Creation:: How to create node pointers with @code{makeinfo}. - -The @code{@@node} Command - -* Node Names:: How to choose node and pointer names. -* Writing a Node:: How to write an @code{@@node} line. -* Node Line Tips:: Keep names short. -* Node Line Requirements:: Keep names unique, without @@-commands. -* First Node:: How to write a `Top' node. -* makeinfo top command:: How to use the @code{@@top} command. -* Top Node Summary:: Write a brief description for readers. - -Menus - -* Menu Location:: Put a menu in a short node. -* Writing a Menu:: What is a menu? -* Menu Parts:: A menu entry has three parts. -* Less Cluttered Menu Entry:: Two part menu entry. -* Menu Example:: Two and three part menu entries. -* Other Info Files:: How to refer to a different Info file. - -Cross References - -* References:: What cross references are for. -* Cross Reference Commands:: A summary of the different commands. -* Cross Reference Parts:: A cross reference has several parts. -* xref:: Begin a reference with `See' @dots{} -* Top Node Naming:: How to refer to the beginning of another file. -* ref:: A reference for the last part of a sentence. -* pxref:: How to write a parenthetical cross reference. -* inforef:: How to refer to an Info-only file. -* uref:: How to refer to a uniform resource locator. - -@code{@@xref} - -* Reference Syntax:: What a reference looks like and requires. -* One Argument:: @code{@@xref} with one argument. -* Two Arguments:: @code{@@xref} with two arguments. -* Three Arguments:: @code{@@xref} with three arguments. -* Four and Five Arguments:: @code{@@xref} with four and five arguments. - -Marking Words and Phrases - -* Indicating:: How to indicate definitions, files, etc. -* Emphasis:: How to emphasize text. - -Indicating Definitions, Commands, etc. - -* Useful Highlighting:: Highlighting provides useful information. -* code:: How to indicate code. -* kbd:: How to show keyboard input. -* key:: How to specify keys. -* samp:: How to show a literal sequence of characters. -* var:: How to indicate a metasyntactic variable. -* file:: How to indicate the name of a file. -* dfn:: How to specify a definition. -* cite:: How to refer to a book that is not in Info. -* url:: How to indicate a world wide web reference. -* email:: How to indicate an electronic mail address. - -Emphasizing Text - -* emph & strong:: How to emphasize text in Texinfo. -* Smallcaps:: How to use the small caps font. -* Fonts:: Various font commands for printed output. -* Customized Highlighting:: How to define highlighting commands. - -Quotations and Examples - -* Block Enclosing Commands:: Use different constructs for - different purposes. -* quotation:: How to write a quotation. -* example:: How to write an example in a fixed-width font. -* noindent:: How to prevent paragraph indentation. -* Lisp Example:: How to illustrate Lisp code. -* smallexample & smalllisp:: Forms for the @code{@@smallbook} option. -* display:: How to write an example in the current font. -* format:: How to write an example that does not narrow - the margins. -* exdent:: How to undo the indentation of a line. -* flushleft & flushright:: How to push text flushleft or flushright. -* cartouche:: How to draw cartouches around examples. - -Lists and Tables - -* Introducing Lists:: Texinfo formats lists for you. -* itemize:: How to construct a simple list. -* enumerate:: How to construct a numbered list. -* Two-column Tables:: How to construct a two-column table. -* Multi-column Tables:: How to construct generalized tables. - -Making a Two-column Table - -* table:: How to construct a two-column table. -* ftable vtable:: Automatic indexing for two-column tables. -* itemx:: How to put more entries in the first column. - -Multi-column Tables - -* Multitable Column Widths:: Defining multitable column widths. -* Multitable Rows:: Defining multitable rows, with examples. - -Creating Indices - -* Index Entries:: Choose different words for index entries. -* Predefined Indices:: Use different indices for different kinds - of entry. -* Indexing Commands:: How to make an index entry. -* Combining Indices:: How to combine indices. -* New Indices:: How to define your own indices. - -Combining Indices - -* syncodeindex:: How to merge two indices, using @code{@@code} - font for the merged-from index. -* synindex:: How to merge two indices, using the - default font of the merged-to index. - -Special Insertions - -* Braces Atsigns:: How to insert braces, @samp{@@}. -* Inserting Space:: How to insert the right amount of space - within a sentence. -* Inserting Accents:: How to insert accents and special characters. -* Dots Bullets:: How to insert dots and bullets. -* TeX and copyright:: How to insert the @TeX{} logo - and the copyright symbol. -* pounds:: How to insert the pounds currency symbol. -* minus:: How to insert a minus sign. -* math:: How to format a mathematical expression. -* Glyphs:: How to indicate results of evaluation, - expansion of macros, errors, etc. -* Images:: How to include graphics. - -Inserting @@ and Braces - -* Inserting An Atsign:: How to insert @samp{@@}. -* Inserting Braces:: How to insert @samp{@{} and @samp{@}}. - -Inserting Space - -* Not Ending a Sentence:: Sometimes a . doesn't end a sentence. -* Ending a Sentence:: Sometimes it does. -* Multiple Spaces:: Inserting multiple spaces. -* dmn:: How to format a dimension. - -Inserting Ellipsis, Dots, and Bullets - -* dots:: How to insert dots @dots{} -* bullet:: How to insert a bullet. - -Inserting @TeX{} and the Copyright Symbol - -* tex:: How to insert the @TeX{} logo. -* copyright symbol:: How to use @code{@@copyright}@{@}. - -Glyphs for Examples - -* Glyphs Summary:: -* result:: How to show the result of expression. -* expansion:: How to indicate an expansion. -* Print Glyph:: How to indicate printed output. -* Error Glyph:: How to indicate an error message. -* Equivalence:: How to indicate equivalence. -* Point Glyph:: How to indicate the location of point. - -Glyphs Summary - -* result:: -* expansion:: -* Print Glyph:: -* Error Glyph:: -* Equivalence:: -* Point Glyph:: - -Making and Preventing Breaks - -* Break Commands:: Cause and prevent splits. -* Line Breaks:: How to force a single line to use two lines. -* - and hyphenation:: How to tell TeX about hyphenation points. -* w:: How to prevent unwanted line breaks. -* sp:: How to insert blank lines. -* page:: How to force the start of a new page. -* group:: How to prevent unwanted page breaks. -* need:: Another way to prevent unwanted page breaks. - -Definition Commands - -* Def Cmd Template:: How to structure a description using a - definition command. -* Optional Arguments:: How to handle optional and repeated arguments. -* deffnx:: How to group two or more `first' lines. -* Def Cmds in Detail:: All the definition commands. -* Def Cmd Conventions:: Conventions for writing definitions. -* Sample Function Definition:: - -The Definition Commands - -* Functions Commands:: Commands for functions and similar entities. -* Variables Commands:: Commands for variables and similar entities. -* Typed Functions:: Commands for functions in typed languages. -* Typed Variables:: Commands for variables in typed languages. -* Abstract Objects:: Commands for object-oriented programming. -* Data Types:: The definition command for data types. - -Footnotes - -* Footnote Commands:: How to write a footnote in Texinfo. -* Footnote Styles:: Controlling how footnotes appear in Info. - -Conditionally Visible Text - -* Conditional Commands:: Specifying text for HTML, Info, or @TeX{}. -* Conditional Not Commands:: Specifying text for not HTML, Info, or @TeX{}. -* Raw Formatter Commands:: Using raw @TeX{} or HTML commands. -* set clear value:: Designating which text to format (for - all output formats); and how to set a - flag to a string that you can insert. - -@code{@@set}, @code{@@clear}, and @code{@@value} - -* ifset ifclear:: Format a region if a flag is set. -* value:: Replace a flag with a string. -* value Example:: An easy way to update edition information. - -Macros: Defining New Texinfo Commands - -* Defining Macros:: Both defining and undefining new commands. -* Invoking Macros:: Using a macro, once you've defined it. - -Format and Print Hardcopy - -* Use TeX:: Use @TeX{} to format for hardcopy. -* Format with tex/texindex:: How to format in a shell. -* Format with texi2dvi:: A simpler way to use the shell. -* Print with lpr:: How to print. -* Within Emacs:: How to format and print from an Emacs shell. -* Texinfo Mode Printing:: How to format and print in Texinfo mode. -* Compile-Command:: How to print using Emacs's compile command. -* Requirements Summary:: @TeX{} formatting requirements summary. -* Preparing for TeX:: What you need to do to use @TeX{}. -* Overfull hboxes:: What are and what to do with overfull hboxes. -* smallbook:: How to print small format books and manuals. -* A4 Paper:: How to print on European A4 paper. -* Cropmarks and Magnification:: How to print marks to indicate the size - of pages and how to print scaled up output. - -Creating an Info File - -* makeinfo advantages:: @code{makeinfo} provides better error checking. -* Invoking makeinfo:: How to run @code{makeinfo} from a shell. -* makeinfo options:: Specify fill-column and other options. -* Pointer Validation:: How to check that pointers point somewhere. -* makeinfo in Emacs:: How to run @code{makeinfo} from Emacs. -* texinfo-format commands:: Two Info formatting commands written - in Emacs Lisp are an alternative - to @code{makeinfo}. -* Batch Formatting:: How to format for Info in Emacs Batch mode. -* Tag and Split Files:: How tagged and split files help Info - to run better. - -Installing an Info File - -* Directory file:: The top level menu for all Info files. -* New Info File:: Listing a new info file. -* Other Info Directories:: How to specify Info files that are - located in other directories. -* Installing Dir Entries:: How to specify what menu entry to add - to the Info directory. -* Invoking install-info:: @code{install-info} options. - -Sample Permissions - -* Inserting Permissions:: How to put permissions in your document. -* ifinfo Permissions:: Sample @samp{ifinfo} copying permissions. -* Titlepage Permissions:: Sample Titlepage copying permissions. - -Include Files - -* Using Include Files:: How to use the @code{@@include} command. -* texinfo-multiple-files-update:: How to create and update nodes and - menus when using included files. -* Include File Requirements:: What @code{texinfo-multiple-files-update} expects. -* Sample Include File:: A sample outer file with included files - within it; and a sample included file. -* Include Files Evolution:: How use of the @code{@@include} command - has changed over time. - -Page Headings - -* Headings Introduced:: Conventions for using page headings. -* Heading Format:: Standard page heading formats. -* Heading Choice:: How to specify the type of page heading. -* Custom Headings:: How to create your own headings and footings. - -Formatting Mistakes - -* makeinfo Preferred:: @code{makeinfo} finds errors. -* Debugging with Info:: How to catch errors with Info formatting. -* Debugging with TeX:: How to catch errors with @TeX{} formatting. -* Using texinfo-show-structure:: How to use @code{texinfo-show-structure}. -* Using occur:: How to list all lines containing a pattern. -* Running Info-Validate:: How to find badly referenced nodes. - -Finding Badly Referenced Nodes - -* Using Info-validate:: How to run @code{Info-validate}. -* Unsplit:: How to create an unsplit file. -* Tagifying:: How to tagify a file. -* Splitting:: How to split a file manually. - -How to Obtain @TeX{} - -* New Texinfo Mode Commands:: The updating commands are especially useful. -* New Commands:: Many newly described @@-commands. -@end detailmenu -@end menu - -@node Copying, Overview, Top, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@unnumbered Texinfo Copying Conditions -@cindex Copying conditions -@cindex Conditions for copying Texinfo - -The programs currently being distributed that relate to Texinfo include -portions of GNU Emacs, plus other separate programs (including -@code{makeinfo}, @code{info}, @code{texindex}, and @file{texinfo.tex}). -These programs are @dfn{free}; this means that everyone is free to use -them and free to redistribute them on a free basis. The Texinfo-related -programs are not in the public domain; they are copyrighted and there -are restrictions on their distribution, but these restrictions are -designed to permit everything that a good cooperating citizen would want -to do. What is not allowed is to try to prevent others from further -sharing any version of these programs that they might get from -you.@refill - - Specifically, we want to make sure that you have the right to give -away copies of the programs that relate to Texinfo, that you receive -source code or else can get it if you want it, that you can change these -programs or use pieces of them in new free programs, and that you know -you can do these things.@refill - - To make sure that everyone has such rights, we have to forbid you to -deprive anyone else of these rights. For example, if you distribute -copies of the Texinfo related programs, you must give the recipients all -the rights that you have. You must make sure that they, too, receive or -can get the source code. And you must tell them their rights.@refill - - Also, for our own protection, we must make certain that everyone finds -out that there is no warranty for the programs that relate to Texinfo. -If these programs are modified by someone else and passed on, we want -their recipients to know that what they have is not what we distributed, -so that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on our -reputation.@refill - - The precise conditions of the licenses for the programs currently -being distributed that relate to Texinfo are found in the General Public -Licenses that accompany them.@refill - -@node Overview, Texinfo Mode, Copying, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@chapter Overview of Texinfo -@cindex Overview of Texinfo -@cindex Texinfo overview - -@dfn{Texinfo}@footnote{Note that the first syllable of ``Texinfo'' is -pronounced like ``speck'', not ``hex''. This odd pronunciation is -derived from, but is not the same as, the pronunciation of @TeX{}. In -the word @TeX{}, the @samp{X} is actually the Greek letter ``chi'' -rather than the English letter ``ex''. Pronounce @TeX{} as if the -@samp{X} were the last sound in the name `Bach'; but pronounce Texinfo -as if the @samp{x} were a `k'. Spell ``Texinfo'' with a capital ``T'' -and write the other letters in lower case.} -is a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both -on-line information and printed output. This means that instead of -writing two different documents, one for the on-line help or other on-line -information and the other for a typeset manual or other printed work, you -need write only one document. When the work is revised, you need revise -only one document. (You can read the on-line information, known as an -@dfn{Info file}, with an Info documentation-reading program.)@refill - -@menu -* Using Texinfo:: Create a conventional printed book - or an Info file. -* Info Files:: What is an Info file? -* Printed Books:: Characteristics of a printed book or manual. -* Formatting Commands:: @@-commands are used for formatting. -* Conventions:: General rules for writing a Texinfo file. -* Comments:: How to write comments and mark regions that - the formatting commands will ignore. -* Minimum:: What a Texinfo file must have. -* Six Parts:: Usually, a Texinfo file has six parts. -* Short Sample:: A short sample Texinfo file. -* Acknowledgements:: -@end menu - -@node Using Texinfo, Info Files, Overview, Overview -@ifinfo -@heading Using Texinfo -@end ifinfo - -Using Texinfo, you can create a printed document with the normal -features of a book, including chapters, sections, cross references, -and indices. From the same Texinfo source file, you can create a -menu-driven, on-line Info file with nodes, menus, cross references, -and indices. You can, if you wish, make the chapters and sections of -the printed document correspond to the nodes of the on-line -information; and you use the same cross references and indices for -both the Info file and the printed work. @cite{The GNU -Emacs Manual} is a good example of a Texinfo file, as is this manual.@refill - -To make a printed document, you process a Texinfo source file with the -@TeX{} typesetting program. This creates a DVI file that you can -typeset and print as a book or report. (Note that the Texinfo language -is completely different from @TeX{}'s usual language, plain @TeX{}.) If -you do not have @TeX{}, but do have @code{troff} or @code{nroff}, you -can use the @code{texi2roff} program instead.@refill - -To make an Info file, you process a Texinfo source file with the -@code{makeinfo} utility or Emacs's @code{texinfo-format-buffer} command; -this creates an Info file that you can install on-line.@refill - -@TeX{} and @code{texi2roff} work with many types of printers; similarly, -Info works with almost every type of computer terminal. This power -makes Texinfo a general purpose system, but brings with it a constraint, -which is that a Texinfo file may contain only the customary -``typewriter'' characters (letters, numbers, spaces, and punctuation -marks) but no special graphics.@refill - -A Texinfo file is a plain @sc{ascii} file containing text and -@dfn{@@-commands} (words preceded by an @samp{@@}) that tell the -typesetting and formatting programs what to do. You may edit a -Texinfo file with any text editor; but it is especially convenient to -use GNU Emacs since that editor has a special mode, called Texinfo -mode, that provides various Texinfo-related features. (@xref{Texinfo -Mode}.)@refill - -Before writing a Texinfo source file, you should become familiar with -the Info documentation reading program and learn about nodes, -menus, cross references, and the rest. (@inforef{Top, info, info}, -for more information.)@refill - -You can use Texinfo to create both on-line help and printed manuals; -moreover, Texinfo is freely redistributable. For these reasons, Texinfo -is the format in which documentation for GNU utilities and libraries is -written.@refill - -@node Info Files, Printed Books, Using Texinfo, Overview -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Info files -@cindex Info files - -An Info file is a Texinfo file formatted so that the Info documentation -reading program can operate on it. (@code{makeinfo} -and @code{texinfo-format-buffer} are two commands that convert a Texinfo file -into an Info file.)@refill - -Info files are divided into pieces called @dfn{nodes}, each of which -contains the discussion of one topic. Each node has a name, and -contains both text for the user to read and pointers to other nodes, -which are identified by their names. The Info program displays one node -at a time, and provides commands with which the user can move to other -related nodes.@refill - -@ifinfo -@inforef{Top, info, info}, for more information about using Info.@refill -@end ifinfo - -Each node of an Info file may have any number of child nodes that -describe subtopics of the node's topic. The names of child -nodes are listed in a @dfn{menu} within the parent node; this -allows you to use certain Info commands to move to one of the child -nodes. Generally, an Info file is organized like a book. If a node -is at the logical level of a chapter, its child nodes are at the level -of sections; likewise, the child nodes of sections are at the level -of subsections.@refill - -All the children of any one parent are linked together in a -bidirectional chain of `Next' and `Previous' pointers. The `Next' -pointer provides a link to the next section, and the `Previous' pointer -provides a link to the previous section. This means that all the nodes -that are at the level of sections within a chapter are linked together. -Normally the order in this chain is the same as the order of the -children in the parent's menu. Each child node records the parent node -name as its `Up' pointer. The last child has no `Next' pointer, and the -first child has the parent both as its `Previous' and as its `Up' -pointer.@footnote{In some documents, the first child has no `Previous' -pointer. Occasionally, the last child has the node name of the next -following higher level node as its `Next' pointer.}@refill - -The book-like structuring of an Info file into nodes that correspond -to chapters, sections, and the like is a matter of convention, not a -requirement. The `Up', `Previous', and `Next' pointers of a node can -point to any other nodes, and a menu can contain any other nodes. -Thus, the node structure can be any directed graph. But it is usually -more comprehensible to follow a structure that corresponds to the -structure of chapters and sections in a printed book or report.@refill - -In addition to menus and to `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers, Info -provides pointers of another kind, called references, that can be -sprinkled throughout the text. This is usually the best way to -represent links that do not fit a hierarchical structure.@refill - -Usually, you will design a document so that its nodes match the -structure of chapters and sections in the printed output. But -occasionally there are times when this is not right for the material -being discussed. Therefore, Texinfo uses separate commands to specify -the node structure for the Info file and the section structure for the -printed output.@refill - -Generally, you enter an Info file through a node that by convention is -named `Top'. This node normally contains just a brief summary of the -file's purpose, and a large menu through which the rest of the file is -reached. From this node, you can either traverse the file -systematically by going from node to node, or you can go to a specific -node listed in the main menu, or you can search the index menus and then -go directly to the node that has the information you want. Alternatively, -with the standalone Info program, you can specify specific menu items on -the command line (@pxref{Top,,, info, Info}). - -If you want to read through an Info file in sequence, as if it were a -printed manual, you can hit @key{SPC} repeatedly, or you get the whole -file with the advanced Info command @kbd{g *}. (@inforef{Expert, -Advanced Info commands, info}.)@refill - -@c !!! dir file may be located in one of many places: -@c /usr/local/emacs/info mentioned in info.c DEFAULT_INFOPATH -@c /usr/local/lib/emacs/info mentioned in info.c DEFAULT_INFOPATH -@c /usr/gnu/info mentioned in info.c DEFAULT_INFOPATH -@c /usr/local/info -@c /usr/local/lib/info -The @file{dir} file in the @file{info} directory serves as the -departure point for the whole Info system. From it, you can reach the -`Top' nodes of each of the documents in a complete Info system.@refill - -@node Printed Books, Formatting Commands, Info Files, Overview -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Printed Books -@cindex Printed book and manual characteristics -@cindex Manual characteristics, printed -@cindex Book characteristics, printed -@cindex Texinfo printed book characteristics -@cindex Characteristics, printed books or manuals - -@cindex Knuth, Donald -A Texinfo file can be formatted and typeset as a printed book or manual. -To do this, you need @TeX{}, a powerful, sophisticated typesetting -program written by Donald Knuth.@footnote{You can also use the -@code{texi2roff} program if you do not have @TeX{}; since Texinfo is -designed for use with @TeX{}, @code{texi2roff} is not described here. -@code{texi2roff} is not part of the standard GNU distribution.} - -A Texinfo-based book is similar to any other typeset, printed work: it -can have a title page, copyright page, table of contents, and preface, -as well as chapters, numbered or unnumbered sections and subsections, -page headers, cross references, footnotes, and indices.@refill - -You can use Texinfo to write a book without ever having the intention -of converting it into on-line information. You can use Texinfo for -writing a printed novel, and even to write a printed memo, although -this latter application is not recommended since electronic mail is so -much easier.@refill - -@TeX{} is a general purpose typesetting program. Texinfo provides a -file called @file{texinfo.tex} that contains information (definitions or -@dfn{macros}) that @TeX{} uses when it typesets a Texinfo file. -(@file{texinfo.tex} tells @TeX{} how to convert the Texinfo @@-commands -to @TeX{} commands, which @TeX{} can then process to create the typeset -document.) @file{texinfo.tex} contains the specifications for printing -a document.@refill - -Most often, documents are printed on 8.5 inch by 11 inch -pages (216@dmn{mm} by 280@dmn{mm}; this is the default size), but you -can also print for 7 inch by 9.25 inch pages (178@dmn{mm} by -235@dmn{mm}; the @code{@@smallbook} size) or on European A4 size paper -(@code{@@afourpaper}). (@xref{smallbook, , Printing ``Small'' Books}. -Also, see @ref{A4 Paper, ,Printing on A4 Paper}.)@refill - -By changing the parameters in @file{texinfo.tex}, you can change the -size of the printed document. In addition, you can change the style in -which the printed document is formatted; for example, you can change the -sizes and fonts used, the amount of indentation for each paragraph, the -degree to which words are hyphenated, and the like. By changing the -specifications, you can make a book look dignified, old and serious, or -light-hearted, young and cheery.@refill - -@TeX{} is freely distributable. It is written in a superset of Pascal -called WEB and can be compiled either in Pascal or (by using a -conversion program that comes with the @TeX{} distribution) in C. -(@xref{TeX Mode, ,@TeX{} Mode, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, for information -about @TeX{}.)@refill - -@TeX{} is very powerful and has a great many features. Because a -Texinfo file must be able to present information both on a -character-only terminal in Info form and in a typeset book, the -formatting commands that Texinfo supports are necessarily -limited.@refill - -@xref{Obtaining TeX, , How to Obtain @TeX{}}. - - -@node Formatting Commands, Conventions, Printed Books, Overview -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @@-commands -@cindex @@-commands -@cindex Formatting commands - -In a Texinfo file, the commands that tell @TeX{} how to typeset the -printed manual and tell @code{makeinfo} and -@code{texinfo-format-buffer} how to create an Info file are preceded -by @samp{@@}; they are called @dfn{@@-commands}. For example, -@code{@@node} is the command to indicate a node and @code{@@chapter} -is the command to indicate the start of a chapter.@refill - -@quotation -@strong{Please note:} All the @@-commands, with the exception of the -@code{@@TeX@{@}} command, must be written entirely in lower -case.@refill -@end quotation - -The Texinfo @@-commands are a strictly limited set of constructs. The -strict limits make it possible for Texinfo files to be understood both -by @TeX{} and by the code that converts them into Info files. You can -display Info files on any terminal that displays alphabetic and -numeric characters. Similarly, you can print the output generated by -@TeX{} on a wide variety of printers.@refill - -Depending on what they do or what arguments@footnote{The word -@dfn{argument} comes from the way it is used in mathematics and does -not refer to a disputation between two people; it refers to the -information presented to the command. According to the @cite{Oxford -English Dictionary}, the word derives from the Latin for @dfn{to make -clear, prove}; thus it came to mean `the evidence offered as proof', -which is to say, `the information offered', which led to its -mathematical meaning. In its other thread of derivation, the word -came to mean `to assert in a manner against which others may make -counter assertions', which led to the meaning of `argument' as a -disputation.} they take, you need to write @@-commands on lines of -their own or as part of sentences:@refill - -@itemize @bullet -@item -Write a command such as @code{@@noindent} at the beginning of a line as -the only text on the line. (@code{@@noindent} prevents the beginning of -the next line from being indented as the beginning of a -paragraph.)@refill - -@item -Write a command such as @code{@@chapter} at the beginning of a line -followed by the command's arguments, in this case the chapter title, on -the rest of the line. (@code{@@chapter} creates chapter titles.)@refill - -@item -Write a command such as @code{@@dots@{@}} wherever you wish but usually -within a sentence. (@code{@@dots@{@}} creates dots @dots{})@refill - -@item -Write a command such as @code{@@code@{@var{sample-code}@}} wherever you -wish (but usually within a sentence) with its argument, -@var{sample-code} in this example, between the braces. (@code{@@code} -marks text as being code.)@refill - -@item -Write a command such as @code{@@example} at the beginning of a line of -its own; write the body-text on following lines; and write the matching -@code{@@end} command, @code{@@end example} in this case, at the -beginning of a line of its own after the body-text. (@code{@@example} -@dots{} @code{@@end example} indents and typesets body-text as an -example.)@refill -@end itemize - -@noindent -@cindex Braces, when to use -As a general rule, a command requires braces if it mingles among other -text; but it does not need braces if it starts a line of its own. The -non-alphabetic commands, such as @code{@@:}, are exceptions to the rule; -they do not need braces.@refill - -As you gain experience with Texinfo, you will rapidly learn how to -write the different commands: the different ways to write commands -make it easier to write and read Texinfo files than if all commands -followed exactly the same syntax. (For details about @@-command -syntax, see @ref{Command Syntax, , @@-Command Syntax}.)@refill - -@node Conventions, Comments, Formatting Commands, Overview -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section General Syntactic Conventions -@cindex General syntactic conventions -@cindex Syntactic conventions -@cindex Conventions, syntactic - -All printable @sc{ascii} characters except @samp{@@}, @samp{@{} and -@samp{@}} can appear in a Texinfo file and stand for themselves. -@samp{@@} is the escape character which introduces commands. -@samp{@{} and @samp{@}} should be used only to surround arguments to -certain commands. To put one of these special characters into the -document, put an @samp{@@} character in front of it, like this: -@samp{@@@@}, @samp{@@@{}, and @samp{@@@}}.@refill - -@ifinfo -It is customary in @TeX{} to use doubled single-quote characters to -begin and end quotations: ` ` and ' ' (but without a space between the -two single-quote characters). This convention should be followed in -Texinfo files. @TeX{} converts doubled single-quote characters to -left- and right-hand doubled quotation marks and Info converts doubled -single-quote characters to @sc{ascii} double-quotes: ` ` and ' ' to " .@refill -@end ifinfo -@iftex -It is customary in @TeX{} to use doubled single-quote characters to -begin and end quotations: @w{@tt{ `` }} and @w{@tt{ '' }}. This -convention should be followed in Texinfo files. @TeX{} converts -doubled single-quote characters to left- and right-hand doubled -quotation marks, ``like this'', and Info converts doubled single-quote -characters to @sc{ascii} double-quotes: @w{@tt{ `` }} and -@w{@tt{ '' }} to @w{@tt{ " }}.@refill -@end iftex - -Use three hyphens in a row, @samp{---}, for a dash---like this. In -@TeX{}, a single or double hyphen produces a printed dash that is -shorter than the usual typeset dash. Info reduces three hyphens to two -for display on the screen. - -To prevent a paragraph from being indented in the printed manual, put -the command @code{@@noindent} on a line by itself before the -paragraph.@refill - -If you mark off a region of the Texinfo file with the @code{@@iftex} -and @w{@code{@@end iftex}} commands, that region will appear only in -the printed copy; in that region, you can use certain commands -borrowed from plain @TeX{} that you cannot use in Info. Likewise, if -you mark off a region with the @code{@@ifinfo} and @code{@@end ifinfo} -commands, that region will appear only in the Info file; in that -region, you can use Info commands that you cannot use in @TeX{}. -Similarly for @code{@@ifhtml @dots{} @@end ifhtml}, -@code{@@ifnothtml @dots{} @@end ifnothtml}, -@code{@@ifnotinfo @dots{} @@end ifnotinfo}, -@code{@@ifnottex @dots{} @@end ifnottex}, -@xref{Conditionals}. - -@cindex Tabs; don't use! -@quotation -@strong{Caution:} Do not use tabs in a Texinfo file! @TeX{} uses -variable-width fonts, which means that it cannot predefine a tab to work -in all circumstances. Consequently, @TeX{} treats tabs like single -spaces, and that is not what they look like. Furthermore, -@code{makeinfo} does nothing special with tabs, and thus a tab character -in your input file may appear differently in the output. - -@noindent -To avoid this problem, Texinfo mode causes GNU Emacs to insert multiple -spaces when you press the @key{TAB} key.@refill - -@noindent -Also, you can run @code{untabify} in Emacs to convert tabs in a region -to multiple spaces.@refill - -@noindent -Don't use tabs. -@end quotation - -@node Comments, Minimum, Conventions, Overview -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Comments - -You can write comments in a Texinfo file that will not appear in -either the Info file or the printed manual by using the -@code{@@comment} command (which may be abbreviated to @code{@@c}). -Such comments are for the person who reads the Texinfo file. All the -text on a line that follows either @code{@@comment} or @code{@@c} is a -comment; the rest of the line does not appear in either the Info file -or the printed manual. (Often, you can write the @code{@@comment} or -@code{@@c} in the middle of a line, and only the text that follows after -the @code{@@comment} or @code{@@c} command does not appear; but some -commands, such as @code{@@settitle} and @code{@@setfilename}, work on a -whole line. You cannot use @code{@@comment} or @code{@@c} in a line -beginning with such a command.)@refill -@cindex Comments -@findex comment -@findex c @r{(comment)} - -You can write long stretches of text that will not appear in either -the Info file or the printed manual by using the @code{@@ignore} and -@code{@@end ignore} commands. Write each of these commands on a line -of its own, starting each command at the beginning of the line. Text -between these two commands does not appear in the processed output. -You can use @code{@@ignore} and @code{@@end ignore} for writing -comments. Often, @code{@@ignore} and @code{@@end ignore} is used -to enclose a part of the copying permissions that applies to the -Texinfo source file of a document, but not to the Info or printed -version of the document.@refill -@cindex Ignored text -@cindex Unprocessed text -@findex ignore -@c !!! Perhaps include this comment about ignore and ifset: -@ignore -Text enclosed by @code{@@ignore} or by failing @code{@@ifset} or -@code{@@ifclear} conditions is ignored in the sense that it will not -contribute to the formatted output. However, TeX and makeinfo must -still parse the ignored text, in order to understand when to -@emph{stop} ignoring text from the source file; that means that you -will still get error messages if you have invalid Texinfo markup -within ignored text. -@end ignore - -@node Minimum, Six Parts, Comments, Overview -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section What a Texinfo File Must Have -@cindex Minimal Texinfo file (requirements) -@cindex Must have in Texinfo file -@cindex Required in Texinfo file -@cindex Texinfo file minimum - -By convention, the names of Texinfo files end with one of the -extensions @file{.texinfo}, @file{.texi}, or @file{.tex}. The longer -extension is preferred since it describes more clearly to a human -reader the nature of the file. The shorter extensions are for -operating systems that cannot handle long file names.@refill - -In order to be made into a printed manual and an Info file, a Texinfo -file @strong{must} begin with lines like this:@refill - -@example -@group -\input texinfo -@@setfilename @var{info-file-name} -@@settitle @var{name-of-manual} -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -The contents of the file follow this beginning, and then you @strong{must} end -a Texinfo file with a line like this:@refill - -@example -@@bye -@end example - -@findex input @r{(@TeX{} command)} -@noindent -The @samp{\input texinfo} line tells @TeX{} to use the -@file{texinfo.tex} file, which tells @TeX{} how to translate the Texinfo -@@-commands into @TeX{} typesetting commands. (Note the use of the -backslash, @samp{\}; this is correct for @TeX{}.) The -@samp{@@setfilename} line provides a name for the Info file and tells -@TeX{} to open auxiliary files. The @samp{@@settitle} line specifies a -title for the page headers (or footers) of the printed manual.@refill - -The @code{@@bye} line at the end of the file on a line of its own tells -the formatters that the file is ended and to stop formatting.@refill - -Usually, you will not use quite such a spare format, but will include -mode setting and start-of-header and end-of-header lines at the -beginning of a Texinfo file, like this:@refill - -@example -@group -\input texinfo @@c -*-texinfo-*- -@@c %**start of header -@@setfilename @var{info-file-name} -@@settitle @var{name-of-manual} -@@c %**end of header -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -In the first line, @samp{-*-texinfo-*-} causes Emacs to switch into -Texinfo mode when you edit the file. - -The @code{@@c} lines which surround the @samp{@@setfilename} and -@samp{@@settitle} lines are optional, but you need them in order to -run @TeX{} or Info on just part of the file. (@xref{Start of Header}, -for more information.)@refill - -Furthermore, you will usually provide a Texinfo file with a title -page, indices, and the like. But the minimum, which can be useful -for short documents, is just the three lines at the beginning and the -one line at the end.@refill - -@node Six Parts, Short Sample, Minimum, Overview -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Six Parts of a Texinfo File - -Generally, a Texinfo file contains more than the minimal -beginning and end---it usually contains six parts:@refill - -@table @r -@item 1. Header -The @dfn{Header} names the file, tells @TeX{} which definitions' file to -use, and performs other ``housekeeping'' tasks.@refill - -@item 2. Summary Description and Copyright -The @dfn{Summary Description and Copyright} segment describes the document -and contains the copyright notice and copying permissions for the Info -file. The segment must be enclosed between @code{@@ifinfo} and -@code{@@end ifinfo} commands so that the formatters place it only in the Info -file.@refill - -@item 3. Title and Copyright -The @dfn{Title and Copyright} segment contains the title and copyright pages -and copying permissions for the printed manual. The segment must be -enclosed between @code{@@titlepage} and @code{@@end titlepage} commands. -The title and copyright page appear only in the printed @w{manual}.@refill - -@item 4. `Top' Node and Master Menu -The @dfn{Master Menu} contains a complete menu of all the nodes in the whole -Info file. It appears only in the Info file, in the `Top' node.@refill - -@item 5. Body -The @dfn{Body} of the document may be structured like a traditional book or -encyclopedia or it may be free form.@refill - -@item 6. End -The @dfn{End} contains commands for printing indices and generating -the table of contents, and the @code{@@bye} command on a line of its -own.@refill -@end table - -@node Short Sample, Acknowledgements, Six Parts, Overview -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section A Short Sample Texinfo File -@cindex Sample Texinfo file - -Here is a complete but very short Texinfo file, in six parts. The first -three parts of the file, from @samp{\input texinfo} through to -@samp{@@end titlepage}, look more intimidating than they are. Most of -the material is standard boilerplate; when you write a manual, simply -insert the names for your own manual in this segment. (@xref{Beginning a -File}.)@refill - -@noindent -In the following, the sample text is @emph{indented}; comments on it are -not. The complete file, without any comments, is shown in -@ref{Sample Texinfo File}. - -@subheading Part 1: Header - -@noindent -The header does not appear in either the Info file or the -printed output. It sets various parameters, including the -name of the Info file and the title used in the header. - -@example -@group -\input texinfo @@c -*-texinfo-*- -@@c %**start of header -@@setfilename sample.info -@@settitle Sample Document -@@c %**end of header - -@@setchapternewpage odd -@end group -@end example - -@subheading Part 2: Summary Description and Copyright - -@noindent -The summary description and copyright segment does not -appear in the printed document. - -@example -@group -@@ifinfo -This is a short example of a complete Texinfo file. - -Copyright @@copyright@{@} 1990 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -@@end ifinfo -@end group -@end example - -@subheading Part 3: Titlepage and Copyright - -@noindent -The titlepage segment does not appear in the Info file. - -@example -@group -@@titlepage -@@sp 10 -@@comment The title is printed in a large font. -@@center @@titlefont@{Sample Title@} -@end group - -@group -@@c The following two commands start the copyright page. -@@page -@@vskip 0pt plus 1filll -Copyright @@copyright@{@} 1990 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -@@end titlepage -@end group -@end example - -@subheading Part 4: `Top' Node and Master Menu - -@noindent -The `Top' node contains the master menu for the Info file. -Since a printed manual uses a table of contents rather than -a menu, the master menu appears only in the Info file. - -@example -@group -@@node Top, First Chapter, , (dir) -@@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@end group -@end example - -@example -@group -@@menu -* First Chapter:: The first chapter is the - only chapter in this sample. -* Concept Index:: This index has two entries. -@@end menu -@end group -@end example - -@subheading Part 5: The Body of the Document - -@noindent -The body segment contains all the text of the document, but not the -indices or table of contents. This example illustrates a node and a -chapter containing an enumerated list.@refill - -@example -@group -@@node First Chapter, Concept Index, Top, Top -@@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@@chapter First Chapter -@@cindex Sample index entry -@end group - -@group -This is the contents of the first chapter. -@@cindex Another sample index entry -@end group - -@group -Here is a numbered list. - -@@enumerate -@@item -This is the first item. - -@@item -This is the second item. -@@end enumerate -@end group - -@group -The @@code@{makeinfo@} and @@code@{texinfo-format-buffer@} -commands transform a Texinfo file such as this into -an Info file; and @@TeX@{@} typesets it for a printed -manual. -@end group -@end example - -@subheading Part 6: The End of the Document - -@noindent -The end segment contains commands both for generating an index in a node -and unnumbered chapter of its own and for generating the table of -contents; and it contains the @code{@@bye} command that marks the end of -the document.@refill - -@example -@group -@@node Concept Index, , First Chapter, Top -@@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@@unnumbered Concept Index -@end group - -@group -@@printindex cp - -@@contents -@@bye -@end group -@end example - -@subheading The Results - -Here is what the contents of the first chapter of the sample look like: - -@sp 1 -@need 700 -@quotation -This is the contents of the first chapter. - -Here is a numbered list. - -@enumerate -@item -This is the first item. - -@item -This is the second item. -@end enumerate - -The @code{makeinfo} and @code{texinfo-format-buffer} -commands transform a Texinfo file such as this into -an Info file; and @TeX{} typesets it for a printed -manual. -@end quotation - -@node Acknowledgements, , Short Sample, Overview -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Acknowledgements - -@cindex Stallman, Richard M. -@cindex Chassell, Robert J. -@cindex Berry, Karl -Richard M.@: Stallman wrote Edition 1.0 of this manual. @w{Robert J.@: -Chassell} revised and extended it, starting with Edition 1.1. Karl -Berry made updates for the Texinfo 3.8 and subsequent releases, starting -with Edition 2.22. - -@cindex Pinard, Fran@,{c}ois -@cindex Zuhn, David D. -@cindex Weisshaus, Melissa -Our thanks go out to all who helped improve this work, particularly to -Fran@,{c}ois Pinard and @w{David D.@: Zuhn}, who tirelessly recorded and -reported mistakes and obscurities; our special thanks go to Melissa -Weisshaus for her frequent and often tedious reviews of nearly similar -editions. Our mistakes are our own. - -Please send suggestions and corrections to: - -@example -@group -@r{Internet address:} - bug-texinfo@@prep.ai.mit.edu -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -Please include the manual's edition number and update date in your messages. - -@node Texinfo Mode, Beginning a File, Overview, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@chapter Using Texinfo Mode -@cindex Texinfo mode -@cindex Mode, using Texinfo -@cindex GNU Emacs -@cindex Emacs - -You may edit a Texinfo file with any text editor you choose. A Texinfo -file is no different from any other @sc{ascii} file. However, GNU Emacs -comes with a special mode, called Texinfo -mode, that provides Emacs commands and tools to help ease your work.@refill - -This chapter describes features of GNU Emacs' Texinfo mode but not any -features of the Texinfo formatting language. If you are reading this -manual straight through from the beginning, you may want to skim through -this chapter briefly and come back to it after reading succeeding -chapters which describe the Texinfo formatting language in -detail.@refill - -@menu -* Texinfo Mode Overview:: How Texinfo mode can help you. -* Emacs Editing:: Texinfo mode adds to GNU Emacs' general - purpose editing features. -* Inserting:: How to insert frequently used @@-commands. -* Showing the Structure:: How to show the structure of a file. -* Updating Nodes and Menus:: How to update or create new nodes and menus. -* Info Formatting:: How to format for Info. -* Printing:: How to format and print part or all of a file. -* Texinfo Mode Summary:: Summary of all the Texinfo mode commands. -@end menu - -@node Texinfo Mode Overview, Emacs Editing, Texinfo Mode, Texinfo Mode -@ifinfo -@heading Texinfo Mode Overview -@end ifinfo - -Texinfo mode provides special features for working with Texinfo -files:@refill - -@itemize @bullet -@item -Insert frequently used @@-commands. @refill - -@item -Automatically create @code{@@node} lines. - -@item -Show the structure of a Texinfo source file.@refill - -@item -Automatically create or update the `Next', -`Previous', and `Up' pointers of a node. - -@item -Automatically create or update menus.@refill - -@item -Automatically create a master menu.@refill - -@item -Format a part or all of a file for Info.@refill - -@item -Typeset and print part or all of a file.@refill -@end itemize - -Perhaps the two most helpful features are those for inserting frequently -used @@-commands and for creating node pointers and menus.@refill - -@node Emacs Editing, Inserting, Texinfo Mode Overview, Texinfo Mode -@section The Usual GNU Emacs Editing Commands - -In most cases, the usual Text mode commands work the same in Texinfo -mode as they do in Text mode. Texinfo mode adds new editing commands -and tools to GNU Emacs' general purpose editing features. The major -difference concerns filling. In Texinfo mode, the paragraph -separation variable and syntax table are redefined so that Texinfo -commands that should be on lines of their own are not inadvertently -included in paragraphs. Thus, the @kbd{M-q} (@code{fill-paragraph}) -command will refill a paragraph but not mix an indexing command on a -line adjacent to it into the paragraph.@refill - -In addition, Texinfo mode sets the @code{page-delimiter} variable to -the value of @code{texinfo-chapter-level-regexp}; by default, this is -a regular expression matching the commands for chapters and their -equivalents, such as appendices. With this value for the page -delimiter, you can jump from chapter title to chapter title with the -@kbd{C-x ]} (@code{forward-page}) and @kbd{C-x [} -(@code{backward-page}) commands and narrow to a chapter with the -@kbd{C-x p} (@code{narrow-to-page}) command. (@xref{Pages, , ,emacs, -The GNU Emacs Manual}, for details about the page commands.)@refill - -You may name a Texinfo file however you wish, but the convention is to -end a Texinfo file name with one of the three extensions -@file{.texinfo}, @file{.texi}, or @file{.tex}. A longer extension is -preferred, since it is explicit, but a shorter extension may be -necessary for operating systems that limit the length of file names. -GNU Emacs automatically enters Texinfo mode when you visit a file with -a @file{.texinfo} or @file{.texi} -extension. Also, Emacs switches to Texinfo mode -when you visit a -file that has @samp{-*-texinfo-*-} in its first line. If ever you are -in another mode and wish to switch to Texinfo mode, type @code{M-x -texinfo-mode}.@refill - -Like all other Emacs features, you can customize or enhance Texinfo -mode as you wish. In particular, the keybindings are very easy to -change. The keybindings described here are the default or standard -ones.@refill - -@node Inserting, Showing the Structure, Emacs Editing, Texinfo Mode -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Inserting Frequently Used Commands -@cindex Inserting frequently used commands -@cindex Frequently used commands, inserting -@cindex Commands, inserting them - -Texinfo mode provides commands to insert various frequently used -@@-commands into the buffer. You can use these commands to save -keystrokes.@refill - -The insert commands are invoked by typing @kbd{C-c} twice and then the -first letter of the @@-command:@refill - -@table @kbd -@item C-c C-c c -@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-@@code -@findex texinfo-insert-@@code -Insert @code{@@code@{@}} and put the -cursor between the braces.@refill - -@item C-c C-c d -@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-@@dfn -@findex texinfo-insert-@@dfn -Insert @code{@@dfn@{@}} and put the -cursor between the braces.@refill - -@item C-c C-c e -@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-@@end -@findex texinfo-insert-@@end -Insert @code{@@end} and attempt to insert the correct following word, -such as @samp{example} or @samp{table}. (This command does not handle -nested lists correctly, but inserts the word appropriate to the -immediately preceding list.)@refill - -@item C-c C-c i -@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-@@item -@findex texinfo-insert-@@item -Insert @code{@@item} and put the -cursor at the beginning of the next line.@refill - -@item C-c C-c k -@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-@@kbd -@findex texinfo-insert-@@kbd -Insert @code{@@kbd@{@}} and put the -cursor between the braces.@refill - -@item C-c C-c n -@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-@@node -@findex texinfo-insert-@@node -Insert @code{@@node} and a comment line -listing the sequence for the `Next', -`Previous', and `Up' nodes. -Leave point after the @code{@@node}.@refill - -@item C-c C-c o -@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-@@noindent -@findex texinfo-insert-@@noindent -Insert @code{@@noindent} and put the -cursor at the beginning of the next line.@refill - -@item C-c C-c s -@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-@@samp -@findex texinfo-insert-@@samp -Insert @code{@@samp@{@}} and put the -cursor between the braces.@refill - -@item C-c C-c t -@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-@@table -@findex texinfo-insert-@@table -Insert @code{@@table} followed by a @key{SPC} -and leave the cursor after the @key{SPC}.@refill - -@item C-c C-c v -@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-@@var -@findex texinfo-insert-@@var -Insert @code{@@var@{@}} and put the -cursor between the braces.@refill - -@item C-c C-c x -@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-@@example -@findex texinfo-insert-@@example -Insert @code{@@example} and put the -cursor at the beginning of the next line.@refill - -@c M-@{ was the binding for texinfo-insert-braces; -@c in Emacs 19, backward-paragraph will take this binding. -@item C-c C-c @{ -@itemx M-x texinfo-insert-braces -@findex texinfo-insert-braces -Insert @code{@{@}} and put the cursor between the braces.@refill - -@item C-c C-c @} -@itemx C-c C-c ] -@itemx M-x up-list -@findex up-list -Move from between a pair of braces forward past the closing brace. -Typing @kbd{C-c C-c ]} is easier than typing @kbd{C-c C-c @}}, which -is, however, more mnemonic; hence the two keybindings. (Also, you can -move out from between braces by typing @kbd{C-f}.)@refill -@end table - -To put a command such as @w{@code{@@code@{@dots{}@}}} around an -@emph{existing} word, position the cursor in front of the word and type -@kbd{C-u 1 C-c C-c c}. This makes it easy to edit existing plain text. -The value of the prefix argument tells Emacs how many words following -point to include between braces---@samp{1} for one word, @samp{2} for -two words, and so on. Use a negative argument to enclose the previous -word or words. If you do not specify a prefix argument, Emacs inserts -the @@-command string and positions the cursor between the braces. This -feature works only for those @@-commands that operate on a word or words -within one line, such as @code{@@kbd} and @code{@@var}.@refill - -This set of insert commands was created after analyzing the frequency -with which different @@-commands are used in the @cite{GNU Emacs -Manual} and the @cite{GDB Manual}. If you wish to add your own insert -commands, you can bind a keyboard macro to a key, use abbreviations, -or extend the code in @file{texinfo.el}.@refill - -@findex texinfo-start-menu-description -@cindex Menu description, start -@cindex Description for menu, start -@kbd{C-c C-c C-d} (@code{texinfo-start-menu-description}) is an insert -command that works differently from the other insert commands. It -inserts a node's section or chapter title in the space for the -description in a menu entry line. (A menu entry has three parts, the -entry name, the node name, and the description. Only the node name is -required, but a description helps explain what the node is about. -@xref{Menu Parts, , The Parts of a Menu}.)@refill - -To use @code{texinfo-start-menu-description}, position point in a menu -entry line and type @kbd{C-c C-c C-d}. The command looks for and copies -the title that goes with the node name, and inserts the title as a -description; it positions point at beginning of the inserted text so you -can edit it. The function does not insert the title if the menu entry -line already contains a description.@refill - -This command is only an aid to writing descriptions; it does not do the -whole job. You must edit the inserted text since a title tends to use -the same words as a node name but a useful description uses different -words.@refill - -@node Showing the Structure, Updating Nodes and Menus, Inserting, Texinfo Mode -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Showing the Section Structure of a File -@cindex Showing the section structure of a file -@cindex Section structure of a file, showing it -@cindex Structure of a file, showing it -@cindex Outline of file structure, showing it -@cindex Contents-like outline of file structure -@cindex File section structure, showing it -@cindex Texinfo file section structure, showing it - -You can show the section structure of a Texinfo file by using the -@kbd{C-c C-s} command (@code{texinfo-show-structure}). This command -shows the section structure of a Texinfo file by listing the lines -that begin with the @@-commands for @code{@@chapter}, -@code{@@section}, and the like. It constructs what amounts -to a table of contents. These lines are displayed in another buffer -called the @samp{*Occur*} buffer. In that buffer, you can position -the cursor over one of the lines and use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command -(@code{occur-mode-goto-occurrence}), to jump to the corresponding spot -in the Texinfo file.@refill - -@table @kbd -@item C-c C-s -@itemx M-x texinfo-show-structure -@findex texinfo-show-structure -Show the @code{@@chapter}, @code{@@section}, and such lines of a -Texinfo file.@refill - -@item C-c C-c -@itemx M-x occur-mode-goto-occurrence -@findex occur-mode-goto-occurrence -Go to the line in the Texinfo file corresponding to the line under the -cursor in the @file{*Occur*} buffer.@refill -@end table - -If you call @code{texinfo-show-structure} with a prefix argument by -typing @w{@kbd{C-u C-c C-s}}, it will list not only those lines with the -@@-commands for @code{@@chapter}, @code{@@section}, and the like, -but also the @code{@@node} lines. (This is how the -@code{texinfo-show-structure} command worked without an argument in -the first version of Texinfo. It was changed because @code{@@node} -lines clutter up the @samp{*Occur*} buffer and are usually not -needed.) You can use @code{texinfo-show-structure} with a prefix -argument to check whether the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers of -an @code{@@node} line are correct.@refill - -Often, when you are working on a manual, you will be interested only -in the structure of the current chapter. In this case, you can mark -off the region of the buffer that you are interested in by using the -@kbd{C-x n n} (@code{narrow-to-region}) command and -@code{texinfo-show-structure} will work on only that region. To see -the whole buffer again, use @w{@kbd{C-x n w}} (@code{widen}). -(@xref{Narrowing, , , emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, for more -information about the narrowing commands.)@refill - -@vindex page-delimiter -@cindex Page delimiter in Texinfo mode -In addition to providing the @code{texinfo-show-structure} command, -Texinfo mode sets the value of the page delimiter variable to match -the chapter-level @@-commands. This enables you to use the @kbd{C-x -]} (@code{forward-page}) and @kbd{C-x [} (@code{backward-page}) -commands to move forward and backward by chapter, and to use the -@kbd{C-x p} (@code{narrow-to-page}) command to narrow to a chapter. -@xref{Pages, , , emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, for more information -about the page commands.@refill - -@node Updating Nodes and Menus, Info Formatting, Showing the Structure, Texinfo Mode -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Updating Nodes and Menus -@cindex Updating nodes and menus -@cindex Create nodes, menus automatically -@cindex Insert nodes, menus automatically -@cindex Automatically insert nodes, menus - -Texinfo mode provides commands for automatically creating or updating -menus and node pointers. The commands are called ``update'' commands -because their most frequent use is for updating a Texinfo file after -you have worked on it; but you can use them to insert the `Next', -`Previous', and `Up' pointers into an @code{@@node} line that has none and to -create menus in a file that has none.@refill - -If you do not use the updating commands, you need to write menus and -node pointers by hand, which is a tedious task.@refill - -@menu -* Updating Commands:: Five major updating commands. -* Updating Requirements:: How to structure a Texinfo file for - using the updating command. -* Other Updating Commands:: How to indent descriptions, insert - missing nodes lines, and update - nodes in sequence. -@end menu - -@node Updating Commands, Updating Requirements, Updating Nodes and Menus, Updating Nodes and Menus -@ifinfo -@subheading The Updating Commands -@end ifinfo - -You can use the updating commands@refill - -@itemize @bullet -@item -to insert or update the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers of a -node,@refill - -@item -to insert or update the menu for a section, and@refill - -@item -to create a master menu for a Texinfo source file.@refill -@end itemize - -You can also use the commands to update all the nodes and menus in a -region or in a whole Texinfo file.@refill - -The updating commands work only with conventional Texinfo files, which -are structured hierarchically like books. In such files, a structuring -command line must follow closely after each @code{@@node} line, except -for the `Top' @code{@@node} line. (A @dfn{structuring command line} is -a line beginning with @code{@@chapter}, @code{@@section}, or other -similar command.) - -You can write the structuring command line on the line that follows -immediately after an @code{@@node} line or else on the line that -follows after a single @code{@@comment} line or a single -@code{@@ifinfo} line. You cannot interpose more than one line between -the @code{@@node} line and the structuring command line; and you may -interpose only an @code{@@comment} line or an @code{@@ifinfo} line. - -Commands which work on a whole buffer require that the `Top' node be -followed by a node with an @code{@@chapter} or equivalent-level command. -Note that the menu updating commands will not create a main or master -menu for a Texinfo file that has only @code{@@chapter}-level nodes! The -menu updating commands only create menus @emph{within} nodes for lower level -nodes. To create a menu of chapters, you must provide a `Top' -node.@refill - -The menu updating commands remove menu entries that refer to other Info -files since they do not refer to nodes within the current buffer. This -is a deficiency. Rather than use menu entries, you can use cross -references to refer to other Info files. None of the updating commands -affect cross references.@refill - -Texinfo mode has five updating commands that are used most often: two -are for updating the node pointers or menu of a single node (or a -region); two are for updating every node pointer and menu in a file; -and one, the @code{texinfo-master-menu} command, is for creating a -master menu for a complete file, and optionally, for updating every -node and menu in the whole Texinfo file.@refill - -The @code{texinfo-master-menu} command is the primary command:@refill - -@table @kbd -@item C-c C-u m -@itemx M-x texinfo-master-menu -@findex texinfo-master-menu -Create or update a master menu that includes all the other menus -(incorporating the descriptions from pre-existing menus, if -any).@refill - -With an argument (prefix argument, @kbd{C-u,} if interactive), first create or -update all the nodes and all the regular menus in the buffer before -constructing the master menu. (@xref{The Top Node, , The Top Node and -Master Menu}, for more about a master menu.)@refill - -For @code{texinfo-master-menu} to work, the Texinfo file must have a -`Top' node and at least one subsequent node.@refill - -After extensively editing a Texinfo file, you can type the following: - -@example -C-u M-x texinfo-master-menu -@exdent or -C-u C-c C-u m -@end example - -@noindent -This updates all the nodes and menus completely and all at once.@refill -@end table - -The other major updating commands do smaller jobs and are designed for -the person who updates nodes and menus as he or she writes a Texinfo -file.@refill - -@need 1000 -The commands are:@refill - -@table @kbd -@item C-c C-u C-n -@itemx M-x texinfo-update-node -@findex texinfo-update-node -Insert the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers for the node that point is -within (i.e., for the @code{@@node} line preceding point). If the -@code{@@node} line has pre-existing `Next', `Previous', or `Up' -pointers in it, the old pointers are removed and new ones inserted. -With an argument (prefix argument, @kbd{C-u}, if interactive), this command -updates all @code{@@node} lines in the region (which is the text -between point and mark).@refill - -@item C-c C-u C-m -@itemx M-x texinfo-make-menu -@findex texinfo-make-menu -Create or update the menu in the node that point is within. -With an argument (@kbd{C-u} as prefix argument, if -interactive), the command makes or updates menus for the -nodes which are either within or a part of the -region.@refill - -Whenever @code{texinfo-make-menu} updates an existing menu, the -descriptions from that menu are incorporated into the new menu. This -is done by copying descriptions from the existing menu to the entries -in the new menu that have the same node names. If the node names are -different, the descriptions are not copied to the new menu.@refill - -@item C-c C-u C-e -@itemx M-x texinfo-every-node-update -@findex texinfo-every-node-update -Insert or update the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers for every -node in the buffer.@refill - -@item C-c C-u C-a -@itemx M-x texinfo-all-menus-update -@findex texinfo-all-menus-update -Create or update all the menus in the buffer. With an argument -(@kbd{C-u} as prefix argument, if interactive), first insert -or update all the node -pointers before working on the menus.@refill - -If a master menu exists, the @code{texinfo-all-menus-update} command -updates it; but the command does not create a new master menu if none -already exists. (Use the @code{texinfo-master-menu} command for -that.)@refill - -When working on a document that does not merit a master menu, you can -type the following: - -@example -C-u C-c C-u C-a -@exdent or -C-u M-x texinfo-all-menus-update -@end example - -@noindent -This updates all the nodes and menus.@refill -@end table - -The @code{texinfo-column-for-description} variable specifies the -column to which menu descriptions are indented. By default, the value -is 32 although it is often useful to reduce it to as low as 24. You -can set the variable with the @kbd{M-x edit-options} command -(@pxref{Edit Options, , Editing Variable Values, emacs, The GNU Emacs -Manual}) or with the @kbd{M-x set-variable} command (@pxref{Examining, -, Examining and Setting Variables, emacs, The GNU Emacs -Manual}).@refill - -Also, the @code{texinfo-indent-menu-description} command may be used to -indent existing menu descriptions to a specified column. Finally, if -you wish, you can use the @code{texinfo-insert-node-lines} command to -insert missing @code{@@node} lines into a file. (@xref{Other Updating -Commands}, for more information.)@refill - -@node Updating Requirements, Other Updating Commands, Updating Commands, Updating Nodes and Menus -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection Updating Requirements -@cindex Updating requirements -@cindex Requirements for updating commands - -To use the updating commands, you must organize the Texinfo file -hierarchically with chapters, sections, subsections, and the like. -When you construct the hierarchy of the manual, do not `jump down' -more than one level at a time: you can follow the `Top' node with a -chapter, but not with a section; you can follow a chapter with a -section, but not with a subsection. However, you may `jump up' any -number of levels at one time---for example, from a subsection to a -chapter.@refill - -Each @code{@@node} line, with the exception of the line for the `Top' -node, must be followed by a line with a structuring command such as -@code{@@chapter}, @code{@@section}, or -@code{@@unnumberedsubsec}.@refill - -Each @code{@@node} line/structuring-command line combination -must look either like this:@refill - -@example -@group -@@node Comments, Minimum, Conventions, Overview -@@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@@section Comments -@end group -@end example - -or like this (without the @code{@@comment} line): - -@example -@group -@@node Comments, Minimum, Conventions, Overview -@@section Comments -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -In this example, `Comments' is the name of both the node and the -section. The next node is called `Minimum' and the previous node is -called `Conventions'. The `Comments' section is within the `Overview' -node, which is specified by the `Up' pointer. (Instead of an -@code{@@comment} line, you can write an @code{@@ifinfo} line.)@refill - -If a file has a `Top' node, it must be called @samp{top} or @samp{Top} -and be the first node in the file.@refill - -The menu updating commands create a menu of sections within a chapter, -a menu of subsections within a section, and so on. This means that -you must have a `Top' node if you want a menu of chapters.@refill - -Incidentally, the @code{makeinfo} command will create an Info file for -a hierarchically organized Texinfo file that lacks `Next', `Previous' -and `Up' pointers. Thus, if you can be sure that your Texinfo file -will be formatted with @code{makeinfo}, you have no need for the -`update node' commands. (@xref{Create an Info File, , Creating an -Info File}, for more information about @code{makeinfo}.) However, -both @code{makeinfo} and the @code{texinfo-format-@dots{}} commands -require that you insert menus in the file.@refill - -@node Other Updating Commands, , Updating Requirements, Updating Nodes and Menus -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection Other Updating Commands - -In addition to the five major updating commands, Texinfo mode -possesses several less frequently used updating commands:@refill - -@table @kbd -@item M-x texinfo-insert-node-lines -@findex texinfo-insert-node-lines -Insert @code{@@node} lines before the @code{@@chapter}, -@code{@@section}, and other sectioning commands wherever they are -missing throughout a region in a Texinfo file.@refill - -With an argument (@kbd{C-u} as prefix argument, if interactive), the -@code{texinfo-insert-node-lines} command not only inserts -@code{@@node} lines but also inserts the chapter or section titles as -the names of the corresponding nodes. In addition, it inserts the -titles as node names in pre-existing @code{@@node} lines that lack -names. Since node names should be more concise than section or -chapter titles, you must manually edit node names so inserted.@refill - -For example, the following marks a whole buffer as a region and inserts -@code{@@node} lines and titles throughout:@refill - -@example -C-x h C-u M-x texinfo-insert-node-lines -@end example - -(Note that this command inserts titles as node names in @code{@@node} -lines; the @code{texinfo-start-menu-description} command -(@pxref{Inserting, Inserting Frequently Used Commands}) inserts titles -as descriptions in menu entries, a different action. However, in both -cases, you need to edit the inserted text.)@refill - -@item M-x texinfo-multiple-files-update -@findex texinfo-multiple-files-update @r{(in brief)} -Update nodes and menus in a document built from several separate files. -With @kbd{C-u} as a prefix argument, create and insert a master menu in -the outer file. With a numeric prefix argument, such as @kbd{C-u 2}, first -update all the menus and all the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers -of all the included files before creating and inserting a master menu in -the outer file. The @code{texinfo-multiple-files-update} command is -described in the appendix on @code{@@include} files. -@ifinfo -@xref{texinfo-multiple-files-update}.@refill -@end ifinfo -@iftex -@xref{texinfo-multiple-files-update, , -@code{texinfo-multiple-files-update}}.@refill -@end iftex - -@item M-x texinfo-indent-menu-description -@findex texinfo-indent-menu-description -Indent every description in the menu following point to the specified -column. You can use this command to give yourself more space for -descriptions. With an argument (@kbd{C-u} as prefix argument, if -interactive), the @code{texinfo-indent-menu-description} command indents -every description in every menu in the region. However, this command -does not indent the second and subsequent lines of a multi-line -description.@refill - -@item M-x texinfo-sequential-node-update -@findex texinfo-sequential-node-update -Insert the names of the nodes immediately following and preceding the -current node as the `Next' or `Previous' pointers regardless of those -nodes' hierarchical level. This means that the `Next' node of a -subsection may well be the next chapter. Sequentially ordered nodes are -useful for novels and other documents that you read through -sequentially. (However, in Info, the @kbd{g *} command lets -you look through the file sequentially, so sequentially ordered nodes -are not strictly necessary.) With an argument (prefix argument, if -interactive), the @code{texinfo-sequential-node-update} command -sequentially updates all the nodes in the region.@refill -@end table - -@node Info Formatting, Printing, Updating Nodes and Menus, Texinfo Mode -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Formatting for Info -@cindex Formatting for Info -@cindex Running an Info formatter -@cindex Info formatting - -Texinfo mode provides several commands for formatting part or all of a -Texinfo file for Info. Often, when you are writing a document, you -want to format only part of a file---that is, a region.@refill - -You can use either the @code{texinfo-format-region} or the -@code{makeinfo-region} command to format a region:@refill - -@table @kbd -@findex texinfo-format-region -@item C-c C-e C-r -@itemx M-x texinfo-format-region -@itemx C-c C-m C-r -@itemx M-x makeinfo-region -Format the current region for Info.@refill -@end table - -You can use either the @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or the -@code{makeinfo-buffer} command to format a whole buffer:@refill - -@table @kbd -@findex texinfo-format-buffer -@item C-c C-e C-b -@itemx M-x texinfo-format-buffer -@itemx C-c C-m C-b -@itemx M-x makeinfo-buffer -Format the current buffer for Info.@refill -@end table - -@need 1000 -For example, after writing a Texinfo file, you can type the following: - -@example -C-u C-c C-u m -@exdent or -C-u M-x texinfo-master-menu -@end example - -@noindent -This updates all the nodes and menus. Then type the following to create -an Info file: - -@example -C-c C-m C-b -@exdent or -M-x makeinfo-buffer -@end example - -For @TeX{} or the Info formatting commands to work, the file @emph{must} -include a line that has @code{@@setfilename} in its header.@refill - -@xref{Create an Info File}, for details about Info formatting.@refill - -@node Printing, Texinfo Mode Summary, Info Formatting, Texinfo Mode -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Formatting and Printing -@cindex Formatting for printing -@cindex Printing a region or buffer -@cindex Region formatting and printing -@cindex Buffer formatting and printing -@cindex Part of file formatting and printing - -Typesetting and printing a Texinfo file is a multi-step process in which -you first create a file for printing (called a DVI file), and then -print the file. Optionally, you may also create indices. To do this, -you must run the @code{texindex} command after first running the -@code{tex} typesetting command; and then you must run the @code{tex} -command again. Or else run the @code{texi2dvi} command which -automatically creates indices as needed.@refill - -Often, when you are writing a document, you want to typeset and print -only part of a file to see what it will look like. You can use the -@code{texinfo-tex-region} and related commands for this purpose. Use -the @code{texinfo-tex-buffer} command to format all of a -buffer.@refill - -@table @kbd -@item C-c C-t C-b -@itemx M-x texinfo-tex-buffer -@findex texinfo-tex-buffer -Run @code{texi2dvi} on the buffer. In addition to running @TeX{} on the -buffer, this command automatically creates or updates indices as -needed.@refill - -@item C-c C-t C-r -@itemx M-x texinfo-tex-region -@findex texinfo-tex-region -Run @TeX{} on the region.@refill - -@item C-c C-t C-i -@itemx M-x texinfo-texindex -Run @code{texindex} to sort the indices of a Texinfo file formatted with -@code{texinfo-tex-region}. The @code{texinfo-tex-region} command does -not run @code{texindex} automatically; it only runs the @code{tex} -typesetting command. You must run the @code{texinfo-tex-region} command -a second time after sorting the raw index files with the @code{texindex} -command. (Usually, you do not format an index when you format a region, -only when you format a buffer. Now that the @code{texi2dvi} command -exists, there is little or no need for this command.)@refill - -@item C-c C-t C-p -@itemx M-x texinfo-tex-print -@findex texinfo-tex-print -Print the file (or the part of the file) previously formatted with -@code{texinfo-tex-buffer} or @code{texinfo-tex-region}.@refill -@end table - -For @code{texinfo-tex-region} or @code{texinfo-tex-buffer} to work, the -file @emph{must} start with a @samp{\input texinfo} line and must -include an @code{@@settitle} line. The file must end with @code{@@bye} -on a line by itself. (When you use @code{texinfo-tex-region}, you must -surround the @code{@@settitle} line with start-of-header and -end-of-header lines.)@refill - -@xref{Format/Print Hardcopy}, for a description of the other @TeX{} related -commands, such as @code{tex-show-print-queue}.@refill - -@node Texinfo Mode Summary, , Printing, Texinfo Mode -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Texinfo Mode Summary - -In Texinfo mode, each set of commands has default keybindings that -begin with the same keys. All the commands that are custom-created -for Texinfo mode begin with @kbd{C-c}. The keys are somewhat -mnemonic.@refill - -@subheading Insert Commands - -The insert commands are invoked by typing @kbd{C-c} twice and then the -first letter of the @@-command to be inserted. (It might make more -sense mnemonically to use @kbd{C-c C-i}, for `custom insert', but -@kbd{C-c C-c} is quick to type.)@refill - -@example -C-c C-c c @r{Insert} @samp{@@code}. -C-c C-c d @r{Insert} @samp{@@dfn}. -C-c C-c e @r{Insert} @samp{@@end}. -C-c C-c i @r{Insert} @samp{@@item}. -C-c C-c n @r{Insert} @samp{@@node}. -C-c C-c s @r{Insert} @samp{@@samp}. -C-c C-c v @r{Insert} @samp{@@var}. -C-c C-c @{ @r{Insert braces.} -C-c C-c ] -C-c C-c @} @r{Move out of enclosing braces.} - -@group -C-c C-c C-d @r{Insert a node's section title} - @r{in the space for the description} - @r{in a menu entry line.} -@end group -@end example - -@subheading Show Structure - -The @code{texinfo-show-structure} command is often used within a -narrowed region.@refill - -@example -C-c C-s @r{List all the headings.} -@end example - -@subheading The Master Update Command - -The @code{texinfo-master-menu} command creates a master menu; and can -be used to update every node and menu in a file as well.@refill - -@example -@group -C-c C-u m -M-x texinfo-master-menu - @r{Create or update a master menu.} -@end group - -@group -C-u C-c C-u m @r{With @kbd{C-u} as a prefix argument, first} - @r{create or update all nodes and regular} - @r{menus, and then create a master menu.} -@end group -@end example - -@subheading Update Pointers - -The update pointer commands are invoked by typing @kbd{C-c C-u} and -then either @kbd{C-n} for @code{texinfo-update-node} or @kbd{C-e} for -@code{texinfo-every-node-update}.@refill - -@example -C-c C-u C-n @r{Update a node.} -C-c C-u C-e @r{Update every node in the buffer.} -@end example - -@subheading Update Menus - -Invoke the update menu commands by typing @kbd{C-c C-u} -and then either @kbd{C-m} for @code{texinfo-make-menu} or -@kbd{C-a} for @code{texinfo-all-menus-update}. To update -both nodes and menus at the same time, precede @kbd{C-c C-u -C-a} with @kbd{C-u}.@refill - -@example -C-c C-u C-m @r{Make or update a menu.} - -@group -C-c C-u C-a @r{Make or update all} - @r{menus in a buffer.} -@end group - -@group -C-u C-c C-u C-a @r{With @kbd{C-u} as a prefix argument,} - @r{first create or update all nodes and} - @r{then create or update all menus.} -@end group -@end example - -@subheading Format for Info - -The Info formatting commands that are written in Emacs Lisp are -invoked by typing @kbd{C-c C-e} and then either @kbd{C-r} for a region -or @kbd{C-b} for the whole buffer.@refill - -The Info formatting commands that are written in C and based on the -@code{makeinfo} program are invoked by typing @kbd{C-c C-m} and then -either @kbd{C-r} for a region or @kbd{C-b} for the whole buffer.@refill - -@need 800 -@noindent -Use the @code{texinfo-format@dots{}} commands: - -@example -@group -C-c C-e C-r @r{Format the region.} -C-c C-e C-b @r{Format the buffer.} -@end group -@end example - -@need 750 -@noindent -Use @code{makeinfo}: - -@example -C-c C-m C-r @r{Format the region.} -C-c C-m C-b @r{Format the buffer.} -C-c C-m C-l @r{Recenter the @code{makeinfo} output buffer.} -C-c C-m C-k @r{Kill the @code{makeinfo} formatting job.} -@end example - -@subheading Typeset and Print - -The @TeX{} typesetting and printing commands are invoked by typing -@kbd{C-c C-t} and then another control command: @kbd{C-r} for -@code{texinfo-tex-region}, @kbd{C-b} for @code{texinfo-tex-buffer}, -and so on.@refill - -@example -C-c C-t C-r @r{Run @TeX{} on the region.} -C-c C-t C-b @r{Run} @code{texi2dvi} @r{on the buffer.} -C-c C-t C-i @r{Run} @code{texindex}. -C-c C-t C-p @r{Print the DVI file.} -C-c C-t C-q @r{Show the print queue.} -C-c C-t C-d @r{Delete a job from the print queue.} -C-c C-t C-k @r{Kill the current @TeX{} formatting job.} -C-c C-t C-x @r{Quit a currently stopped @TeX{} formatting job.} -C-c C-t C-l @r{Recenter the output buffer.} -@end example - -@subheading Other Updating Commands - -The `other updating commands' do not have standard keybindings because -they are rarely used. - -@example -@group -M-x texinfo-insert-node-lines - @r{Insert missing @code{@@node} lines in region.} - @r{With @kbd{C-u} as a prefix argument,} - @r{use section titles as node names.} -@end group - -@group -M-x texinfo-multiple-files-update - @r{Update a multi-file document.} - @r{With @kbd{C-u 2} as a prefix argument,} - @r{create or update all nodes and menus} - @r{in all included files first.} -@end group - -@group -M-x texinfo-indent-menu-description - @r{Indent descriptions.} -@end group - -@group -M-x texinfo-sequential-node-update - @r{Insert node pointers in strict sequence.} -@end group -@end example - -@node Beginning a File, Ending a File, Texinfo Mode, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@chapter Beginning a Texinfo File -@cindex Beginning a Texinfo file -@cindex Texinfo file beginning -@cindex File beginning - -Certain pieces of information must be provided at the beginning of a -Texinfo file, such as the name of the file and the title of the -document.@refill - -@menu -* Four Parts:: Four parts begin a Texinfo file. -* Sample Beginning:: Here is a sample beginning for a Texinfo file. -* Header:: The very beginning of a Texinfo file. -* Info Summary and Permissions:: Summary and copying permissions for Info. -* Titlepage & Copyright Page:: Creating the title and copyright pages. -* The Top Node:: Creating the `Top' node and master menu. -* Software Copying Permissions:: Ensure that you and others continue to - have the right to use and share software. -@end menu - -@node Four Parts, Sample Beginning, Beginning a File, Beginning a File -@ifinfo -@heading Four Parts Begin a File -@end ifinfo - -Generally, the beginning of a Texinfo file has four parts:@refill - -@enumerate -@item -The header, delimited by special comment lines, that includes the -commands for naming the Texinfo file and telling @TeX{} what -definitions file to use when processing the Texinfo file.@refill - -@item -A short statement of what the file is about, with a copyright notice -and copying permissions. This is enclosed in @code{@@ifinfo} and -@code{@@end ifinfo} commands so that the formatters place it only -in the Info file.@refill - -@item -A title page and copyright page, with a copyright notice and copying -permissions. This is enclosed between @code{@@titlepage} and -@code{@@end titlepage} commands. The title and copyright page appear -only in the printed @w{manual}.@refill - -@item -The `Top' node that contains a menu for the whole Info file. The -contents of this node appear only in the Info file.@refill -@end enumerate - -Also, optionally, you may include the copying conditions for a program -and a warranty disclaimer. The copying section will be followed by an -introduction or else by the first chapter of the manual.@refill - -Since the copyright notice and copying permissions for the Texinfo -document (in contrast to the copying permissions for a program) are in -parts that appear only in the Info file or only in the printed manual, -this information must be given twice.@refill - -@node Sample Beginning, Header, Four Parts, Beginning a File -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Sample Texinfo File Beginning - -The following sample shows what is needed.@refill - -@example -\input texinfo @@c -*-texinfo-*- -@@c %**start of header -@@setfilename @var{name-of-info-file} -@@settitle @var{name-of-manual} -@@setchapternewpage odd -@@c %**end of header - -@@ifinfo -This file documents @dots{} - -Copyright @var{year} @var{copyright-owner} - -@group -Permission is granted to @dots{} -@@end ifinfo -@end group - -@group -@@c This title page illustrates only one of the -@@c two methods of forming a title page. -@end group - -@group -@@titlepage -@@title @var{name-of-manual-when-printed} -@@subtitle @var{subtitle-if-any} -@@subtitle @var{second-subtitle} -@@author @var{author} -@end group - -@group -@@c The following two commands -@@c start the copyright page. -@@page -@@vskip 0pt plus 1filll -Copyright @@copyright@{@} @var{year} @var{copyright-owner} -@end group - -Published by @dots{} - -Permission is granted to @dots{} -@@end titlepage - -@@node Top, Overview, , (dir) - -@@ifinfo -This document describes @dots{} - -This document applies to version @dots{} -of the program named @dots{} -@@end ifinfo - -@group -@@menu -* Copying:: Your rights and freedoms. -* First Chapter:: Getting started @dots{} -* Second Chapter:: @dots{} - @dots{} - @dots{} -@@end menu -@end group - -@group -@@node First Chapter, Second Chapter, top, top -@@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@@chapter First Chapter -@@cindex Index entry for First Chapter -@end group -@end example - -@node Header, Info Summary and Permissions, Sample Beginning, Beginning a File -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section The Texinfo File Header -@cindex Header for Texinfo files -@cindex Texinfo file header - -Texinfo files start with at least three lines that provide Info and -@TeX{} with necessary information. These are the @code{\input -texinfo} line, the @code{@@settitle} line, and the -@code{@@setfilename} line. If you want to run @TeX{} on just a part -of the Texinfo File, you must write the @code{@@settitle} -and @code{@@setfilename} lines between start-of-header and end-of-header -lines.@refill - -Thus, the beginning of a Texinfo file looks like this: - -@example -@group -\input texinfo @@c -*-texinfo-*- -@@setfilename sample.info -@@settitle Sample Document -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -or else like this: - -@example -@group -\input texinfo @@c -*-texinfo-*- -@@c %**start of header -@@setfilename sample.info -@@settitle Sample Document -@@c %**end of header -@end group -@end example - -@menu -* First Line:: The first line of a Texinfo file. -* Start of Header:: Formatting a region requires this. -* setfilename:: Tell Info the name of the Info file. -* settitle:: Create a title for the printed work. -* setchapternewpage:: Start chapters on right-hand pages. -* paragraphindent:: An option to specify paragraph indentation. -* End of Header:: Formatting a region requires this. -@end menu - -@node First Line, Start of Header, Header, Header -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection The First Line of a Texinfo File -@cindex First line of a Texinfo file -@cindex Beginning line of a Texinfo file -@cindex Header of a Texinfo file - -Every Texinfo file that is to be the top-level input to @TeX{} must begin -with a line that looks like this:@refill - -@example -\input texinfo @@c -*-texinfo-*- -@end example - -@noindent -This line serves two functions: - -@enumerate -@item -When the file is processed by @TeX{}, the @samp{\input texinfo} command -tells @TeX{} to load the macros needed for processing a Texinfo file. -These are in a file called @file{texinfo.tex}, which is usually located -in the @file{/usr/lib/tex/macros} directory. @TeX{} uses the backslash, -@samp{\}, to mark the beginning of a command, just as Texinfo uses -@samp{@@}. The @file{texinfo.tex} file causes the switch from @samp{\} -to @samp{@@}; before the switch occurs, @TeX{} requires @samp{\}, which -is why it appears at the beginning of the file.@refill - -@item -When the file is edited in GNU Emacs, the @samp{-*-texinfo-*-} mode -specification tells Emacs to use Texinfo mode.@refill -@end enumerate - -@node Start of Header, setfilename, First Line, Header -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection Start of Header -@cindex Start of header line - -Write a start-of-header line on the second line of a Texinfo file. -Follow the start-of-header line with @code{@@setfilename} and -@code{@@settitle} lines and, optionally, with other command lines, such -as @code{@@smallbook} or @code{@@footnotestyle}; and then by an -end-of-header line (@pxref{End of Header}).@refill - -With these lines, you can format part of a Texinfo file for Info or -typeset part for printing.@refill - -A start-of-header line looks like this:@refill - -@example -@@c %**start of header -@end example - -The odd string of characters, @samp{%**}, is to ensure that no other -comment is accidentally taken for a start-of-header line.@refill - -@node setfilename, settitle, Start of Header, Header -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection @code{@@setfilename} -@cindex Info file requires @code{@@setfilename} -@findex setfilename - -In order to serve as the primary input file for either @code{makeinfo} -or @TeX{}, a Texinfo file must contain a line that looks like this: - -@example -@@setfilename @var{info-file-name} -@end example - -Write the @code{@@setfilename} command at the beginning of a line and -follow it on the same line by the Info file name. Do not write anything -else on the line; anything on the line after the command is considered -part of the file name, including what would otherwise be a -comment. - -The @code{@@setfilename} line specifies the name of the Info file to be -generated. This name should be different from the name of the Texinfo -file. There are two conventions for choosing the name: you can either -remove the @samp{.texi} extension from the input file name, or replace -it with the @samp{.info} extension. - -Some operating systems cannot handle long file names. You can run into -a problem even when the file name you specify is itself short enough. -This occurs because the Info formatters split a long Info file into -short indirect subfiles, and name them by appending @samp{-1}, -@samp{-2}, @dots{}, @samp{-10}, @samp{-11}, and so on, to the original -file name. (@xref{Tag and Split Files, , Tag Files and Split Files}.) -The subfile name @file{texinfo.info-10}, for example, is too long for -some systems; so the Info file name for this document is @file{texinfo} -rather than @file{texinfo.info}. - -@cindex Ignored before @code{@@setfilename} -The Info formatting commands ignore everything written before the -@code{@@setfilename} line, which is why the very first line of -the file (the @code{\input} line) does not show up in the output. - -@pindex texinfo.cnf -The @code{@@setfilename} line produces no output when you typeset a -manual with @TeX{}, but it nevertheless is essential: it opens the -index, cross-reference, and other auxiliary files used by Texinfo, and -also reads @file{texinfo.cnf} if that file is present on your system -(@pxref{Preparing for TeX,, Preparing to Use @TeX{}}). - - -@node settitle, setchapternewpage, setfilename, Header -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection @code{@@settitle} -@findex settitle - -In order to be made into a printed manual, a Texinfo file must contain -a line that looks like this:@refill - -@example -@@settitle @var{title} -@end example - -Write the @code{@@settitle} command at the beginning of a line and -follow it on the same line by the title. This tells @TeX{} the title -to use in a header or footer. Do not write anything else on the line; -anything on the line after the command is considered part of the -title, including a comment.@refill - -Conventionally, when @TeX{} formats a Texinfo file for double-sided -output, the title is printed in the left-hand (even-numbered) page -headings and the current chapter title is printed in the right-hand -(odd-numbered) page headings. (@TeX{} learns the title of each chapter -from each @code{@@chapter} command.) Page footers are not -printed.@refill - -Even if you are printing in a single-sided style, @TeX{} looks for an -@code{@@settitle} command line, in case you include the manual title -in the heading. @refill - -The @code{@@settitle} command should precede everything that generates -actual output in @TeX{}.@refill - -Although the title in the @code{@@settitle} command is usually the -same as the title on the title page, it does not affect the title as -it appears on the title page. Thus, the two do not need not match -exactly; and the title in the @code{@@settitle} command can be a -shortened or expanded version of the title as it appears on the title -page. (@xref{titlepage, , @code{@@titlepage}}.)@refill - -@TeX{} prints page headings only for that text that comes after the -@code{@@end titlepage} command in the Texinfo file, or that comes -after an @code{@@headings} command that turns on headings. -(@xref{headings on off, , The @code{@@headings} Command}, for more -information.)@refill - -You may, if you wish, create your own, customized headings and -footings. @xref{Headings, , Page Headings}, for a detailed discussion -of this process.@refill - -@node setchapternewpage, paragraphindent, settitle, Header -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection @code{@@setchapternewpage} -@cindex Starting chapters -@cindex Pages, starting odd -@findex setchapternewpage - -In a book or a manual, text is usually printed on both sides of the -paper, chapters start on right-hand pages, and right-hand pages have -odd numbers. But in short reports, text often is printed only on one -side of the paper. Also in short reports, chapters sometimes do not -start on new pages, but are printed on the same page as the end of the -preceding chapter, after a small amount of vertical whitespace.@refill - -You can use the @code{@@setchapternewpage} command with various -arguments to specify how @TeX{} should start chapters and whether it -should typeset pages for printing on one or both sides of the paper -(single-sided or double-sided printing).@refill - -Write the @code{@@setchapternewpage} command at the beginning of a -line followed by its argument.@refill - -For example, you would write the following to cause each chapter to -start on a fresh odd-numbered page:@refill - -@example -@@setchapternewpage odd -@end example - -You can specify one of three alternatives with the -@code{@@setchapternewpage} command:@refill - -@table @asis -@ignore -@item No @code{@@setchapternewpage} command -If the Texinfo file does not contain an @code{@@setchapternewpage} -command before the @code{@@titlepage} command, @TeX{} automatically -begins chapters on new pages and prints headings in the standard -format for single-sided printing. This is the conventional format for -single-sided printing.@refill - -The result is exactly the same as when you write -@code{@@setchapternewpage on}.@refill -@end ignore -@item @code{@@setchapternewpage off} -Cause @TeX{} to typeset a new chapter on the same page as the last -chapter, after skipping some vertical whitespace. Also, cause @TeX{} to -format page headers for single-sided printing. (You can override the -headers format with the @code{@@headings double} command; see -@ref{headings on off, , The @code{@@headings} Command}.)@refill - -@item @code{@@setchapternewpage on} -Cause @TeX{} to start new chapters on new pages and to typeset page -headers for single-sided printing. This is the form most often -used for short reports.@refill - -This alternative is the default.@refill - -@item @code{@@setchapternewpage odd} -Cause @TeX{} to start new chapters on new, odd-numbered pages -(right-handed pages) and to typeset for double-sided printing. This is -the form most often used for books and manuals.@refill -@end table - -@noindent -Texinfo does not have an @code{@@setchapternewpage even} command.@refill - -@noindent -(You can countermand or modify an @code{@@setchapternewpage} command -with an @code{@@headings} command. @xref{headings on off, , The -@code{@@headings} Command}.)@refill - -At the beginning of a manual or book, pages are not numbered---for -example, the title and copyright pages of a book are not numbered. -By convention, table of contents pages are numbered with roman -numerals and not in sequence with the rest of the document.@refill - -Since an Info file does not have pages, the @code{@@setchapternewpage} -command has no effect on it.@refill - -Usually, you do not write an @code{@@setchapternewpage} command for -single-sided printing, but accept the default which is to typeset for -single-sided printing and to start new chapters on new pages. Usually, -you write an @code{@@setchapternewpage odd} command for double-sided -printing.@refill - -@node paragraphindent, End of Header, setchapternewpage, Header -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection Paragraph Indenting -@cindex Indenting paragraphs -@cindex Paragraph indentation -@findex paragraphindent - -The Info formatting commands may insert spaces at the beginning of the -first line of each paragraph, thereby indenting that paragraph. You -can use the @code{@@paragraphindent} command to specify the -indentation. Write an @code{@@paragraphindent} command at the -beginning of a line followed by either @samp{asis} or a number. The -template is:@refill - -@example -@@paragraphindent @var{indent} -@end example - -The Info formatting commands indent according to the value of -@var{indent}:@refill - -@itemize @bullet -@item -If the value of @var{indent} is @samp{asis}, the Info formatting -commands do not change the existing indentation.@refill - -@item -If the value of @var{indent} is zero, the Info formatting commands delete -existing indentation.@refill - -@item -If the value of @var{indent} is greater than zero, the Info formatting -commands indent the paragraph by that number of spaces.@refill -@end itemize - -The default value of @var{indent} is @samp{asis}.@refill - -Write the @code{@@paragraphindent} command before or shortly after the -end-of-header line at the beginning of a Texinfo file. (If you write -the command between the start-of-header and end-of-header lines, the -region formatting commands indent paragraphs as specified.)@refill - -A peculiarity of the @code{texinfo-format-buffer} and -@code{texinfo-format-region} commands is that they do not indent (nor -fill) paragraphs that contain @code{@@w} or @code{@@*} commands. -@xref{Refilling Paragraphs}, for a detailed description of what goes -on.@refill - -@node End of Header, , paragraphindent, Header -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection End of Header -@cindex End of header line - -Follow the header lines with an @w{end-of-header} line. -An end-of-header line looks like this:@refill - -@example -@@c %**end of header -@end example - -If you include the @code{@@setchapternewpage} command between the -start-of-header and end-of-header lines, @TeX{} will typeset a region as -that command specifies. Similarly, if you include an @code{@@smallbook} -command between the start-of-header and end-of-header lines, @TeX{} will -typeset a region in the ``small'' book format.@refill - -@ifinfo -The reason for the odd string of characters (@samp{%**}) is so that the -@code{texinfo-tex-region} command does not accidentally find -something that it should not when it is looking for the header.@refill - -The start-of-header line and the end-of-header line are Texinfo mode -variables that you can change.@refill -@end ifinfo - -@iftex -@xref{Start of Header}. -@end iftex - -@node Info Summary and Permissions, Titlepage & Copyright Page, Header, Beginning a File -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Summary and Copying Permissions for Info - -The title page and the copyright page appear only in the printed copy of -the manual; therefore, the same information must be inserted in a -section that appears only in the Info file. This section usually -contains a brief description of the contents of the Info file, a -copyright notice, and copying permissions.@refill - -The copyright notice should read:@refill - -@example -Copyright @var{year} @var{copyright-owner} -@end example - -@noindent -and be put on a line by itself.@refill - -Standard text for the copyright permissions is contained in an appendix -to this manual; see @ref{ifinfo Permissions, , @samp{ifinfo} Copying -Permissions}, for the complete text.@refill - -The permissions text appears in an Info file @emph{before} the first -node. This mean that a reader does @emph{not} see this text when -reading the file using Info, except when using the advanced Info command -@kbd{g *}. - -@node Titlepage & Copyright Page, The Top Node, Info Summary and Permissions, Beginning a File -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section The Title and Copyright Pages - -A manual's name and author are usually printed on a title page. -Sometimes copyright information is printed on the title page as well; -more often, copyright information is printed on the back of the title -page. - -The title and copyright pages appear in the printed manual, but not in the -Info file. Because of this, it is possible to use several slightly -obscure @TeX{} typesetting commands that cannot be used in an Info file. -In addition, this part of the beginning of a Texinfo file contains the text -of the copying permissions that will appear in the printed manual.@refill - -@xref{Titlepage Permissions, , Titlepage Copying Permissions}, for the -standard text for the copyright permissions.@refill - -@menu -* titlepage:: Create a title for the printed document. -* titlefont center sp:: The @code{@@titlefont}, @code{@@center}, - and @code{@@sp} commands. -* title subtitle author:: The @code{@@title}, @code{@@subtitle}, - and @code{@@author} commands. -* Copyright & Permissions:: How to write the copyright notice and - include copying permissions. -* end titlepage:: Turn on page headings after the title and - copyright pages. -* headings on off:: An option for turning headings on and off - and double or single sided printing. -@end menu - -@node titlepage, titlefont center sp, Titlepage & Copyright Page, Titlepage & Copyright Page -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection @code{@@titlepage} -@cindex Title page -@findex titlepage - -Start the material for the title page and following copyright page -with @code{@@titlepage} on a line by itself and end it with -@code{@@end titlepage} on a line by itself.@refill - -The @code{@@end titlepage} command starts a new page and turns on page -numbering. (@xref{Headings, , Page Headings}, for details about how to -generate page headings.) All the material that you want to -appear on unnumbered pages should be put between the -@code{@@titlepage} and @code{@@end titlepage} commands. By using the -@code{@@page} command you can force a page break within the region -delineated by the @code{@@titlepage} and @code{@@end titlepage} -commands and thereby create more than one unnumbered page. This is -how the copyright page is produced. (The @code{@@titlepage} command -might perhaps have been better named the -@code{@@titleandadditionalpages} command, but that would have been -rather long!)@refill - -@c !!! append refill to footnote when makeinfo can handle it. -When you write a manual about a computer program, you should write the -version of the program to which the manual applies on the title -page. If the manual changes more frequently than the program or is -independent of it, you should also include an edition -number@footnote{We have found that it is helpful to refer to versions -of manuals as `editions' and versions of programs as `versions'; -otherwise, we find we are liable to confuse each other in conversation -by referring to both the documentation and the software with the same -words.} for the manual. This helps readers keep track of which manual -is for which version of the program. (The `Top' node -should also contain this information; see @ref{makeinfo top, , -@code{@@top}}.)@refill - -Texinfo provides two main methods for creating a title page. One method -uses the @code{@@titlefont}, @code{@@sp}, and @code{@@center} commands -to generate a title page in which the words on the page are -centered.@refill - -The second method uses the @code{@@title}, @code{@@subtitle}, and -@code{@@author} commands to create a title page with black rules under -the title and author lines and the subtitle text set flush to the -right hand side of the page. With this method, you do not specify any -of the actual formatting of the title page. You specify the text -you want, and Texinfo does the formatting. You may use either -method.@refill - -@findex shorttitlepage -For extremely simple applications, Texinfo also provides a command -@code{@@shorttitlepage} which takes a single argument as the title. -The argument is typeset on a page by itself and followed by a blank -page. - - -@node titlefont center sp, title subtitle author, titlepage, Titlepage & Copyright Page -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection @code{@@titlefont}, @code{@@center}, and @code{@@sp} -@findex titlefont -@findex center -@findex sp @r{(titlepage line spacing)} - -You can use the @code{@@titlefont}, @code{@@sp}, and @code{@@center} -commands to create a title page for a printed document. (This is the -first of the two methods for creating a title page in Texinfo.)@refill - -Use the @code{@@titlefont} command to select a large font suitable for -the title itself.@refill - -@need 700 -For example: - -@example -@@titlefont@{Texinfo@} -@end example - -Use the @code{@@center} command at the beginning of a line to center -the remaining text on that line. Thus,@refill - -@example -@@center @@titlefont@{Texinfo@} -@end example - -@noindent -centers the title, which in this example is ``Texinfo'' printed -in the title font.@refill - -Use the @code{@@sp} command to insert vertical space. For example:@refill - -@example -@@sp 2 -@end example - -@noindent -This inserts two blank lines on the printed page. (@xref{sp, , -@code{@@sp}}, for more information about the @code{@@sp} -command.)@refill - -A template for this method looks like this:@refill - -@example -@group -@@titlepage -@@sp 10 -@@center @@titlefont@{@var{name-of-manual-when-printed}@} -@@sp 2 -@@center @var{subtitle-if-any} -@@sp 2 -@@center @var{author} -@dots{} -@@end titlepage -@end group -@end example - -The spacing of the example fits an 8 1/2 by 11 inch manual.@refill - -@node title subtitle author, Copyright & Permissions, titlefont center sp, Titlepage & Copyright Page -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection @code{@@title}, @code{@@subtitle}, and @code{@@author} -@findex title -@findex subtitle -@findex author - -You can use the @code{@@title}, @code{@@subtitle}, and @code{@@author} -commands to create a title page in which the vertical and horizontal -spacing is done for you automatically. This contrasts with the method -described in -the previous section, in which the @code{@@sp} command is needed to -adjust vertical spacing.@refill - -Write the @code{@@title}, @code{@@subtitle}, or @code{@@author} -commands at the beginning of a line followed by the title, subtitle, -or author.@refill - -The @code{@@title} command produces a line in which the title is set -flush to the left-hand side of the page in a larger than normal font. -The title is underlined with a black rule.@refill - -The @code{@@subtitle} command sets subtitles in a normal-sized font -flush to the right-hand side of the page.@refill - -The @code{@@author} command sets the names of the author or authors in -a middle-sized font flush to the left-hand side of the page on a line -near the bottom of the title page. The names are underlined with a -black rule that is thinner than the rule that underlines the title. -(The black rule only occurs if the @code{@@author} command line is -followed by an @code{@@page} command line.)@refill - -There are two ways to use the @code{@@author} command: you can write -the name or names on the remaining part of the line that starts with -an @code{@@author} command:@refill - -@example -@@author by Jane Smith and John Doe -@end example - -@noindent -or you can write the names one above each other by using two (or more) -@code{@@author} commands:@refill - -@example -@group -@@author Jane Smith -@@author John Doe -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -(Only the bottom name is underlined with a black rule.)@refill - -@need 950 -A template for this method looks like this:@refill - -@example -@group -@@titlepage -@@title @var{name-of-manual-when-printed} -@@subtitle @var{subtitle-if-any} -@@subtitle @var{second-subtitle} -@@author @var{author} -@@page -@dots{} -@@end titlepage -@end group -@end example - -@ifinfo -@noindent -Contrast this form with the form of a title page written using the -@code{@@sp}, @code{@@center}, and @code{@@titlefont} commands:@refill - -@example -@@titlepage -@@sp 10 -@@center @@titlefont@{Name of Manual When Printed@} -@@sp 2 -@@center Subtitle, If Any -@@sp 1 -@@center Second subtitle -@@sp 2 -@@center Author -@@page -@dots{} -@@end titlepage -@end example -@end ifinfo - -@node Copyright & Permissions, end titlepage, title subtitle author, Titlepage & Copyright Page -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection Copyright Page and Permissions -@cindex Copyright page -@cindex Printed permissions -@cindex Permissions, printed - -By international treaty, the copyright notice for a book should be -either on the title page or on the back of the title page. The -copyright notice should include the year followed by the name of the -organization or person who owns the copyright.@refill - -When the copyright notice is on the back of the title page, that page -is customarily not numbered. Therefore, in Texinfo, the information -on the copyright page should be within @code{@@titlepage} and -@code{@@end titlepage} commands.@refill - -@findex vskip -@findex filll -@cindex Vertical whitespace (@samp{vskip}) -Use the @code{@@page} command to cause a page break. To push the -copyright notice and the other text on the copyright page towards the -bottom of the page, you can write a somewhat mysterious line after the -@code{@@page} command that reads like this:@refill - -@example -@@vskip 0pt plus 1filll -@end example - -@noindent -This is a @TeX{} command that is not supported by the Info formatting -commands. The @code{@@vskip} command inserts whitespace. The -@samp{0pt plus 1filll} means to put in zero points of mandatory whitespace, -and as much optional whitespace as needed to push the -following text to the bottom of the page. Note the use of three -@samp{l}s in the word @samp{filll}; this is the correct usage in -@TeX{}.@refill - -@findex copyright -In a printed manual, the @code{@@copyright@{@}} command generates a -@samp{c} inside a circle. (In Info, it generates @samp{(C)}.) The -copyright notice itself has the following legally defined sequence:@refill - -@example -Copyright @copyright{} @var{year} @var{copyright-owner} -@end example - -It is customary to put information on how to get a manual after the -copyright notice, followed by the copying permissions for the -manual.@refill - -Note that permissions must be given here as well as in the summary -segment within @code{@@ifinfo} and @code{@@end ifinfo} that -immediately follows the header since this text appears only in the -printed manual and the @samp{ifinfo} text appears only in the Info -file.@refill - -@xref{Sample Permissions}, for the standard text.@refill - -@node end titlepage, headings on off, Copyright & Permissions, Titlepage & Copyright Page -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection Heading Generation -@findex end titlepage -@cindex Headings, page, begin to appear -@cindex Titlepage end starts headings -@cindex End titlepage starts headings - -An @code{@@end titlepage} command on a line by itself not only marks -the end of the title and copyright pages, but also causes @TeX{} to start -generating page headings and page numbers. - -To repeat what is said elsewhere, Texinfo has two standard page heading -formats, one for documents which are printed on one side of each sheet of paper -(single-sided printing), and the other for documents which are printed on both -sides of each sheet (double-sided printing). -(@xref{setchapternewpage, ,@code{@@setchapternewpage}}.) -You can specify these formats in different ways:@refill - -@itemize @bullet -@item -The conventional way is to write an @code{@@setchapternewpage} command -before the title page commands, and then have the @code{@@end -titlepage} command start generating page headings in the manner desired. -(@xref{setchapternewpage, , @code{@@setchapternewpage}}.)@refill - -@item -Alternatively, you can use the @code{@@headings} command to prevent page -headings from being generated or to start them for either single or -double-sided printing. (Write an @code{@@headings} command immediately -after the @code{@@end titlepage} command. @xref{headings on off, , The -@code{@@headings} Command}, for more information.)@refill - -@item -Or, you may specify your own page heading and footing format. -@xref{Headings, , Page Headings}, for detailed -information about page headings and footings.@refill -@end itemize - -Most documents are formatted with the standard single-sided or -double-sided format, using @code{@@setchapternewpage odd} for -double-sided printing and no @code{@@setchapternewpage} command for -single-sided printing.@refill - -@node headings on off, , end titlepage, Titlepage & Copyright Page -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection The @code{@@headings} Command -@findex headings - -The @code{@@headings} command is rarely used. It specifies what kind of -page headings and footings to print on each page. Usually, this is -controlled by the @code{@@setchapternewpage} command. You need the -@code{@@headings} command only if the @code{@@setchapternewpage} command -does not do what you want, or if you want to turn off pre-defined page -headings prior to defining your own. Write an @code{@@headings} command -immediately after the @code{@@end titlepage} command.@refill - -You can use @code{@@headings} as follows:@refill - -@table @code -@item @@headings off -Turn off printing of page headings.@refill - -@item @@headings single -Turn on page headings appropriate for single-sided printing. -@refill - -@item @@headings double -Turn on page headings appropriate for double-sided printing. The two -commands, @code{@@headings on} and @code{@@headings double}, are -synonymous.@refill - -@item @@headings singleafter -@itemx @@headings doubleafter -Turn on @code{single} or @code{double} headings, respectively, after the -current page is output. - -@item @@headings on -Turn on page headings: @code{single} if @samp{@@setchapternewpage -on}, @code{double} otherwise. -@end table - -For example, suppose you write @code{@@setchapternewpage off} before the -@code{@@titlepage} command to tell @TeX{} to start a new chapter on the -same page as the end of the last chapter. This command also causes -@TeX{} to typeset page headers for single-sided printing. To cause -@TeX{} to typeset for double sided printing, write @code{@@headings -double} after the @code{@@end titlepage} command. - -You can stop @TeX{} from generating any page headings at all by -writing @code{@@headings off} on a line of its own immediately after the -line containing the @code{@@end titlepage} command, like this:@refill - -@example -@@end titlepage -@@headings off -@end example - -@noindent -The @code{@@headings off} command overrides the @code{@@end titlepage} -command, which would otherwise cause @TeX{} to print page -headings.@refill - -You can also specify your own style of page heading and footing. -@xref{Headings, , Page Headings}, for more information.@refill - -@node The Top Node, Software Copying Permissions, Titlepage & Copyright Page, Beginning a File -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section The `Top' Node and Master Menu -@cindex @samp{@r{Top}} node -@cindex Master menu -@cindex Node, `Top' - -The `Top' node is the node from which you enter an Info file.@refill - -A `Top' node should contain a brief description of the Info file and an -extensive, master menu for the whole Info file. -This helps the reader understand what the Info file is -about. Also, you should write the version number of the program to -which the Info file applies; or, at least, the edition number.@refill - -The contents of the `Top' node should appear only in the Info file; none -of it should appear in printed output, so enclose it between -@code{@@ifinfo} and @code{@@end ifinfo} commands. (@TeX{} does not -print either an @code{@@node} line or a menu; they appear only in Info; -strictly speaking, you are not required to enclose these parts between -@code{@@ifinfo} and @code{@@end ifinfo}, but it is simplest to do so. -@xref{Conditionals, , Conditionally Visible Text}.)@refill - -@menu -* Title of Top Node:: Sketch what the file is about. -* Master Menu Parts:: A master menu has three or more parts. -@end menu - -@node Title of Top Node, Master Menu Parts, The Top Node, The Top Node -@ifinfo -@subheading `Top' Node Title -@end ifinfo - -Sometimes, you will want to place an @code{@@top} sectioning command -line containing the title of the document immediately after the -@code{@@node Top} line (@pxref{makeinfo top command, , The @code{@@top} -Sectioning Command}, for more information).@refill - -For example, the beginning of the Top node of this manual contains an -@code{@@top} sectioning command, a short description, and edition and -version information. It looks like this:@refill - -@example -@group -@dots{} -@@end titlepage - -@@ifinfo -@@node Top, Copying, , (dir) -@@top Texinfo - -Texinfo is a documentation system@dots{} -@end group - -@group -This is edition@dots{} -@dots{} -@@end ifinfo -@end group - -@group -@@menu -* Copying:: Texinfo is freely - redistributable. -* Overview:: What is Texinfo? -@dots{} -@end group -@@end menu -@end example - -In a `Top' node, the `Previous', and `Up' nodes usually refer to the top -level directory of the whole Info system, which is called @samp{(dir)}. -The `Next' node refers to the first node that follows the main or master -menu, which is usually the copying permissions, introduction, or first -chapter.@refill - -@node Master Menu Parts, , Title of Top Node, The Top Node -@subsection Parts of a Master Menu -@cindex Master menu parts -@cindex Parts of a master menu - -A @dfn{master menu} is a detailed main menu listing all the nodes in a -file. - -A master menu is enclosed in @code{@@menu} and @code{@@end menu} -commands and does not appear in the printed document.@refill - -Generally, a master menu is divided into parts.@refill - -@itemize @bullet -@item -The first part contains the major nodes in the Texinfo file: the nodes -for the chapters, chapter-like sections, and the appendices.@refill - -@item -The second part contains nodes for the indices.@refill - -@item -The third and subsequent parts contain a listing of the other, lower -level nodes, often ordered by chapter. This way, rather than go -through an intermediary menu, an inquirer can go directly to a -particular node when searching for specific information. These menu -items are not required; add them if you think they are a -convenience. If you do use them, put @code{@@detailmenu} before the -first one, and @code{@@end detailmenu} after the last; otherwise, -@code{makeinfo} will get confused. -@end itemize - -Each section in the menu can be introduced by a descriptive line. So -long as the line does not begin with an asterisk, it will not be -treated as a menu entry. (@xref{Writing a Menu}, for more -information.)@refill - -For example, the master menu for this manual looks like the following -(but has many more entries):@refill - -@example -@group -@@menu -* Copying:: Texinfo is freely - redistributable. -* Overview:: What is Texinfo? -* Texinfo Mode:: Special features in GNU Emacs. -@dots{} -@dots{} -@end group -@group -* Command and Variable Index:: - An entry for each @@-command. -* Concept Index:: An entry for each concept. -@end group - -@group -@@detailmenu - --- The Detailed Node Listing --- - -Overview of Texinfo - -* Info Files:: What is an Info file? -* Printed Manuals:: Characteristics of - a printed manual. -@dots{} -@dots{} -@end group - -@group -Using Texinfo Mode - -* Info on a Region:: Formatting part of a file - for Info. -@dots{} -@dots{} -@@end detailmenu -@@end menu -@end group -@end example - -@node Software Copying Permissions, , The Top Node, Beginning a File -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Software Copying Permissions -@cindex Software copying permissions -@cindex Copying software -@cindex Distribution -@cindex License agreement - -If the Texinfo file has a section containing the ``General Public -License'' and the distribution information and a warranty disclaimer -for the software that is documented, this section usually follows the -`Top' node. The General Public License is very important to Project -GNU software. It ensures that you and others will continue to have a -right to use and share the software.@refill - -The copying and distribution information and the disclaimer are -followed by an introduction or else by the first chapter of the -manual.@refill - -@cindex Introduction, as part of file -Although an introduction is not a required part of a Texinfo file, it -is very helpful. Ideally, it should state clearly and concisely what -the file is about and who would be interested in reading it. In -general, an introduction would follow the licensing and distribution -information, although sometimes people put it earlier in the document. -Usually, an introduction is put in an @code{@@unnumbered} section. -(@xref{unnumbered & appendix, , The @code{@@unnumbered} and -@code{@@appendix} Commands}.)@refill - -@node Ending a File, Structuring, Beginning a File, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@chapter Ending a Texinfo File -@cindex Ending a Texinfo file -@cindex Texinfo file ending -@cindex File ending -@findex bye - -The end of a Texinfo file should include the commands that create -indices and generate detailed and summary tables of contents. -And it must include the @code{@@bye} command that marks the last line -processed by @TeX{}.@refill - -@need 700 -For example: - -@example -@@node Concept Index, , Variables Index, Top -@@c node-name, next, previous, up -@@unnumbered Concept Index - -@@printindex cp - -@@contents -@@bye -@end example - -@menu -* Printing Indices & Menus:: How to print an index in hardcopy and - generate index menus in Info. -* Contents:: How to create a table of contents. -* File End:: How to mark the end of a file. -@end menu - -@node Printing Indices & Menus, Contents, Ending a File, Ending a File -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Index Menus and Printing an Index -@findex printindex -@cindex Printing an index -@cindex Indices, printing and menus -@cindex Generating menus with indices -@cindex Menus generated with indices - -To print an index means to include it as part of a manual or Info -file. This does not happen automatically just because you use -@code{@@cindex} or other index-entry generating commands in the -Texinfo file; those just cause the raw data for the index to be -accumulated. To generate an index, you must include the -@code{@@printindex} command at the place in the document where you -want the index to appear. Also, as part of the process of creating a -printed manual, you must run a program called @code{texindex} -(@pxref{Format/Print Hardcopy}) to sort the raw data to produce a sorted -index file. The sorted index file is what is actually used to -print the index.@refill - -Texinfo offers six different types of predefined index: the concept -index, the function index, the variables index, the keystroke index, the -program index, and the data type index (@pxref{Predefined Indices}). Each -index type has a two-letter name: @samp{cp}, @samp{fn}, @samp{vr}, -@samp{ky}, @samp{pg}, and @samp{tp}. You may merge indices, or put them -into separate sections (@pxref{Combining Indices}); or you may define -your own indices (@pxref{New Indices, , Defining New Indices}).@refill - -The @code{@@printindex} command takes a two-letter index name, reads -the corresponding sorted index file and formats it appropriately into -an index.@refill - -@ignore -The two-letter index names are: - -@table @samp -@item cp -concept index -@item fn -function index -@item vr -variable index -@item ky -key index -@item pg -program index -@item tp -data type index -@end table -@end ignore -The @code{@@printindex} command does not generate a chapter heading -for the index. Consequently, you should precede the -@code{@@printindex} command with a suitable section or chapter command -(usually @code{@@unnumbered}) to supply the chapter heading and put -the index into the table of contents. Precede the @code{@@unnumbered} -command with an @code{@@node} line.@refill - -@need 1200 -For example: - -@smallexample -@group -@@node Variable Index, Concept Index, Function Index, Top -@@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@@unnumbered Variable Index - -@@printindex vr -@end group - -@group -@@node Concept Index, , Variable Index, Top -@@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@@unnumbered Concept Index - -@@printindex cp -@end group - -@group -@@summarycontents -@@contents -@@bye -@end group -@end smallexample - -@noindent -(Readers often prefer that the concept index come last in a book, -since that makes it easiest to find.)@refill - -@ignore -@c TeX can do sorting, just not conveniently enough to handle sorting -@c Texinfo indexes. --karl, 5may97. -In @TeX{}, the @code{@@printindex} command needs a sorted index file -to work from. @TeX{} does not know how to do sorting; this is a -deficiency. @TeX{} writes output files of raw index data; use the -@code{texindex} program to convert these files to sorted index files. -(@xref{Format/Print Hardcopy}, for more information.)@refill -@end ignore - - -@node Contents, File End, Printing Indices & Menus, Ending a File -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Generating a Table of Contents -@cindex Table of contents -@cindex Contents, Table of -@findex contents -@findex summarycontents -@findex shortcontents - -The @code{@@chapter}, @code{@@section}, and other structuring commands -supply the information to make up a table of contents, but they do not -cause an actual table to appear in the manual. To do this, you must -use the @code{@@contents} and @code{@@summarycontents} -commands:@refill - -@table @code -@item @@contents -Generate a table of contents in a printed manual, including all -chapters, sections, subsections, etc., as well as appendices and -unnumbered chapters. (Headings generated by the @code{@@heading} -series of commands do not appear in the table of contents.) The -@code{@@contents} command should be written on a line by -itself.@refill - -@item @@shortcontents -@itemx @@summarycontents -(@code{@@summarycontents} is a synonym for @code{@@shortcontents}; the -two commands are exactly the same.)@refill - -Generate a short or summary table of contents that lists only the -chapters (and appendices and unnumbered chapters). Omit sections, subsections -and subsubsections. Only a long manual needs a short table -of contents in addition to the full table of contents.@refill - -Write the @code{@@shortcontents} command on a line by itself right -@emph{before} the @code{@@contents} command.@refill -@end table - -The table of contents commands automatically generate a chapter-like -heading at the top of the first table of contents page. Write the table -of contents commands at the very end of a Texinfo file, just before the -@code{@@bye} command, following any index sections---anything in the -Texinfo file after the table of contents commands will be omitted from -the table of contents.@refill - -When you print a manual with a table of contents, the table of -contents are printed last and numbered with roman numerals. You need -to place those pages in their proper place, after the title page, -yourself. (This is the only collating you need to do for a printed -manual. The table of contents is printed last because it is generated -after the rest of the manual is typeset.)@refill - -@need 700 -Here is an example of where to write table of contents commands:@refill - -@example -@group -@var{indices}@dots{} -@@shortcontents -@@contents -@@bye -@end group -@end example - -Since an Info file uses menus instead of tables of contents, the Info -formatting commands ignore the @code{@@contents} and -@code{@@shortcontents} commands.@refill - -@node File End, , Contents, Ending a File -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@bye} File Ending -@findex bye - -An @code{@@bye} command terminates @TeX{} or Info formatting. None of -the formatting commands see any of the file following @code{@@bye}. -The @code{@@bye} command should be on a line by itself.@refill - -If you wish, you may follow the @code{@@bye} line with notes. These notes -will not be formatted and will not appear in either Info or a printed -manual; it is as if text after @code{@@bye} were within @code{@@ignore} -@dots{} @code{@@end ignore}. Also, you may follow the @code{@@bye} line -with a local variables list. @xref{Compile-Command, , Using Local -Variables and the Compile Command}, for more information.@refill - -@node Structuring, Nodes, Ending a File, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@chapter Chapter Structuring -@cindex Chapter structuring -@cindex Structuring of chapters - -The @dfn{chapter structuring} commands divide a document into a hierarchy of -chapters, sections, subsections, and subsubsections. These commands -generate large headings; they also provide information for the table -of contents of a printed manual (@pxref{Contents, , Generating a Table -of Contents}).@refill - -The chapter structuring commands do not create an Info node structure, -so normally you should put an @code{@@node} command immediately before -each chapter structuring command (@pxref{Nodes}). The only time you -are likely to use the chapter structuring commands without using the -node structuring commands is if you are writing a document that -contains no cross references and will never be transformed into Info -format.@refill - -It is unlikely that you will ever write a Texinfo file that is -intended only as an Info file and not as a printable document. If you -do, you might still use chapter structuring commands to create a -heading at the top of each node---but you don't need to.@refill - -@menu -* Tree Structuring:: A manual is like an upside down tree @dots{} -* Structuring Command Types:: How to divide a manual into parts. -* makeinfo top:: The @code{@@top} command, part of the `Top' node. -* chapter:: -* unnumbered & appendix:: -* majorheading & chapheading:: -* section:: -* unnumberedsec appendixsec heading:: -* subsection:: -* unnumberedsubsec appendixsubsec subheading:: -* subsubsection:: Commands for the lowest level sections. -* Raise/lower sections:: How to change commands' hierarchical level. -@end menu - -@node Tree Structuring, Structuring Command Types, Structuring, Structuring -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Tree Structure of Sections -@cindex Tree structuring - -A Texinfo file is usually structured like a book with chapters, -sections, subsections, and the like. This structure can be visualized -as a tree (or rather as an upside-down tree) with the root at the top -and the levels corresponding to chapters, sections, subsection, and -subsubsections.@refill - -Here is a diagram that shows a Texinfo file with three chapters, -each of which has two sections.@refill - -@example -@group - Top - | - ------------------------------------- - | | | - Chapter 1 Chapter 2 Chapter 3 - | | | - -------- -------- -------- - | | | | | | - Section Section Section Section Section Section - 1.1 1.2 2.1 2.2 3.1 3.2 - -@end group -@end example - -In a Texinfo file that has this structure, the beginning of Chapter 2 -looks like this:@refill - -@example -@group -@@node Chapter 2, Chapter 3, Chapter 1, top -@@chapter Chapter 2 -@end group -@end example - -The chapter structuring commands are described in the sections that -follow; the @code{@@node} and @code{@@menu} commands are described in -following chapters. (@xref{Nodes}, and see @ref{Menus}.)@refill - -@node Structuring Command Types, makeinfo top, Tree Structuring, Structuring -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Types of Structuring Commands - -The chapter structuring commands fall into four groups or series, each -of which contains structuring commands corresponding to the -hierarchical levels of chapters, sections, subsections, and -subsubsections.@refill - -The four groups are the @code{@@chapter} series, the -@code{@@unnumbered} series, the @code{@@appendix} series, and the -@code{@@heading} series.@refill - -Each command produces titles that have a different appearance on the -printed page or Info file; only some of the commands produce -titles that are listed in the table of contents of a printed book or -manual.@refill - -@itemize @bullet -@item -The @code{@@chapter} and @code{@@appendix} series of commands produce -numbered or lettered entries both in the body of a printed work and in -its table of contents.@refill - -@item -The @code{@@unnumbered} series of commands produce unnumbered entries -both in the body of a printed work and in its table of contents. The -@code{@@top} command, which has a special use, is a member of this -series (@pxref{makeinfo top, , @code{@@top}}).@refill - -@item -The @code{@@heading} series of commands produce unnumbered headings -that do not appear in a table of contents. The heading commands never -start a new page.@refill - -@item -The @code{@@majorheading} command produces results similar to using -the @code{@@chapheading} command but generates a larger vertical -whitespace before the heading.@refill - -@item -When an @code{@@setchapternewpage} command says to do so, the -@code{@@chapter}, @code{@@unnumbered}, and @code{@@appendix} commands -start new pages in the printed manual; the @code{@@heading} commands -do not.@refill -@end itemize - -@need 1000 -Here are the four groups of chapter structuring commands:@refill - -@c Slightly different formatting for regular sized books and smallbooks. -@ifset smallbook -@sp 1 -@tex -{\let\rm=\indrm \let\tt=\indtt -\halign{\hskip\itemindent#\hfil& \hskip.5em#\hfil& \hskip.5em#\hfil& -\hskip.5em#\hfil\cr - -& & & \rm No new pages\cr -\rm Numbered& \rm Unnumbered& \rm Lettered and numbered& \rm Unnumbered\cr -\rm In contents& \rm In contents& \rm In contents& \rm Not in contents\cr - -& & & \cr - & \tt @@top& & \tt @@majorheading\cr -\tt @@chapter& \tt @@unnumbered& \tt @@appendix& \tt @@chapheading\cr -\tt @@section& \tt @@unnumberedsec& \tt @@appendixsec& \tt @@heading\cr -\tt @@subsection&\tt @@unnumberedsubsec&\tt @@appendixsubsec& -\tt @@subheading\cr -\tt @@subsubsection& \tt @@unnumberedsubsubsec& \tt @@appendixsubsubsec& -\tt @@subsubheading\cr}} -@end tex -@end ifset -@ifclear smallbook -@sp 1 -@tex -\vbox{ -\halign{\hskip\itemindent\hskip.5em#\hfil& \hskip.5em#\hfil& -\hskip.5em#\hfil& \hskip.5em #\hfil\cr - -& & & \cr -& & & \rm No new pages\cr -\rm Numbered& \rm Unnumbered& \rm Lettered and numbered& \rm Unnumbered\cr -\rm In contents& \rm In contents& \rm In contents& \rm Not in contents\cr - -& & & \cr - & \tt @@top& & \tt @@majorheading\cr -\tt @@chapter& \tt @@unnumbered& \tt @@appendix& \tt @@chapheading\cr -\tt @@section& \tt @@unnumberedsec& \tt @@appendixsec& \tt @@heading\cr -\tt @@subsection&\tt @@unnumberedsubsec&\tt @@appendixsubsec& -\tt @@subheading\cr -\tt @@subsubsection& \tt @@unnumberedsubsubsec& \tt @@appendixsubsubsec& -\tt @@subsubheading\cr}} -@end tex -@end ifclear -@ifinfo -@example -@group - @r{No new pages} -@r{Numbered} @r{Unnumbered} @r{Lettered and numbered} @r{Unnumbered} -@r{In contents} @r{In contents} @r{In contents} @r{Not in contents} - - @@top @@majorheading -@@chapter @@unnumbered @@appendix @@chapheading -@@section @@unnumberedsec @@appendixsec @@heading -@@subsection @@unnumberedsubsec @@appendixsubsec @@subheading -@@subsubsection @@unnumberedsubsubsec @@appendixsubsubsec @@subsubheading -@end group -@end example -@end ifinfo - -@c Cannot line up columns properly inside of an example because of roman -@c proportional fonts. -@ignore -@ifset smallbook -@iftex -@smallexample -@group - @r{No new pages} -@r{Numbered} @r{Unnumbered} @r{Lettered and numbered} @r{Unnumbered} -@r{In contents} @r{In contents} @r{In contents} @r{Not in contents} - - @@top @@majorheading -@@chapter @@unnumbered @@appendix @@chapheading -@@section @@unnumberedsec @@appendixsec @@heading -@@subsection @@unnumberedsubsec @@appendixsubsec @@subheading -@@subsubsection @@unnumberedsubsubsec @@appendixsubsubsec @@subsubheading -@end group -@end smallexample -@end iftex -@end ifset -@ifclear smallbook -@iftex -@smallexample -@group - @r{No new pages} -@r{Numbered} @r{Unnumbered} @r{Lettered and numbered} @r{Unnumbered} -@r{In contents} @r{In contents} @r{In contents} @r{Not in contents} - - @@top @@majorheading -@@chapter @@unnumbered @@appendix @@chapheading -@@section @@unnumberedsec @@appendixsec @@heading -@@subsection @@unnumberedsubsec @@appendixsubsec @@subheading -@@subsubsection @@unnumberedsubsubsec @@appendixsubsubsec @@subsubheading -@end group -@end smallexample -@end iftex -@end ignore - -@node makeinfo top, chapter, Structuring Command Types, Structuring -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@top} - -The @code{@@top} command is a special sectioning command that you use -only after an @samp{@@node Top} line at the beginning of a Texinfo file. -The @code{@@top} command tells the @code{makeinfo} formatter -which node is the `Top' -node. It has the same typesetting effect as @code{@@unnumbered} -(@pxref{unnumbered & appendix, , @code{@@unnumbered}, @code{@@appendix}}). -For detailed information, see -@ref{makeinfo top command, , The @code{@@top} Command}.@refill - -@node chapter, unnumbered & appendix, makeinfo top, Structuring -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@chapter} -@findex chapter - -@code{@@chapter} identifies a chapter in the document. Write the -command at the beginning of a line and follow it on the same line by -the title of the chapter.@refill - -For example, this chapter in this manual is entitled ``Chapter -Structuring''; the @code{@@chapter} line looks like this:@refill - -@example -@@chapter Chapter Structuring -@end example - -In @TeX{}, the @code{@@chapter} command creates a chapter in the -document, specifying the chapter title. The chapter is numbered -automatically.@refill - -In Info, the @code{@@chapter} command causes the title to appear on a -line by itself, with a line of asterisks inserted underneath. Thus, -in Info, the above example produces the following output:@refill - -@example -Chapter Structuring -******************* -@end example - -@findex centerchap -Texinfo also provides a command @code{@@centerchap}, which is analogous -to @code{@@unnumbered}, but centers its argument in the printed output. -This kind of stylistic choice is not usually offered by Texinfo. -@c but the Hacker's Dictionary wanted it ... - - -@node unnumbered & appendix, majorheading & chapheading, chapter, Structuring -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@unnumbered}, @code{@@appendix} -@findex unnumbered -@findex appendix - -Use the @code{@@unnumbered} command to create a chapter that appears -in a printed manual without chapter numbers of any kind. Use the -@code{@@appendix} command to create an appendix in a printed manual -that is labelled by letter instead of by number.@refill - -For Info file output, the @code{@@unnumbered} and @code{@@appendix} -commands are equivalent to @code{@@chapter}: the title is printed on a -line by itself with a line of asterisks underneath. (@xref{chapter, , -@code{@@chapter}}.)@refill - -To create an appendix or an unnumbered chapter, write an -@code{@@appendix} or @code{@@unnumbered} command at the beginning of a -line and follow it on the same line by the title, as you would if you -were creating a chapter.@refill - - -@node majorheading & chapheading, section, unnumbered & appendix, Structuring -@section @code{@@majorheading}, @code{@@chapheading} -@findex majorheading -@findex chapheading - -The @code{@@majorheading} and @code{@@chapheading} commands put -chapter-like headings in the body of a document.@refill - -However, neither command causes @TeX{} to produce a numbered heading -or an entry in the table of contents; and neither command causes -@TeX{} to start a new page in a printed manual.@refill - -In @TeX{}, an @code{@@majorheading} command generates a larger vertical -whitespace before the heading than an @code{@@chapheading} command but -is otherwise the same.@refill - -In Info, -the @code{@@majorheading} and -@code{@@chapheading} commands are equivalent to -@code{@@chapter}: the title is printed on a line by itself with a line -of asterisks underneath. (@xref{chapter, , @code{@@chapter}}.)@refill - -@node section, unnumberedsec appendixsec heading, majorheading & chapheading, Structuring -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@section} -@findex section - -In a printed manual, an @code{@@section} command identifies a -numbered section within a chapter. The section title appears in the -table of contents. In Info, an @code{@@section} command provides a -title for a segment of text, underlined with @samp{=}.@refill - -This section is headed with an @code{@@section} command and looks like -this in the Texinfo file:@refill - -@example -@@section @@code@{@@@@section@} -@end example - -To create a section, write the @code{@@section} command at the -beginning of a line and follow it on the same line by the section -title.@refill - -Thus, - -@example -@@section This is a section -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@example -@group -This is a section -================= -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -in Info. - -@node unnumberedsec appendixsec heading, subsection, section, Structuring -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@unnumberedsec}, @code{@@appendixsec}, @code{@@heading} -@findex unnumberedsec -@findex appendixsec -@findex heading - -The @code{@@unnumberedsec}, @code{@@appendixsec}, and @code{@@heading} -commands are, respectively, the unnumbered, appendix-like, and -heading-like equivalents of the @code{@@section} command. -(@xref{section, , @code{@@section}}.)@refill - -@table @code -@item @@unnumberedsec -The @code{@@unnumberedsec} command may be used within an -unnumbered chapter or within a regular chapter or appendix to -provide an unnumbered section.@refill - -@item @@appendixsec -@itemx @@appendixsection -@code{@@appendixsection} is a longer spelling of the -@code{@@appendixsec} command; the two are synonymous.@refill -@findex appendixsection - -Conventionally, the @code{@@appendixsec} or @code{@@appendixsection} -command is used only within appendices.@refill - -@item @@heading -You may use the @code{@@heading} command anywhere you wish for a -section-style heading that will not appear in the table of contents.@refill -@end table - -@node subsection, unnumberedsubsec appendixsubsec subheading, unnumberedsec appendixsec heading, Structuring -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section The @code{@@subsection} Command -@findex subsection - -Subsections are to sections as sections are to chapters. -(@xref{section, , @code{@@section}}.) In Info, subsection titles are -underlined with @samp{-}. For example,@refill - -@example -@@subsection This is a subsection -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@example -@group -This is a subsection --------------------- -@end group -@end example - -In a printed manual, subsections are listed in the table of contents -and are numbered three levels deep.@refill - -@node unnumberedsubsec appendixsubsec subheading, subsubsection, subsection, Structuring -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section The @code{@@subsection}-like Commands -@cindex Subsection-like commands -@findex unnumberedsubsec -@findex appendixsubsec -@findex subheading - -The @code{@@unnumberedsubsec}, @code{@@appendixsubsec}, and -@code{@@subheading} commands are, respectively, the unnumbered, -appendix-like, and heading-like equivalents of the @code{@@subsection} -command. (@xref{subsection, , @code{@@subsection}}.)@refill - -In Info, the @code{@@subsection}-like commands generate a title -underlined with hyphens. In a printed manual, an @code{@@subheading} -command produces a heading like that of a subsection except that it is -not numbered and does not appear in the table of contents. Similarly, -an @code{@@unnumberedsubsec} command produces an unnumbered heading like -that of a subsection and an @code{@@appendixsubsec} command produces a -subsection-like heading labelled with a letter and numbers; both of -these commands produce headings that appear in the table of -contents.@refill - -@node subsubsection, Raise/lower sections, unnumberedsubsec appendixsubsec subheading, Structuring -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section The `subsub' Commands -@cindex Subsub commands -@findex subsubsection -@findex unnumberedsubsubsec -@findex appendixsubsubsec -@findex subsubheading - -The fourth and lowest level sectioning commands in Texinfo are the -`subsub' commands. They are:@refill - -@table @code -@item @@subsubsection -Subsubsections are to subsections as subsections are to sections. -(@xref{subsection, , @code{@@subsection}}.) In a printed manual, -subsubsection titles appear in the table of contents and are numbered -four levels deep.@refill - -@item @@unnumberedsubsubsec -Unnumbered subsubsection titles appear in the table of contents of a -printed manual, but lack numbers. Otherwise, unnumbered -subsubsections are the same as subsubsections. In Info, unnumbered -subsubsections look exactly like ordinary subsubsections.@refill - -@item @@appendixsubsubsec -Conventionally, appendix commands are used only for appendices and are -lettered and numbered appropriately in a printed manual. They also -appear in the table of contents. In Info, appendix subsubsections look -exactly like ordinary subsubsections.@refill - -@item @@subsubheading -The @code{@@subsubheading} command may be used anywhere that you need -a small heading that will not appear in the table of contents. In -Info, subsubheadings look exactly like ordinary subsubsection -headings.@refill -@end table - -In Info, `subsub' titles are underlined with periods. -For example,@refill - -@example -@@subsubsection This is a subsubsection -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@example -@group -This is a subsubsection -....................... -@end group -@end example - -@node Raise/lower sections, , subsubsection, Structuring -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@raisesections} and @code{@@lowersections} -@findex raisesections -@findex lowersections -@cindex Raising and lowering sections -@cindex Sections, raising and lowering - -The @code{@@raisesections} and @code{@@lowersections} commands raise and -lower the hierarchical level of chapters, sections, subsections and the -like. The @code{@@raisesections} command changes sections to chapters, -subsections to sections, and so on. The @code{@@lowersections} command -changes chapters to sections, sections to subsections, and so on. - -@cindex Include files, and section levels -An @code{@@lowersections} command is useful if you wish to include text -that is written as an outer or standalone Texinfo file in another -Texinfo file as an inner, included file. If you write the command at -the beginning of the file, all your @code{@@chapter} commands are -formatted as if they were @code{@@section} commands, all your -@code{@@section} command are formatted as if they were -@code{@@subsection} commands, and so on. - -@need 1000 -@code{@@raisesections} raises a command one level in the chapter -structuring hierarchy:@refill - -@example -@group - @r{Change} @r{To} - -@@subsection @@section, -@@section @@chapter, -@@heading @@chapheading, - @r{etc.} -@end group -@end example - -@need 1000 -@code{@@lowersections} lowers a command one level in the chapter -structuring hierarchy:@refill - -@example -@group - @r{Change} @r{To} - -@@chapter @@section, -@@subsection @@subsubsection, -@@heading @@subheading, - @r{etc.} -@end group -@end example - -An @code{@@raisesections} or @code{@@lowersections} command changes only -those structuring commands that follow the command in the Texinfo file. -Write an @code{@@raisesections} or @code{@@lowersections} command on a -line of its own. - -An @code{@@lowersections} command cancels an @code{@@raisesections} -command, and vice versa. Typically, the commands are used like this: - -@example -@@lowersections -@@include somefile.texi -@@raisesections -@end example - -Without the @code{@@raisesections}, all the subsequent sections in your -document will be lowered. - -Repeated use of the commands continue to raise or lower the hierarchical -level a step at a time. - -An attempt to raise above `chapters' reproduces chapter commands; an -attempt to lower below `subsubsections' reproduces subsubsection -commands. - -@node Nodes, Menus, Structuring, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@chapter Nodes - -@dfn{Nodes} are the primary segments of a Texinfo file. They do not -themselves impose a hierarchic or any other kind of structure on a file. -Nodes contain @dfn{node pointers} that name other nodes, and can contain -@dfn{menus} which are lists of nodes. In Info, the movement commands -can carry you to a pointed-to node or to a node listed in a menu. Node -pointers and menus provide structure for Info files just as chapters, -sections, subsections, and the like, provide structure for printed -books.@refill - -@menu -* Two Paths:: Different commands to structure - Info output and printed output. -* Node Menu Illustration:: A diagram, and sample nodes and menus. -* node:: How to write a node, in detail. -* makeinfo Pointer Creation:: How to create node pointers with @code{makeinfo}. -@end menu - -@node Two Paths, Node Menu Illustration, Nodes, Nodes -@ifinfo -@heading Two Paths -@end ifinfo - -The node and menu commands and the chapter structuring commands are -independent of each other: - -@itemize @bullet -@item -In Info, node and menu commands provide structure. The chapter -structuring commands generate headings with different kinds of -underlining---asterisks for chapters, hyphens for sections, and so on; -they do nothing else.@refill - -@item -In @TeX{}, the chapter structuring commands generate chapter and section -numbers and tables of contents. The node and menu commands provide -information for cross references; they do nothing else.@refill -@end itemize - -You can use node pointers and menus to structure an Info file any way -you want; and you can write a Texinfo file so that its Info output has a -different structure than its printed output. However, most Texinfo -files are written such that the structure for the Info output -corresponds to the structure for the printed output. It is not -convenient to do otherwise.@refill - -Generally, printed output is structured in a tree-like hierarchy in -which the chapters are the major limbs from which the sections branch -out. Similarly, node pointers and menus are organized to create a -matching structure in the Info output.@refill - -@node Node Menu Illustration, node, Two Paths, Nodes -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Node and Menu Illustration - -Here is a copy of the diagram shown earlier that illustrates a Texinfo -file with three chapters, each of which contains two sections.@refill - -Note that the ``root'' is at the top of the diagram and the ``leaves'' -are at the bottom. This is how such a diagram is drawn conventionally; -it illustrates an upside-down tree. For this reason, the root node is -called the `Top' node, and `Up' node pointers carry you closer to the -root.@refill - -@example -@group - Top - | - ------------------------------------- - | | | - Chapter 1 Chapter 2 Chapter 3 - | | | - -------- -------- -------- - | | | | | | - Section Section Section Section Section Section - 1.1 1.2 2.1 2.2 3.1 3.2 - -@end group -@end example - -Write the beginning of the node for Chapter 2 like this:@refill - -@example -@group -@@node Chapter 2, Chapter 3, Chapter 1, top -@@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -This @code{@@node} line says that the name of this node is ``Chapter 2'', the -name of the `Next' node is ``Chapter 3'', the name of the `Previous' -node is ``Chapter 1'', and the name of the `Up' node is ``Top''. - -@quotation -@strong{Please Note:} `Next' refers to the next node at the same -hierarchical level in the manual, not necessarily to the next node -within the Texinfo file. In the Texinfo file, the subsequent node may -be at a lower level---a section-level node may follow a chapter-level -node, and a subsection-level node may follow a section-level node. -`Next' and `Previous' refer to nodes at the @emph{same} hierarchical -level. (The `Top' node contains the exception to this rule. Since the -`Top' node is the only node at that level, `Next' refers to the first -following node, which is almost always a chapter or chapter-level -node.)@refill -@end quotation - -To go to Sections 2.1 and 2.2 using Info, you need a menu inside Chapter -2. (@xref{Menus}.) You would write the menu just -before the beginning of Section 2.1, like this:@refill - -@example -@group - @@menu - * Sect. 2.1:: Description of this section. - * Sect. 2.2:: - @@end menu -@end group -@end example - -Write the node for Sect. 2.1 like this:@refill - -@example -@group - @@node Sect. 2.1, Sect. 2.2, Chapter 2, Chapter 2 - @@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@end group -@end example - -In Info format, the `Next' and `Previous' pointers of a node usually -lead to other nodes at the same level---from chapter to chapter or from -section to section (sometimes, as shown, the `Previous' pointer points -up); an `Up' pointer usually leads to a node at the level above (closer -to the `Top' node); and a `Menu' leads to nodes at a level below (closer -to `leaves'). (A cross reference can point to a node at any level; -see @ref{Cross References}.)@refill - -Usually, an @code{@@node} command and a chapter structuring command are -used in sequence, along with indexing commands. (You may follow the -@code{@@node} line with a comment line that reminds you which pointer is -which.)@refill - -Here is the beginning of the chapter in this manual called ``Ending a -Texinfo File''. This shows an @code{@@node} line followed by a comment -line, an @code{@@chapter} line, and then by indexing lines.@refill - -@example -@group -@@node Ending a File, Structuring, Beginning a File, Top -@@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@@chapter Ending a Texinfo File -@@cindex Ending a Texinfo file -@@cindex Texinfo file ending -@@cindex File ending -@end group -@end example - -@node node, makeinfo Pointer Creation, Node Menu Illustration, Nodes -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section The @code{@@node} Command - -@cindex Node, defined -A @dfn{node} is a segment of text that begins at an @code{@@node} -command and continues until the next @code{@@node} command. The -definition of node is different from that for chapter or section. A -chapter may contain sections and a section may contain subsections; -but a node cannot contain subnodes; the text of a node continues only -until the next @code{@@node} command in the file. A node usually -contains only one chapter structuring command, the one that follows -the @code{@@node} line. On the other hand, in printed output nodes -are used only for cross references, so a chapter or section may -contain any number of nodes. Indeed, a chapter usually contains -several nodes, one for each section, subsection, and -subsubsection.@refill - -To create a node, write an @code{@@node} command at the beginning of a -line, and follow it with four arguments, separated by commas, on the -rest of the same line. These arguments are the name of the node, and -the names of the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers, in that order. -You may insert spaces before each pointer if you wish; the spaces are -ignored. You must write the name of the node, and the names of the -`Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers, all on the same line. Otherwise, -the formatters fail. (@inforef{Top, info, info}, for more information -about nodes in Info.)@refill - -Usually, you write one of the chapter-structuring command lines -immediately after an @code{@@node} line---for example, an -@code{@@section} or @code{@@subsection} line. (@xref{Structuring -Command Types, , Types of Structuring Commands}.)@refill - -@quotation -@strong{Please note:} The GNU Emacs Texinfo mode updating commands work -only with Texinfo files in which @code{@@node} lines are followed by chapter -structuring lines. @xref{Updating Requirements}.@refill -@end quotation - -@TeX{} uses @code{@@node} lines to identify the names to use for cross -references. For this reason, you must write @code{@@node} lines in a -Texinfo file that you intend to format for printing, even if you do not -intend to format it for Info. (Cross references, such as the one at the -end of this sentence, are made with @code{@@xref} and its related -commands; see @ref{Cross References}.)@refill - -@menu -* Node Names:: How to choose node and pointer names. -* Writing a Node:: How to write an @code{@@node} line. -* Node Line Tips:: Keep names short. -* Node Line Requirements:: Keep names unique, without @@-commands. -* First Node:: How to write a `Top' node. -* makeinfo top command:: How to use the @code{@@top} command. -* Top Node Summary:: Write a brief description for readers. -@end menu - -@node Node Names, Writing a Node, node, node -@ifinfo -@subheading Choosing Node and Pointer Names -@end ifinfo - -The name of a node identifies the node. The pointers enable -you to reach other nodes and consist of the names of those nodes.@refill - -Normally, a node's `Up' pointer contains the name of the node whose menu -mentions that node. The node's `Next' pointer contains the name of the -node that follows that node in that menu and its `Previous' pointer -contains the name of the node that precedes it in that menu. When a -node's `Previous' node is the same as its `Up' node, both node pointers -name the same node.@refill - -Usually, the first node of a Texinfo file is the `Top' node, and its -`Up' and `Previous' pointers point to the @file{dir} file, which -contains the main menu for all of Info.@refill - -The `Top' node itself contains the main or master menu for the manual. -Also, it is helpful to include a brief description of the manual in the -`Top' node. @xref{First Node}, for information on how to write the -first node of a Texinfo file.@refill - -@node Writing a Node, Node Line Tips, Node Names, node -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection How to Write an @code{@@node} Line -@cindex Writing an @code{@@node} line -@cindex @code{@@node} line writing -@cindex Node line writing - -The easiest way to write an @code{@@node} line is to write @code{@@node} -at the beginning of a line and then the name of the node, like -this:@refill - -@example -@@node @var{node-name} -@end example - -If you are using GNU Emacs, you can use the update node commands -provided by Texinfo mode to insert the names of the pointers; or you -can leave the pointers out of the Texinfo file and let @code{makeinfo} -insert node pointers into the Info file it creates. (@xref{Texinfo -Mode}, and @ref{makeinfo Pointer Creation}.)@refill - -Alternatively, you can insert the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' -pointers yourself. If you do this, you may find it helpful to use the -Texinfo mode keyboard command @kbd{C-c C-c n}. This command inserts -@samp{@@node} and a comment line listing the names of the pointers in -their proper order. The comment line helps you keep track of which -arguments are for which pointers. This comment line is especially useful -if you are not familiar with Texinfo.@refill - -The template for a node line with `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers -looks like this:@refill - -@example -@@node @var{node-name}, @var{next}, @var{previous}, @var{up} -@end example - -If you wish, you can ignore @code{@@node} lines altogether in your first -draft and then use the @code{texinfo-insert-node-lines} command to -create @code{@@node} lines for you. However, we do not -recommend this practice. It is better to name the node itself -at the same time that you -write a segment so you can easily make cross references. A large number -of cross references are an especially important feature of a good Info -file.@refill - -After you have inserted an @code{@@node} line, you should immediately -write an @@-command for the chapter or section and insert its name. -Next (and this is important!), put in several index entries. Usually, -you will find at least two and often as many as four or five ways of -referring to the node in the index. Use them all. This will make it -much easier for people to find the node.@refill - -@node Node Line Tips, Node Line Requirements, Writing a Node, node -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection @code{@@node} Line Tips - -Here are three suggestions: - -@itemize @bullet -@item -Try to pick node names that are informative but short.@refill - -In the Info file, the file name, node name, and pointer names are all -inserted on one line, which may run into the right edge of the window. -(This does not cause a problem with Info, but is ugly.)@refill - -@item -Try to pick node names that differ from each other near the beginnings -of their names. This way, it is easy to use automatic name completion in -Info.@refill - -@item -By convention, node names are capitalized just as they would be for -section or chapter titles---initial and significant words are -capitalized; others are not.@refill -@end itemize - -@node Node Line Requirements, First Node, Node Line Tips, node -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection @code{@@node} Line Requirements - -@cindex Node line requirements -Here are several requirements for @code{@@node} lines: - -@itemize @bullet -@cindex Unique nodename requirement -@cindex Nodename must be unique -@item -All the node names for a single Info file must be unique.@refill - -Duplicates confuse the Info movement commands. This means, for -example, that if you end every chapter with a summary, you must name -each summary node differently. You cannot just call each one -``Summary''. You may, however, duplicate the titles of chapters, sections, -and the like. Thus you can end each chapter in a book with a section -called ``Summary'', so long as the node names for those sections are all -different.@refill - -@item -A pointer name must be the name of a node.@refill - -The node to which a pointer points may come before or after the -node containing the pointer.@refill - -@cindex @@-command in nodename -@cindex Nodename, cannot contain -@item -You cannot use any of the Texinfo @@-commands in a node name; -@w{@@-commands} confuse Info.@refill - -@need 750 -Thus, the beginning of the section called @code{@@chapter} looks like -this:@refill - -@smallexample -@group -@@node chapter, unnumbered & appendix, makeinfo top, Structuring -@@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@@section @@code@{@@@@chapter@} -@@findex chapter -@end group -@end smallexample - -@cindex Comma in nodename -@cindex Apostrophe in nodename -@item -You cannot use commas or apostrophes within a node name; these -confuse @TeX{} or the Info formatters.@refill - -@need 700 -For example, the following is a section title: - -@smallexample -@@code@{@@@@unnumberedsec@}, @@code@{@@@@appendixsec@}, @@code@{@@@@heading@} -@end smallexample - -@noindent -The corresponding node name is: - -@smallexample -unnumberedsec appendixsec heading -@end smallexample - -@cindex Case in nodename -@item -Case is significant. -@end itemize - - -@node First Node, makeinfo top command, Node Line Requirements, node -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection The First Node -@cindex Top node is first -@cindex First node - -The first node of a Texinfo file is the @dfn{Top} node, except in an -included file (@pxref{Include Files}). The Top node contains the main -or master menu for the document, and a short summary of the document -(@pxref{Top Node Summary}). - -@cindex Up node of Top node -@cindex (dir) as Up node of Top node -The Top node (which must be named @samp{top} or @samp{Top}) should have -as its `Up' node the name of a node in another file, where there is a -menu that leads to this file. Specify the file name in parentheses. If -the file is to be installed directly in the Info directory file, use -@samp{(dir)} as the parent of the Top node; this is short for -@samp{(dir)top}, and specifies the Top node in the @file{dir} file, -which contains the main menu for the Info system as a whole. For -example, the @code{@@node Top} line of this manual looks like this: - -@example -@@node Top, Copying, , (dir) -@end example - -@noindent -(You can use the Texinfo updating commands or the @code{makeinfo} -utility to insert these pointers automatically.) - -@cindex Previous node of Top node -Do not define the `Previous' node of the Top node to be @samp{(dir)}, as -it causes confusing behavior for users: if you are in the Top node and -hits @key{DEL} to go backwards, you wind up in the middle of the -some other entry in the @file{dir} file, which has nothing to do with -what you were reading. - -@xref{Install an Info File}, for more information about installing -an Info file in the @file{info} directory. - - -@node makeinfo top command, Top Node Summary, First Node, node -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection The @code{@@top} Sectioning Command -@findex top @r{(@@-command)} - -A special sectioning command, @code{@@top}, has been created for use -with the @code{@@node Top} line. The @code{@@top} sectioning command tells -@code{makeinfo} that it marks the `Top' node in the file. It provides -the information that @code{makeinfo} needs to insert node -pointers automatically. Write the @code{@@top} command at the -beginning of the line immediately following the @code{@@node Top} -line. Write the title on the remaining part of the same line as the -@code{@@top} command.@refill - -In Info, the @code{@@top} sectioning command causes the title to appear on a -line by itself, with a line of asterisks inserted underneath.@refill - -In @TeX{} and @code{texinfo-format-buffer}, the @code{@@top} -sectioning command is merely a synonym for @code{@@unnumbered}. -Neither of these formatters require an @code{@@top} command, and do -nothing special with it. You can use @code{@@chapter} or -@code{@@unnumbered} after the @code{@@node Top} line when you use -these formatters. Also, you can use @code{@@chapter} or -@code{@@unnumbered} when you use the Texinfo updating commands to -create or update pointers and menus.@refill - - -@node Top Node Summary, , makeinfo top command, node -@subsection The `Top' Node Summary -@cindex @samp{@r{Top}} node summary - -You can help readers by writing a summary in the `Top' node, after the -@code{@@top} line, before the main or master menu. The summary should -briefly describe the document. In Info, this summary will appear just -before the master menu. In a printed manual, this summary will appear -on a page of its own.@refill - -If you do not want the summary to appear on a page of its own in a -printed manual, you can enclose the whole of the `Top' node, including -the @code{@@node Top} line and the @code{@@top} sectioning command line -or other sectioning command line between @code{@@ifinfo} and @code{@@end -ifinfo}. This prevents any of the text from appearing in the printed -output. (@pxref{Conditionals, , Conditionally Visible Text}). You can -repeat the brief description from the `Top' node within @code{@@iftex} -@dots{} @code{@@end iftex} at the beginning of the first chapter, for -those who read the printed manual. This saves paper and may look -neater.@refill - -You should write the version number of the program to which the manual -applies in the summary. This helps the reader keep track of which -manual is for which version of the program. If the manual changes more -frequently than the program or is independent of it, you should also -include an edition number for the manual. (The title page should also -contain this information: see @ref{titlepage, , -@code{@@titlepage}}.)@refill - -@node makeinfo Pointer Creation, , node, Nodes -@section Creating Pointers with @code{makeinfo} -@cindex Creating pointers with @code{makeinfo} -@cindex Pointer creation with @code{makeinfo} -@cindex Automatic pointer creation with @code{makeinfo} - -The @code{makeinfo} program has a feature for automatically creating -node pointers for a hierarchically organized file that lacks -them.@refill - -When you take advantage of this feature, you do not need to write the -`Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers after the name of a node. -However, you must write a sectioning command, such as @code{@@chapter} -or @code{@@section}, on the line immediately following each truncated -@code{@@node} line. You cannot write a comment line after a node -line; the section line must follow it immediately.@refill - -In addition, you must follow the `Top' @code{@@node} line with a line beginning -with @code{@@top} to mark the `Top' node in the file. @xref{makeinfo -top, , @code{@@top}}. - -Finally, you must write the name of each node (except for the `Top' -node) in a menu that is one or more hierarchical levels above the -node's hierarchical level.@refill - -This node pointer insertion feature in @code{makeinfo} is an -alternative to the menu and pointer creation and update commands in -Texinfo mode. (@xref{Updating Nodes and Menus}.) It is especially -helpful to people who do not use GNU Emacs for writing Texinfo -documents.@refill - -@node Menus, Cross References, Nodes, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@chapter Menus -@cindex Menus -@findex menu - -@dfn{Menus} contain pointers to subordinate -nodes.@footnote{Menus can carry you to any node, regardless -of the hierarchical structure; even to nodes in a different -Info file. However, the GNU Emacs Texinfo mode updating -commands work only to create menus of subordinate nodes. -Conventionally, cross references are used to refer to other -nodes.} In Info, you use menus to go to such nodes. Menus -have no effect in printed manuals and do not appear in -them.@refill - -By convention, a menu is put at the end of a node since a reader who -uses the menu may not see text that follows it.@refill - -@ifinfo -A node that has a menu should @emph{not} contain much text. If you -have a lot of text and a menu, move most of the text into a new -subnode---all but a few lines.@refill -@end ifinfo -@iftex -@emph{A node that has a menu should not contain much text.} If you -have a lot of text and a menu, move most of the text into a new -subnode---all but a few lines. Otherwise, a reader with a terminal -that displays only a few lines may miss the menu and its associated -text. As a practical matter, you should locate a menu within 20 lines -of the beginning of the node.@refill -@end iftex - -@menu -* Menu Location:: Put a menu in a short node. -* Writing a Menu:: What is a menu? -* Menu Parts:: A menu entry has three parts. -* Less Cluttered Menu Entry:: Two part menu entry. -* Menu Example:: Two and three part menu entries. -* Other Info Files:: How to refer to a different Info file. -@end menu - -@node Menu Location, Writing a Menu, Menus, Menus -@ifinfo -@heading Menus Need Short Nodes -@end ifinfo -@cindex Menu location -@cindex Location of menus -@cindex Nodes for menus are short -@cindex Short nodes for menus - -@ifinfo -A reader can easily see a menu that is close to the beginning of the -node. The node should be short. As a practical matter, you should -locate a menu within 20 lines of the beginning of the node. -Otherwise, a reader with a terminal that displays only a few lines may -miss the menu and its associated text.@refill -@end ifinfo - -The short text before a menu may look awkward in a printed manual. To -avoid this, you can write a menu near the beginning of its node and -follow the menu by an @code{@@node} line, and then an @code{@@heading} -line located within @code{@@ifinfo} and @code{@@end ifinfo}. This way, -the menu, @code{@@node} line, and title appear only in the Info file, -not the printed document.@refill - -For example, the preceding two paragraphs follow an Info-only menu, -@code{@@node} line, and heading, and look like this:@refill - -@example -@group -@@menu -* Menu Location:: Put a menu in a short node. -* Writing a Menu:: What is a menu? -* Menu Parts:: A menu entry has three parts. -* Less Cluttered Menu Entry:: Two part menu entry. -* Menu Example:: Two and three part entries. -* Other Info Files:: How to refer to a different - Info file. -@@end menu - -@@node Menu Location, Writing a Menu, , Menus -@@ifinfo -@@heading Menus Need Short Nodes -@@end ifinfo -@end group -@end example - -The Texinfo file for this document contains more than a dozen -examples of this procedure. One is at the beginning of this chapter; -another is at the beginning of the ``Cross References'' chapter.@refill - -@node Writing a Menu, Menu Parts, Menu Location, Menus -@section Writing a Menu -@cindex Writing a menu -@cindex Menu writing - -A menu consists of an @code{@@menu} command on a line by -itself followed by menu entry lines or menu comment lines -and then by an @code{@@end menu} command on a line by -itself.@refill - -A menu looks like this:@refill - -@example -@group -@@menu -Larger Units of Text - -* Files:: All about handling files. -* Multiples: Buffers. Multiple buffers; editing - several files at once. -@@end menu -@end group -@end example - -In a menu, every line that begins with an @w{@samp{* }} is a -@dfn{menu entry}. (Note the space after the asterisk.) A -line that does not start with an @w{@samp{* }} may also -appear in a menu. Such a line is not a menu entry but is a -menu comment line that appears in the Info file. In -the example above, the line @samp{Larger Units of Text} is a -menu comment line; the two lines starting with @w{@samp{* }} -are menu entries. - -@node Menu Parts, Less Cluttered Menu Entry, Writing a Menu, Menus -@section The Parts of a Menu -@cindex Parts of a menu -@cindex Menu parts -@cindex @code{@@menu} parts - -A menu entry has three parts, only the second of which is required: - -@enumerate -@item -The menu entry name (optional). - -@item -The name of the node (required). - -@item -A description of the item (optional). -@end enumerate - -The template for a menu entry looks like this:@refill - -@example -* @var{menu-entry-name}: @var{node-name}. @var{description} -@end example - -Follow the menu entry name with a single colon and follow the node name -with tab, comma, period, or newline.@refill - -In Info, a user selects a node with the @kbd{m} (@code{Info-menu}) -command. The menu entry name is what the user types after the @kbd{m} -command.@refill - -The third part of a menu entry is a descriptive phrase or sentence. -Menu entry names and node names are often short; the description -explains to the reader what the node is about. A useful description -complements the node name rather than repeats it. The description, -which is optional, can spread over two or more lines; if it does, some -authors prefer to indent the second line while others prefer to align it -with the first (and all others). It's up to you. - - -@node Less Cluttered Menu Entry, Menu Example, Menu Parts, Menus -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Less Cluttered Menu Entry -@cindex Two part menu entry -@cindex Double-colon menu entries -@cindex Menu entries with two colons -@cindex Less cluttered menu entry -@cindex Uncluttered menu entry - -When the menu entry name and node name are the same, you can write -the name immediately after the asterisk and space at the beginning of -the line and follow the name with two colons.@refill - -@need 800 -For example, write - -@example -* Name:: @var{description} -@end example - -@need 800 -@noindent -instead of - -@example -* Name: Name. @var{description} -@end example - -You should use the node name for the menu entry name whenever possible, -since it reduces visual clutter in the menu.@refill - -@node Menu Example, Other Info Files, Less Cluttered Menu Entry, Menus -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section A Menu Example -@cindex Menu example -@cindex Example menu - -A menu looks like this in Texinfo:@refill - -@example -@group -@@menu -* menu entry name: Node name. A short description. -* Node name:: This form is preferred. -@@end menu -@end group -@end example - -@need 800 -@noindent -This produces: - -@example -@group -* menu: - -* menu entry name: Node name. A short description. -* Node name:: This form is preferred. -@end group -@end example - -@need 700 -Here is an example as you might see it in a Texinfo file:@refill - -@example -@group -@@menu -Larger Units of Text - -* Files:: All about handling files. -* Multiples: Buffers. Multiple buffers; editing - several files at once. -@@end menu -@end group -@end example - -@need 800 -@noindent -This produces: - -@example -@group -* menu: -Larger Units of Text - -* Files:: All about handling files. -* Multiples: Buffers. Multiple buffers; editing - several files at once. -@end group -@end example - -In this example, the menu has two entries. @samp{Files} is both a menu -entry name and the name of the node referred to by that name. -@samp{Multiples} is the menu entry name; it refers to the node named -@samp{Buffers}. The line @samp{Larger Units of Text} is a comment; it -appears in the menu, but is not an entry.@refill - -Since no file name is specified with either @samp{Files} or -@samp{Buffers}, they must be the names of nodes in the same Info file -(@pxref{Other Info Files, , Referring to Other Info Files}).@refill - -@node Other Info Files, , Menu Example, Menus -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Referring to Other Info Files -@cindex Referring to other Info files -@cindex Nodes in other Info files -@cindex Other Info files' nodes -@cindex Going to other Info files' nodes -@cindex Info; other files' nodes - -You can create a menu entry that enables a reader in Info to go to a -node in another Info file by writing the file name in parentheses just -before the node name. In this case, you should use the three-part menu -entry format, which saves the reader from having to type the file -name.@refill - -@need 800 -The format looks like this:@refill - -@example -@group -@@menu -* @var{first-entry-name}:(@var{filename})@var{nodename}. @var{description} -* @var{second-entry-name}:(@var{filename})@var{second-node}. @var{description} -@@end menu -@end group -@end example - -For example, to refer directly to the @samp{Outlining} and -@samp{Rebinding} nodes in the @cite{Emacs Manual}, you would write a -menu like this:@refill - -@example -@group -@@menu -* Outlining: (emacs)Outline Mode. The major mode for - editing outlines. -* Rebinding: (emacs)Rebinding. How to redefine the - meaning of a key. -@@end menu -@end group -@end example - -If you do not list the node name, but only name the file, then Info -presumes that you are referring to the `Top' node.@refill - -The @file{dir} file that contains the main menu for Info has menu -entries that list only file names. These take you directly to the `Top' -nodes of each Info document. (@xref{Install an Info File}.)@refill - -@need 700 -For example: - -@example -@group -* Info: (info). Documentation browsing system. -* Emacs: (emacs). The extensible, self-documenting - text editor. -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -(The @file{dir} top level directory for the Info system is an Info file, -not a Texinfo file, but a menu entry looks the same in both types of -file.)@refill - -Note that the GNU Emacs Texinfo mode menu updating commands only work -with nodes within the current buffer, so you cannot use them to create -menus that refer to other files. You must write such menus by hand.@refill - -@node Cross References, Marking Text, Menus, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@chapter Cross References -@cindex Making cross references -@cindex Cross references -@cindex References - -@dfn{Cross references} are used to refer the reader to other parts of the -same or different Texinfo files. In Texinfo, nodes are the -places to which cross references can refer.@refill - -@menu -* References:: What cross references are for. -* Cross Reference Commands:: A summary of the different commands. -* Cross Reference Parts:: A cross reference has several parts. -* xref:: Begin a reference with `See' @dots{} -* Top Node Naming:: How to refer to the beginning of another file. -* ref:: A reference for the last part of a sentence. -* pxref:: How to write a parenthetical cross reference. -* inforef:: How to refer to an Info-only file. -* uref:: How to refer to a uniform resource locator. -@end menu - -@node References, Cross Reference Commands, Cross References, Cross References -@ifinfo -@heading What References Are For -@end ifinfo - -Often, but not always, a printed document should be designed so that -it can be read sequentially. People tire of flipping back and forth -to find information that should be presented to them as they need -it.@refill - -However, in any document, some information will be too detailed for -the current context, or incidental to it; use cross references to -provide access to such information. Also, an on-line help system or a -reference manual is not like a novel; few read such documents in -sequence from beginning to end. Instead, people look up what they -need. For this reason, such creations should contain many cross -references to help readers find other information that they may not -have read.@refill - -In a printed manual, a cross reference results in a page reference, -unless it is to another manual altogether, in which case the cross -reference names that manual.@refill - -In Info, a cross reference results in an entry that you can follow using -the Info @samp{f} command. (@inforef{Help-Adv, Some advanced Info -commands, info}.)@refill - -The various cross reference commands use nodes to define cross -reference locations. This is evident in Info, in which a cross -reference takes you to the specified node. @TeX{} also uses nodes to -define cross reference locations, but the action is less obvious. When -@TeX{} generates a DVI file, it records nodes' page numbers and -uses the page numbers in making references. Thus, if you are writing -a manual that will only be printed, and will not be used on-line, you -must nonetheless write @code{@@node} lines to name the places to which -you make cross references.@refill - -@need 800 -@node Cross Reference Commands, Cross Reference Parts, References, Cross References -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Different Cross Reference Commands -@cindex Different cross reference commands - -There are four different cross reference commands:@refill - -@table @code -@item @@xref -Used to start a sentence in the printed manual saying @w{`See @dots{}'} -or an Info cross-reference saying @samp{*Note @var{name}: @var{node}.}. - -@item @@ref -Used within or, more often, at the end of a sentence; same as -@code{@@xref} for Info; produces just the reference in the printed -manual without a preceding `See'.@refill - -@item @@pxref -Used within parentheses to make a reference that suits both an Info -file and a printed book. Starts with a lower case `see' within the -printed manual. (@samp{p} is for `parenthesis'.)@refill - -@item @@inforef -Used to make a reference to an Info file for which there is no printed -manual.@refill -@end table - -@noindent -(The @code{@@cite} command is used to make references to books and -manuals for which there is no corresponding Info file and, therefore, -no node to which to point. @xref{cite, , @code{@@cite}}.)@refill - -@node Cross Reference Parts, xref, Cross Reference Commands, Cross References -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Parts of a Cross Reference -@cindex Cross reference parts -@cindex Parts of a cross reference - -A cross reference command requires only one argument, which is the -name of the node to which it refers. But a cross reference command -may contain up to four additional arguments. By using these -arguments, you can provide a cross reference name for Info, a topic -description or section title for the printed output, the name of a -different Info file, and the name of a different printed -manual.@refill - -Here is a simple cross reference example:@refill - -@example -@@xref@{Node name@}. -@end example - -@noindent -which produces - -@example -*Note Node name::. -@end example - -@noindent -and - -@quotation -See Section @var{nnn} [Node name], page @var{ppp}. -@end quotation - -@need 700 -Here is an example of a full five-part cross reference:@refill - -@example -@group -@@xref@{Node name, Cross Reference Name, Particular Topic, -info-file-name, A Printed Manual@}, for details. -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -which produces - -@example -*Note Cross Reference Name: (info-file-name)Node name, -for details. -@end example - -@noindent -in Info and - -@quotation -See section ``Particular Topic'' in @i{A Printed Manual}, for details. -@end quotation - -@noindent -in a printed book. - -The five possible arguments for a cross reference are:@refill - -@enumerate -@item -The node name (required). This is the node to which the -cross reference takes you. In a printed document, the location of the -node provides the page reference only for references within the same -document.@refill - -@item -The cross reference name for the Info reference, if it is to be different -from the node name. If you include this argument, it becomes -the first part of the cross reference. It is usually omitted.@refill - -@item -A topic description or section name. Often, this is the title of the -section. This is used as the name of the reference in the printed -manual. If omitted, the node name is used.@refill - -@item -The name of the Info file in which the reference is located, if it is -different from the current file. You need not include any @samp{.info} -suffix on the file name, since Info readers try appending it -automatically. - -@item -The name of a printed manual from a different Texinfo file.@refill -@end enumerate - -The template for a full five argument cross reference looks like -this:@refill - -@example -@group -@@xref@{@var{node-name}, @var{cross-reference-name}, @var{title-or-topic}, -@var{info-file-name}, @var{printed-manual-title}@}. -@end group -@end example - -Cross references with one, two, three, four, and five arguments are -described separately following the description of @code{@@xref}.@refill - -Write a node name in a cross reference in exactly the same way as in -the @code{@@node} line, including the same capitalization; otherwise, the -formatters may not find the reference.@refill - -You can write cross reference commands within a paragraph, but note -how Info and @TeX{} format the output of each of the various commands: -write @code{@@xref} at the beginning of a sentence; write -@code{@@pxref} only within parentheses, and so on.@refill - -@node xref, Top Node Naming, Cross Reference Parts, Cross References -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@xref} -@findex xref -@cindex Cross references using @code{@@xref} -@cindex References using @code{@@xref} - -The @code{@@xref} command generates a cross reference for the -beginning of a sentence. The Info formatting commands convert it into -an Info cross reference, which the Info @samp{f} command can use to -bring you directly to another node. The @TeX{} typesetting commands -convert it into a page reference, or a reference to another book or -manual.@refill - -@menu -* Reference Syntax:: What a reference looks like and requires. -* One Argument:: @code{@@xref} with one argument. -* Two Arguments:: @code{@@xref} with two arguments. -* Three Arguments:: @code{@@xref} with three arguments. -* Four and Five Arguments:: @code{@@xref} with four and five arguments. -@end menu - -@node Reference Syntax, One Argument, xref, xref -@ifinfo -@subheading What a Reference Looks Like and Requires -@end ifinfo - -Most often, an Info cross reference looks like this:@refill - -@example -*Note @var{node-name}::. -@end example - -@noindent -or like this - -@example -*Note @var{cross-reference-name}: @var{node-name}. -@end example - -@noindent -In @TeX{}, a cross reference looks like this: - -@example -See Section @var{section-number} [@var{node-name}], page @var{page}. -@end example - -@noindent -or like this - -@example -See Section @var{section-number} [@var{title-or-topic}], page @var{page}. -@end example - -The @code{@@xref} command does not generate a period or comma to end -the cross reference in either the Info file or the printed output. -You must write that period or comma yourself; otherwise, Info will not -recognize the end of the reference. (The @code{@@pxref} command works -differently. @xref{pxref, , @code{@@pxref}}.)@refill - -@quotation -@strong{Please note:} A period or comma @strong{must} follow the closing -brace of an @code{@@xref}. It is required to terminate the cross -reference. This period or comma will appear in the output, both in -the Info file and in the printed manual.@refill -@end quotation - -@code{@@xref} must refer to an Info node by name. Use @code{@@node} -to define the node (@pxref{Writing a Node}).@refill - -@code{@@xref} is followed by several arguments inside braces, separated by -commas. Whitespace before and after these commas is ignored.@refill - -A cross reference requires only the name of a node; but it may contain -up to four additional arguments. Each of these variations produces a -cross reference that looks somewhat different.@refill - -@quotation -@strong{Please note:} Commas separate arguments in a cross reference; -avoid including them in the title or other part lest the formatters -mistake them for separators.@refill -@end quotation - -@node One Argument, Two Arguments, Reference Syntax, xref -@subsection @code{@@xref} with One Argument - -The simplest form of @code{@@xref} takes one argument, the name of -another node in the same Info file. The Info formatters produce -output that the Info readers can use to jump to the reference; @TeX{} -produces output that specifies the page and section number for you.@refill - -@need 700 -@noindent -For example, - -@example -@@xref@{Tropical Storms@}. -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@example -*Note Tropical Storms::. -@end example - -@noindent -and - -@quotation -See Section 3.1 [Tropical Storms], page 24. -@end quotation - -@noindent -(Note that in the preceding example the closing brace is followed by a -period.)@refill - -You can write a clause after the cross reference, like this:@refill - -@example -@@xref@{Tropical Storms@}, for more info. -@end example - -@noindent -which produces - -@example -*Note Tropical Storms::, for more info. -@end example - -@quotation -See Section 3.1 [Tropical Storms], page 24, for more info. -@end quotation - -@noindent -(Note that in the preceding example the closing brace is followed by a -comma, and then by the clause, which is followed by a period.)@refill - -@node Two Arguments, Three Arguments, One Argument, xref -@subsection @code{@@xref} with Two Arguments - -With two arguments, the second is used as the name of the Info cross -reference, while the first is still the name of the node to which the -cross reference points.@refill - -@need 750 -@noindent -The template is like this: - -@example -@@xref@{@var{node-name}, @var{cross-reference-name}@}. -@end example - -@need 700 -@noindent -For example, - -@example -@@xref@{Electrical Effects, Lightning@}. -@end example - -@noindent -produces: - -@example -*Note Lightning: Electrical Effects. -@end example - -@noindent -and - -@quotation -See Section 5.2 [Electrical Effects], page 57. -@end quotation - -@noindent -(Note that in the preceding example the closing brace is followed by a -period; and that the node name is printed, not the cross reference name.)@refill - -You can write a clause after the cross reference, like this:@refill - -@example -@@xref@{Electrical Effects, Lightning@}, for more info. -@end example - -@noindent -which produces -@example -*Note Lightning: Electrical Effects, for more info. -@end example - -@noindent -and - -@quotation -See Section 5.2 [Electrical Effects], page 57, for more info. -@end quotation - -@noindent -(Note that in the preceding example the closing brace is followed by a -comma, and then by the clause, which is followed by a period.)@refill - -@node Three Arguments, Four and Five Arguments, Two Arguments, xref -@subsection @code{@@xref} with Three Arguments - -A third argument replaces the node name in the @TeX{} output. The third -argument should be the name of the section in the printed output, or -else state the topic discussed by that section. Often, you will want to -use initial upper case letters so it will be easier to read when the -reference is printed. Use a third argument when the node name is -unsuitable because of syntax or meaning.@refill - -Remember to avoid placing a comma within the title or topic section of -a cross reference, or within any other section. The formatters divide -cross references into arguments according to the commas; a comma -within a title or other section will divide it into two arguments. In -a reference, you need to write a title such as ``Clouds, Mist, and -Fog'' without the commas.@refill - -Also, remember to write a comma or period after the closing brace of a -@code{@@xref} to terminate the cross reference. In the following -examples, a clause follows a terminating comma.@refill - - -@need 750 -@noindent -The template is like this: - -@example -@group -@@xref@{@var{node-name}, @var{cross-reference-name}, @var{title-or-topic}@}. -@end group -@end example - -@need 700 -@noindent -For example, - -@example -@group -@@xref@{Electrical Effects, Lightning, Thunder and Lightning@}, -for details. -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@example -*Note Lightning: Electrical Effects, for details. -@end example - -@noindent -and - -@quotation -See Section 5.2 [Thunder and Lightning], page 57, for details. -@end quotation - -If a third argument is given and the second one is empty, then the -third argument serves both. (Note how two commas, side by side, mark -the empty second argument.)@refill - -@example -@group -@@xref@{Electrical Effects, , Thunder and Lightning@}, -for details. -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@example -*Note Thunder and Lightning: Electrical Effects, for details. -@end example - -@noindent -and - -@quotation -See Section 5.2 [Thunder and Lightning], page 57, for details. -@end quotation - -As a practical matter, it is often best to write cross references with -just the first argument if the node name and the section title are the -same, and with the first and third arguments if the node name and title -are different.@refill - -Here are several examples from @cite{The GNU Awk User's Guide}:@refill - -@smallexample -@@xref@{Sample Program@}. -@@xref@{Glossary@}. -@@xref@{Case-sensitivity, ,Case-sensitivity in Matching@}. -@@xref@{Close Output, , Closing Output Files and Pipes@}, - for more information. -@@xref@{Regexp, , Regular Expressions as Patterns@}. -@end smallexample - -@node Four and Five Arguments, , Three Arguments, xref -@subsection @code{@@xref} with Four and Five Arguments - -In a cross reference, a fourth argument specifies the name of another -Info file, different from the file in which the reference appears, and -a fifth argument specifies its title as a printed manual.@refill - -Remember that a comma or period must follow the closing brace of an -@code{@@xref} command to terminate the cross reference. In the -following examples, a clause follows a terminating comma.@refill - -@need 800 -@noindent -The template is: - -@example -@group -@@xref@{@var{node-name}, @var{cross-reference-name}, @var{title-or-topic}, -@var{info-file-name}, @var{printed-manual-title}@}. -@end group -@end example - -@need 700 -@noindent -For example, - -@example -@@xref@{Electrical Effects, Lightning, Thunder and Lightning, -weather, An Introduction to Meteorology@}, for details. -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@example -*Note Lightning: (weather)Electrical Effects, for details. -@end example - -@noindent -The name of the Info file is enclosed in parentheses and precedes -the name of the node. - -@noindent -In a printed manual, the reference looks like this:@refill - -@quotation -See section ``Thunder and Lightning'' in @i{An Introduction to -Meteorology}, for details. -@end quotation - -@noindent -The title of the printed manual is typeset in italics; and the -reference lacks a page number since @TeX{} cannot know to which page a -reference refers when that reference is to another manual.@refill - -Often, you will leave out the second argument when you use the long -version of @code{@@xref}. In this case, the third argument, the topic -description, will be used as the cross reference name in Info.@refill - -@noindent -The template looks like this: - -@example -@@xref@{@var{node-name}, , @var{title-or-topic}, @var{info-file-name}, -@var{printed-manual-title}@}, for details. -@end example - -@noindent -which produces - -@example -*Note @var{title-or-topic}: (@var{info-file-name})@var{node-name}, for details. -@end example - -@noindent -and - -@quotation -See section @var{title-or-topic} in @var{printed-manual-title}, for details. -@end quotation - -@need 700 -@noindent -For example, - -@example -@@xref@{Electrical Effects, , Thunder and Lightning, -weather, An Introduction to Meteorology@}, for details. -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@example -@group -*Note Thunder and Lightning: (weather)Electrical Effects, -for details. -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -and - -@quotation -See section ``Thunder and Lightning'' in @i{An Introduction to -Meteorology}, for details. -@end quotation - -On rare occasions, you may want to refer to another Info file that -is within a single printed manual---when multiple Texinfo files are -incorporated into the same @TeX{} run but make separate Info files. -In this case, you need to specify only the fourth argument, and not -the fifth.@refill - -@node Top Node Naming, ref, xref, Cross References -@section Naming a `Top' Node -@cindex Naming a `Top' Node in references -@cindex @samp{@r{Top}} node naming for references - -In a cross reference, you must always name a node. This means that in -order to refer to a whole manual, you must identify the `Top' node by -writing it as the first argument to the @code{@@xref} command. (This -is different from the way you write a menu entry; see @ref{Other Info -Files, , Referring to Other Info Files}.) At the same time, to -provide a meaningful section topic or title in the printed cross -reference (instead of the word `Top'), you must write an appropriate -entry for the third argument to the @code{@@xref} command. -@refill - -@noindent -Thus, to make a cross reference to @cite{The GNU Make Manual}, -write:@refill - -@example -@@xref@{Top, , Overview, make, The GNU Make Manual@}. -@end example - -@noindent -which produces - -@example -*Note Overview: (make)Top. -@end example - -@noindent -and - -@quotation -See section ``Overview'' in @i{The GNU Make Manual}. -@end quotation - -@noindent -In this example, @samp{Top} is the name of the first node, and -@samp{Overview} is the name of the first section of the manual.@refill -@node ref, pxref, Top Node Naming, Cross References -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@ref} -@cindex Cross references using @code{@@ref} -@cindex References using @code{@@ref} -@findex ref - -@code{@@ref} is nearly the same as @code{@@xref} except that it does -not generate a `See' in the printed output, just the reference itself. -This makes it useful as the last part of a sentence.@refill - -@need 700 -@noindent -For example, - -@example -For more information, see @@ref@{Hurricanes@}. -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@example -For more information, see *Note Hurricanes. -@end example - -@noindent -and - -@quotation -For more information, see Section 8.2 [Hurricanes], page 123. -@end quotation - -The @code{@@ref} command sometimes leads writers to express themselves -in a manner that is suitable for a printed manual but looks awkward -in the Info format. Bear in mind that your audience will be using -both the printed and the Info format.@refill - -@need 800 -@noindent -For example, - -@example -@group -Sea surges are described in @@ref@{Hurricanes@}. -@end group -@end example - -@need 800 -@noindent -produces - -@quotation -Sea surges are described in Section 6.7 [Hurricanes], page 72. -@end quotation - -@need 800 -@noindent -in a printed document, and the following in Info: - -@example -Sea surges are described in *Note Hurricanes::. -@end example - -@quotation -@strong{Caution:} You @emph{must} write a period or comma immediately -after an @code{@@ref} command with two or more arguments. Otherwise, -Info will not find the end of the cross reference entry and its -attempt to follow the cross reference will fail. As a general rule, -you should write a period or comma after every @code{@@ref} command. -This looks best in both the printed and the Info output.@refill -@end quotation - -@node pxref, inforef, ref, Cross References -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@pxref} -@cindex Cross references using @code{@@pxref} -@cindex References using @code{@@pxref} -@findex pxref - -The parenthetical reference command, @code{@@pxref}, is nearly the -same as @code{@@xref}, but you use it @emph{only} inside parentheses -and you do @emph{not} type a comma or period after the command's -closing brace. The command differs from @code{@@xref} in two -ways:@refill - -@enumerate -@item -@TeX{} typesets the reference for the printed manual with a lower case -`see' rather than an upper case `See'.@refill - -@item -The Info formatting commands automatically end the reference with a -closing colon or period.@refill -@end enumerate - -Because one type of formatting automatically inserts closing -punctuation and the other does not, you should use @code{@@pxref} -@emph{only} inside parentheses as part of another sentence. Also, you -yourself should not insert punctuation after the reference, as you do -with @code{@@xref}.@refill - -@code{@@pxref} is designed so that the output looks right and works -right between parentheses both in printed output and in an Info file. -In a printed manual, a closing comma or period should not follow a -cross reference within parentheses; such punctuation is wrong. But in -an Info file, suitable closing punctuation must follow the cross -reference so Info can recognize its end. @code{@@pxref} spares you -the need to use complicated methods to put a terminator into one form -of the output and not the other.@refill - -@noindent -With one argument, a parenthetical cross reference looks like -this:@refill - -@example -@dots{} storms cause flooding (@@pxref@{Hurricanes@}) @dots{} -@end example - -@need 800 -@noindent -which produces - -@example -@group -@dots{} storms cause flooding (*Note Hurricanes::) @dots{} -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -and - -@quotation -@dots{} storms cause flooding (see Section 6.7 [Hurricanes], page 72) @dots{} -@end quotation - -With two arguments, a parenthetical cross reference has this -template:@refill - -@example -@dots{} (@@pxref@{@var{node-name}, @var{cross-reference-name}@}) @dots{} -@end example - -@noindent -which produces - -@example -@dots{} (*Note @var{cross-reference-name}: @var{node-name}.) @dots{} -@end example - -@noindent -and - -@need 1500 -@quotation -@dots{} (see Section @var{nnn} [@var{node-name}], page @var{ppp}) @dots{} -@end quotation - -@code{@@pxref} can be used with up to five arguments just like -@code{@@xref} (@pxref{xref, , @code{@@xref}}).@refill - -@quotation -@strong{Please note:} Use @code{@@pxref} only as a parenthetical -reference. Do not try to use @code{@@pxref} as a clause in a sentence. -It will look bad in either the Info file, the printed output, or -both.@refill - -Also, parenthetical cross references look best at the ends of sentences. -Although you may write them in the middle of a sentence, that location -breaks up the flow of text.@refill -@end quotation - -@node inforef, uref, pxref, Cross References -@section @code{@@inforef} -@cindex Cross references using @code{@@inforef} -@cindex References using @code{@@inforef} -@findex inforef - -@code{@@inforef} is used for cross references to Info files for which -there are no printed manuals. Even in a printed manual, -@code{@@inforef} generates a reference directing the user to look in -an Info file.@refill - -The command takes either two or three arguments, in the following -order:@refill - -@enumerate -@item -The node name. - -@item -The cross reference name (optional). - -@item -The Info file name. -@end enumerate - -@noindent -Separate the arguments with commas, as with @code{@@xref}. Also, you -must terminate the reference with a comma or period after the -@samp{@}}, as you do with @code{@@xref}.@refill - -@noindent -The template is: - -@example -@@inforef@{@var{node-name}, @var{cross-reference-name}, @var{info-file-name}@}, -@end example - -@need 800 -@noindent -Thus, - -@example -@group -@@inforef@{Expert, Advanced Info commands, info@}, -for more information. -@end group -@end example - -@need 800 -@noindent -produces - -@example -@group -*Note Advanced Info commands: (info)Expert, -for more information. -@end group -@end example - -@need 800 -@noindent -and - -@quotation -See Info file @file{info}, node @samp{Expert}, for more information. -@end quotation - -@need 800 -@noindent -Similarly, - -@example -@group -@@inforef@{Expert, , info@}, for more information. -@end group -@end example - -@need 800 -@noindent -produces - -@example -*Note (info)Expert::, for more information. -@end example - -@need 800 -@noindent -and - -@quotation -See Info file @file{info}, node @samp{Expert}, for more information. -@end quotation - -The converse of @code{@@inforef} is @code{@@cite}, which is used to -refer to printed works for which no Info form exists. @xref{cite, , -@code{@@cite}}.@refill - - -@node uref, , inforef, Cross References -@section @code{@@uref@{@var{url}[, @var{displayed-text}]@}} -@findex uref -@cindex Uniform resource locator, referring to -@cindex URL, referring to - -@code{@@uref} produces a reference to a uniform resource locator (URL). -It takes one mandatory argument, the URL, and one optional argument, the -text to display (the default is the URL itself). In HTML output, -@code{@@uref} produces a link you can follow. For example: - -@example -The official GNU ftp site is -@@uref@{ftp://ftp.gnu.ai.mit.edu/pub/gnu@} -@end example - -@noindent produces (in text): -@display -The official GNU ftp site is -@uref{ftp://ftp.gnu.ai.mit.edu/pub/gnu} -@end display - -@noindent whereas -@example -The official -@@uref@{ftp://ftp.gnu.ai.mit.edu/pub/gnu, - GNU ftp site@} holds programs and texts. -@end example - -@noindent produces (in text): -@display -The official @uref{ftp://ftp.gnu.ai.mit.edu/pub/gnu, GNU ftp site} holds -programs and texts. -@end display - -@noindent and (in HTML): -@example -The official <A HREF="ftp://ftp.gnu.ai.mit.edu/pub/gnu">GNU ftp -site</A> holds programs and texts. -@end example - -To merely indicate a URL, use @code{@@url} (@pxref{url, @code{@@url}}). - - -@node Marking Text, Quotations and Examples, Cross References, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@chapter Marking Words and Phrases -@cindex Paragraph, marking text within -@cindex Marking words and phrases -@cindex Words and phrases, marking them -@cindex Marking text within a paragraph - -In Texinfo, you can mark words and phrases in a variety of ways. -The Texinfo formatters use this information to determine how to -highlight the text. -You can specify, for example, whether a word or phrase is a -defining occurrence, a metasyntactic variable, or a symbol used in a -program. Also, you can emphasize text.@refill - -@menu -* Indicating:: How to indicate definitions, files, etc. -* Emphasis:: How to emphasize text. -@end menu - -@node Indicating, Emphasis, Marking Text, Marking Text -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Indicating Definitions, Commands, etc. -@cindex Highlighting text -@cindex Indicating commands, definitions, etc. - -Texinfo has commands for indicating just what kind of object a piece of -text refers to. For example, metasyntactic variables are marked by -@code{@@var}, and code by @code{@@code}. Since the pieces of text are -labelled by commands that tell what kind of object they are, it is easy -to change the way the Texinfo formatters prepare such text. (Texinfo is -an @emph{intentional} formatting language rather than a @emph{typesetting} -formatting language.)@refill - -For example, in a printed manual, -code is usually illustrated in a typewriter font; -@code{@@code} tells @TeX{} to typeset this text in this font. But it -would be easy to change the way @TeX{} highlights code to use another -font, and this change would not effect how keystroke examples are -highlighted. If straight typesetting commands were used in the body -of the file and you wanted to make a change, you would need to check -every single occurrence to make sure that you were changing code and -not something else that should not be changed.@refill - -@menu -* Useful Highlighting:: Highlighting provides useful information. -* code:: How to indicate code. -* kbd:: How to show keyboard input. -* key:: How to specify keys. -* samp:: How to show a literal sequence of characters. -* var:: How to indicate a metasyntactic variable. -* file:: How to indicate the name of a file. -* dfn:: How to specify a definition. -* cite:: How to refer to a book that is not in Info. -* url:: How to indicate a world wide web reference. -* email:: How to indicate an electronic mail address. -@end menu - -@node Useful Highlighting, code, Indicating, Indicating -@ifinfo -@subheading Highlighting Commands are Useful -@end ifinfo - -The highlighting commands can be used to generate useful information -from the file, such as lists of functions or file names. It is -possible, for example, to write a program in Emacs Lisp (or a keyboard -macro) to insert an index entry after every paragraph that contains -words or phrases marked by a specified command. You could do this to -construct an index of functions if you had not already made the -entries.@refill - -The commands serve a variety of purposes:@refill - -@table @code -@item @@code@{@var{sample-code}@} -Indicate text that is a literal example of a piece of a program.@refill - -@item @@kbd@{@var{keyboard-characters}@} -Indicate keyboard input.@refill - -@item @@key@{@var{key-name}@} -Indicate the conventional name for a key on a keyboard.@refill - -@item @@samp@{@var{text}@} -Indicate text that is a literal example of a sequence of characters.@refill - -@item @@var@{@var{metasyntactic-variable}@} -Indicate a metasyntactic variable.@refill - -@item @@url@{@var{uniform-resource-locator}@} -Indicate a uniform resource locator for the World Wide Web. - -@item @@file@{@var{file-name}@} -Indicate the name of a file.@refill - -@item @@email@{@var{email-address}[, @var{displayed-text}]@} -Indicate an electronic mail address. - -@item @@dfn@{@var{term}@} -Indicate the introductory or defining use of a term.@refill - -@item @@cite@{@var{reference}@} -Indicate the name of a book.@refill - -@ignore -@item @@ctrl@{@var{ctrl-char}@} -Use for an @sc{ascii} control character.@refill -@end ignore -@end table - -@node code, kbd, Useful Highlighting, Indicating -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection @code{@@code}@{@var{sample-code}@} -@findex code - -Use the @code{@@code} command to indicate text that is a piece of a -program and which consists of entire syntactic tokens. Enclose the -text in braces.@refill - -Thus, you should use @code{@@code} for an expression in a program, for -the name of a variable or function used in a program, or for a -keyword. Also, you should use @code{@@code} for the name of a -program, such as @code{diff}, that is a name used in the machine. (You -should write the name of a program in the ordinary text font if you -regard it as a new English word, such as `Emacs' or `Bison'.)@refill - -Use @code{@@code} for environment variables such as @code{TEXINPUTS}, -and other variables.@refill - -Use @code{@@code} for command names in command languages that -resemble programming languages, such as Texinfo or the shell. -For example, @code{@@code} and @code{@@samp} are produced by writing -@samp{@@code@{@@@@code@}} and @samp{@@code@{@@@@samp@}} in the Texinfo -source, respectively.@refill - -Note, however, that you should not use @code{@@code} for shell options -such as @samp{-c} when such options stand alone. (Use @code{@@samp}.) -Also, an entire shell command often looks better if written using -@code{@@samp} rather than @code{@@code}. In this case, the rule is to -choose the more pleasing format.@refill - -It is incorrect to alter the case of a word inside an @code{@@code} -command when it appears at the beginning of a sentence. Most computer -languages are case sensitive. In C, for example, @code{Printf} is -different from the identifier @code{printf}, and most likely is a -misspelling of it. Even in languages which are not case sensitive, it -is confusing to a human reader to see identifiers spelled in different -ways. Pick one spelling and always use that. If you do not want to -start a sentence with a command written all in lower case, you should -rearrange the sentence.@refill - -Do not use the @code{@@code} command for a string of characters shorter -than a syntactic token. If you are writing about @samp{TEXINPU}, which -is just a part of the name for the @code{TEXINPUTS} environment -variable, you should use @code{@@samp}.@refill - -In particular, you should not use the @code{@@code} command when writing -about the characters used in a token; do not, for example, use -@code{@@code} when you are explaining what letters or printable symbols -can be used in the names of functions. (Use @code{@@samp}.) Also, you -should not use @code{@@code} to mark text that is considered input to -programs unless the input is written in a language that is like a -programming language. For example, you should not use @code{@@code} for -the keystroke commands of GNU Emacs (use @code{@@kbd} instead) although -you may use @code{@@code} for the names of the Emacs Lisp functions that -the keystroke commands invoke.@refill - -In the printed manual, @code{@@code} causes @TeX{} to typeset the -argument in a typewriter face. In the Info file, it causes the Info -formatting commands to use single quotation marks around the text. - -@need 700 -For example, - -@example -Use @@code@{diff@} to compare two files. -@end example - -@noindent -produces this in the printed manual:@refill - -@quotation -Use @code{diff} to compare two files. -@end quotation -@iftex - -@noindent -and this in the Info file:@refill - -@example -Use `diff' to compare two files. -@end example -@end iftex - - -@node kbd, key, code, Indicating -@subsection @code{@@kbd}@{@var{keyboard-characters}@} -@findex kbd -@cindex keyboard input - -Use the @code{@@kbd} command for characters of input to be typed by -users. For example, to refer to the characters @kbd{M-a}, -write@refill - -@example -@@kbd@{M-a@} -@end example - -@noindent -and to refer to the characters @kbd{M-x shell}, write@refill - -@example -@@kbd@{M-x shell@} -@end example - -@cindex user input -@cindex slanted typewriter font, for @code{@@kbd} -The @code{@@kbd} command has the same effect as @code{@@code} in Info, -but by default produces a different font (slanted typewriter instead of -normal typewriter) in the printed manual, so users can distinguish the -characters they are supposed to type from those the computer outputs. - -@findex kbdinputstyle -Since the usage of @code{@@kbd} varies from manual to manual, you can -control the font switching with the @code{@@kbdinputstyle} command. -This command has no effect on Info output. Write this command at the -beginning of a line with a single word as an argument, one of the -following: -@vindex distinct@r{, arg to @@kbdinputstyle} -@vindex example@r{, arg to @@kbdinputstyle} -@vindex code@r{, arg to @@kbdinputstyle} -@table @samp -@item code -Always use the same font for @code{@@kbd} as @code{@@code}. -@item example -Use the distinguishing font for @code{@@kbd} only in @code{@@example} -and similar environments. -@item example -(the default) Always use the distinguishing font for @code{@@kbd}. -@end table - -You can embed another @@-command inside the braces of an @code{@@kbd} -command. Here, for example, is the way to describe a command that -would be described more verbosely as ``press an @samp{r} and then -press the @key{RET} key'':@refill - -@example -@@kbd@{r @@key@{RET@}@} -@end example - -@noindent -This produces: @kbd{r @key{RET}} - -You also use the @code{@@kbd} command if you are spelling out the letters -you type; for example:@refill - -@example -To give the @@code@{logout@} command, -type the characters @@kbd@{l o g o u t @@key@{RET@}@}. -@end example - -@noindent -This produces: - -@quotation -To give the @code{logout} command, -type the characters @kbd{l o g o u t @key{RET}}. -@end quotation - -(Also, this example shows that you can add spaces for clarity. If you -really want to mention a space character as one of the characters of -input, write @kbd{@@key@{SPC@}} for it.)@refill - - -@node key, samp, kbd, Indicating -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection @code{@@key}@{@var{key-name}@} -@findex key - -Use the @code{@@key} command for the conventional name for a key on a -keyboard, as in:@refill - -@example -@@key@{RET@} -@end example - -You can use the @code{@@key} command within the argument of an -@code{@@kbd} command when the sequence of characters to be typed -includes one or more keys that are described by name.@refill - -@need 700 -For example, to produce @kbd{C-x @key{ESC}} you would type:@refill - -@example -@@kbd@{C-x @@key@{ESC@}@} -@end example - -Here is a list of the recommended names for keys: -@cindex Recommended names for keys -@cindex Keys, recommended names -@cindex Names recommended for keys -@cindex Abbreviations for keys - -@quotation -@table @t -@item SPC -Space -@item RET -Return -@item LFD -Linefeed (however, since most keyboards nowadays do not have a Linefeed key, -it might be better to call this character @kbd{C-j}. -@item TAB -Tab -@item BS -Backspace -@item ESC -Escape -@item DEL -Delete -@item SHIFT -Shift -@item CTRL -Control -@item META -Meta -@end table -@end quotation - -@cindex META key -There are subtleties to handling words like `meta' or `ctrl' that are -names of modifier keys. When mentioning a character in which the -modifier key is used, such as @kbd{Meta-a}, use the @code{@@kbd} command -alone; do not use the @code{@@key} command; but when you are referring -to the modifier key in isolation, use the @code{@@key} command. For -example, write @samp{@@kbd@{Meta-a@}} to produce @kbd{Meta-a} and -@samp{@@key@{META@}} to produce @key{META}. - -@c I don't think this is a good explanation. -@c I think it will puzzle readers more than it clarifies matters. -- rms. -@c In other words, use @code{@@kbd} for what you do, and use @code{@@key} -@c for what you talk about: ``Press @code{@@kbd@{M-a@}} to move point to -@c the beginning of the sentence. The @code{@@key@{META@}} key is often in -@c the lower left of the keyboard.''@refill - -@node samp, var, key, Indicating -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection @code{@@samp}@{@var{text}@} -@findex samp - -Use the @code{@@samp} command to indicate text that is a literal example -or `sample' of a sequence of characters in a file, string, pattern, etc. -Enclose the text in braces. The argument appears within single -quotation marks in both the Info file and the printed manual; in -addition, it is printed in a fixed-width font.@refill - -@example -To match @@samp@{foo@} at the end of the line, -use the regexp @@samp@{foo$@}. -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@quotation -To match @samp{foo} at the end of the line, use the regexp -@samp{foo$}.@refill -@end quotation - -Any time you are referring to single characters, you should use -@code{@@samp} unless @code{@@kbd} or @code{@@key} is more appropriate. -Use @code{@@samp} for the names of command-line options (except in an -@code{@@table}, where @code{@@code} seems to read more easily). Also, -you may use @code{@@samp} for entire statements in C and for entire -shell commands---in this case, @code{@@samp} often looks better than -@code{@@code}. Basically, @code{@@samp} is a catchall for whatever is -not covered by @code{@@code}, @code{@@kbd}, or @code{@@key}.@refill - -Only include punctuation marks within braces if they are part of the -string you are specifying. Write punctuation marks outside the braces -if those punctuation marks are part of the English text that surrounds -the string. In the following sentence, for example, the commas and -period are outside of the braces:@refill - -@example -@group -In English, the vowels are @@samp@{a@}, @@samp@{e@}, -@@samp@{i@}, @@samp@{o@}, @@samp@{u@}, and sometimes -@@samp@{y@}. -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -This produces: - -@quotation -In English, the vowels are @samp{a}, @samp{e}, -@samp{i}, @samp{o}, @samp{u}, and sometimes -@samp{y}. -@end quotation - -@node var, file, samp, Indicating -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection @code{@@var}@{@var{metasyntactic-variable}@} -@findex var - -Use the @code{@@var} command to indicate metasyntactic variables. A -@dfn{metasyntactic variable} is something that stands for another piece of -text. For example, you should use a metasyntactic variable in the -documentation of a function to describe the arguments that are passed -to that function.@refill - -Do not use @code{@@var} for the names of particular variables in -programming languages. These are specific names from a program, so -@code{@@code} is correct for them. For example, the Emacs Lisp variable -@code{texinfo-tex-command} is not a metasyntactic variable; it is -properly formatted using @code{@@code}.@refill - -The effect of @code{@@var} in the Info file is to change the case of -the argument to all upper case; in the printed manual, to italicize it. - -@need 700 -For example, - -@example -To delete file @@var@{filename@}, -type @@code@{rm @@var@{filename@}@}. -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@quotation -To delete file @var{filename}, type @code{rm @var{filename}}. -@end quotation - -@noindent -(Note that @code{@@var} may appear inside @code{@@code}, -@code{@@samp}, @code{@@file}, etc.)@refill - -Write a metasyntactic variable all in lower case without spaces, and -use hyphens to make it more readable. Thus, the Texinfo source for -the illustration of how to begin a Texinfo manual looks like -this:@refill - -@example -@group -\input texinfo -@@@@setfilename @@var@{info-file-name@} -@@@@settitle @@var@{name-of-manual@} -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -This produces: - -@example -@group -\input texinfo -@@setfilename @var{info-file-name} -@@settitle @var{name-of-manual} -@end group -@end example - -In some documentation styles, metasyntactic variables are shown with -angle brackets, for example:@refill - -@example -@dots{}, type rm <filename> -@end example - -@noindent -However, that is not the style that Texinfo uses. (You can, of -course, modify the sources to @TeX{} and the Info formatting commands -to output the @code{<@dots{}>} format if you wish.)@refill - -@node file, dfn, var, Indicating -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection @code{@@file}@{@var{file-name}@} -@findex file - -Use the @code{@@file} command to indicate text that is the name of a -file, buffer, or directory, or is the name of a node in Info. You can -also use the command for file name suffixes. Do not use @code{@@file} -for symbols in a programming language; use @code{@@code}. - -Currently, @code{@@file} is equivalent to @code{@@samp} in its effects. -For example,@refill - -@example -The @@file@{.el@} files are in -the @@file@{/usr/local/emacs/lisp@} directory. -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@quotation -The @file{.el} files are in -the @file{/usr/local/emacs/lisp} directory. -@end quotation - -@node dfn, cite, file, Indicating -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection @code{@@dfn}@{@var{term}@} -@findex dfn - -Use the @code{@@dfn} command to identify the introductory or defining -use of a technical term. Use the command only in passages whose -purpose is to introduce a term which will be used again or which the -reader ought to know. Mere passing mention of a term for the first -time does not deserve @code{@@dfn}. The command generates italics in -the printed manual, and double quotation marks in the Info file. For -example:@refill - -@example -Getting rid of a file is called @@dfn@{deleting@} it. -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@quotation -Getting rid of a file is called @dfn{deleting} it. -@end quotation - -As a general rule, a sentence containing the defining occurrence of a -term should be a definition of the term. The sentence does not need -to say explicitly that it is a definition, but it should contain the -information of a definition---it should make the meaning clear. - -@node cite, url, dfn, Indicating -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection @code{@@cite}@{@var{reference}@} -@findex cite - -Use the @code{@@cite} command for the name of a book that lacks a -companion Info file. The command produces italics in the printed -manual, and quotation marks in the Info file.@refill - -(If a book is written in Texinfo, it is better to use a cross reference -command since a reader can easily follow such a reference in Info. -@xref{xref, , @code{@@xref}}.)@refill - -@ignore -@c node ctrl, , cite, Indicating -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@c subsection @code{@@ctrl}@{@var{ctrl-char}@} -@findex ctrl - -The @code{@@ctrl} command is seldom used. It describes an @sc{ascii} -control character by inserting the actual character into the Info -file. - -Usually, in Texinfo, you talk what you type as keyboard entry by -describing it with @code{@@kbd}: thus, @samp{@@kbd@{C-a@}} for -@kbd{C-a}. Use @code{@@kbd} in this way when talking about a control -character that is typed on the keyboard by the user. When talking -about a control character appearing in a file or a string, do not use -@code{@@kbd} since the control character is not typed. Also, do not -use @samp{C-} but spell out @code{control-}, as in @samp{control-a}, -to make it easier for a reader to understand.@refill - -@code{@@ctrl} is an idea from the beginnings of Texinfo which may not -really fit in to the scheme of things. But there may be times when -you want to use the command. The pattern is -@code{@@ctrl@{@var{ch}@}}, where @var{ch} is an @sc{ascii} character -whose control-equivalent is wanted. For example, to specify -@samp{control-f}, you would enter@refill - -@example -@@ctrl@{f@} -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@quotation -@ctrl{f} -@end quotation - -In the Info file, this generates the specified control character, output -literally into the file. This is done so a user can copy the specified -control character (along with whatever else he or she wants) into another -Emacs buffer and use it. Since the `control-h',`control-i', and -`control-j' characters are formatting characters, they should not be -indicated with @code{@@ctrl}.@refill - -In a printed manual, @code{@@ctrl} generates text to describe or -identify that control character: an uparrow followed by the character -@var{ch}.@refill -@end ignore - - -@node url, email, cite, Indicating -@subsection @code{@@url}@{@var{uniform-resource-locator}@} -@findex url -@cindex Uniform resource locator, indicating -@cindex URL, indicating - -Use the @code{@@url} to indicate a uniform resource locator on the World -Wide Web. This is analogous to @code{@@file}, @code{@@var}, etc., and -is purely for markup purposes. It does not produce a link you can -follow in HTML output (the @code{@@uref} command does, @pxref{uref,, -@code{@@uref}}). It is useful for example URL's which do not actually -exist. For example: - -@c Two lines because one is too long for smallbook format. -@example -For example, the url might be -@@url@{http://host.domain.org/path@}. -@end example - - -@node email, , url, Indicating -@subsection @code{@@email}@{@var{email-address}[, @var{displayed-text}]@} -@findex email - -Use the @code{@@email} command to indicate an electronic mail address. -It takes one mandatory argument, the address, and one optional argument, the -text to display (the default is the address itself). - -@cindex mailto link -In Info and @TeX{}, the address is shown in angle brackets, preceded by -the text to display if any. In HTML output, @code{@@email} produces a -@samp{mailto} link that usually brings up a mail composition window. -For example: - -@example -Send bug reports to @@email@{bug-texinfo@@@@prep.ai.mit.edu@}. -Send suggestions to the @@email@{bug-texinfo@@@@prep.ai.mit.edu, same place@}. -@end example -@noindent produces -@example -Send bug reports to @email{bug-texinfo@@prep.ai.mit.edu}. -Send suggestions to the @email{bug-texinfo@@prep.ai.mit.edu, same place}. -@end example - - -@node Emphasis, , Indicating, Marking Text -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Emphasizing Text -@cindex Emphasizing text - -Usually, Texinfo changes the font to mark words in the text according to -what category the words belong to; an example is the @code{@@code} command. -Most often, this is the best way to mark words. -However, sometimes you will want to emphasize text without indicating a -category. Texinfo has two commands to do this. Also, Texinfo has -several commands that specify the font in which @TeX{} will typeset -text. These commands have no affect on Info and only one of them, -the @code{@@r} command, has any regular use.@refill - -@menu -* emph & strong:: How to emphasize text in Texinfo. -* Smallcaps:: How to use the small caps font. -* Fonts:: Various font commands for printed output. -* Customized Highlighting:: How to define highlighting commands. -@end menu - -@node emph & strong, Smallcaps, Emphasis, Emphasis -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection @code{@@emph}@{@var{text}@} and @code{@@strong}@{@var{text}@} -@cindex Emphasizing text, font for -@findex emph -@findex strong - -The @code{@@emph} and @code{@@strong} commands are for emphasis; -@code{@@strong} is stronger. In printed output, @code{@@emph} -produces @emph{italics} and @code{@@strong} produces -@strong{bold}.@refill - -@need 800 -For example, - -@example -@group -@@quotation -@@strong@{Caution:@} @@samp@{rm * .[^.]*@} removes @@emph@{all@} -files in the directory. -@@end quotation -@end group -@end example - -@iftex -@noindent -produces the following in printed output: - -@quotation -@strong{Caution}: @code{rm * .[^.]*} removes @emph{all} -files in the directory. -@end quotation - -@noindent -and the following in Info: -@end iftex -@ifinfo -@noindent -produces: -@end ifinfo - -@example - *Caution*: `rm * .[^.]*' removes *all* - files in the directory. -@end example - -The @code{@@strong} command is seldom used except to mark what is, in -effect, a typographical element, such as the word `Caution' in the -preceding example. - -In the Info file, both @code{@@emph} and @code{@@strong} put asterisks -around the text.@refill - -@quotation -@strong{Caution:} Do not use @code{@@emph} or @code{@@strong} with the -word @samp{Note}; Info will mistake the combination for a cross -reference. Use a phrase such as @strong{Please note} or -@strong{Caution} instead.@refill -@end quotation - -@node Smallcaps, Fonts, emph & strong, Emphasis -@subsection @code{@@sc}@{@var{text}@}: The Small Caps Font -@cindex Small caps font -@findex sc @r{(small caps font)} - -@iftex -Use the @samp{@@sc} command to set text in the printed output in @sc{a -small caps font} and set text in the Info file in upper case letters.@refill -@end iftex -@ifinfo -Use the @samp{@@sc} command to set text in the printed output in a -small caps font and set text in the Info file in upper case letters.@refill -@end ifinfo - -Write the text between braces in lower case, like this:@refill - -@example -The @@sc@{acm@} and @@sc@{ieee@} are technical societies. -@end example - -@noindent -This produces: - -@display -The @sc{acm} and @sc{ieee} are technical societies. -@end display - -@TeX{} typesets the small caps font in a manner that prevents the -letters from `jumping out at you on the page'. This makes small caps -text easier to read than text in all upper case. The Info formatting -commands set all small caps text in upper case.@refill - -@ifinfo -If the text between the braces of an @code{@@sc} command is upper case, -@TeX{} typesets in full-size capitals. Use full-size capitals -sparingly.@refill -@end ifinfo -@iftex -If the text between the braces of an @code{@@sc} command is upper case, -@TeX{} typesets in @sc{FULL-SIZE CAPITALS}. Use full-size capitals -sparingly.@refill -@end iftex - -You may also use the small caps font for a jargon word such as -@sc{ato} (a @sc{nasa} word meaning `abort to orbit').@refill - -There are subtleties to using the small caps font with a jargon word -such as @sc{cdr}, a word used in Lisp programming. In this case, you -should use the small caps font when the word refers to the second and -subsequent elements of a list (the @sc{cdr} of the list), but you -should use @samp{@@code} when the word refers to the Lisp function of -the same spelling.@refill - -@node Fonts, Customized Highlighting, Smallcaps, Emphasis -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection Fonts for Printing, Not Info -@cindex Fonts for printing, not for Info -@findex i @r{(italic font)} -@findex b @r{(bold font)} -@findex t @r{(typewriter font)} -@findex r @r{(Roman font)} - -Texinfo provides four font commands that specify font changes in the -printed manual but have no effect in the Info file. @code{@@i} -requests @i{italic} font (in some versions of @TeX{}, a slanted font -is used), @code{@@b} requests @b{bold} face, @code{@@t} requests the -@t{fixed-width}, typewriter-style font used by @code{@@code}, and @code{@@r} requests a -@r{roman} font, which is the usual font in which text is printed. All -four commands apply to an argument that follows, surrounded by -braces.@refill - -Only the @code{@@r} command has much use: in example programs, you -can use the @code{@@r} command to convert code comments from the -fixed-width font to a roman font. This looks better in printed -output.@refill - -@need 700 -For example, - -@example -@group -@@lisp -(+ 2 2) ; @@r@{Add two plus two.@} -@@end lisp -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@lisp -(+ 2 2) ; @r{Add two plus two.} -@end lisp - -If possible, you should avoid using the other three font commands. If -you need to use one, it probably indicates a gap in the Texinfo -language.@refill - -@node Customized Highlighting, , Fonts, Emphasis -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection Customized Highlighting -@cindex Highlighting, customized -@cindex Customized highlighting - -@c I think this whole section is obsolete with the advent of macros -@c --karl, 15sep96. -You can use regular @TeX{} commands inside of @code{@@iftex} @dots{} -@code{@@end iftex} to create your own customized highlighting commands -for Texinfo. The easiest way to do this is to equate your customized -commands with pre-existing commands, such as those for italics. Such -new commands work only with @TeX{}.@refill - -@findex definfoenclose -@cindex Enclosure command for Info -You can use the @code{@@definfoenclose} command inside of -@code{@@ifinfo} @dots{} @code{@@end ifinfo} to define commands for Info -with the same names as new commands for @TeX{}. -@code{@@definfoenclose} creates new commands for Info that mark text by -enclosing it in strings that precede and follow the text. -@footnote{Currently, @code{@@definfoenclose} works only with -@code{texinfo-format-buffer} and @code{texinfo-format-region}, not with -@code{makeinfo}.}@refill - -Here is how to create a new @@-command called @code{@@phoo} that causes -@TeX{} to typeset its argument in italics and causes Info to display the -argument between @samp{//} and @samp{\\}.@refill - -@need 1300 -For @TeX{}, write the following to equate the @code{@@phoo} command with -the existing @code{@@i} italics command:@refill - -@example -@group -@@iftex -@@global@@let@@phoo=@@i -@@end iftex -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -This defines @code{@@phoo} as a command that causes @TeX{} to typeset -the argument to @code{@@phoo} in italics. @code{@@global@@let} tells -@TeX{} to equate the next argument with the argument that follows the -equals sign. - -@need 1300 -For Info, write the following to tell the Info formatters to enclose the -argument between @samp{//} and @samp{\\}: - -@example -@group -@@ifinfo -@@definfoenclose phoo, //, \\ -@@end ifinfo -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -Write the @code{@@definfoenclose} command on a line and follow it with -three arguments separated by commas (commas are used as separators in an -@code{@@node} line in the same way).@refill - -@itemize @bullet -@item -The first argument to @code{@@definfoenclose} is the @@-command name -@strong{without} the @samp{@@}; - -@item -the second argument is the Info start delimiter string; and, - -@item -the third argument is the Info end delimiter string. -@end itemize - -@noindent -The latter two arguments enclose the highlighted text in the Info file. -A delimiter string may contain spaces. Neither the start nor end -delimiter is required. However, if you do not provide a start -delimiter, you must follow the command name with two commas in a row; -otherwise, the Info formatting commands will misinterpret the end -delimiter string as a start delimiter string.@refill - -After you have defined @code{@@phoo} both for @TeX{} and for Info, you -can then write @code{@@phoo@{bar@}} to see @samp{//bar\\} -in Info and see -@ifinfo -@samp{bar} in italics in printed output. -@end ifinfo -@iftex -@i{bar} in italics in printed output. -@end iftex - -Note that each definition applies to its own formatter: one for @TeX{}, -the other for Info. - -@need 1200 -Here is another example: - -@example -@group -@@ifinfo -@@definfoenclose headword, , : -@@end ifinfo -@@iftex -@@global@@let@@headword=@@b -@@end iftex -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -This defines @code{@@headword} as an Info formatting command that -inserts nothing before and a colon after the argument and as a @TeX{} -formatting command to typeset its argument in bold. - -@node Quotations and Examples, Lists and Tables, Marking Text, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@chapter Quotations and Examples - -Quotations and examples are blocks of text consisting of one or more -whole paragraphs that are set off from the bulk of the text and -treated differently. They are usually indented.@refill - -In Texinfo, you always begin a quotation or example by writing an -@@-command at the beginning of a line by itself, and end it by writing -an @code{@@end} command that is also at the beginning of a line by -itself. For instance, you begin an example by writing @code{@@example} -by itself at the beginning of a line and end the example by writing -@code{@@end example} on a line by itself, at the beginning of that -line.@refill -@findex end - -@menu -* Block Enclosing Commands:: Use different constructs for - different purposes. -* quotation:: How to write a quotation. -* example:: How to write an example in a fixed-width font. -* noindent:: How to prevent paragraph indentation. -* Lisp Example:: How to illustrate Lisp code. -* smallexample & smalllisp:: Forms for the @code{@@smallbook} option. -* display:: How to write an example in the current font. -* format:: How to write an example that does not narrow - the margins. -* exdent:: How to undo the indentation of a line. -* flushleft & flushright:: How to push text flushleft or flushright. -* cartouche:: How to draw cartouches around examples. -@end menu - -@node Block Enclosing Commands, quotation, Quotations and Examples, Quotations and Examples -@section The Block Enclosing Commands - -Here are commands for quotations and examples:@refill - -@table @code -@item @@quotation -Indicate text that is quoted. The text is filled, indented, and -printed in a roman font by default.@refill - -@item @@example -Illustrate code, commands, and the like. The text is printed -in a fixed-width font, and indented but not filled.@refill - -@item @@lisp -Illustrate Lisp code. The text is printed in a fixed-width font, -and indented but not filled.@refill - -@item @@smallexample -Illustrate code, commands, and the like. Similar to -@code{@@example}, except that in @TeX{} this command typesets text in -a smaller font for the smaller @code{@@smallbook} format than for the -8.5 by 11 inch format.@refill - -@item @@smalllisp -Illustrate Lisp code. Similar to @code{@@lisp}, except that -in @TeX{} this command typesets text in a smaller font for the smaller -@code{@@smallbook} format than for the 8.5 by 11 inch format.@refill - -@item @@display -Display illustrative text. The text is indented but not filled, and -no font is specified (so, by default, the font is roman).@refill - -@item @@format -Print illustrative text. The text is not indented and not filled -and no font is specified (so, by default, the font is roman).@refill -@end table - -The @code{@@exdent} command is used within the above constructs to -undo the indentation of a line. - -The @code{@@flushleft} and @code{@@flushright} commands are used to line -up the left or right margins of unfilled text.@refill - -The @code{@@noindent} command may be used after one of the above -constructs to prevent the following text from being indented as a new -paragraph.@refill - -You can use the @code{@@cartouche} command within one of the above -constructs to highlight the example or quotation by drawing a box with -rounded corners around it. (The @code{@@cartouche} command affects -only the printed manual; it has no effect in the Info file; see -@ref{cartouche, , Drawing Cartouches Around Examples}.)@refill - -@node quotation, example, Block Enclosing Commands, Quotations and Examples -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@quotation} -@cindex Quotations -@findex quotation - -The text of a quotation is -processed normally except that:@refill - -@itemize @bullet -@item -the margins are closer to the center of the page, so the whole of the -quotation is indented;@refill - -@item -the first lines of paragraphs are indented no more than other -lines;@refill - -@item -in the printed output, interparagraph spacing is reduced.@refill -@end itemize - -@quotation -This is an example of text written between an @code{@@quotation} -command and an @code{@@end quotation} command. An @code{@@quotation} -command is most often used to indicate text that is excerpted from -another (real or hypothetical) printed work.@refill -@end quotation - -Write an @code{@@quotation} command as text on a line by itself. This -line will disappear from the output. Mark the end of the quotation -with a line beginning with and containing only @code{@@end quotation}. -The @code{@@end quotation} line will likewise disappear from the -output. Thus, the following,@refill - -@example -@@quotation -This is -a foo. -@@end quotation -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@quotation -This is a foo. -@end quotation - -@node example, noindent, quotation, Quotations and Examples -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@example} -@cindex Examples, formatting them -@cindex Formatting examples -@findex example - -The @code{@@example} command is used to indicate an example that is -not part of the running text, such as computer input or output.@refill - -@example -@group -This is an example of text written between an -@code{@@example} command -and an @code{@@end example} command. -The text is indented but not filled. -@end group - -@group -In the printed manual, the text is typeset in a -fixed-width font, and extra spaces and blank lines are -significant. In the Info file, an analogous result is -obtained by indenting each line with five spaces. -@end group -@end example - -Write an @code{@@example} command at the beginning of a line by itself. -This line will disappear from the output. Mark the end of the example -with an @code{@@end example} command, also written at the beginning of a -line by itself. The @code{@@end example} will disappear from the -output.@refill - -@need 700 -For example, - -@example -@@example -mv foo bar -@@end example -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@example -mv foo bar -@end example - -Since the lines containing @code{@@example} and @code{@@end example} -will disappear, you should put a blank line before the -@code{@@example} and another blank line after the @code{@@end -example}. (Remember that blank lines between the beginning -@code{@@example} and the ending @code{@@end example} will appear in -the output.)@refill - -@quotation -@strong{Caution:} Do not use tabs in the lines of an example (or anywhere -else in Texinfo, for that matter)! @TeX{} treats tabs as single -spaces, and that is not what they look like. This is a problem with -@TeX{}. (If necessary, in Emacs, you can use @kbd{M-x untabify} to -convert tabs in a region to multiple spaces.)@refill -@end quotation - -Examples are often, logically speaking, ``in the middle'' of a -paragraph, and the text continues after an example should not be -indented. The @code{@@noindent} command prevents a piece of text from -being indented as if it were a new paragraph. -@ifinfo -(@xref{noindent}.) -@end ifinfo - -(The @code{@@code} command is used for examples of code that are -embedded within sentences, not set off from preceding and following -text. @xref{code, , @code{@@code}}.) - -@node noindent, Lisp Example, example, Quotations and Examples -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@noindent} -@findex noindent - -An example or other inclusion can break a paragraph into segments. -Ordinarily, the formatters indent text that follows an example as a new -paragraph. However, you can prevent this by writing @code{@@noindent} -at the beginning of a line by itself preceding the continuation -text.@refill - -@need 1500 -For example: - -@example -@group -@@example -This is an example -@@end example - -@@noindent -This line is not indented. As you can see, the -beginning of the line is fully flush left with the line -that follows after it. (This whole example is between -@@code@{@@@@display@} and @@code@{@@@@end display@}.) -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@display -@example -This is an example -@end example -@tex -% Remove extra vskip; this is a kludge to counter the effect of display -\vskip-3.5\baselineskip -@end tex - -@noindent -This line is not indented. As you can see, the -beginning of the line is fully flush left with the line -that follows after it. (This whole example is between -@code{@@display} and @code{@@end display}.) -@end display - -To adjust the number of blank lines properly in the Info file output, -remember that the line containing @code{@@noindent} does not generate a -blank line, and neither does the @code{@@end example} line.@refill - -In the Texinfo source file for this manual, each line that says -`produces' is preceded by a line containing @code{@@noindent}.@refill - -Do not put braces after an @code{@@noindent} command; they are not -necessary, since @code{@@noindent} is a command used outside of -paragraphs (@pxref{Command Syntax}).@refill - -@node Lisp Example, smallexample & smalllisp, noindent, Quotations and Examples -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@lisp} -@cindex Lisp example -@findex lisp - -The @code{@@lisp} command is used for Lisp code. It is synonymous -with the @code{@@example} command. - -@lisp -This is an example of text written between an -@code{@@lisp} command and an @code{@@end lisp} command. -@end lisp - -Use @code{@@lisp} instead of @code{@@example} to preserve information -regarding the nature of the example. This is useful, for example, if -you write a function that evaluates only and all the Lisp code in a -Texinfo file. Then you can use the Texinfo file as a Lisp -library.@footnote{It would be straightforward to extend Texinfo to work -in a similar fashion for C, Fortran, or other languages.}@refill - -Mark the end of @code{@@lisp} with @code{@@end lisp} on a line by -itself.@refill - -@node smallexample & smalllisp, display, Lisp Example, Quotations and Examples -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp} -@cindex Small book example -@cindex Example for a small book -@cindex Lisp example for a small book -@findex smallexample -@findex smalllisp - -In addition to the regular @code{@@example} and @code{@@lisp} commands, -Texinfo has two other ``example-style'' commands. These are the -@code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp} commands. Both these -commands are designed for use with the @code{@@smallbook} command that -causes @TeX{} to produce a printed manual in a 7 by 9.25 inch format -rather than the regular 8.5 by 11 inch format.@refill - -In @TeX{}, the @code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp} commands -typeset text in a smaller font for the smaller @code{@@smallbook} -format than for the 8.5 by 11 inch format. Consequently, many examples -containing long lines fit in a narrower, @code{@@smallbook} page -without needing to be shortened. Both commands typeset in the normal -font size when you format for the 8.5 by 11 inch size; indeed, -in this situation, the @code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp} -commands are defined to be the @code{@@example} and @code{@@lisp} -commands.@refill - -In Info, the @code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp} commands are -equivalent to the @code{@@example} and @code{@@lisp} commands, and work -exactly the same.@refill - -Mark the end of @code{@@smallexample} or @code{@@smalllisp} with -@code{@@end smallexample} or @code{@@end smalllisp}, -respectively.@refill - -@iftex -Here is an example written in the small font used by the -@code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp} commands: - -@ifclear smallbook -@display -@tex -% Remove extra vskip; this is a kludge to counter the effect of display -\vskip-3\baselineskip -{\ninett -\dots{} to make sure that you have the freedom to -distribute copies of free software (and charge for -this service if you wish), that you receive source -code or can get it if you want it, that you can -change the software or use pieces of it in new free -programs; and that you know you can do these things.} -@end tex -@end display -@end ifclear -@end iftex -@ifset smallbook -@iftex -@smallexample -This is an example of text written between @code{@@smallexample} and -@code{@@end smallexample}. In Info and in an 8.5 by 11 inch manual, -this text appears in its normal size; but in a 7 by 9.25 inch manual, -this text appears in a smaller font. -@end smallexample -@end iftex -@end ifset -@ifinfo -@smallexample -This is an example of text written between @code{@@smallexample} and -@code{@@end smallexample}. In Info and in an 8.5 by 11 inch manual, -this text appears in its normal size; but in a 7 by 9.25 inch manual, -this text appears in a smaller font. -@end smallexample -@end ifinfo - -The @code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp} commands make it -easier to prepare smaller format manuals without forcing you to edit -examples by hand to fit them onto narrower pages.@refill - -As a general rule, a printed document looks better if you write all the -examples in a chapter consistently in @code{@@example} or in -@code{@@smallexample}. Only occasionally should you mix the two -formats.@refill - -@xref{smallbook, , Printing ``Small'' Books}, for more information -about the @code{@@smallbook} command.@refill - -@node display, format, smallexample & smalllisp, Quotations and Examples -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@display} -@cindex Display formatting -@findex display - -The @code{@@display} command begins a kind of example. It is like the -@code{@@example} command -except that, in -a printed manual, @code{@@display} does not select the fixed-width -font. In fact, it does not specify the font at all, so that the text -appears in the same font it would have appeared in without the -@code{@@display} command.@refill - -@display -This is an example of text written between an @code{@@display} command -and an @code{@@end display} command. The @code{@@display} command -indents the text, but does not fill it. -@end display - -@node format, exdent, display, Quotations and Examples -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@format} -@findex format - -The @code{@@format} command is similar to @code{@@example} except -that, in the printed manual, @code{@@format} does not select the -fixed-width font and does not narrow the margins.@refill - -@format -This is an example of text written between an @code{@@format} command -and an @code{@@end format} command. As you can see -from this example, -the @code{@@format} command does not fill the text. -@end format - -@node exdent, flushleft & flushright, format, Quotations and Examples -@section @code{@@exdent}: Undoing a Line's Indentation -@cindex Indentation undoing -@findex exdent - -The @code{@@exdent} command removes any indentation a line might have. -The command is written at the beginning of a line and applies only to -the text that follows the command that is on the same line. Do not use -braces around the text. In a printed manual, the text on an -@code{@@exdent} line is printed in the roman font.@refill - -@code{@@exdent} is usually used within examples. Thus,@refill - -@example -@group -@@example -This line follows an @@@@example command. -@@exdent This line is exdented. -This line follows the exdented line. -The @@@@end example comes on the next line. -@@end group -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@example -@group -This line follows an @@example command. -@exdent This line is exdented. -This line follows the exdented line. -The @@end example comes on the next line. -@end group -@end example - -In practice, the @code{@@exdent} command is rarely used. -Usually, you un-indent text by ending the example and -returning the page to its normal width.@refill - -@node flushleft & flushright, cartouche, exdent, Quotations and Examples -@section @code{@@flushleft} and @code{@@flushright} -@findex flushleft -@findex flushright - -The @code{@@flushleft} and @code{@@flushright} commands line up the -ends of lines on the left and right margins of a page, -but do not fill the text. The commands are written on lines of their -own, without braces. The @code{@@flushleft} and @code{@@flushright} -commands are ended by @code{@@end flushleft} and @code{@@end -flushright} commands on lines of their own.@refill - -@need 1500 -For example, - -@example -@group -@@flushleft -This text is -written flushleft. -@@end flushleft -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@quotation -@flushleft -This text is -written flushleft. -@end flushleft -@end quotation - - -@code{@@flushright} produces the type of indentation often used in the -return address of letters. For example, - -@example -@group -@@flushright -Here is an example of text written -flushright. The @@code@{@@flushright@} command -right justifies every line but leaves the -left end ragged. -@@end flushright -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@flushright -Here is an example of text written -flushright. The @code{@@flushright} command -right justifies every line but leaves the -left end ragged. -@end flushright - -@node cartouche, , flushleft & flushright, Quotations and Examples -@section Drawing Cartouches Around Examples -@findex cartouche -@cindex Box with rounded corners - -In a printed manual, the @code{@@cartouche} command draws a box with -rounded corners around its contents. You can use this command to -further highlight an example or quotation. For instance, you could -write a manual in which one type of example is surrounded by a cartouche -for emphasis.@refill - -The @code{@@cartouche} command affects only the printed manual; it has -no effect in the Info file.@refill - -@need 1500 -For example, - -@example -@group -@@example -@@cartouche -% pwd -/usr/local/share/emacs -@@end cartouche -@@end example -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -surrounds the two-line example with a box with rounded corners, in the -printed manual. - -@iftex -In a printed manual, the example looks like this:@refill - -@example -@group -@cartouche -% pwd -/usr/local/lib/emacs/info -@end cartouche -@end group -@end example -@end iftex - - -@node Lists and Tables, Indices, Quotations and Examples, Top -@chapter Lists and Tables -@cindex Making lists and tables -@cindex Lists and tables, making -@cindex Tables and lists, making - -Texinfo has several ways of making lists and tables. Lists can be -bulleted or numbered; two-column tables can highlight the items in -the first column; multi-column tables are also supported. - -@menu -* Introducing Lists:: Texinfo formats lists for you. -* itemize:: How to construct a simple list. -* enumerate:: How to construct a numbered list. -* Two-column Tables:: How to construct a two-column table. -* Multi-column Tables:: How to construct generalized tables. -@end menu - -@ifinfo -@node Introducing Lists, itemize, Lists and Tables, Lists and Tables -@heading Introducing Lists -@end ifinfo - -Texinfo automatically indents the text in lists or tables, and numbers -an enumerated list. This last feature is useful if you modify the -list, since you do not need to renumber it yourself.@refill - -Numbered lists and tables begin with the appropriate @@-command at the -beginning of a line, and end with the corresponding @code{@@end} -command on a line by itself. The table and itemized-list commands -also require that you write formatting information on the same line as -the beginning @@-command.@refill - -Begin an enumerated list, for example, with an @code{@@enumerate} -command and end the list with an @code{@@end enumerate} command. -Begin an itemized list with an @code{@@itemize} command, followed on -the same line by a formatting command such as @code{@@bullet}, and end -the list with an @code{@@end itemize} command.@refill -@findex end - -Precede each element of a list with an @code{@@item} or @code{@@itemx} -command.@refill - -@sp 1 -@noindent -Here is an itemized list of the different kinds of table and lists:@refill - -@itemize @bullet -@item -Itemized lists with and without bullets. - -@item -Enumerated lists, using numbers or letters. - -@item -Two-column tables with highlighting. -@end itemize - -@sp 1 -@noindent -Here is an enumerated list with the same items:@refill - -@enumerate -@item -Itemized lists with and without bullets. - -@item -Enumerated lists, using numbers or letters. - -@item -Two-column tables with highlighting. -@end enumerate - -@sp 1 -@noindent -And here is a two-column table with the same items and their -@w{@@-commands}:@refill - -@table @code -@item @@itemize -Itemized lists with and without bullets. - -@item @@enumerate -Enumerated lists, using numbers or letters. - -@item @@table -@itemx @@ftable -@itemx @@vtable -Two-column tables with indexing. -@end table - -@node itemize, enumerate, Introducing Lists, Lists and Tables -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Making an Itemized List -@cindex Itemization -@findex itemize - -The @code{@@itemize} command produces sequences of indented -paragraphs, with a bullet or other mark inside the left margin -at the beginning of each paragraph for which such a mark is desired.@refill - -Begin an itemized list by writing @code{@@itemize} at the beginning of -a line. Follow the command, on the same line, with a character or a -Texinfo command that generates a mark. Usually, you will write -@code{@@bullet} after @code{@@itemize}, but you can use -@code{@@minus}, or any character or any special symbol that results in -a single character in the Info file. (When you write @code{@@bullet} -or @code{@@minus} after an @code{@@itemize} command, you may omit the -@samp{@{@}}.)@refill - -Write the text of the indented paragraphs themselves after the -@code{@@itemize}, up to another line that says @code{@@end -itemize}.@refill - -Before each paragraph for which a mark in the margin is desired, write -a line that says just @code{@@item}. Do not write any other text on this -line.@refill -@findex item - -Usually, you should put a blank line before an @code{@@item}. This -puts a blank line in the Info file. (@TeX{} inserts the proper -interline whitespace in either case.) Except when the entries are -very brief, these blank lines make the list look better.@refill - -Here is an example of the use of @code{@@itemize}, followed by the -output it produces. Note that @code{@@bullet} produces an @samp{*} in -Info and a round dot in @TeX{}.@refill - -@example -@group -@@itemize @@bullet -@@item -Some text for foo. - -@@item -Some text -for bar. -@@end itemize -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -This produces: - -@quotation -@itemize @bullet -@item -Some text for foo. - -@item -Some text -for bar. -@end itemize -@end quotation - -Itemized lists may be embedded within other itemized lists. Here is a -list marked with dashes embedded in a list marked with bullets:@refill - -@example -@group -@@itemize @@bullet -@@item -First item. - -@@itemize @@minus -@@item -Inner item. - -@@item -Second inner item. -@@end itemize - -@@item -Second outer item. -@@end itemize -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -This produces: - -@quotation -@itemize @bullet -@item -First item. - -@itemize @minus -@item -Inner item. - -@item -Second inner item. -@end itemize - -@item -Second outer item. -@end itemize -@end quotation - -@node enumerate, Two-column Tables, itemize, Lists and Tables -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Making a Numbered or Lettered List -@cindex Enumeration -@findex enumerate - -@code{@@enumerate} is like @code{@@itemize} (@pxref{itemize,, -@code{@@itemize}}), except that the labels on the items are -successive integers or letters instead of bullets. - -Write the @code{@@enumerate} command at the beginning of a line. The -command does not require an argument, but accepts either a number or a -letter as an option. Without an argument, @code{@@enumerate} starts the -list with the number @samp{1}. With a numeric argument, such as -@samp{3}, the command starts the list with that number. With an upper -or lower case letter, such as @samp{a} or @samp{A}, the command starts -the list with that letter.@refill - -Write the text of the enumerated list in the same way you write an -itemized list: put @code{@@item} on a line of its own before the start -of each paragraph that you want enumerated. Do not write any other text -on the line beginning with @code{@@item}.@refill - -You should put a blank line between entries in the list. -This generally makes it easier to read the Info file.@refill - -@need 1500 -Here is an example of @code{@@enumerate} without an argument:@refill - -@example -@group -@@enumerate -@@item -Underlying causes. - -@@item -Proximate causes. -@@end enumerate -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -This produces: - -@enumerate -@item -Underlying causes. - -@item -Proximate causes. -@end enumerate -@sp 1 -Here is an example with an argument of @kbd{3}:@refill -@sp 1 -@example -@group -@@enumerate 3 -@@item -Predisposing causes. - -@@item -Precipitating causes. - -@@item -Perpetuating causes. -@@end enumerate -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -This produces: - -@enumerate 3 -@item -Predisposing causes. - -@item -Precipitating causes. - -@item -Perpetuating causes. -@end enumerate -@sp 1 -Here is a brief summary of the alternatives. The summary is constructed -using @code{@@enumerate} with an argument of @kbd{a}.@refill -@sp 1 -@enumerate a -@item -@code{@@enumerate} - -Without an argument, produce a numbered list, starting with the number -1.@refill - -@item -@code{@@enumerate @var{positive-integer}} - -With a (positive) numeric argument, start a numbered list with that -number. You can use this to continue a list that you interrupted with -other text.@refill - -@item -@code{@@enumerate @var{upper-case-letter}} - -With an upper case letter as argument, start a list -in which each item is marked -by a letter, beginning with that upper case letter.@refill - -@item -@code{@@enumerate @var{lower-case-letter}} - -With a lower case letter as argument, start a list -in which each item is marked by -a letter, beginning with that lower case letter.@refill -@end enumerate - -You can also nest enumerated lists, as in an outline.@refill - -@node Two-column Tables, Multi-column Tables, enumerate, Lists and Tables -@section Making a Two-column Table -@cindex Tables, making two-column -@findex table - -@code{@@table} is similar to @code{@@itemize} (@pxref{itemize,, -@code{@@itemize}}), but allows you to specify a name or heading line for -each item. The @code{@@table} command is used to produce two-column -tables, and is especially useful for glossaries, explanatory -exhibits, and command-line option summaries. - -@menu -* table:: How to construct a two-column table. -* ftable vtable:: Automatic indexing for two-column tables. -* itemx:: How to put more entries in the first column. -@end menu - -@ifinfo -@node table, ftable vtable, Two-column Tables, Two-column Tables -@subheading Using the @code{@@table} Command - -Use the @code{@@table} command to produce two-column tables.@refill -@end ifinfo - -Write the @code{@@table} command at the beginning of a line and follow -it on the same line with an argument that is a Texinfo ``indicating'' -command such as @code{@@code}, @code{@@samp}, @code{@@var}, or -@code{@@kbd} (@pxref{Indicating}). Although these commands are usually -followed by arguments in braces, in this case you use the command name -without an argument because @code{@@item} will supply the argument. -This command will be applied to the text that goes into the first column -of each item and determines how it will be highlighted. For example, -@code{@@code} will cause the text in the first column to be highlighted -with an @code{@@code} command. (We recommend @code{@@code} for -@code{@@table}'s of command-line options.) - -@findex asis -You may also choose to use the @code{@@asis} command as an argument to -@code{@@table}. @code{@@asis} is a command that does nothing; if you -use this command after @code{@@table}, @TeX{} and the Info formatting -commands output the first column entries without added highlighting -(``as is'').@refill - -(The @code{@@table} command may work with other commands besides those -listed here. However, you can only use commands that normally take -arguments in braces.)@refill - -Begin each table entry with an @code{@@item} command at the beginning -of a line. Write the first column text on the same line as the -@code{@@item} command. Write the second column text on the line -following the @code{@@item} line and on subsequent lines. (You do not -need to type anything for an empty second column entry.) You may -write as many lines of supporting text as you wish, even several -paragraphs. But only text on the same line as the @code{@@item} will -be placed in the first column.@refill -@findex item - -Normally, you should put a blank line before an @code{@@item} line. -This puts a blank like in the Info file. Except when the entries are -very brief, a blank line looks better.@refill - -@need 1500 -The following table, for example, highlights the text in the first -column with an @code{@@samp} command:@refill - -@example -@group -@@table @@samp -@@item foo -This is the text for -@@samp@{foo@}. - -@@item bar -Text for @@samp@{bar@}. -@@end table -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -This produces: - -@table @samp -@item foo -This is the text for -@samp{foo}. -@item bar -Text for @samp{bar}. -@end table - -If you want to list two or more named items with a single block of -text, use the @code{@@itemx} command. (@xref{itemx, , -@code{@@itemx}}.)@refill - -@node ftable vtable, itemx, table, Two-column Tables -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection @code{@@ftable} and @code{@@vtable} -@cindex Tables with indexes -@cindex Indexing table entries automatically -@findex ftable -@findex vtable - -The @code{@@ftable} and @code{@@vtable} commands are the same as the -@code{@@table} command except that @code{@@ftable} automatically enters -each of the items in the first column of the table into the index of -functions and @code{@@vtable} automatically enters each of the items in -the first column of the table into the index of variables. This -simplifies the task of creating indices. Only the items on the same -line as the @code{@@item} commands are indexed, and they are indexed in -exactly the form that they appear on that line. @xref{Indices, , -Creating Indices}, for more information about indices.@refill - -Begin a two-column table using @code{@@ftable} or @code{@@vtable} by -writing the @@-command at the beginning of a line, followed on the same -line by an argument that is a Texinfo command such as @code{@@code}, -exactly as you would for an @code{@@table} command; and end the table -with an @code{@@end ftable} or @code{@@end vtable} command on a line by -itself. - -See the example for @code{@@table} in the previous section. - -@node itemx, , ftable vtable, Two-column Tables -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@subsection @code{@@itemx} -@cindex Two named items for @code{@@table} -@findex itemx - -Use the @code{@@itemx} command inside a table when you have two or more -first column entries for the same item, each of which should appear on a -line of its own. Use @code{@@itemx} for all but the first entry; -@code{@@itemx} should always follow an @code{@@item} command. The -@code{@@itemx} command works exactly like @code{@@item} except that it -does not generate extra vertical space above the first column text. - -@need 1000 -For example, - -@example -@group -@@table @@code -@@item upcase -@@itemx downcase -These two functions accept a character or a string as -argument, and return the corresponding upper case (lower -case) character or string. -@@end table -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -This produces: - -@table @code -@item upcase -@itemx downcase -These two functions accept a character or a string as -argument, and return the corresponding upper case (lower -case) character or string.@refill -@end table - -@noindent -(Note also that this example illustrates multi-line supporting text in -a two-column table.)@refill - - -@node Multi-column Tables, , Two-column Tables, Lists and Tables -@section Multi-column Tables -@cindex Tables, making multi-column -@findex multitable - -@code{@@multitable} allows you to construct tables with any number of -columns, with each column having any width you like. - -You define the column widths on the @code{@@multitable} line itself, and -write each row of the actual table following an @code{@@item} command, -with columns separated by an @code{@@tab} command. Finally, @code{@@end -multitable} completes the table. Details in the sections below. - -@menu -* Multitable Column Widths:: Defining multitable column widths. -* Multitable Rows:: Defining multitable rows, with examples. -@end menu - -@node Multitable Column Widths, Multitable Rows, Multi-column Tables, Multi-column Tables -@subsection Multitable Column Widths -@cindex Multitable column widths -@cindex Column widths, defining for multitables -@cindex Widths, defining multitable column - -You can define the column widths for a multitable in two ways: as -fractions of the line length; or with a prototype row. Mixing the two -methods is not supported. In either case, the widths are defined -entirely on the same line as the @code{@@multitable} command. - -@enumerate -@item -@findex columnfractions -@cindex Line length, column widths as fraction of -To specify column widths as fractions of the line length, write -@code{@@columnfractions} and the decimal numbers (presumably less than -1) after the @code{@@multitable} command, as in: - -@example -@@multitable @@columnfractions .33 .33 .33 -@end example - -@noindent The fractions need not add up exactly to 1.0, as these do -not. This allows you to produce tables that do not need the full line -length. - -@item -@cindex Prototype row, column widths defined by -To specify a prototype row, write the longest entry for each column -enclosed in braces after the @code{@@multitable} command. For example: - -@example -@@multitable @{some text for column one@} @{for column two@} -@end example - -@noindent -The first column will then have the width of the typeset `some text for -column one', and the second column the width of `for column two'. - -The prototype entries need not appear in the table itself. - -Although we used simple text in this example, the prototype entries can -contain Texinfo commands; markup commands such as @code{@@code} are -particularly likely to be useful. - -@end enumerate - - -@node Multitable Rows, , Multitable Column Widths, Multi-column Tables -@subsection Multitable Rows -@cindex Multitable rows -@cindex Rows, of a multitable - -@findex item -@cindex tab -After the @code{@@multitable} command defining the column widths (see -the previous section), you begin each row in the body of a multitable -with @code{@@item}, and separate the column entries with @code{@@tab}. -Line breaks are not special within the table body, and you may break -input lines in your source file as necessary. - -Here is a complete example of a multi-column table (the text is from -@cite{The GNU Emacs Manual}, @pxref{Split Window,, Splitting Windows, -emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}): - -@example -@@multitable @@columnfractions .15 .45 .4 -@@item Key @@tab Command @@tab Description -@@item C-x 2 -@@tab @@code@{split-window-vertically@} -@@tab Split the selected window into two windows, -with one above the other. -@@item C-x 3 -@@tab @@code@{split-window-horizontally@} -@@tab Split the selected window into two windows -positioned side by side. -@@item C-Mouse-2 -@@tab -@@tab In the mode line or scroll bar of a window, -split that window. -@@end multitable -@end example - -@noindent produces: - -@multitable @columnfractions .15 .45 .4 -@item Key @tab Command @tab Description -@item C-x 2 -@tab @code{split-window-vertically} -@tab Split the selected window into two windows, -with one above the other. -@item C-x 3 -@tab @code{split-window-horizontally} -@tab Split the selected window into two windows -positioned side by side. -@item C-Mouse-2 -@tab -@tab In the mode line or scroll bar of a window, -split that window. -@end multitable - - -@node Indices, Insertions, Lists and Tables, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@chapter Creating Indices -@cindex Indices -@cindex Creating indices - -Using Texinfo, you can generate indices without having to sort and -collate entries manually. In an index, the entries are listed in -alphabetical order, together with information on how to find the -discussion of each entry. In a printed manual, this information -consists of page numbers. In an Info file, this information is a menu -entry leading to the first node referenced.@refill - -Texinfo provides several predefined kinds of index: an index -for functions, an index for variables, an index for concepts, and so -on. You can combine indices or use them for other than their -canonical purpose. If you wish, you can define your own indices.@refill - -@menu -* Index Entries:: Choose different words for index entries. -* Predefined Indices:: Use different indices for different kinds - of entry. -* Indexing Commands:: How to make an index entry. -* Combining Indices:: How to combine indices. -* New Indices:: How to define your own indices. -@end menu - -@node Index Entries, Predefined Indices, Indices, Indices -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Making Index Entries -@cindex Index entries, making -@cindex Entries, making index - -When you are making index entries, it is good practice to think of the -different ways people may look for something. Different people -@emph{do not} think of the same words when they look something up. A -helpful index will have items indexed under all the different words -that people may use. For example, one reader may think it obvious that -the two-letter names for indices should be listed under ``Indices, -two-letter names'', since the word ``Index'' is the general concept. -But another reader may remember the specific concept of two-letter -names and search for the entry listed as ``Two letter names for -indices''. A good index will have both entries and will help both -readers.@refill - -Like typesetting, the construction of an index is a highly skilled, -professional art, the subtleties of which are not appreciated until you -need to do it yourself.@refill - -@xref{Printing Indices & Menus}, for information about printing an index -at the end of a book or creating an index menu in an Info file.@refill - -@node Predefined Indices, Indexing Commands, Index Entries, Indices -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Predefined Indices - -Texinfo provides six predefined indices:@refill - -@itemize @bullet -@item -A @dfn{concept index} listing concepts that are discussed.@refill - -@item -A @dfn{function index} listing functions (such as entry points of -libraries).@refill - -@item -A @dfn{variables index} listing variables (such as global variables -of libraries).@refill - -@item -A @dfn{keystroke index} listing keyboard commands.@refill - -@item -A @dfn{program index} listing names of programs.@refill - -@item -A @dfn{data type index} listing data types (such as structures defined in -header files).@refill -@end itemize - -@noindent -Not every manual needs all of these, and most manuals use two or three -of them. This manual has two indices: a -concept index and an @@-command index (that is actually the function -index but is called a command index in the chapter heading). Two or -more indices can be combined into one using the @code{@@synindex} or -@code{@@syncodeindex} commands. @xref{Combining Indices}.@refill - -@node Indexing Commands, Combining Indices, Predefined Indices, Indices -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Defining the Entries of an Index -@cindex Defining indexing entries -@cindex Index entries -@cindex Entries for an index -@cindex Specifying index entries -@cindex Creating index entries - -The data to make an index come from many individual indexing commands -scattered throughout the Texinfo source file. Each command says to add -one entry to a particular index; after formatting, the index will give -the current page number or node name as the reference.@refill - -An index entry consists of an indexing command at the beginning of a -line followed, on the rest of the line, by the entry.@refill - -For example, this section begins with the following five entries for -the concept index:@refill - -@example -@@cindex Defining indexing entries -@@cindex Index entries -@@cindex Entries for an index -@@cindex Specifying index entries -@@cindex Creating index entries -@end example - -Each predefined index has its own indexing command---@code{@@cindex} -for the concept index, @code{@@findex} for the function index, and so -on.@refill - -@cindex Writing index entries -@cindex Index entry writing -Concept index entries consist of text. The best way to write an index -is to choose entries that are terse yet clear. If you can do this, -the index often looks better if the entries are not capitalized, but -written just as they would appear in the middle of a sentence. -(Capitalize proper names and acronyms that always call for upper case -letters.) This is the case convention we use in most GNU manuals' -indices. - -If you don't see how to make an entry terse yet clear, make it longer -and clear---not terse and confusing. If many of the entries are several -words long, the index may look better if you use a different convention: -to capitalize the first word of each entry. But do not capitalize a -case-sensitive name such as a C or Lisp function name or a shell -command; that would be a spelling error. - -Whichever case convention you use, please use it consistently! - -@ignore -Concept index entries consist of English text. The usual convention -is to capitalize the first word of each such index entry, unless that -word is the name of a function, variable, or other such entity that -should not be capitalized. However, if your concept index entries are -consistently short (one or two words each) it may look better for each -regular entry to start with a lower case letter, aside from proper -names and acronyms that always call for upper case letters. Whichever -convention you adapt, please be consistent! -@end ignore - -Entries in indices other than the concept index are symbol names in -programming languages, or program names; these names are usually -case-sensitive, so use upper and lower case as required for them. - -By default, entries for a concept index are printed in a small roman -font and entries for the other indices are printed in a small -@code{@@code} font. You may change the way part of an entry is -printed with the usual Texinfo commands, such as @code{@@file} for -file names and @code{@@emph} for emphasis (@pxref{Marking -Text}).@refill -@cindex Index font types - -@cindex Predefined indexing commands -@cindex Indexing commands, predefined -The six indexing commands for predefined indices are: - -@table @code -@item @@cindex @var{concept} -@findex cindex -Make an entry in the concept index for @var{concept}.@refill - -@item @@findex @var{function} -@findex findex -Make an entry in the function index for @var{function}.@refill - -@item @@vindex @var{variable} -@findex vindex -Make an entry in the variable index for @var{variable}.@refill - -@item @@kindex @var{keystroke} -@findex kindex -Make an entry in the key index for @var{keystroke}.@refill - -@item @@pindex @var{program} -@findex pindex -Make an entry in the program index for @var{program}.@refill - -@item @@tindex @var{data type} -@findex tindex -Make an entry in the data type index for @var{data type}.@refill -@end table - -@quotation -@strong{Caution:} Do not use a colon in an index entry. In Info, a -colon separates the menu entry name from the node name. An extra -colon confuses Info. -@xref{Menu Parts, , The Parts of a Menu}, -for more information about the structure of a menu entry.@refill -@end quotation - -If you write several identical index entries in different places in a -Texinfo file, the index in the printed manual will list all the pages to -which those entries refer. However, the index in the Info file will -list @strong{only} the node that references the @strong{first} of those -index entries. Therefore, it is best to write indices in which each -entry refers to only one place in the Texinfo file. Fortunately, this -constraint is a feature rather than a loss since it means that the index -will be easy to use. Otherwise, you could create an index that lists -several pages for one entry and your reader would not know to which page -to turn. If you have two identical entries for one topic, change the -topics slightly, or qualify them to indicate the difference.@refill - -You are not actually required to use the predefined indices for their -canonical purposes. For example, suppose you wish to index some C -preprocessor macros. You could put them in the function index along -with actual functions, just by writing @code{@@findex} commands for -them; then, when you print the ``Function Index'' as an unnumbered -chapter, you could give it the title `Function and Macro Index' and -all will be consistent for the reader. Or you could put the macros in -with the data types by writing @code{@@tindex} commands for them, and -give that index a suitable title so the reader will understand. -(@xref{Printing Indices & Menus}.)@refill - -@node Combining Indices, New Indices, Indexing Commands, Indices -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Combining Indices -@cindex Combining indices -@cindex Indices, combining them - -Sometimes you will want to combine two disparate indices such as functions -and concepts, perhaps because you have few enough of one of them that -a separate index for them would look silly.@refill - -You could put functions into the concept index by writing -@code{@@cindex} commands for them instead of @code{@@findex} commands, -and produce a consistent manual by printing the concept index with the -title `Function and Concept Index' and not printing the `Function -Index' at all; but this is not a robust procedure. It works only if -your document is never included as part of another -document that is designed to have a separate function index; if your -document were to be included with such a document, the functions from -your document and those from the other would not end up together. -Also, to make your function names appear in the right font in the -concept index, you would need to enclose every one of them between -the braces of @code{@@code}.@refill - -@menu -* syncodeindex:: How to merge two indices, using @code{@@code} - font for the merged-from index. -* synindex:: How to merge two indices, using the - default font of the merged-to index. -@end menu - -@node syncodeindex, synindex, Combining Indices, Combining Indices -@subsection @code{@@syncodeindex} -@findex syncodeindex - -When you want to combine functions and concepts into one index, you -should index the functions with @code{@@findex} and index the concepts -with @code{@@cindex}, and use the @code{@@syncodeindex} command to -redirect the function index entries into the concept index.@refill -@findex syncodeindex - -The @code{@@syncodeindex} command takes two arguments; they are the name -of the index to redirect, and the name of the index to redirect it to. -The template looks like this:@refill - -@example -@@syncodeindex @var{from} @var{to} -@end example - -@cindex Predefined names for indices -@cindex Two letter names for indices -@cindex Indices, two letter names -@cindex Names for indices -For this purpose, the indices are given two-letter names:@refill - -@table @samp -@item cp -concept index -@item fn -function index -@item vr -variable index -@item ky -key index -@item pg -program index -@item tp -data type index -@end table - -Write an @code{@@syncodeindex} command before or shortly after the -end-of-header line at the beginning of a Texinfo file. For example, -to merge a function index with a concept index, write the -following:@refill - -@example -@@syncodeindex fn cp -@end example - -@noindent -This will cause all entries designated for the function index to merge -in with the concept index instead.@refill - -To merge both a variables index and a function index into a concept -index, write the following:@refill - -@example -@group -@@syncodeindex vr cp -@@syncodeindex fn cp -@end group -@end example - -@cindex Fonts for indices -The @code{@@syncodeindex} command puts all the entries from the `from' -index (the redirected index) into the @code{@@code} font, overriding -whatever default font is used by the index to which the entries are -now directed. This way, if you direct function names from a function -index into a concept index, all the function names are printed in the -@code{@@code} font as you would expect.@refill - -@node synindex, , syncodeindex, Combining Indices -@subsection @code{@@synindex} -@findex synindex - -The @code{@@synindex} command is nearly the same as the -@code{@@syncodeindex} command, except that it does not put the -`from' index entries into the @code{@@code} font; rather it puts -them in the roman font. Thus, you use @code{@@synindex} when you -merge a concept index into a function index.@refill - -@xref{Printing Indices & Menus}, for information about printing an index -at the end of a book or creating an index menu in an Info file.@refill - -@node New Indices, , Combining Indices, Indices -@section Defining New Indices -@cindex Defining new indices -@cindex Indices, defining new -@cindex New index defining -@findex defindex -@findex defcodeindex - -In addition to the predefined indices, you may use the -@code{@@defindex} and @code{@@defcodeindex} commands to define new -indices. These commands create new indexing @@-commands with which -you mark index entries. The @code{@@defindex }command is used like -this:@refill - -@example -@@defindex @var{name} -@end example - -The name of an index should be a two letter word, such as @samp{au}. -For example:@refill - -@example -@@defindex au -@end example - -This defines a new index, called the @samp{au} index. At the same -time, it creates a new indexing command, @code{@@auindex}, that you -can use to make index entries. Use the new indexing command just as -you would use a predefined indexing command.@refill - -For example, here is a section heading followed by a concept index -entry and two @samp{au} index entries.@refill - -@example -@@section Cognitive Semantics -@@cindex kinesthetic image schemas -@@auindex Johnson, Mark -@@auindex Lakoff, George -@end example - -@noindent -(Evidently, @samp{au} serves here as an abbreviation for ``author''.) -Texinfo constructs the new indexing command by concatenating the name -of the index with @samp{index}; thus, defining an @samp{au} index -leads to the automatic creation of an @code{@@auindex} command.@refill - -Use the @code{@@printindex} command to print the index, as you do with -the predefined indices. For example:@refill - -@example -@group -@@node Author Index, Subject Index, , Top -@@unnumbered Author Index - -@@printindex au -@end group -@end example - -The @code{@@defcodeindex} is like the @code{@@defindex} command, except -that, in the printed output, it prints entries in an @code{@@code} font -instead of a roman font. Thus, it parallels the @code{@@findex} command -rather than the @code{@@cindex} command.@refill - -You should define new indices within or right after the end-of-header -line of a Texinfo file, before any @code{@@synindex} or -@code{@@syncodeindex} commands (@pxref{Header}).@refill - -@node Insertions, Breaks, Indices, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@chapter Special Insertions -@cindex Inserting special characters and symbols -@cindex Special insertions - -Texinfo provides several commands for inserting characters that have -special meaning in Texinfo, such as braces, and for other graphic -elements that do not correspond to simple characters you can type. - -@iftex -These are: - -@itemize @bullet -@item Braces, @samp{@@} and periods. -@item Whitespace within and around a sentence. -@item Accents. -@item Dots and bullets. -@item The @TeX{} logo and the copyright symbol. -@item Mathematical expressions. -@end itemize -@end iftex - -@menu -* Braces Atsigns:: How to insert braces, @samp{@@}. -* Inserting Space:: How to insert the right amount of space - within a sentence. -* Inserting Accents:: How to insert accents and special characters. -* Dots Bullets:: How to insert dots and bullets. -* TeX and copyright:: How to insert the @TeX{} logo - and the copyright symbol. -* pounds:: How to insert the pounds currency symbol. -* minus:: How to insert a minus sign. -* math:: How to format a mathematical expression. -* Glyphs:: How to indicate results of evaluation, - expansion of macros, errors, etc. -* Images:: How to include graphics. -@end menu - - -@node Braces Atsigns, Inserting Space, Insertions, Insertions -@section Inserting @@ and Braces -@cindex Inserting @@, braces -@cindex Braces, inserting -@cindex Special characters, commands to insert -@cindex Commands to insert special characters - -@samp{@@} and curly braces are special characters in Texinfo. To insert -these characters so they appear in text, you must put an @samp{@@} in -front of these characters to prevent Texinfo from misinterpreting -them. - -Do not put braces after any of these commands; they are not -necessary. - -@menu -* Inserting An Atsign:: How to insert @samp{@@}. -* Inserting Braces:: How to insert @samp{@{} and @samp{@}}. -@end menu - -@node Inserting An Atsign, Inserting Braces, Braces Atsigns, Braces Atsigns -@subsection Inserting @samp{@@} with @@@@ -@findex @@ @r{(single @samp{@@})} - -@code{@@@@} stands for a single @samp{@@} in either printed or Info -output. - -Do not put braces after an @code{@@@@} command. - -@node Inserting Braces, , Inserting An Atsign, Braces Atsigns -@subsection Inserting @samp{@{} and @samp{@}}with @@@{ and @@@} -@findex @{ @r{(single @samp{@{})} -@findex @} @r{(single @samp{@}})} - -@code{@@@{} stands for a single @samp{@{} in either printed or Info -output. - -@code{@@@}} stands for a single @samp{@}} in either printed or Info -output. - -Do not put braces after either an @code{@@@{} or an @code{@@@}} -command. - - -@node Inserting Space, Inserting Accents, Braces Atsigns, Insertions -@section Inserting Space - -@cindex Inserting space -@cindex Spacing, inserting -@cindex Whitespace, inserting -The following sections describe commands that control spacing of various -kinds within and after sentences. - -@menu -* Not Ending a Sentence:: Sometimes a . doesn't end a sentence. -* Ending a Sentence:: Sometimes it does. -* Multiple Spaces:: Inserting multiple spaces. -* dmn:: How to format a dimension. -@end menu - -@node Not Ending a Sentence, Ending a Sentence, Inserting Space, Inserting Space -@subsection Not Ending a Sentence - -@cindex Not ending a sentence -@cindex Sentence non-ending punctuation -@cindex Periods, inserting -Depending on whether a period or exclamation point or question mark is -inside or at the end of a sentence, less or more space is inserted after -a period in a typeset manual. Since it is not always possible for -Texinfo to determine when a period ends a sentence and when it is used -in an abbreviation, special commands are needed in some circumstances. -(Usually, Texinfo can guess how to handle periods, so you do not need to -use the special commands; you just enter a period as you would if you -were using a typewriter, which means you put two spaces after the -period, question mark, or exclamation mark that ends a sentence.) - -@findex : @r{(suppress widening)} -Use the @code{@@:}@: command after a period, question mark, -exclamation mark, or colon that should not be followed by extra space. -For example, use @code{@@:}@: after periods that end abbreviations -which are not at the ends of sentences. - -@need 700 -For example, - -@example -The s.o.p.@@: has three parts @dots{} -The s.o.p. has three parts @dots{} -@end example - -@noindent -@ifinfo -produces -@end ifinfo -@iftex -produces the following. If you look carefully at this printed output, -you will see a little more whitespace after @samp{s.o.p.} in the second -line.@refill -@end iftex - -@quotation -The s.o.p.@: has three parts @dots{}@* -The s.o.p. has three parts @dots{} -@end quotation - -@noindent -(Incidentally, @samp{s.o.p.} is an abbreviation for ``Standard Operating -Procedure''.) - -@code{@@:} has no effect on the Info output. Do not put braces after -@code{@@:}. - - -@node Ending a Sentence, Multiple Spaces, Not Ending a Sentence, Inserting Space -@subsection Ending a Sentence - -@cindex Ending a Sentence -@cindex Sentence ending punctuation - -@findex . @r{(end of sentence)} -@findex ! @r{(end of sentence)} -@findex ? @r{(end of sentence)} -Use @code{@@.}@: instead of a period, @code{@@!}@: instead of an -exclamation point, and @code{@@?}@: instead of a question mark at the end -of a sentence that ends with a single capital letter. Otherwise, @TeX{} -will think the letter is an abbreviation and will not insert the correct -end-of-sentence spacing. Here is an example: - -@example -Give it to M.I.B. and to M.E.W@@. Also, give it to R.J.C@@. -Give it to M.I.B. and to M.E.W. Also, give it to R.J.C. -@end example - -@noindent -@ifinfo -produces -@end ifinfo -@iftex -produces the following. If you look carefully at this printed output, -you will see a little more whitespace after the @samp{W} in the first -line. -@end iftex - -@quotation -Give it to M.I.B. and to M.E.W@. Also, give it to R.J.C@.@* -Give it to M.I.B. and to M.E.W. Also, give it to R.J.C. -@end quotation - -In the Info file output, @code{@@.}@: is equivalent to a simple -@samp{.}; likewise for @code{@@!}@: and @code{@@?}@:. - -The meanings of @code{@@:} and @code{@@.}@: in Texinfo are designed to -work well with the Emacs sentence motion commands (@pxref{Sentences,,, -emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}). This made it necessary for them to be -incompatible with some other formatting systems that use @@-commands. - -Do not put braces after any of these commands. - - -@node Multiple Spaces, dmn, Ending a Sentence, Inserting Space -@subsection Multiple Spaces - -@cindex Multiple spaces -@cindex Whitespace, inserting -@findex (space) -@findex (tab) -@findex (newline) - -Ordinarily, @TeX{} collapses multiple whitespace characters (space, tab, -and newline) into a single space. Info output, on the other hand, -preserves whitespace as you type it, except for changing a newline into -a space; this is why it is important to put two spaces at the end of -sentences in Texinfo documents. - -Occasionally, you may want to actually insert several consecutive -spaces, either for purposes of example (what your program does with -multiple spaces as input), or merely for purposes of appearance in -headings or lists. Texinfo supports three commands: -@code{@@@kbd{SPACE}}, @code{@@@kbd{TAB}}, and @code{@@@kbd{NL}}, all of -which insert a single space into the output. (Here, -@code{@@@kbd{SPACE}} represents an @samp{@@} character followed by a -space, i.e., @samp{@@ }, and @kbd{TAB} and @kbd{NL} represent the tab -character and end-of-line, i.e., when @samp{@@} is the last character on -a line.) - -For example, -@example -Spacey@@ @@ @@ @@ -example. -@end example - -@noindent produces - -@example -Spacey@ @ @ @ -example. -@end example - -Other possible uses of @code{@@@kbd{SPACE}} have been subsumed by -@code{@@multitable} (@pxref{Multi-column Tables}). - -Do not follow any of these commands with braces. - - -@node dmn, , Multiple Spaces, Inserting Space -@subsection @code{@@dmn}@{@var{dimension}@}: Format a Dimension -@cindex Thin space between number, dimension -@cindex Dimension formatting -@cindex Format a dimension -@findex dmn - -At times, you may want to write @samp{12@dmn{pt}} or -@samp{8.5@dmn{in}} with little or no space between the number and the -abbreviation for the dimension. You can use the @code{@@dmn} command -to do this. On seeing the command, @TeX{} inserts just enough space -for proper typesetting; the Info formatting commands insert no space -at all, since the Info file does not require it.@refill - -To use the @code{@@dmn} command, write the number and then follow it -immediately, with no intervening space, by @code{@@dmn}, and then by -the dimension within braces. For example, - -@example -A4 paper is 8.27@@dmn@{in@} wide. -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@quotation -A4 paper is 8.27@dmn{in} wide. -@end quotation - -Not everyone uses this style. Some people prefer @w{@samp{8.27 in.@@:}} -or @w{@samp{8.27 inches}} to @samp{8.27@@dmn@{in@}} in the Texinfo file. -In these cases, however, the formatters may insert a line break between -the number and the dimension, so use @code{@@w} (@pxref{w}). Also, if -you write a period after an abbreviation within a sentence, you should -write @samp{@@:} after the period to prevent @TeX{} from inserting extra -whitespace, as shown here. @xref{Inserting Space}. - - -@node Inserting Accents, Dots Bullets, Inserting Space, Insertions -@section Inserting Accents - -@cindex Inserting accents -@cindex Accents, inserting -@cindex Floating accents, inserting - -Here is a table with the commands Texinfo provides for inserting -floating accents. The commands with non-alphabetic names do not take -braces around their argument (which is taken to be the next character). -(Exception: @code{@@,} @emph{does} take braces around its argument.) -This is so as to make the source as convenient to type and read as -possible, since accented characters are very common in some languages. - -@findex " -@cindex Umlaut accent -@findex ' -@cindex Acute accent -@findex = -@cindex Macron accent -@findex ^ -@cindex Circumflex accent -@findex ` -@cindex Grave accent -@findex ~ -@cindex Tilde accent -@findex , -@cindex Cedilla accent -@findex dotaccent -@cindex Dot accent -@findex H -@cindex Hungariam umlaut accent -@findex ringaccent -@cindex Ring accent -@findex tieaccent -@cindex Tie-after accent -@findex u -@cindex Breve accent -@findex ubaraccent -@cindex Underbar accent -@findex udotaccent -@cindex Underdot accent -@findex v -@cindex Check accent -@multitable {@@questiondown@{@}} {Output} {macron/overbar accent} -@item Command @tab Output @tab What -@item @t{@@"o} @tab @"o @tab umlaut accent -@item @t{@@'o} @tab @'o @tab acute accent -@item @t{@@,@{c@}} @tab @,{c} @tab cedilla accent -@item @t{@@=o} @tab @=o @tab macron/overbar accent -@item @t{@@^o} @tab @^o @tab circumflex accent -@item @t{@@`o} @tab @`o @tab grave accent -@item @t{@@~o} @tab @~o @tab tilde accent -@item @t{@@dotaccent@{o@}} @tab @dotaccent{o} @tab overdot accent -@item @t{@@H@{o@}} @tab @H{o} @tab long Hungarian umlaut -@item @t{@@ringaccent@{o@}} @tab @ringaccent{o} @tab ring accent -@item @t{@@tieaccent@{oo@}} @tab @tieaccent{oo} @tab tie-after accent -@item @t{@@u@{o@}} @tab @u{o} @tab breve accent -@item @t{@@ubaraccent@{o@}} @tab @ubaraccent{o} @tab underbar accent -@item @t{@@udotaccent@{o@}} @tab @udotaccent{o} @tab underdot accent -@item @t{@@v@{o@}} @tab @v{o} @tab hacek or check accent -@end multitable - -This table lists the Texinfo commands for inserting other characters -commonly used in languages other than English. - -@findex questiondown -@cindex @questiondown{} -@findex exclamdown -@cindex @exclamdown{} -@findex aa -@cindex @aa{} -@findex AA -@cindex @AA{} -@findex ae -@cindex @ae{} -@findex AE -@cindex @AE{} -@findex dotless -@cindex @dotless{i} -@cindex @dotless{j} -@cindex Dotless i, j -@findex l -@cindex @l{} -@findex L -@cindex @L{} -@findex o -@cindex @o{} -@findex O -@cindex @O{} -@findex oe -@cindex @oe{} -@findex OE -@cindex @OE{} -@findex ss -@cindex @ss{} -@cindex Es-zet -@cindex Sharp S -@cindex German S -@multitable {@@questiondown@{@}} {oe,OE} {es-zet or sharp S} -@item @t{@@exclamdown@{@}} @tab @exclamdown{} @tab upside-down ! -@item @t{@@questiondown@{@}} @tab @questiondown{} @tab upside-down ? -@item @t{@@aa@{@},@@AA@{@}} @tab @aa{},@AA{} @tab A,a with circle -@item @t{@@ae@{@},@@AE@{@}} @tab @ae{},@AE{} @tab ae,AE ligatures -@item @t{@@dotless@{i@}} @tab @dotless{i} @tab dotless i -@item @t{@@dotless@{j@}} @tab @dotless{j} @tab dotless j -@item @t{@@l@{@},@@L@{@}} @tab @l{},@L{} @tab suppressed-L,l -@item @t{@@o@{@},@@O@{@}} @tab @o{},@O{} @tab O,o with slash -@item @t{@@oe@{@},@@OE@{@}} @tab @oe{},@OE{} @tab OE,oe ligatures -@item @t{@@ss@{@}} @tab @ss{} @tab es-zet or sharp S -@end multitable - - -@node Dots Bullets, TeX and copyright, Inserting Accents, Insertions -@section Inserting Ellipsis, Dots, and Bullets -@cindex Dots, inserting -@cindex Bullets, inserting -@cindex Ellipsis, inserting -@cindex Inserting ellipsis -@cindex Inserting dots -@cindex Special typesetting commands -@cindex Typesetting commands for dots, etc. - -An @dfn{ellipsis} (a line of dots) is not typeset as a string of -periods, so a special command is used for ellipsis in Texinfo. The -@code{@@bullet} command is special, too. Each of these commands is -followed by a pair of braces, @samp{@{@}}, without any whitespace -between the name of the command and the braces. (You need to use braces -with these commands because you can use them next to other text; without -the braces, the formatters would be confused. @xref{Command Syntax, , -@@-Command Syntax}, for further information.)@refill - -@menu -* dots:: How to insert dots @dots{} -* bullet:: How to insert a bullet. -@end menu - - -@node dots, bullet, Dots Bullets, Dots Bullets -@subsection @code{@@dots}@{@} (@dots{}) -@findex dots -@cindex Inserting dots -@cindex Dots, inserting - -Use the @code{@@dots@{@}} command to generate an ellipsis, which is -three dots in a row, appropriately spaced, like this: `@dots{}'. Do -not simply write three periods in the input file; that would work for -the Info file output, but would produce the wrong amount of space -between the periods in the printed manual. - -Similarly, the @code{@@enddots@{@}} command generates an -end-of-sentence ellipsis (four dots) @enddots{} - -@iftex -Here is an ellipsis: @dots{} -Here are three periods in a row: ... - -In printed output, the three periods in a row are closer together than -the dots in the ellipsis. -@end iftex - - -@node bullet, , dots, Dots Bullets -@subsection @code{@@bullet}@{@} (@bullet{}) -@findex bullet - -Use the @code{@@bullet@{@}} command to generate a large round dot, or -the closest possible thing to one. In Info, an asterisk is used.@refill - -Here is a bullet: @bullet{} - -When you use @code{@@bullet} in @code{@@itemize}, you do not need to -type the braces, because @code{@@itemize} supplies them. -(@xref{itemize, , @code{@@itemize}}.)@refill - - -@node TeX and copyright, pounds, Dots Bullets, Insertions -@section Inserting @TeX{} and the Copyright Symbol - -The logo `@TeX{}' is typeset in a special fashion and it needs an -@@-command. The copyright symbol, `@copyright{}', is also special. -Each of these commands is followed by a pair of braces, @samp{@{@}}, -without any whitespace between the name of the command and the -braces.@refill - -@menu -* tex:: How to insert the @TeX{} logo. -* copyright symbol:: How to use @code{@@copyright}@{@}. -@end menu - - -@node tex, copyright symbol, TeX and copyright, TeX and copyright -@subsection @code{@@TeX}@{@} (@TeX{}) -@findex tex (command) - -Use the @code{@@TeX@{@}} command to generate `@TeX{}'. In a printed -manual, this is a special logo that is different from three ordinary -letters. In Info, it just looks like @samp{TeX}. The -@code{@@TeX@{@}} command is unique among Texinfo commands in that the -@kbd{T} and the @kbd{X} are in upper case.@refill - - -@node copyright symbol, , tex, TeX and copyright -@subsection @code{@@copyright}@{@} (@copyright{}) -@findex copyright - -Use the @code{@@copyright@{@}} command to generate `@copyright{}'. In -a printed manual, this is a @samp{c} inside a circle, and in Info, -this is @samp{(C)}.@refill - - -@node pounds, minus, TeX and copyright, Insertions -@section @code{@@pounds}@{@} (@pounds{}): Pounds Sterling -@findex pounds - -Use the @code{@@pounds@{@}} command to generate `@pounds{}'. In a -printed manual, this is the symbol for the currency pounds sterling. -In Info, it is a @samp{#}. Other currency symbols are unfortunately not -available. - - -@node minus, math, pounds, Insertions -@section @code{@@minus}@{@} (@minus{}): Inserting a Minus Sign -@findex minus - -Use the @code{@@minus@{@}} command to generate a minus sign. In a -fixed-width font, this is a single hyphen, but in a proportional font, -the symbol is the customary length for a minus sign---a little longer -than a hyphen, shorter than an em-dash: - -@display -@samp{@minus{}} is a minus sign generated with @samp{@@minus@{@}}, - -`-' is a hyphen generated with the character @samp{-}, - -`---' is an em-dash for text. -@end display - -@noindent -In the fixed-width font used by Info, @code{@@minus@{@}} is the same -as a hyphen. - -You should not use @code{@@minus@{@}} inside @code{@@code} or -@code{@@example} because the width distinction is not made in the -fixed-width font they use. - -When you use @code{@@minus} to specify the mark beginning each entry in -an itemized list, you do not need to type the braces -(@pxref{itemize, , @code{@@itemize}}.) - - -@node math, Glyphs, minus, Insertions -@section @code{@@math}: Inserting Mathematical Expressions -@findex math -@cindex Mathematical expressions - -You can write a short mathematical expression with the @code{@@math} -command. Write the mathematical expression between braces, like this: - -@example -@@math@{(a + b)(a + b) = a^2 + 2ab + b^2@} -@end example - -@iftex -@need 1000 -@noindent -This produces the following in @TeX{}: - -@display -@math{(a + b)(a + b) = a^2 + 2ab + b^2} -@end display - -@noindent -and the following in Info: -@end iftex -@ifinfo -@noindent -This produces the following in Info: -@end ifinfo - -@example -(a + b)(a + b) = a^2 + 2ab + b^2 -@end example - -Thus, the @code{@@math} command has no effect on the Info output. - -For complex mathematical expressions, you can also use @TeX{} directly -(@pxref{Raw Formatter Commands}). When you use @TeX{} directly, -remember to write the mathematical expression between one or two -@samp{$} (dollar-signs) as appropriate. - - -@node Glyphs, Images, math, Insertions -@section Glyphs for Examples -@cindex Glyphs - -In Texinfo, code is often illustrated in examples that are delimited -by @code{@@example} and @code{@@end example}, or by @code{@@lisp} and -@code{@@end lisp}. In such examples, you can indicate the results of -evaluation or an expansion using @samp{@result{}} or -@samp{@expansion{}}. Likewise, there are commands to insert glyphs -to indicate -printed output, error messages, equivalence of expressions, and the -location of point.@refill - -The glyph-insertion commands do not need to be used within an example, but -most often they are. Every glyph-insertion command is followed by a pair of -left- and right-hand braces.@refill - -@menu -* Glyphs Summary:: -* result:: How to show the result of expression. -* expansion:: How to indicate an expansion. -* Print Glyph:: How to indicate printed output. -* Error Glyph:: How to indicate an error message. -* Equivalence:: How to indicate equivalence. -* Point Glyph:: How to indicate the location of point. -@end menu - -@node Glyphs Summary, result, Glyphs, Glyphs -@ifinfo -@subheading Glyphs Summary - -Here are the different glyph commands:@refill -@end ifinfo - -@table @asis -@item @result{} -@code{@@result@{@}} points to the result of an expression.@refill - -@item @expansion{} -@code{@@expansion@{@}} shows the results of a macro expansion.@refill - -@item @print{} -@code{@@print@{@}} indicates printed output.@refill - -@item @error{} -@code{@@error@{@}} indicates that the following text is an error -message.@refill - -@item @equiv{} -@code{@@equiv@{@}} indicates the exact equivalence of two forms.@refill - -@item @point{} -@code{@@point@{@}} shows the location of point.@refill -@end table - - -@menu -* result:: -* expansion:: -* Print Glyph:: -* Error Glyph:: -* Equivalence:: -* Point Glyph:: -@end menu - -@node result, expansion, Glyphs Summary, Glyphs -@subsection @code{@@result@{@}} (@result{}): Indicating Evaluation -@cindex Result of an expression -@cindex Indicating evaluation -@cindex Evaluation glyph -@cindex Value of an expression, indicating - -Use the @code{@@result@{@}} command to indicate the result of -evaluating an expression.@refill - -@iftex -The @code{@@result@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{=>} in Info and -as @samp{@result{}} in the printed output. -@end iftex -@ifinfo -The @code{@@result@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{@result{}} in Info -and as a double stemmed arrow in the printed output.@refill -@end ifinfo - -Thus, the following, - -@lisp -(cdr '(1 2 3)) - @result{} (2 3) -@end lisp - -@noindent -may be read as ``@code{(cdr '(1 2 3))} evaluates to @code{(2 3)}''. - - -@node expansion, Print Glyph, result, Glyphs -@subsection @code{@@expansion@{@}} (@expansion{}): Indicating an Expansion -@cindex Expansion, indicating it - -When an expression is a macro call, it expands into a new expression. -You can indicate the result of the expansion with the -@code{@@expansion@{@}} command.@refill - -@iftex -The @code{@@expansion@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{==>} in Info and -as @samp{@expansion{}} in the printed output. -@end iftex -@ifinfo -The @code{@@expansion@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{@expansion{}} -in Info and as a long arrow with a flat base in the printed output.@refill -@end ifinfo - -@need 700 -For example, the following - -@example -@group -@@lisp -(third '(a b c)) - @@expansion@{@} (car (cdr (cdr '(a b c)))) - @@result@{@} c -@@end lisp -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@lisp -@group -(third '(a b c)) - @expansion{} (car (cdr (cdr '(a b c)))) - @result{} c -@end group -@end lisp - -@noindent -which may be read as: - -@quotation -@code{(third '(a b c))} expands to @code{(car (cdr (cdr '(a b c))))}; -the result of evaluating the expression is @code{c}. -@end quotation - -@noindent -Often, as in this case, an example looks better if the -@code{@@expansion@{@}} and @code{@@result@{@}} commands are indented -five spaces.@refill - - -@node Print Glyph, Error Glyph, expansion, Glyphs -@subsection @code{@@print@{@}} (@print{}): Indicating Printed Output -@cindex Printed output, indicating it - -Sometimes an expression will print output during its execution. You -can indicate the printed output with the @code{@@print@{@}} command.@refill - -@iftex -The @code{@@print@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{-|} in Info and -as @samp{@print{}} in the printed output. -@end iftex -@ifinfo -The @code{@@print@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{@print{}} in Info -and similarly, as a horizontal dash butting against a vertical bar, in -the printed output.@refill -@end ifinfo - -In the following example, the printed text is indicated with -@samp{@print{}}, and the value of the expression follows on the -last line.@refill - -@lisp -@group -(progn (print 'foo) (print 'bar)) - @print{} foo - @print{} bar - @result{} bar -@end group -@end lisp - -@noindent -In a Texinfo source file, this example is written as follows: - -@lisp -@group -@@lisp -(progn (print 'foo) (print 'bar)) - @@print@{@} foo - @@print@{@} bar - @@result@{@} bar -@@end lisp -@end group -@end lisp - - -@node Error Glyph, Equivalence, Print Glyph, Glyphs -@subsection @code{@@error@{@}} (@error{}): Indicating an Error Message -@cindex Error message, indicating it - -A piece of code may cause an error when you evaluate it. You can -designate the error message with the @code{@@error@{@}} command.@refill - -@iftex -The @code{@@error@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{error-->} in Info -and as @samp{@error{}} in the printed output. -@end iftex -@ifinfo -The @code{@@error@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{@error{}} in Info -and as the word `error' in a box in the printed output.@refill -@end ifinfo - -@need 700 -Thus, - -@example -@@lisp -(+ 23 'x) -@@error@{@} Wrong type argument: integer-or-marker-p, x -@@end lisp -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@lisp -(+ 23 'x) -@error{} Wrong type argument: integer-or-marker-p, x -@end lisp - -@noindent -This indicates that the following error message is printed -when you evaluate the expression: - -@lisp -Wrong type argument: integer-or-marker-p, x -@end lisp - -@samp{@error{}} itself is not part of the error message. - - -@node Equivalence, Point Glyph, Error Glyph, Glyphs -@subsection @code{@@equiv@{@}} (@equiv{}): Indicating Equivalence -@cindex Equivalence, indicating it - -Sometimes two expressions produce identical results. You can indicate the -exact equivalence of two forms with the @code{@@equiv@{@}} command.@refill - -@iftex -The @code{@@equiv@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{==} in Info and -as @samp{@equiv{}} in the printed output. -@end iftex -@ifinfo -The @code{@@equiv@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{@equiv{}} in Info -and as a three parallel horizontal lines in the printed output.@refill -@end ifinfo - -Thus, - -@example -@@lisp -(make-sparse-keymap) @@equiv@{@} (list 'keymap) -@@end lisp -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@lisp -(make-sparse-keymap) @equiv{} (list 'keymap) -@end lisp - -@noindent -This indicates that evaluating @code{(make-sparse-keymap)} produces -identical results to evaluating @code{(list 'keymap)}. - - -@node Point Glyph, , Equivalence, Glyphs -@subsection @code{@@point@{@}} (@point{}): Indicating Point in a Buffer -@cindex Point, indicating it in a buffer - -Sometimes you need to show an example of text in an Emacs buffer. In -such examples, the convention is to include the entire contents of the -buffer in question between two lines of dashes containing the buffer -name.@refill - -You can use the @samp{@@point@{@}} command to show the location of point -in the text in the buffer. (The symbol for point, of course, is not -part of the text in the buffer; it indicates the place @emph{between} -two characters where point is located.)@refill - -@iftex -The @code{@@point@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{-!-} in Info and -as @samp{@point{}} in the printed output. -@end iftex -@ifinfo -The @code{@@point@{@}} command is displayed as @samp{@point{}} in Info -and as a small five pointed star in the printed output.@refill -@end ifinfo - -The following example shows the contents of buffer @file{foo} before -and after evaluating a Lisp command to insert the word @code{changed}.@refill - -@example -@group ----------- Buffer: foo ---------- -This is the @point{}contents of foo. ----------- Buffer: foo ---------- - -@end group -@end example - -@example -@group -(insert "changed ") - @result{} nil ----------- Buffer: foo ---------- -This is the changed @point{}contents of foo. ----------- Buffer: foo ---------- - -@end group -@end example - -In a Texinfo source file, the example is written like this:@refill - -@example -@@example ----------- Buffer: foo ---------- -This is the @@point@{@}contents of foo. ----------- Buffer: foo ---------- - -(insert "changed ") - @@result@{@} nil ----------- Buffer: foo ---------- -This is the changed @@point@{@}contents of foo. ----------- Buffer: foo ---------- -@@end example -@end example - - -@c this should be described with figures when we have them -@c perhaps in the quotation/example chapter. -@node Images, , Glyphs, Insertions -@section Inserting Images - -@cindex Images, inserting -@cindex Pictures, inserting -@findex image - -You can insert an image in an external file with the @code{@@image} -command: - -@example -@@image@{@var{filename}, @r{[}@var{width}@r{]}, @r{[}@var{height}@r{]}@} -@end example - -@cindex Formats for images -@cindex Image formats -The @var{filename} argument is mandatory, and must not have an -extension, because the different processors support different formats: -@TeX{} reads the file @file{@var{filename}.eps} (Encapsulated PostScript -format); @code{makeinfo} uses @file{@var{filename}.txt} verbatim for -Info output (more or less as if it was an @code{@@example}). HTML -output requires @file{@var{filename}.jpg}. - -@cindex Width of images -@cindex Height of images -@cindex Aspect ratio of images -@cindex Distorting images -The optional @var{width} and @var{height} arguments specify the size to -scale the image to (they are ignored for Info output). If they are both -specified, the image is presented in its natural size (given in the -file); if only one is specified, the other is scaled proportionately; -and if both are specified, both are respected, thus possibly distorting -the original image by changing its aspect ratio. - -@cindex Dimensions and image sizes -The @var{width} and @var{height} may be specified using any valid @TeX{} -dimension, namely: - -@table @asis -@item pt -@cindex Points (dimension) -point (72.27pt = 1in) -@item pc -@cindex Picas -pica (1pc = 12pt) -@item bp -@cindex Big points -big point (72bp = 1in) -@item in -@cindex Inches -inch -@item cm -@cindex Centimeters -centimeter (2.54cm = 1in) -@item mm -@cindex Millimeters -millimeter (10mm = 1cm) -@item dd -@cindex Did@^ot points -did@^ot point (1157dd = 1238pt) -@item cc -@cindex Ciceros -cicero (1cc = 12dd) -@item sp -@cindex Scaled points -scaled point (65536sp = 1pt) -@end table - -@pindex ridt.eps -For example, the following will scale a file @file{ridt.eps} to one -inch vertically, with the width scaled proportionately: - -@example -@@image@{ridt,,1in@} -@end example - -@pindex epsf.tex -For @code{@@image} to work with @TeX{}, the file @file{epsf.tex} must be -installed somewhere that @TeX{} can find it. This file is included in -the Texinfo distribution and is available from -@uref{ftp://ftp.tug.org/tex/epsf.tex}. - - -@node Breaks, Definition Commands, Insertions, Top -@chapter Making and Preventing Breaks -@cindex Making line and page breaks -@cindex Preventing line and page breaks - -Usually, a Texinfo file is processed both by @TeX{} and by one of the -Info formatting commands. Line, paragraph, or page breaks sometimes -occur in the `wrong' place in one or other form of output. You must -ensure that text looks right both in the printed manual and in the -Info file.@refill - -For example, in a printed manual, page breaks may occur awkwardly in -the middle of an example; to prevent this, you can hold text together -using a grouping command that keeps the text from being split across -two pages. Conversely, you may want to force a page break where none -would occur normally. Fortunately, problems like these do not often -arise. When they do, use the break, break prevention, or pagination -commands.@refill - -@menu -* Break Commands:: Cause and prevent splits. -* Line Breaks:: How to force a single line to use two lines. -* - and hyphenation:: How to tell TeX about hyphenation points. -* w:: How to prevent unwanted line breaks. -* sp:: How to insert blank lines. -* page:: How to force the start of a new page. -* group:: How to prevent unwanted page breaks. -* need:: Another way to prevent unwanted page breaks. -@end menu - -@ifinfo -@node Break Commands, Line Breaks, Breaks, Breaks -@heading The Break Commands -@end ifinfo -@iftex -@sp 1 -@end iftex - -The break commands create or allow line and paragraph breaks:@refill - -@table @code -@item @@* -Force a line break. - -@item @@sp @var{n} -Skip @var{n} blank lines.@refill - -@item @@- -Insert a discretionary hyphen. - -@item @@hyphenation@{@var{hy-phen-a-ted words}@} -Define hyphen points in @var{hy-phen-a-ted words}. -@end table - -The line-break-prevention command holds text together all on one -line:@refill - -@table @code -@item @@w@{@var{text}@} -Prevent @var{text} from being split and hyphenated across two lines.@refill -@end table -@iftex -@sp 1 -@end iftex - -The pagination commands apply only to printed output, since Info -files do not have pages.@refill - -@table @code -@item @@page -Start a new page in the printed manual.@refill - -@item @@group -Hold text together that must appear on one printed page.@refill - -@item @@need @var{mils} -Start a new printed page if not enough space on this one.@refill -@end table - -@node Line Breaks, - and hyphenation, Break Commands, Breaks -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@*}: Generate Line Breaks -@findex * @r{(force line break)} -@cindex Line breaks -@cindex Breaks in a line - -The @code{@@*} command forces a line break in both the printed manual and -in Info.@refill - -@need 700 -For example, - -@example -This line @@* is broken @@*in two places. -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@example -@group -This line - is broken -in two places. -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -(Note that the space after the first @code{@@*} command is faithfully -carried down to the next line.)@refill - -@need 800 -The @code{@@*} command is often used in a file's copyright page:@refill - -@example -@group -This is edition 2.0 of the Texinfo documentation,@@* -and is for @dots{} -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -In this case, the @code{@@*} command keeps @TeX{} from stretching the -line across the whole page in an ugly manner.@refill - -@quotation -@strong{Please note:} Do not write braces after an @code{@@*} command; -they are not needed.@refill - -Do not write an @code{@@refill} command at the end of a paragraph -containing an @code{@@*} command; it will cause the paragraph to be -refilled after the line break occurs, negating the effect of the line -break.@refill -@end quotation - -@node - and hyphenation, w, Line Breaks, Breaks -@section @code{@@-} and @code{@@hyphenation}: Helping @TeX{} hyphenate - -@findex - -@findex hyphenation -@cindex Hyphenation, helping @TeX{} do -@cindex Fine-tuning, and hyphenation - -Although @TeX{}'s hyphenation algorithm is generally pretty good, it -does miss useful hyphenation points from time to time. (Or, far more -rarely, insert an incorrect hyphenation.) So, for documents with an -unusual vocabulary or when fine-tuning for a printed edition, you may -wish to help @TeX{} out. Texinfo supports two commands for this: - -@table @code -@item @@- -Insert a discretionary hyphen, i.e., a place where @TeX{} can (but does -not have to) hyphenate. This is especially useful when you notice -an overfull hbox is due to @TeX{} missing a hyphenation (@pxref{Overfull -hboxes}). @TeX{} will not insert any hyphenation points in a word -containing @code{@@-}. - -@item @@hyphenation@{@var{hy-phen-a-ted words}@} -Tell @TeX{} how to hyphenate @var{hy-phen-a-ted words}. As shown, you -put a @samp{-} at each hyphenation point. For example: -@example -@@hyphenation@{man-u-script man-u-scripts@} -@end example -@noindent @TeX{} only uses the specified hyphenation points when the -words match exactly, so give all necessary variants. -@end table - -Info output is not hyphenated, so these commands have no effect there. - -@node w, sp, - and hyphenation, Breaks -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@w}@{@var{text}@}: Prevent Line Breaks -@findex w @r{(prevent line break)} -@cindex Line breaks, preventing -@cindex Hyphenation, preventing - -@code{@@w@{@var{text}@}} outputs @var{text} and prohibits line breaks -within @var{text}.@refill - -You can use the @code{@@w} command to prevent @TeX{} from automatically -hyphenating a long name or phrase that happens to fall near the end of a -line.@refill - -@example -You can copy GNU software from @@w@{@@samp@{ftp.gnu.ai.mit.edu@}@}. -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@quotation -You can copy GNU software from @w{@samp{ftp.gnu.ai.mit.edu}}. -@end quotation - -@quotation -@strong{Caution:} Do not write an @code{@@refill} command at the end -of a paragraph containing an @code{@@w} command; it will cause the -paragraph to be refilled and may thereby negate the effect of the -@code{@@w} command.@refill -@end quotation - -@node sp, page, w, Breaks -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@sp} @var{n}: Insert Blank Lines -@findex sp @r{(line spacing)} -@cindex Spaces (blank lines) -@cindex Blank lines -@cindex Line spacing - -A line beginning with and containing only @code{@@sp @var{n}} -generates @var{n} blank lines of space in both the printed manual and -the Info file. @code{@@sp} also forces a paragraph break. For -example,@refill - -@example -@@sp 2 -@end example - -@noindent -generates two blank lines. - -The @code{@@sp} command is most often used in the title page.@refill - -@ignore -@c node br, page, sp, Breaks -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@c section @code{@@br}: Generate Paragraph Breaks -@findex br @r{(paragraph breaks)} -@cindex Paragraph breaks -@cindex Breaks in a paragraph - -The @code{@@br} command forces a paragraph break. It inserts a blank -line. You can use the command within or at the end of a line. If -used within a line, the @code{@@br@{@}} command must be followed by -left and right braces (as shown here) to mark the end of the -command.@refill - -@need 700 -For example, - -@example -@group -This line @@br@{@}contains and is ended by paragraph breaks@@br -and is followed by another line. -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@example -@group -This line - -contains and is ended by paragraph breaks - -and is followed by another line. -@end group -@end example - -The @code{@@br} command is seldom used. -@end ignore - -@node page, group, sp, Breaks -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@page}: Start a New Page -@cindex Page breaks -@findex page - -A line containing only @code{@@page} starts a new page in a printed -manual. The command has no effect on Info files since they are not -paginated. An @code{@@page} command is often used in the @code{@@titlepage} -section of a Texinfo file to start the copyright page.@refill - -@node group, need, page, Breaks -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@group}: Prevent Page Breaks -@cindex Group (hold text together vertically) -@cindex Holding text together vertically -@cindex Vertically holding text together -@findex group - -The @code{@@group} command (on a line by itself) is used inside an -@code{@@example} or similar construct to begin an unsplittable vertical -group, which will appear entirely on one page in the printed output. -The group is terminated by a line containing only @code{@@end group}. -These two lines produce no output of their own, and in the Info file -output they have no effect at all.@refill - -@c Once said that these environments -@c turn off vertical spacing between ``paragraphs''. -@c Also, quotation used to work, but doesn't in texinfo-2.72 -Although @code{@@group} would make sense conceptually in a wide -variety of contexts, its current implementation works reliably only -within @code{@@example} and variants, and within @code{@@display}, -@code{@@format}, @code{@@flushleft} and @code{@@flushright}. -@xref{Quotations and Examples}. (What all these commands have in -common is that each line of input produces a line of output.) In -other contexts, @code{@@group} can cause anomalous vertical -spacing.@refill - -@need 750 -This formatting requirement means that you should write: - -@example -@group -@@example -@@group -@dots{} -@@end group -@@end example -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -with the @code{@@group} and @code{@@end group} commands inside the -@code{@@example} and @code{@@end example} commands. - -The @code{@@group} command is most often used to hold an example -together on one page. In this Texinfo manual, more than 100 examples -contain text that is enclosed between @code{@@group} and @code{@@end -group}. - -If you forget to end a group, you may get strange and unfathomable -error messages when you run @TeX{}. This is because @TeX{} keeps -trying to put the rest of the Texinfo file onto the one page and does -not start to generate error messages until it has processed -considerable text. It is a good rule of thumb to look for a missing -@code{@@end group} if you get incomprehensible error messages in -@TeX{}.@refill - -@node need, , group, Breaks -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@need @var{mils}}: Prevent Page Breaks -@cindex Need space at page bottom -@findex need - -A line containing only @code{@@need @var{n}} starts -a new page in a printed manual if fewer than @var{n} mils (thousandths -of an inch) remain on the current page. Do not use -braces around the argument @var{n}. The @code{@@need} command has no -effect on Info files since they are not paginated.@refill - -@need 800 -This paragraph is preceded by an @code{@@need} command that tells -@TeX{} to start a new page if fewer than 800 mils (eight-tenths -inch) remain on the page. It looks like this:@refill - -@example -@group -@@need 800 -This paragraph is preceded by @dots{} -@end group -@end example - -The @code{@@need} command is useful for preventing orphans (single -lines at the bottoms of printed pages).@refill - -@node Definition Commands, Footnotes, Breaks, Top -@chapter Definition Commands -@cindex Definition commands - -The @code{@@deffn} command and the other @dfn{definition commands} -enable you to describe functions, variables, macros, commands, user -options, special forms and other such artifacts in a uniform -format.@refill - -In the Info file, a definition causes the entity -category---`Function', `Variable', or whatever---to appear at the -beginning of the first line of the definition, followed by the -entity's name and arguments. In the printed manual, the command -causes @TeX{} to print the entity's name and its arguments on the left -margin and print the category next to the right margin. In both -output formats, the body of the definition is indented. Also, the -name of the entity is entered into the appropriate index: -@code{@@deffn} enters the name into the index of functions, -@code{@@defvr} enters it into the index of variables, and so -on.@refill - -A manual need not and should not contain more than one definition for -a given name. An appendix containing a summary should use -@code{@@table} rather than the definition commands.@refill - -@menu -* Def Cmd Template:: How to structure a description using a - definition command. -* Optional Arguments:: How to handle optional and repeated arguments. -* deffnx:: How to group two or more `first' lines. -* Def Cmds in Detail:: All the definition commands. -* Def Cmd Conventions:: Conventions for writing definitions. -* Sample Function Definition:: -@end menu - -@node Def Cmd Template, Optional Arguments, Definition Commands, Definition Commands -@section The Template for a Definition -@cindex Definition template -@cindex Template for a definition - -The @code{@@deffn} command is used for definitions of entities that -resemble functions. To write a definition using the @code{@@deffn} -command, write the @code{@@deffn} command at the beginning of a line -and follow it on the same line by the category of the entity, the name -of the entity itself, and its arguments (if any). Then write the body -of the definition on succeeding lines. (You may embed examples in the -body.) Finally, end the definition with an @code{@@end deffn} command -written on a line of its own. (The other definition commands follow -the same format.)@refill - -The template for a definition looks like this: - -@example -@group -@@deffn @var{category} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -@var{body-of-definition} -@@end deffn -@end group -@end example - -@need 700 -@noindent -For example, - -@example -@group -@@deffn Command forward-word count -This command moves point forward @@var@{count@} words -(or backward if @@var@{count@} is negative). @dots{} -@@end deffn -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@quotation -@deffn Command forward-word count -This function moves point forward @var{count} words -(or backward if @var{count} is negative). @dots{} -@end deffn -@end quotation - -Capitalize the category name like a title. If the name of the -category contains spaces, as in the phrase `Interactive Command', -write braces around it. For example:@refill - -@example -@group -@@deffn @{Interactive Command@} isearch-forward -@dots{} -@@end deffn -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -Otherwise, the second word will be mistaken for the name of the -entity.@refill - -Some of the definition commands are more general than others. The -@code{@@deffn} command, for example, is the general definition command -for functions and the like---for entities that may take arguments. When -you use this command, you specify the category to which the entity -belongs. The @code{@@deffn} command possesses three predefined, -specialized variations, @code{@@defun}, @code{@@defmac}, and -@code{@@defspec}, that specify the category for you: ``Function'', -``Macro'', and ``Special Form'' respectively. (In Lisp, a special form -is an entity much like a function.) The @code{@@defvr} command also is -accompanied by several predefined, specialized variations for describing -particular kinds of variables.@refill - -The template for a specialized definition, such as @code{@@defun}, is -similar to the template for a generalized definition, except that you -do not need to specify the category:@refill - -@example -@group -@@defun @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -@var{body-of-definition} -@@end defun -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -Thus, - -@example -@group -@@defun buffer-end flag -This function returns @@code@{(point-min)@} if @@var@{flag@} -is less than 1, @@code@{(point-max)@} otherwise. -@dots{} -@@end defun -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@quotation -@defun buffer-end flag -This function returns @code{(point-min)} if @var{flag} is less than 1, -@code{(point-max)} otherwise. @dots{} -@end defun -@end quotation - -@noindent -@xref{Sample Function Definition, Sample Function Definition, A Sample -Function Definition}, for a more detailed example of a function -definition, including the use of @code{@@example} inside the -definition.@refill - -The other specialized commands work like @code{@@defun}.@refill - -@node Optional Arguments, deffnx, Def Cmd Template, Definition Commands -@section Optional and Repeated Arguments -@cindex Optional and repeated arguments -@cindex Repeated and optional arguments -@cindex Arguments, repeated and optional -@cindex Syntax, optional & repeated arguments -@cindex Meta-syntactic chars for arguments - -Some entities take optional or repeated arguments, which may be -specified by a distinctive glyph that uses square brackets and -ellipses. For @w{example}, a special form often breaks its argument list -into separate arguments in more complicated ways than a -straightforward function.@refill - -@iftex -An argument enclosed within square brackets is optional. -Thus, the phrase -@samp{@code{@r{[}@var{optional-arg}@r{]}}} means that -@var{optional-arg} is optional. -An argument followed by an ellipsis is optional -and may be repeated more than once. -@c This is consistent with Emacs Lisp Reference manual -Thus, @samp{@var{repeated-args}@dots{}} stands for zero or more arguments. -Parentheses are used when several arguments are grouped -into additional levels of list structure in Lisp. -@end iftex -@c The following looks better in Info (no `r', `samp' and `code'): -@ifinfo -An argument enclosed within square brackets is optional. -Thus, [@var{optional-arg}] means that @var{optional-arg} is optional. -An argument followed by an ellipsis is optional -and may be repeated more than once. -@c This is consistent with Emacs Lisp Reference manual -Thus, @var{repeated-args}@dots{} stands for zero or more arguments. -Parentheses are used when several arguments are grouped -into additional levels of list structure in Lisp. -@end ifinfo - -Here is the @code{@@defspec} line of an example of an imaginary -special form:@refill - -@quotation -@defspec foobar (@var{var} [@var{from} @var{to} [@var{inc}]]) @var{body}@dots{} -@end defspec -@tex -\vskip \parskip -@end tex -@end quotation - -@noindent -In this example, the arguments @var{from} and @var{to} are optional, -but must both be present or both absent. If they are present, -@var{inc} may optionally be specified as well. These arguments are -grouped with the argument @var{var} into a list, to distinguish them -from @var{body}, which includes all remaining elements of the -form.@refill - -In a Texinfo source file, this @code{@@defspec} line is written like -this (except it would not be split over two lines, as it is in this -example).@refill - -@example -@group -@@defspec foobar (@@var@{var@} [@@var@{from@} @@var@{to@} - [@@var@{inc@}]]) @@var@{body@}@@dots@{@} -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -The function is listed in the Command and Variable Index under -@samp{foobar}.@refill - -@node deffnx, Def Cmds in Detail, Optional Arguments, Definition Commands -@section Two or More `First' Lines -@cindex Two `First' Lines for @code{@@deffn} -@cindex Grouping two definitions together -@cindex Definitions grouped together -@findex deffnx - -To create two or more `first' or header lines for a definition, follow -the first @code{@@deffn} line by a line beginning with @code{@@deffnx}. -The @code{@@deffnx} command works exactly like @code{@@deffn} -except that it does not generate extra vertical white space between it -and the preceding line.@refill - -@need 1000 -For example, - -@example -@group -@@deffn @{Interactive Command@} isearch-forward -@@deffnx @{Interactive Command@} isearch-backward -These two search commands are similar except @dots{} -@@end deffn -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -produces - -@deffn {Interactive Command} isearch-forward -@deffnx {Interactive Command} isearch-backward -These two search commands are similar except @dots{} -@end deffn - -Each of the other definition commands has an `x' form: @code{@@defunx}, -@code{@@defvrx}, @code{@@deftypefunx}, etc. - -The `x' forms work just like @code{@@itemx}; see @ref{itemx, , @code{@@itemx}}. - -@node Def Cmds in Detail, Def Cmd Conventions, deffnx, Definition Commands -@section The Definition Commands - -Texinfo provides more than a dozen definition commands, all of which -are described in this section.@refill - -The definition commands automatically enter the name of the entity in -the appropriate index: for example, @code{@@deffn}, @code{@@defun}, -and @code{@@defmac} enter function names in the index of functions; -@code{@@defvr} and @code{@@defvar} enter variable names in the index -of variables.@refill - -Although the examples that follow mostly illustrate Lisp, the commands -can be used for other programming languages.@refill - -@menu -* Functions Commands:: Commands for functions and similar entities. -* Variables Commands:: Commands for variables and similar entities. -* Typed Functions:: Commands for functions in typed languages. -* Typed Variables:: Commands for variables in typed languages. -* Abstract Objects:: Commands for object-oriented programming. -* Data Types:: The definition command for data types. -@end menu - -@node Functions Commands, Variables Commands, Def Cmds in Detail, Def Cmds in Detail -@subsection Functions and Similar Entities - -This section describes the commands for describing functions and similar -entities:@refill - -@table @code -@findex deffn -@item @@deffn @var{category} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -The @code{@@deffn} command is the general definition command for -functions, interactive commands, and similar entities that may take -arguments. You must choose a term to describe the category of entity -being defined; for example, ``Function'' could be used if the entity is -a function. The @code{@@deffn} command is written at the beginning of a -line and is followed on the same line by the category of entity being -described, the name of this particular entity, and its arguments, if -any. Terminate the definition with @code{@@end deffn} on a line of its -own.@refill - -@need 750 -For example, here is a definition: - -@example -@group -@@deffn Command forward-char nchars -Move point forward @@var@{nchars@} characters. -@@end deffn -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -This shows a rather terse definition for a ``command'' named -@code{forward-char} with one argument, @var{nchars}. - -@code{@@deffn} prints argument names such as @var{nchars} in italics or -upper case, as if @code{@@var} had been used, because we think of these -names as metasyntactic variables---they stand for the actual argument -values. Within the text of the description, write an argument name -explicitly with @code{@@var} to refer to the value of the argument. In -the example above, we used @samp{@@var@{nchars@}} in this way. - -The template for @code{@@deffn} is: - -@example -@group -@@deffn @var{category} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -@var{body-of-definition} -@@end deffn -@end group -@end example - -@findex defun -@item @@defun @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -The @code{@@defun} command is the definition command for functions. -@code{@@defun} is equivalent to @samp{@@deffn Function -@dots{}}.@refill - -@need 800 -@noindent -For example, - -@example -@group -@@defun set symbol new-value -Change the value of the symbol @@var@{symbol@} -to @@var@{new-value@}. -@@end defun -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -shows a rather terse definition for a function @code{set} whose -arguments are @var{symbol} and @var{new-value}. The argument names on -the @code{@@defun} line automatically appear in italics or upper case as -if they were enclosed in @code{@@var}. Terminate the definition with -@code{@@end defun} on a line of its own.@refill - -The template is: - -@example -@group -@@defun @var{function-name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -@var{body-of-definition} -@@end defun -@end group -@end example - -@code{@@defun} creates an entry in the index of functions. - -@findex defmac -@item @@defmac @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -The @code{@@defmac} command is the definition command for macros. -@code{@@defmac} is equivalent to @samp{@@deffn Macro @dots{}} and -works like @code{@@defun}.@refill - -@findex defspec -@item @@defspec @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -The @code{@@defspec} command is the definition command for special -forms. (In Lisp, a special form is an entity much like a function, -@pxref{Special Forms,,, elisp, GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.) -@code{@@defspec} is equivalent to @samp{@@deffn @{Special Form@} -@dots{}} and works like @code{@@defun}.@refill -@end table - -@node Variables Commands, Typed Functions, Functions Commands, Def Cmds in Detail -@subsection Variables and Similar Entities - -Here are the commands for defining variables and similar -entities:@refill - -@table @code -@findex defvr -@item @@defvr @var{category} @var{name} -The @code{@@defvr} command is a general definition command for -something like a variable---an entity that records a value. You must -choose a term to describe the category of entity being defined; for -example, ``Variable'' could be used if the entity is a variable. -Write the @code{@@defvr} command at the beginning of a line and -followed it on the same line by the category of the entity and the -name of the entity.@refill - -Capitalize the category name like a title. If the name of the category -contains spaces, as in the name ``User Option'', enclose it in braces. -Otherwise, the second word will be mistaken for the name of the entity. -For example, - -@example -@group -@@defvr @{User Option@} fill-column -This buffer-local variable specifies -the maximum width of filled lines. -@dots{} -@@end defvr -@end group -@end example - -Terminate the definition with @code{@@end defvr} on a line of its -own.@refill - -The template is: - -@example -@group -@@defvr @var{category} @var{name} -@var{body-of-definition} -@@end defvr -@end group -@end example - -@code{@@defvr} creates an entry in the index of variables for @var{name}. - -@findex defvar -@item @@defvar @var{name} -The @code{@@defvar} command is the definition command for variables. -@code{@@defvar} is equivalent to @samp{@@defvr Variable -@dots{}}.@refill - -@need 750 -For example: - -@example -@group -@@defvar kill-ring -@dots{} -@@end defvar -@end group -@end example - -The template is: - -@example -@group -@@defvar @var{name} -@var{body-of-definition} -@@end defvar -@end group -@end example - -@code{@@defvar} creates an entry in the index of variables for -@var{name}.@refill - -@findex defopt -@item @@defopt @var{name} -@cindex User options, marking -The @code{@@defopt} command is the definition command for @dfn{user -options}, i.e., variables intended for users to change according to -taste; Emacs has many such (@pxref{Variables,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs -Manual}). @code{@@defopt} is equivalent to @samp{@@defvr @{User -Option@} @dots{}} and works like @code{@@defvar}.@refill -@end table - - -@node Typed Functions, Typed Variables, Variables Commands, Def Cmds in Detail -@subsection Functions in Typed Languages - -The @code{@@deftypefn} command and its variations are for describing -functions in languages in which you must declare types of variables and -functions, such as C and C++. - -@table @code -@findex deftypefn -@item @@deftypefn @var{category} @var{data-type} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -The @code{@@deftypefn} command is the general definition command for -functions and similar entities that may take arguments and that are -typed. The @code{@@deftypefn} command is written at the beginning of -a line and is followed on the same line by the category of entity -being described, the type of the returned value, the name of this -particular entity, and its arguments, if any.@refill - -@need 800 -@noindent -For example, - -@example -@group -@@deftypefn @{Library Function@} int foobar - (int @@var@{foo@}, float @@var@{bar@}) -@dots{} -@@end deftypefn -@end group -@end example - -@need 1000 -@noindent -(where the text before the ``@dots{}'', shown above as two lines, would -actually be a single line in a real Texinfo file) produces the following -in Info: - -@smallexample -@group --- Library Function: int foobar (int FOO, float BAR) -@dots{} -@end group -@end smallexample -@iftex - -In a printed manual, it produces: - -@quotation -@deftypefn {Library Function} int foobar (int @var{foo}, float @var{bar}) -@dots{} -@end deftypefn -@end quotation -@end iftex - -This means that @code{foobar} is a ``library function'' that returns an -@code{int}, and its arguments are @var{foo} (an @code{int}) and -@var{bar} (a @code{float}).@refill - -The argument names that you write in @code{@@deftypefn} are not subject -to an implicit @code{@@var}---since the actual names of the arguments in -@code{@@deftypefn} are typically scattered among data type names and -keywords, Texinfo cannot find them without help. Instead, you must write -@code{@@var} explicitly around the argument names. In the example -above, the argument names are @samp{foo} and @samp{bar}.@refill - -The template for @code{@@deftypefn} is:@refill - -@example -@group -@@deftypefn @var{category} @var{data-type} @var{name} @var{arguments} @dots{} -@var{body-of-description} -@@end deftypefn -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -Note that if the @var{category} or @var{data type} is more than one -word then it must be enclosed in braces to make it a single argument.@refill - -If you are describing a procedure in a language that has packages, -such as Ada, you might consider using @code{@@deftypefn} in a manner -somewhat contrary to the convention described in the preceding -paragraphs.@refill - -@need 800 -@noindent -For example: - -@example -@group -@@deftypefn stacks private push - (@@var@{s@}:in out stack; - @@var@{n@}:in integer) -@dots{} -@@end deftypefn -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -(The @code{@@deftypefn} arguments are shown split into three lines, but -would be a single line in a real Texinfo file.) - -In this instance, the procedure is classified as belonging to the -package @code{stacks} rather than classified as a `procedure' and its -data type is described as @code{private}. (The name of the procedure -is @code{push}, and its arguments are @var{s} and @var{n}.)@refill - -@code{@@deftypefn} creates an entry in the index of functions for -@var{name}.@refill - -@item @@deftypefun @var{data-type} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -@findex deftypefun -The @code{@@deftypefun} command is the specialized definition command -for functions in typed languages. The command is equivalent to -@samp{@@deftypefn Function @dots{}}.@refill - -@need 800 -@noindent -Thus, - -@smallexample -@group -@@deftypefun int foobar (int @@var@{foo@}, float @@var@{bar@}) -@dots{} -@@end deftypefun -@end group -@end smallexample - -@noindent -produces the following in Info: - -@example -@group --- Function: int foobar (int FOO, float BAR) -@dots{} -@end group -@end example -@iftex - -@need 800 -@noindent -and the following in a printed manual: - -@quotation -@deftypefun int foobar (int @var{foo}, float @var{bar}) -@dots{} -@end deftypefun -@end quotation -@end iftex - -@need 800 -The template is: - -@example -@group -@@deftypefun @var{type} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -@var{body-of-description} -@@end deftypefun -@end group -@end example - -@code{@@deftypefun} creates an entry in the index of functions for -@var{name}.@refill - -@item @@deftypemethod @var{class} @var{data-type} @var{method-name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -@findex deftypefun -The @code{@@deftypemethod} command is the definition command for methods -in object-oriented typed languages, such as C++ and Java. It is similar -to the @code{@@deftypefn} with the addition of the @var{class} parameter -to specify the class containing the method. - -@end table - - -@node Typed Variables, Abstract Objects, Typed Functions, Def Cmds in Detail -@subsection Variables in Typed Languages - -Variables in typed languages are handled in a manner similar to -functions in typed languages. @xref{Typed Functions}. The general -definition command @code{@@deftypevr} corresponds to -@code{@@deftypefn} and the specialized definition command -@code{@@deftypevar} corresponds to @code{@@deftypefun}.@refill - -@table @code -@findex deftypevr -@item @@deftypevr @var{category} @var{data-type} @var{name} -The @code{@@deftypevr} command is the general definition command for -something like a variable in a typed language---an entity that records -a value. You must choose a term to describe the category of the -entity being defined; for example, ``Variable'' could be used if the -entity is a variable.@refill - -The @code{@@deftypevr} command is written at the beginning of a line -and is followed on the same line by the category of the entity -being described, the data type, and the name of this particular -entity.@refill - -@need 800 -@noindent -For example: - -@example -@group -@@deftypevr @{Global Flag@} int enable -@dots{} -@@end deftypevr -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -produces the following in Info: - -@example -@group --- Global Flag: int enable -@dots{} -@end group -@end example -@iftex - -@noindent -and the following in a printed manual: - -@quotation -@deftypevr {Global Flag} int enable -@dots{} -@end deftypevr -@end quotation -@end iftex - -@need 800 -The template is: - -@example -@@deftypevr @var{category} @var{data-type} @var{name} -@var{body-of-description} -@@end deftypevr -@end example - -@code{@@deftypevr} creates an entry in the index of variables for -@var{name}.@refill - -@findex deftypevar -@item @@deftypevar @var{data-type} @var{name} -The @code{@@deftypevar} command is the specialized definition command -for variables in typed languages. @code{@@deftypevar} is equivalent -to @samp{@@deftypevr Variable @dots{}}.@refill - -@need 800 -@noindent -For example: - -@example -@group -@@deftypevar int fubar -@dots{} -@@end deftypevar -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -produces the following in Info: - -@example -@group --- Variable: int fubar -@dots{} -@end group -@end example -@iftex - -@need 800 -@noindent -and the following in a printed manual: - -@quotation -@deftypevar int fubar -@dots{} -@end deftypevar -@end quotation -@end iftex - -@need 800 -@noindent -The template is: - -@example -@group -@@deftypevar @var{data-type} @var{name} -@var{body-of-description} -@@end deftypevar -@end group -@end example - -@code{@@deftypevar} creates an entry in the index of variables for -@var{name}.@refill -@end table - -@node Abstract Objects, Data Types, Typed Variables, Def Cmds in Detail -@subsection Object-Oriented Programming - -Here are the commands for formatting descriptions about abstract -objects, such as are used in object-oriented programming. A class is -a defined type of abstract object. An instance of a class is a -particular object that has the type of the class. An instance -variable is a variable that belongs to the class but for which each -instance has its own value.@refill - -In a definition, if the name of a class is truly a name defined in the -programming system for a class, then you should write an @code{@@code} -around it. Otherwise, it is printed in the usual text font.@refill - -@table @code -@findex defcv -@item @@defcv @var{category} @var{class} @var{name} -The @code{@@defcv} command is the general definition command for -variables associated with classes in object-oriented programming. The -@code{@@defcv} command is followed by three arguments: the category of -thing being defined, the class to which it belongs, and its -name. Thus,@refill - -@example -@group -@@defcv @{Class Option@} Window border-pattern -@dots{} -@@end defcv -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -illustrates how you would write the first line of a definition of the -@code{border-pattern} class option of the class @code{Window}.@refill - -The template is - -@example -@group -@@defcv @var{category} @var{class} @var{name} -@dots{} -@@end defcv -@end group -@end example - -@code{@@defcv} creates an entry in the index of variables. - -@findex defivar -@item @@defivar @var{class} @var{name} -The @code{@@defivar} command is the definition command for instance -variables in object-oriented programming. @code{@@defivar} is -equivalent to @samp{@@defcv @{Instance Variable@} @dots{}}@refill - -The template is: - -@example -@group -@@defivar @var{class} @var{instance-variable-name} -@var{body-of-definition} -@@end defivar -@end group -@end example - -@code{@@defivar} creates an entry in the index of variables. - -@findex defop -@item @@defop @var{category} @var{class} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -The @code{@@defop} command is the general definition command for -entities that may resemble methods in object-oriented programming. -These entities take arguments, as functions do, but are associated -with particular classes of objects.@refill - -For example, some systems have constructs called @dfn{wrappers} that -are associated with classes as methods are, but that act more like -macros than like functions. You could use @code{@@defop Wrapper} to -describe one of these.@refill - -Sometimes it is useful to distinguish methods and @dfn{operations}. -You can think of an operation as the specification for a method. -Thus, a window system might specify that all window classes have a -method named @code{expose}; we would say that this window system -defines an @code{expose} operation on windows in general. Typically, -the operation has a name and also specifies the pattern of arguments; -all methods that implement the operation must accept the same -arguments, since applications that use the operation do so without -knowing which method will implement it.@refill - -Often it makes more sense to document operations than methods. For -example, window application developers need to know about the -@code{expose} operation, but need not be concerned with whether a -given class of windows has its own method to implement this operation. -To describe this operation, you would write:@refill - -@example -@@defop Operation windows expose -@end example - -The @code{@@defop} command is written at the beginning of a line and -is followed on the same line by the overall name of the category of -operation, the name of the class of the operation, the name of the -operation, and its arguments, if any.@refill - -@need 800 -@noindent -The template is: - -@example -@group -@@defop @var{category} @var{class} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -@var{body-of-definition} -@@end defop -@end group -@end example - -@code{@@defop} creates an entry, such as `@code{expose} on -@code{windows}', in the index of functions.@refill - -@item @@defmethod @var{class} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -@findex defmethod -The @code{@@defmethod} command is the definition command for methods -in object-oriented programming. A method is a kind of function that -implements an operation for a particular class of objects and its -subclasses. In the Lisp Machine, methods actually were functions, but -they were usually defined with @code{defmethod}. - -@code{@@defmethod} is equivalent to @samp{@@defop Method @dots{}}. -The command is written at the beginning of a line and is followed by -the name of the class of the method, the name of the method, and its -arguments, if any.@refill - -@need 800 -@noindent -For example, - -@example -@group -@@defmethod @code{bar-class} bar-method argument -@dots{} -@@end defmethod -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -illustrates the definition for a method called @code{bar-method} of -the class @code{bar-class}. The method takes an argument.@refill - -The template is: - -@example -@group -@@defmethod @var{class} @var{method-name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -@var{body-of-definition} -@@end defmethod -@end group -@end example - -@code{@@defmethod} creates an entry, such as `@code{bar-method} on -@code{bar-class}', in the index of functions.@refill - -@item @@deftypemethod @var{class} @var{data-type} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -@findex defmethod -The @code{@@deftypemethod} command is the definition command for methods -in object-oriented typed languages, such as C++ and Java. It is similar -to the @code{@@defmethod} command with the addition of the -@var{data-type} parameter to specify the return type of the method. - -@end table - - -@node Data Types, , Abstract Objects, Def Cmds in Detail -@subsection Data Types - -Here is the command for data types:@refill - -@table @code -@findex deftp -@item @@deftp @var{category} @var{name} @var{attributes}@dots{} -The @code{@@deftp} command is the generic definition command for data -types. The command is written at the beginning of a line and is -followed on the same line by the category, by the name of the type -(which is a word like @code{int} or @code{float}), and then by names of -attributes of objects of that type. Thus, you could use this command -for describing @code{int} or @code{float}, in which case you could use -@code{data type} as the category. (A data type is a category of -certain objects for purposes of deciding which operations can be -performed on them.)@refill - -In Lisp, for example, @dfn{pair} names a particular data -type, and an object of that type has two slots called the -@sc{car} and the @sc{cdr}. Here is how you would write the first line -of a definition of @code{pair}.@refill - -@example -@group -@@deftp @{Data type@} pair car cdr -@dots{} -@@end deftp -@end group -@end example - -@need 950 -The template is: - -@example -@group -@@deftp @var{category} @var{name-of-type} @var{attributes}@dots{} -@var{body-of-definition} -@@end deftp -@end group -@end example - -@code{@@deftp} creates an entry in the index of data types. -@end table - -@node Def Cmd Conventions, Sample Function Definition, Def Cmds in Detail, Definition Commands -@section Conventions for Writing Definitions -@cindex Definition conventions -@cindex Conventions for writing definitions - -When you write a definition using @code{@@deffn}, @code{@@defun}, or -one of the other definition commands, please take care to use -arguments that indicate the meaning, as with the @var{count} argument -to the @code{forward-word} function. Also, if the name of an argument -contains the name of a type, such as @var{integer}, take care that the -argument actually is of that type.@refill - -@node Sample Function Definition, , Def Cmd Conventions, Definition Commands -@section A Sample Function Definition -@cindex Function definitions -@cindex Command definitions -@cindex Macro definitions -@cindex Sample function definition - -A function definition uses the @code{@@defun} and @code{@@end defun} -commands. The name of the function follows immediately after the -@code{@@defun} command and it is followed, on the same line, by the -parameter list.@refill - -Here is a definition from @ref{Calling Functions,,, elisp, The GNU Emacs -Lisp Reference Manual}. - -@quotation -@defun apply function &rest arguments -@code{apply} calls @var{function} with @var{arguments}, just -like @code{funcall} but with one difference: the last of -@var{arguments} is a list of arguments to give to -@var{function}, rather than a single argument. We also say -that this list is @dfn{appended} to the other arguments. - -@code{apply} returns the result of calling @var{function}. -As with @code{funcall}, @var{function} must either be a Lisp -function or a primitive function; special forms and macros -do not make sense in @code{apply}. - -@example -(setq f 'list) - @result{} list -(apply f 'x 'y 'z) -@error{} Wrong type argument: listp, z -(apply '+ 1 2 '(3 4)) - @result{} 10 -(apply '+ '(1 2 3 4)) - @result{} 10 - -(apply 'append '((a b c) nil (x y z) nil)) - @result{} (a b c x y z) -@end example - -An interesting example of using @code{apply} is found in the description -of @code{mapcar}.@refill -@end defun -@end quotation - -@need 1200 -In the Texinfo source file, this example looks like this: - -@example -@group -@@defun apply function &rest arguments - -@@code@{apply@} calls @@var@{function@} with -@@var@{arguments@}, just like @@code@{funcall@} but with one -difference: the last of @@var@{arguments@} is a list of -arguments to give to @@var@{function@}, rather than a single -argument. We also say that this list is @@dfn@{appended@} -to the other arguments. -@end group - -@group -@@code@{apply@} returns the result of calling -@@var@{function@}. As with @@code@{funcall@}, -@@var@{function@} must either be a Lisp function or a -primitive function; special forms and macros do not make -sense in @@code@{apply@}. -@end group - -@group -@@example -(setq f 'list) - @@result@{@} list -(apply f 'x 'y 'z) -@@error@{@} Wrong type argument: listp, z -(apply '+ 1 2 '(3 4)) - @@result@{@} 10 -(apply '+ '(1 2 3 4)) - @@result@{@} 10 - -(apply 'append '((a b c) nil (x y z) nil)) - @@result@{@} (a b c x y z) -@@end example -@end group - -@group -An interesting example of using @@code@{apply@} is found -in the description of @@code@{mapcar@}.@@refill -@@end defun -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -In this manual, this function is listed in the Command and Variable -Index under @code{apply}.@refill - -Ordinary variables and user options are described using a format like -that for functions except that variables do not take arguments. - - -@node Footnotes, Conditionals, Definition Commands, Top -@chapter Footnotes -@cindex Footnotes -@findex footnote - -A @dfn{footnote} is for a reference that documents or elucidates the -primary text.@footnote{A footnote should complement or expand upon -the primary text, but a reader should not need to read a footnote to -understand the primary text. For a thorough discussion of footnotes, -see @cite{The Chicago Manual of Style}, which is published by the -University of Chicago Press.}@refill - -@menu -* Footnote Commands:: How to write a footnote in Texinfo. -* Footnote Styles:: Controlling how footnotes appear in Info. -@end menu - -@node Footnote Commands, Footnote Styles, Footnotes, Footnotes -@section Footnote Commands - -In Texinfo, footnotes are created with the @code{@@footnote} command. -This command is followed immediately by a left brace, then by the text -of the footnote, and then by a terminating right brace. Footnotes may -be of any length (they will be broken across pages if necessary), but -are usually short. The template is: - -@example -ordinary text@@footnote@{@var{text of footnote}@} -@end example - -As shown here, the @code{@@footnote} command should come right after the -text being footnoted, with no intervening space; otherwise, the -formatters the footnote mark might end up starting up a line. - -For example, this clause is followed by a sample -footnote@footnote{Here is the sample footnote.}; in the Texinfo -source, it looks like this:@refill - -@example -@dots{}a sample footnote@@footnote@{Here is the sample -footnote.@}; in the Texinfo source@dots{} -@end example - -@strong{Warning:} Don't use footnotes in the argument of the -@code{@@item} command for a @code{@@table} table. This doesn't work, and -because of limitations of @TeX{}, there is no way to fix it. You must -put the footnote into the body text of the table. - -In a printed manual or book, the reference mark for a footnote is a -small, superscripted number; the text of the footnote appears at the -bottom of the page, below a horizontal line.@refill - -In Info, the reference mark for a footnote is a pair of parentheses -with the footnote number between them, like this: @samp{(1)}.@refill - - -@node Footnote Styles, , Footnote Commands, Footnotes -@section Footnote Styles - -Info has two footnote styles, which determine where the text of the -footnote is located:@refill - -@itemize @bullet -@cindex @samp{@r{End}} node footnote style -@item -In the `End' node style, all the footnotes for a single node -are placed at the end of that node. The footnotes are separated from -the rest of the node by a line of dashes with the word -@samp{Footnotes} within it. Each footnote begins with an -@samp{(@var{n})} reference mark.@refill - -@need 700 -@noindent -Here is an example of a single footnote in the end of node style:@refill - -@example -@group - --------- Footnotes --------- - -(1) Here is a sample footnote. -@end group -@end example - -@cindex @samp{@r{Separate}} footnote style -@item -In the `Separate' node style, all the footnotes for a single -node are placed in an automatically constructed node of -their own. In this style, a ``footnote reference'' follows -each @samp{(@var{n})} reference mark in the body of the -node. The footnote reference is actually a cross reference -which you use to reach the footnote node.@refill - -The name of the node containing the footnotes is constructed -by appending @w{@samp{-Footnotes}} to the name of the node -that contains the footnotes. (Consequently, the footnotes' -node for the @file{Footnotes} node is -@w{@file{Footnotes-Footnotes}}!) The footnotes' node has an -`Up' node pointer that leads back to its parent node.@refill - -@noindent -Here is how the first footnote in this manual looks after being -formatted for Info in the separate node style:@refill - -@smallexample -@group -File: texinfo.info Node: Overview-Footnotes, Up: Overview - -(1) Note that the first syllable of "Texinfo" is -pronounced like "speck", not "hex". @dots{} -@end group -@end smallexample -@end itemize - -A Texinfo file may be formatted into an Info file with either footnote -style.@refill - -@findex footnotestyle -Use the @code{@@footnotestyle} command to specify an Info file's -footnote style. Write this command at the beginning of a line followed -by an argument, either @samp{end} for the end node style or -@samp{separate} for the separate node style. - -@need 700 -For example, - -@example -@@footnotestyle end -@end example -@noindent -or -@example -@@footnotestyle separate -@end example - -Write an @code{@@footnotestyle} command before or shortly after the -end-of-header line at the beginning of a Texinfo file. (If you -include the @code{@@footnotestyle} command between the start-of-header -and end-of-header lines, the region formatting commands will format -footnotes as specified.)@refill - -If you do not specify a footnote style, the formatting commands use -their default style. Currently, @code{texinfo-format-buffer} and -@code{texinfo-format-region} use the `separate' style and -@code{makeinfo} uses the `end' style.@refill - -@c !!! note: makeinfo's --footnote-style option overrides footnotestyle -@ignore -If you use @code{makeinfo} to create the Info file, the -@samp{--footnote-style} option determines which style is used, -@samp{end} for the end of node style or @samp{separate} for the -separate node style. Thus, to format the Texinfo manual in the -separate node style, you would use the following shell command:@refill - -@example -makeinfo --footnote-style=separate texinfo.texi -@end example - -@noindent -To format the Texinfo manual in the end of node style, you would -type:@refill - -@example -makeinfo --footnote-style=end texinfo.texi -@end example -@end ignore -@ignore -If you use @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or -@code{texinfo-format-region} to create the Info file, the value of the -@code{texinfo-footnote-style} variable controls the footnote style. -It can be either @samp{"separate"} for the separate node style or -@samp{"end"} for the end of node style. (You can change the value of -this variable with the @kbd{M-x edit-options} command (@pxref{Edit -Options, , Editing Variable Values, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}), or -with the @kbd{M-x set-variable} command (@pxref{Examining, , Examining -and Setting Variables, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).@refill - -The @code{texinfo-footnote-style} variable also controls the style if -you use the @kbd{M-x makeinfo-region} or @kbd{M-x makeinfo-buffer} -command in Emacs.@refill -@end ignore -This chapter contains two footnotes.@refill - - -@node Conditionals, Macros, Footnotes, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@chapter Conditionally Visible Text -@cindex Conditionally visible text -@cindex Text, conditionally visible -@cindex Visibility of conditional text -@cindex If text conditionally visible - -Sometimes it is good to use different text for a printed manual and -its corresponding Info file. In this case, you can use the -@dfn{conditional commands} to specify which text is for the printed manual -and which is for the Info file.@refill - -@menu -* Conditional Commands:: Specifying text for HTML, Info, or @TeX{}. -* Conditional Not Commands:: Specifying text for not HTML, Info, or @TeX{}. -* Raw Formatter Commands:: Using raw @TeX{} or HTML commands. -* set clear value:: Designating which text to format (for - all output formats); and how to set a - flag to a string that you can insert. -@end menu - -@node Conditional Commands, Conditional Not Commands, Conditionals, Conditionals -@ifinfo -@heading Conditional Commands -@end ifinfo - -@findex ifinfo -@code{@@ifinfo} begins segments of text that should be ignored -by @TeX{} when it -typesets the printed manual. The segment of text appears only -in the Info file. -The @code{@@ifinfo} command should appear on a line by itself; end -the Info-only text with a line containing @code{@@end ifinfo} by -itself. At the beginning of a Texinfo file, the Info permissions are -contained within a region marked by @code{@@ifinfo} and @code{@@end -ifinfo}. (@xref{Info Summary and Permissions}.)@refill - -@findex iftex -@findex ifhtml -The @code{@@iftex} and @code{@@end iftex} commands are similar to the -@code{@@ifinfo} and @code{@@end ifinfo} commands, except that they -specify text that will appear in the printed manual but not in the Info -file. Likewise for @code{@@ifhtml} and @code{@@end ifhtml}, which -specify text to appear only in HTML output.@refill - -For example, - -@example -@@iftex -This text will appear only in the printed manual. -@@end iftex -@@ifinfo -However, this text will appear only in Info. -@@end ifinfo -@end example - -@noindent -The preceding example produces the following line: -@iftex -This text will appear only in the printed manual. -@end iftex -@ifinfo -However, this text will appear only in Info. -@end ifinfo - -@noindent -Note how you only see one of the two lines, depending on whether you -are reading the Info version or the printed version of this -manual.@refill - -The @code{@@titlepage} command is a special variant of @code{@@iftex} that -is used for making the title and copyright pages of the printed -manual. (@xref{titlepage, , @code{@@titlepage}}.) @refill - - -@node Conditional Not Commands, Raw Formatter Commands, Conditional Commands, Conditionals -@section Conditional Not Commands -@findex ifnothtml -@findex ifnotinfo -@findex ifnottex - -You can specify text to be included in any output format @emph{other} -than some given one with the @code{@@ifnot@dots{}} commands: -@example -@@ifnothtml @dots{} @@end ifnothtml -@@ifnotinfo @dots{} @@end ifnotinfo -@@ifnottex @dots{} @@end ifnottex -@end example -@noindent -(The @code{@@ifnot@dots{}} command and the @code{@@end} command must -actually appear on lines by themselves.) - -If the output file is not being made for the given format, the region is -included. Otherwise, it is ignored. - -The regions delimited by these commands are ordinary Texinfo source as -with @code{@@iftex}, not raw formatter source as with @code{@@tex}. - - -@node Raw Formatter Commands, set clear value, Conditional Not Commands, Conditionals -@section Raw Formatter Commands -@cindex @TeX{} commands, using ordinary -@cindex HTML commands, using ordinary -@cindex Raw formatter commands -@cindex Ordinary @TeX{} commands, using -@cindex Ordinary HTML commands, using -@cindex Commands using raw @TeX{} -@cindex Commands using raw HTML -@cindex plain @TeX{} - -Inside a region delineated by @code{@@iftex} and @code{@@end iftex}, you -can embed some raw @TeX{} commands. Info will ignore these commands -since they are only in that part of the file which is seen by @TeX{}. -You can write the @TeX{} commands as you would write them in a normal -@TeX{} file, except that you must replace the @samp{\} used by @TeX{} -with an @samp{@@}. For example, in the @code{@@titlepage} section of a -Texinfo file, you can use the @TeX{} command @code{@@vskip} to format -the copyright page. (The @code{@@titlepage} command causes Info to -ignore the region automatically, as it does with the @code{@@iftex} -command.) - -However, many features of plain @TeX{} will not work, as they are -overridden by Texinfo features. - -@findex tex -You can enter plain @TeX{} completely, and use @samp{\} in the @TeX{} -commands, by delineating a region with the @code{@@tex} and @code{@@end -tex} commands. (The @code{@@tex} command also causes Info to ignore the -region, like the @code{@@iftex} command.) The sole exception is that -@code{@@} chracter still introduces a command, so that @code{@@end tex} -can be recognized properly. - -@cindex Mathematical expressions -For example, here is a mathematical expression written in -plain @TeX{}: - -@example -@@tex -$$ \chi^2 = \sum_@{i=1@}^N - \left (y_i - (a + b x_i) - \over \sigma_i\right)^2 $$ -@@end tex -@end example - -@noindent -The output of this example will appear only in a printed manual. If -you are reading this in Info, you will not see the equation that appears -in the printed manual. -@iftex -In a printed manual, the above expression looks like -this: -@end iftex - -@tex -$$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N - \left(y_i - (a + b x_i) - \over \sigma_i\right)^2 $$ -@end tex - -@findex ifhtml -@findex html -Analogously, you can use @code{@@ifhtml @dots{} @@end ifhtml} to delimit -a region to be included in HTML output only, and @code{@@html @dots{} -@@end ifhtml} for a region of raw HTML (again, except that @code{@@} is -still the escape character, so the @code{@@end} command can be -recognized.) - - -@node set clear value, , Raw Formatter Commands, Conditionals -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @code{@@set}, @code{@@clear}, and @code{@@value} - -You can direct the Texinfo formatting commands to format or ignore parts -of a Texinfo file with the @code{@@set}, @code{@@clear}, @code{@@ifset}, -and @code{@@ifclear} commands.@refill - -In addition, you can use the @code{@@set @var{flag}} command to set the -value of @var{flag} to a string of characters; and use -@code{@@value@{@var{flag}@}} to insert that string. You can use -@code{@@set}, for example, to set a date and use @code{@@value} to -insert the date in several places in the Texinfo file.@refill - -@menu -* ifset ifclear:: Format a region if a flag is set. -* value:: Replace a flag with a string. -* value Example:: An easy way to update edition information. -@end menu - - -@node ifset ifclear, value, set clear value, set clear value -@subsection @code{@@ifset} and @code{@@ifclear} - -@findex ifset -When a @var{flag} is set, the Texinfo formatting commands format text -between subsequent pairs of @code{@@ifset @var{flag}} and @code{@@end -ifset} commands. When the @var{flag} is cleared, the Texinfo formatting -commands do @emph{not} format the text. - -Use the @code{@@set @var{flag}} command to turn on, or @dfn{set}, a -@var{flag}; a @dfn{flag} can be any single word. The format for the -command looks like this:@refill -@findex set - -@example -@@set @var{flag} -@end example - -Write the conditionally formatted text between @code{@@ifset @var{flag}} -and @code{@@end ifset} commands, like this:@refill - -@example -@group -@@ifset @var{flag} -@var{conditional-text} -@@end ifset -@end group -@end example - -For example, you can create one document that has two variants, such as -a manual for a `large' and `small' model:@refill - -@example -You can use this machine to dig up shrubs -without hurting them. - -@@set large - -@@ifset large -It can also dig up fully grown trees. -@@end ifset - -Remember to replant promptly @dots{} -@end example - -@noindent -In the example, the formatting commands will format the text between -@code{@@ifset large} and @code{@@end ifset} because the @code{large} -flag is set.@refill - -@findex clear -Use the @code{@@clear @var{flag}} command to turn off, or @dfn{clear}, -a flag. Clearing a flag is the opposite of setting a flag. The -command looks like this:@refill - -@example -@@clear @var{flag} -@end example - -@noindent -Write the command on a line of its own. - -When @var{flag} is cleared, the Texinfo formatting commands do -@emph{not} format the text between @code{@@ifset @var{flag}} and -@code{@@end ifset}; that text is ignored and does not appear in either -printed or Info output.@refill - -For example, if you clear the flag of the preceding example by writing -an @code{@@clear large} command after the @code{@@set large} command -(but before the conditional text), then the Texinfo formatting commands -ignore the text between the @code{@@ifset large} and @code{@@end ifset} -commands. In the formatted output, that text does not appear; in both -printed and Info output, you see only the lines that say, ``You can use -this machine to dig up shrubs without hurting them. Remember to replant -promptly @dots{}''. - -@findex ifclear -If a flag is cleared with an @code{@@clear @var{flag}} command, then -the formatting commands format text between subsequent pairs of -@code{@@ifclear} and @code{@@end ifclear} commands. But if the flag -is set with @code{@@set @var{flag}}, then the formatting commands do -@emph{not} format text between an @code{@@ifclear} and an @code{@@end -ifclear} command; rather, they ignore that text. An @code{@@ifclear} -command looks like this:@refill - -@example -@@ifclear @var{flag} -@end example - -@need 700 -In brief, the commands are:@refill - -@table @code -@item @@set @var{flag} -Tell the Texinfo formatting commands that @var{flag} is set.@refill - -@item @@clear @var{flag} -Tell the Texinfo formatting commands that @var{flag} is cleared.@refill - -@item @@ifset @var{flag} -If @var{flag} is set, tell the Texinfo formatting commands to format -the text up to the following @code{@@end ifset} command.@refill - -If @var{flag} is cleared, tell the Texinfo formatting commands to -ignore text up to the following @code{@@end ifset} command.@refill - -@item @@ifclear @var{flag} -If @var{flag} is set, tell the Texinfo formatting commands to ignore -the text up to the following @code{@@end ifclear} command.@refill - -If @var{flag} is cleared, tell the Texinfo formatting commands to -format the text up to the following @code{@@end ifclear} -command.@refill -@end table - -@node value, value Example, ifset ifclear, set clear value -@subsection @code{@@value} -@findex value - -You can use the @code{@@set} command to specify a value for a flag, -which is expanded by the @code{@@value} command. The value is a string -a characters. - -Write the @code{@@set} command like this: - -@example -@@set foo This is a string. -@end example - -@noindent -This sets the value of @code{foo} to ``This is a string.'' - -The Texinfo formatters replace an @code{@@value@{@var{flag}@}} command with -the string to which @var{flag} is set.@refill - -Thus, when @code{foo} is set as shown above, the Texinfo formatters convert - -@example -@group -@@value@{foo@} -@exdent @r{to} -This is a string. -@end group -@end example - -You can write an @code{@@value} command within a paragraph; but you -must write an @code{@@set} command on a line of its own. - -If you write the @code{@@set} command like this: - -@example -@@set foo -@end example - -@noindent -without specifying a string, the value of @code{foo} is an empty string. - -If you clear a previously set flag with an @code{@@clear @var{flag}} -command, a subsequent @code{@@value@{flag@}} command is invalid and the -string is replaced with an error message that says @samp{@{No value for -"@var{flag}"@}}. - -For example, if you set @code{foo} as follows:@refill - -@example -@@set how-much very, very, very -@end example - -@noindent -then the formatters transform - -@example -@group -It is a @@value@{how-much@} wet day. -@exdent @r{into} -It is a very, very, very wet day. -@end group -@end example - -If you write - -@example -@@clear how-much -@end example - -@noindent -then the formatters transform - -@example -@group -It is a @@value@{how-much@} wet day. -@exdent @r{into} -It is a @{No value for "how-much"@} wet day. -@end group -@end example - -@node value Example, , value, set clear value -@subsection @code{@@value} Example - -You can use the @code{@@value} command to limit the number of places you -need to change when you record an update to a manual. -Here is how it is done in @cite{The GNU Make Manual}: - -@need 1000 -@noindent -Set the flags: - -@example -@group -@@set EDITION 0.35 Beta -@@set VERSION 3.63 Beta -@@set UPDATED 14 August 1992 -@@set UPDATE-MONTH August 1992 -@end group -@end example - -@need 750 -@noindent -Write text for the first @code{@@ifinfo} section, for people reading the -Texinfo file: - -@example -@group -This is Edition @@value@{EDITION@}, -last updated @@value@{UPDATED@}, -of @@cite@{The GNU Make Manual@}, -for @@code@{make@}, Version @@value@{VERSION@}. -@end group -@end example - -@need 1000 -@noindent -Write text for the title page, for people reading the printed manual: -@c List only the month and the year since that looks less fussy on a -@c printed cover than a date that lists the day as well. - -@example -@group -@@title GNU Make -@@subtitle A Program for Directing Recompilation -@@subtitle Edition @@value@{EDITION@}, @dots{} -@@subtitle @@value@{UPDATE-MONTH@} -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -(On a printed cover, a date listing the month and the year looks less -fussy than a date listing the day as well as the month and year.) - -@need 750 -@noindent -Write text for the Top node, for people reading the Info file: - -@example -@group -This is Edition @@value@{EDITION@} -of the @@cite@{GNU Make Manual@}, -last updated @@value@{UPDATED@} -for @@code@{make@} Version @@value@{VERSION@}. -@end group -@end example - -@need 950 -After you format the manual, the text in the first @code{@@ifinfo} -section looks like this: - -@example -@group -This is Edition 0.35 Beta, last updated 14 August 1992, -of `The GNU Make Manual', for `make', Version 3.63 Beta. -@end group -@end example - -When you update the manual, change only the values of the flags; you do -not need to rewrite the three sections. - - -@node Macros, Format/Print Hardcopy, Conditionals, Top -@chapter Macros: Defining New Texinfo Commands -@cindex Macros -@cindex Defining new Texinfo commands -@cindex New Texinfo commands, defining -@cindex Texinfo commands, defining new -@cindex User-defined Texinfo commands - -A Texinfo @dfn{macro} allows you to define a new Texinfo command as any -sequence of text and/or existing commands (including other macros). The -macro can have any number of @dfn{parameters}---text you supply each -time you use the macro. (This has nothing to do with the -@code{@@defmac} command, which is for documenting macros in the subject -of the manual; @pxref{Def Cmd Template}.) - -@menu -* Defining Macros:: Both defining and undefining new commands. -* Invoking Macros:: Using a macro, once you've defined it. -@end menu - - -@node Defining Macros, Invoking Macros, Macros, Macros -@section Defining Macros -@cindex Defining macros -@cindex Macro definitions - -@findex macro -You use the Texinfo @code{@@macro} command to define a macro. For example: - -@example -@@macro @var{macro-name}@{@var{param1}, @var{param2}, @dots{}@} -@var{text} @dots{} \@var{param1}\ @dots{} -@@end macro -@end example - -The @dfn{parameters} @var{param1}, @var{param2}, @dots{} correspond to -arguments supplied when the macro is subsequently used in the document -(see the next section). - -If a macro needs no parameters, you can define it either with an empty -list (@samp{@@macro foo @{@}}) or with no braces at all (@samp{@@macro -foo}). - -@cindex Body of a macro -@cindex Mutually recursive macros -@cindex Recursion, mutual -The definition or @dfn{body} of the macro can contain any Texinfo -commands, including previously-defined macros. (It is not possible to -have mutually recursive Texinfo macros.) In the body, instances of a -parameter name surrounded by backslashes, as in @samp{\@var{param1}\} in -the example above, are replaced by the corresponding argument from the -macro invocation. - -@findex unmacro -@cindex Macros, undefining -@cindex Undefining macros -You can undefine a macro @var{foo} with @code{@@unmacro @var{foo}}. -It is not an error to undefine a macro that is already undefined. -For example: - -@example -@@unmacro foo -@end example - - -@node Invoking Macros, , Defining Macros, Macros -@section Invoking Macros -@cindex Invoking macros -@cindex Macro invocation - -After a macro is defined (see the previous section), you can use -(@dfn{invoke}) it in your document like this: - -@example -@@@var{macro-name} @{@var{arg1}, @var{arg2}, @dots{}@} -@end example - -@noindent and the result will be just as if you typed the body of -@var{macro-name} at that spot. For example: - -@example -@@macro foo @{p, q@} -Together: \p\ & \q\. -@@end macro -@@foo@{a, b@} -@end example - -@noindent produces: - -@display -Together: a & b. -@end display - -@cindex Backslash, and macros -Thus, the arguments and parameters are separated by commas and delimited -by braces; any whitespace after (but not before) a comma is ignored. To -insert a comma, brace, or backslash in an argument, prepend a backslash, -as in - -@example -@@@var{macro-name} @{\\\@{\@}\,@} -@end example - -@noindent -which will pass the (almost certainly error-producing) argument -@samp{\@{@},} to @var{macro-name}. - -If the macro is defined to take a single argument, and is invoked -without any braces, the entire rest of the line after the macro name is -supplied as the argument. For example: - -@example -@@macro bar @{p@} -Twice: \p\, \p\. -@@end macro -@@bar aah -@end example - -@noindent produces: - -@display -Twice: aah, aah. -@end display - - -@node Format/Print Hardcopy, Create an Info File, Macros, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@chapter Format and Print Hardcopy -@cindex Format and print hardcopy -@cindex Hardcopy, printing it -@cindex Making a printed manual -@cindex Sorting indices -@cindex Indices, sorting -@cindex @TeX{} index sorting -@pindex texindex - -There are three major shell commands for making a printed manual from a -Texinfo file: one for converting the Texinfo file into a file that will be -printed, a second for sorting indices, and a third for printing the -formatted document. When you use the shell commands, you can either -work directly in the operating system shell or work within a shell -inside GNU Emacs.@refill - -If you are using GNU Emacs, you can use commands provided by Texinfo -mode instead of shell commands. In addition to the three commands to -format a file, sort the indices, and print the result, Texinfo mode -offers key bindings for commands to recenter the output buffer, show the -print queue, and delete a job from the print queue.@refill - -@menu -* Use TeX:: Use @TeX{} to format for hardcopy. -* Format with tex/texindex:: How to format in a shell. -* Format with texi2dvi:: A simpler way to use the shell. -* Print with lpr:: How to print. -* Within Emacs:: How to format and print from an Emacs shell. -* Texinfo Mode Printing:: How to format and print in Texinfo mode. -* Compile-Command:: How to print using Emacs's compile command. -* Requirements Summary:: @TeX{} formatting requirements summary. -* Preparing for TeX:: What you need to do to use @TeX{}. -* Overfull hboxes:: What are and what to do with overfull hboxes. -* smallbook:: How to print small format books and manuals. -* A4 Paper:: How to print on European A4 paper. -* Cropmarks and Magnification:: How to print marks to indicate the size - of pages and how to print scaled up output. -@end menu - -@node Use TeX, Format with tex/texindex, Format/Print Hardcopy, Format/Print Hardcopy -@ifinfo -@heading Use @TeX{} -@end ifinfo - -The typesetting program called @TeX{} is used for formatting a Texinfo -file. @TeX{} is a very powerful typesetting program and, if used right, -does an exceptionally good job. (@xref{Obtaining TeX, , How to Obtain -@TeX{}}, for information on how to obtain @TeX{}.) - -The @code{makeinfo}, @code{texinfo-format-region}, and -@code{texinfo-format-buffer} commands read the very same @@-commands -in the Texinfo file as does @TeX{}, but process them differently to -make an Info file; see @ref{Create an Info File}.@refill - -@node Format with tex/texindex, Format with texi2dvi, Use TeX, Format/Print Hardcopy -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Format using @code{tex} and @code{texindex} -@cindex Shell formatting with @code{tex} and @code{texindex} -@cindex Formatting with @code{tex} and @code{texindex} -@cindex DVI file - -Format the Texinfo file with the shell command @code{tex} followed by -the name of the Texinfo file. For example: - -@example -tex foo.texi -@end example - -@noindent @TeX{} will produce a @dfn{DVI file} as well as several auxiliary -files containing information for indices, cross references, etc. The -DVI file (for @dfn{DeVice Independent} file) can be printed on virtually -any printe (see the following sections). - -@pindex texindex -The @code{tex} formatting command itself does not sort the indices; it -writes an output file of unsorted index data. (The @code{texi2dvi} -command automatically generates indices; see @ref{Format with texi2dvi,, -Format using @code{texi2dvi}}.) To generate a printed index after -running the @code{tex} command, you first need a sorted index to work -from. The @code{texindex} command sorts indices. (The source file -@file{texindex.c} comes as part of the standard Texinfo distribution, -among other places.)@refill - -@cindex Names of index files -The @code{tex} formatting command outputs unsorted index files under -names that obey a standard convention: the name of your main input file -with any @samp{.tex} (or similar, @pxref{tex invocation,,, web2c, -Web2c}) extension removed, followed by the two letter names of indices. -For example, the raw index output files for the input file -@file{foo.texinfo} would be @file{foo.cp}, @file{foo.vr}, @file{foo.fn}, -@file{foo.tp}, @file{foo.pg} and @file{foo.ky}. Those are exactly the -arguments to give to @code{texindex}.@refill - -@need 1000 -@cindex Wildcards -@cindex Globbing -Instead of specifying all the unsorted index file names explicitly, you -can use @samp{??} as shell wildcards and give the command in this -form:@refill - -@example -texindex foo.?? -@end example - -@noindent -This command will run @code{texindex} on all the unsorted index files, -including any that you have defined yourself using @code{@@defindex} -or @code{@@defcodeindex}. (You may execute @samp{texindex foo.??} -even if there are similarly named files with two letter extensions -that are not index files, such as @samp{foo.el}. The @code{texindex} -command reports but otherwise ignores such files.)@refill - -For each file specified, @code{texindex} generates a sorted index file -whose name is made by appending @samp{s} to the input file name. The -@code{@@printindex} command knows to look for a file of that name -(@pxref{Printing Indices & Menus}). @code{texindex} does not alter the -raw index output file.@refill - -After you have sorted the indices, you need to rerun the @code{tex} -formatting command on the Texinfo file. This regenerates the DVI file, -this time with up-to-date index entries. - -Finally, you may need to run @code{tex} one more time, to get the page -numbers in the cross-references correct. - -To summarize, this is a four step process: - -@enumerate -@item -Run @code{tex} on your Texinfo file. This generates a DVI file (with -undefined cross-references and no indices), and the raw index files -(with two letter extensions). - -@item -Run @code{texindex} on the raw index files. This creates the -corresponding sorted index files (with three letter extensions). - -@item -Run @code{tex} again on your Texinfo file. This regenerates the DVI -file, this time with indices and defined cross-references, but with page -numbers for the cross-references from last time, generally incorrect. - -@item -Run @code{tex} one last time. This time the correct page numbers are -written for the cross-references. -@end enumerate - -@pindex texi2dvi -Alternatively, it's a one-step process: run @code{texi2dvi}. - -You need not run @code{texindex} each time after you run @code{tex}. If -you do not, on the next run, the @code{tex} formatting command will use -whatever sorted index files happen to exist from the previous use of -@code{texindex}. This is usually ok while you are -debugging.@refill - -@node Format with texi2dvi, Print with lpr, Format with tex/texindex, Format/Print Hardcopy -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Format using @code{texi2dvi} -@pindex texi2dvi @r{(shell script)} - -The @code{texi2dvi} command is a shell script that automatically runs -both @code{tex} and @code{texindex} as many times as necessary to -produce a DVI file with up-to-date, sorted indices. It simplifies the -@code{tex}---@code{texindex}---@code{tex} sequence described in the -previous section. - -@need 1000 -The syntax for @code{texi2dvi} is like this (where @samp{prompt$} is the -shell prompt):@refill - -@example -prompt$ @kbd{texi2dvi @var{filename}@dots{}} -@end example - -@node Print with lpr, Within Emacs, Format with texi2dvi, Format/Print Hardcopy -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Shell Print Using @code{lpr -d} -@pindex lpr @r{(DVI print command)} - -The precise command to print a DVI file depends on your system -installation, but @samp{lpr -d} is common. The command may require the -DVI file name without any extension or with a @samp{.dvi} -extension. (If it is @samp{lpr}, you must include the @samp{.dvi}.) - -The following commands, for example, will (probably) suffice to sort the -indices, format, and print the @cite{Bison Manual}: - -@example -@group -tex bison.texinfo -texindex bison.?? -tex bison.texinfo -lpr -d bison.dvi -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -(Remember that the shell commands may be different at your site; but -these are commonly used versions.)@refill - -@need 1000 -Using the @code{texi2dvi} shell script, you simply need type:@refill - -@example -@group -texi2dvi bison.texinfo -lpr -d bison.dvi -@end group -@end example - -@node Within Emacs, Texinfo Mode Printing, Print with lpr, Format/Print Hardcopy -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section From an Emacs Shell -@cindex Print, format from Emacs shell -@cindex Format, print from Emacs shell -@cindex Shell, format, print from -@cindex Emacs shell, format, print from -@cindex GNU Emacs shell, format, print from - -You can give formatting and printing commands from a shell within GNU -Emacs. To create a shell within Emacs, type @kbd{M-x shell}. In this -shell, you can format and print the document. @xref{Format/Print -Hardcopy, , Format and Print Hardcopy}, for details.@refill - -You can switch to and from the shell buffer while @code{tex} is -running and do other editing. If you are formatting a long document -on a slow machine, this can be very convenient.@refill - -You can also use @code{texi2dvi} from an Emacs shell. For example, -here is how to use @code{texi2dvi} to format and print @cite{Using and -Porting GNU CC} from a shell within Emacs: - -@example -@group -texi2dvi gcc.texinfo -lpr -d gcc.dvi -@end group -@end example -@ifinfo - -@xref{Texinfo Mode Printing}, for more information about formatting -and printing in Texinfo mode.@refill -@end ifinfo - -@node Texinfo Mode Printing, Compile-Command, Within Emacs, Format/Print Hardcopy -@section Formatting and Printing in Texinfo Mode -@cindex Region printing in Texinfo mode -@cindex Format and print in Texinfo mode -@cindex Print and format in Texinfo mode - -Texinfo mode provides several predefined key commands for @TeX{} -formatting and printing. These include commands for sorting indices, -looking at the printer queue, killing the formatting job, and -recentering the display of the buffer in which the operations -occur.@refill - -@table @kbd -@item C-c C-t C-b -@itemx M-x texinfo-tex-buffer -Run @code{texi2dvi} on the current buffer.@refill - -@item C-c C-t C-r -@itemx M-x texinfo-tex-region -Run @TeX{} on the current region.@refill - -@item C-c C-t C-i -@itemx M-x texinfo-texindex -Sort the indices of a Texinfo file formatted with -@code{texinfo-tex-region}.@refill - -@item C-c C-t C-p -@itemx M-x texinfo-tex-print -Print a DVI file that was made with @code{texinfo-tex-region} or -@code{texinfo-tex-buffer}.@refill - -@item C-c C-t C-q -@itemx M-x tex-show-print-queue -Show the print queue.@refill - -@item C-c C-t C-d -@itemx M-x texinfo-delete-from-print-queue -Delete a job from the print queue; you will be prompted for the job -number shown by a preceding @kbd{C-c C-t C-q} command -(@code{texinfo-show-tex-print-queue}).@refill - -@item C-c C-t C-k -@itemx M-x tex-kill-job -Kill the currently running @TeX{} job started by -@code{texinfo-tex-region} or @code{texinfo-tex-buffer}, or any other -process running in the Texinfo shell buffer.@refill - -@item C-c C-t C-x -@itemx M-x texinfo-quit-job -Quit a @TeX{} formatting job that has stopped because of an error by -sending an @key{x} to it. When you do this, @TeX{} preserves a record -of what it did in a @file{.log} file.@refill - -@item C-c C-t C-l -@itemx M-x tex-recenter-output-buffer -Redisplay the shell buffer in which the @TeX{} printing and formatting -commands are run to show its most recent output.@refill -@end table - -@need 1000 -Thus, the usual sequence of commands for formatting a buffer is as -follows (with comments to the right):@refill - -@example -@group -C-c C-t C-b @r{Run @code{texi2dvi} on the buffer.} -C-c C-t C-p @r{Print the DVI file.} -C-c C-t C-q @r{Display the printer queue.} -@end group -@end example - -The Texinfo mode @TeX{} formatting commands start a subshell in Emacs -called the @file{*tex-shell*}. The @code{texinfo-tex-command}, -@code{texinfo-texindex-command}, and @code{tex-dvi-print-command} -commands are all run in this shell. - -You can watch the commands operate in the @samp{*tex-shell*} buffer, -and you can switch to and from and use the @samp{*tex-shell*} buffer -as you would any other shell buffer.@refill - -@need 1500 -The formatting and print commands depend on the values of several variables. -The default values are:@refill - -@example -@group - @r{Variable} @r{Default value} - -texinfo-texi2dvi-command "texi2dvi" -texinfo-tex-command "tex" -texinfo-texindex-command "texindex" -texinfo-delete-from-print-queue-command "lprm" -texinfo-tex-trailer "@@bye" -tex-start-of-header "%**start" -tex-end-of-header "%**end" -tex-dvi-print-command "lpr -d" -tex-show-queue-command "lpq" -@end group -@end example - -You can change the values of these variables with the @kbd{M-x -edit-options} command (@pxref{Edit Options, , Editing Variable Values, -emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}), with the @kbd{M-x set-variable} command -(@pxref{Examining, , Examining and Setting Variables, emacs, The GNU -Emacs Manual}), or with your @file{.emacs} initialization file -(@pxref{Init File, , , emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).@refill - -@node Compile-Command, Requirements Summary, Texinfo Mode Printing, Format/Print Hardcopy -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Using the Local Variables List -@cindex Local variables -@cindex Compile command for formatting -@cindex Format with the compile command - -Yet another way to apply the @TeX{} formatting command to a Texinfo file -is to put that command in a @dfn{local variables list} at the end of the -Texinfo file. You can then specify the @code{tex} or @code{texi2dvi} -commands as a @code{compile-command} and have Emacs run it by typing -@kbd{M-x compile}. This creates a special shell called the -@file{*compilation*} buffer in which Emacs runs the compile command. -For example, at the end of the @file{gdb.texinfo} file, after the -@code{@@bye}, you could put the following:@refill - -@example -@group -Local Variables: -compile-command: "texi2dvi gdb.texinfo" -End: -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -This technique is most often used by programmers who also compile programs -this way; see @ref{Compilation, , , emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.@refill - - -@node Requirements Summary, Preparing for TeX, Compile-Command, Format/Print Hardcopy -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section @TeX{} Formatting Requirements Summary -@cindex Requirements for formatting -@cindex Minimal requirements for formatting -@cindex Formatting requirements - -Every Texinfo file that is to be input to @TeX{} must begin with a -@code{\input} command and must contain an @code{@@setfilename} command: - -@example -\input texinfo -@@setfilename @var{arg-not-used-by-@TeX{}} -@end example - -@noindent -The first command instructs @TeX{} to load the macros it needs to -process a Texinfo file and the second command opens auxiliary files. - -Every Texinfo file must end with a line that terminates @TeX{}'s -processing and forces out unfinished pages: - -@example -@@bye -@end example - -Strictly speaking, these lines are all a Texinfo file needs to be -processed successfully by @TeX{}. - -Usually, however, the beginning includes an @code{@@settitle} command to -define the title of the printed manual, an @code{@@setchapternewpage} -command, a title page, a copyright page, and permissions. Besides an -@code{@@bye}, the end of a file usually includes indices and a table of -contents. (And of course most manuals contain a body of text as well.) - -@iftex -For more information, see -@ref{settitle, , @code{@@settitle}}, -@ref{setchapternewpage, , @code{@@setchapternewpage}}, -@ref{Headings, ,Page Headings}, -@ref{Titlepage & Copyright Page}, -@ref{Printing Indices & Menus}, and -@ref{Contents}. -@end iftex -@noindent -@ifinfo -For more information, see@* -@ref{settitle, , @code{@@settitle}},@* -@ref{setchapternewpage, , @code{@@setchapternewpage}},@* -@ref{Headings, ,Page Headings},@* -@ref{Titlepage & Copyright Page},@* -@ref{Printing Indices & Menus}, and@* -@ref{Contents}. -@end ifinfo - - -@node Preparing for TeX, Overfull hboxes, Requirements Summary, Format/Print Hardcopy -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Preparing to Use @TeX{} -@cindex Preparing to use @TeX{} -@cindex @TeX{} input initialization -@cindex @code{TEXINPUTS} environment variable -@vindex TEXINPUTS -@cindex @b{.profile} initialization file -@cindex @b{.cshrc} initialization file -@cindex Initialization file for @TeX{} input - -@TeX{} needs to know where to find the @file{texinfo.tex} file that you -have told it to input with the @samp{\input texinfo} command at the -beginning of the first line. The @file{texinfo.tex} file tells @TeX{} -how to handle @@-commands; it is included in all standard GNU -distributions. - -@pindex texinfo.tex@r{, installing} -Usually, the @file{texinfo.tex} file is put under the default directory -that contains @TeX{} macros -(@file{/usr/local/share/texmf/tex/texinfo/texinfo.tex} by default) when -GNU Emacs or other GNU software is installed. In this case, @TeX{} will -find the file and you do not need to do anything special. -Alternatively, you can put @file{texinfo.tex} in the current directory -when you run @TeX{}, and @TeX{} will find it there. - -@pindex epsf.tex@r{, installing} -Also, you should install @file{epsf.tex} in the same place as -@file{texinfo.tex}, if it is not already installed from another -distribution. This file is needed to support the @code{@@image} command -(@pxref{Images}). - -@pindex texinfo.cnf @r{installation} -@cindex Customizing of @TeX{} for Texinfo -@cindex Site-wide Texinfo configuration file -Optionally, you may create an additional @file{texinfo.cnf}, and install -it as well. This file is read by @TeX{} at the @code{@@setfilename} -command (@pxref{setfilename,, @code{@@setfilename}}). You can put any -commands you like there according to local site-wide conventions, and -they will be read by @TeX{} when processing any Texinfo document. For -example, if @file{texinfo.cnf} contains the a single line -@samp{@@afourpaper} (@pxref{A4 Paper}), then all Texinfo documents will -be processed with that page size in effect. If you have nothing to put -in @file{texinfo.cnf}, you do not need to create it. - -@vindex TEXINPUTS -If neither of the above locations for these system files suffice for -you, you can specify the directories explicitly. For -@file{texinfo.tex}, you can do this by writing the complete path for the -file after the @code{\input} command. Another way, that works for both -@file{texinfo.tex} and @file{texinfo.cnf} (and any other file @TeX{} -might read), is to set the @code{TEXINPUTS} environment variable in your -@file{.cshrc} or @file{.profile} file. - -Which you use of @file{.cshrc} or @file{.profile} depends on -whether you use a Bourne shell-compatible (@code{sh}, @code{bash}, -@code{ksh}, @dots{}) or C shell-compatible (@code{csh}, @code{tcsh}) -command interpreter. The latter read the @file{.cshrc} file for -initialization information, and the former read @file{.profile}. - -In a @file{.cshrc} file, you could use the following @code{csh} command -sequence: - -@example -setenv TEXINPUTS .:/home/me/mylib:/usr/lib/tex/macros -@end example - -@need 1000 -In a @file{.profile} file, you could use the following @code{sh} command -sequence: - -@example -@group -TEXINPUTS=.:/home/me/mylib:/usr/lib/tex/macros -export TEXINPUTS -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -This would cause @TeX{} to look for @file{\input} file first in the current -directory, indicated by the @samp{.}, then in a hypothetical user's -@file{me/mylib} directory, and finally in a system directory. - - -@node Overfull hboxes, smallbook, Preparing for TeX, Format/Print Hardcopy -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Overfull ``hboxes'' -@cindex Overfull @samp{hboxes} -@cindex @samp{hboxes}, overfull -@cindex Final output - -@TeX{} is sometimes unable to typeset a line without extending it into -the right margin. This can occur when @TeX{} comes upon what it -interprets as a long word that it cannot hyphenate, such as an -electronic mail network address or a very long title. When this -happens, @TeX{} prints an error message like this:@refill - -@example -Overfull \hbox (20.76302pt too wide) -@end example - -@noindent -(In @TeX{}, lines are in ``horizontal boxes'', hence the term, ``hbox''. -The backslash, @samp{\}, is the @TeX{} equivalent of @samp{@@}.)@refill - -@TeX{} also provides the line number in the Texinfo source file and -the text of the offending line, which is marked at all the places that -@TeX{} knows how to hyphenate words. -@xref{Debugging with TeX, , Catching Errors with @TeX{} Formatting}, -for more information about typesetting errors.@refill - -If the Texinfo file has an overfull hbox, you can rewrite the sentence -so the overfull hbox does not occur, or you can decide to leave it. A -small excursion into the right margin often does not matter and may not -even be noticeable.@refill - -@cindex Black rectangle in hardcopy -@cindex Rectangle, ugly, black in hardcopy -However, unless told otherwise, @TeX{} will print a large, ugly, black -rectangle beside the line that contains the overfull hbox. This is so -you will notice the location of the problem if you are correcting a -draft.@refill - -@need 1000 -@findex finalout -To prevent such a monstrosity from marring your final printout, write -the following in the beginning of the Texinfo file on a line of its own, -before the @code{@@titlepage} command:@refill - -@example -@@finalout -@end example - -@node smallbook, A4 Paper, Overfull hboxes, Format/Print Hardcopy -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Printing ``Small'' Books -@findex smallbook -@cindex Small book size -@cindex Book, printing small -@cindex Page sizes for books -@cindex Size of printed book - -By default, @TeX{} typesets pages for printing in an 8.5 by 11 inch -format. However, you can direct @TeX{} to typeset a document in a 7 by -9.25 inch format that is suitable for bound books by inserting the -following command on a line by itself at the beginning of the Texinfo -file, before the title page:@refill - -@example -@@smallbook -@end example - -@noindent -(Since regular sized books are often about 7 by 9.25 inches, this -command might better have been called the @code{@@regularbooksize} -command, but it came to be called the @code{@@smallbook} command by -comparison to the 8.5 by 11 inch format.)@refill - -If you write the @code{@@smallbook} command between the -start-of-header and end-of-header lines, the Texinfo mode @TeX{} -region formatting command, @code{texinfo-tex-region}, will format the -region in ``small'' book size (@pxref{Start of Header}).@refill - -The Free Software Foundation distributes printed copies of @cite{The GNU -Emacs Manual} and other manuals in the ``small'' book size. -@xref{smallexample & smalllisp, , @code{@@smallexample} and -@code{@@smalllisp}}, for information about commands that make it easier -to produce examples for a smaller manual.@refill - -Alternatively, to avoid embedding this physical paper size in your -document, use @code{texi2dvi} to format your document (@pxref{Format -with texi2dvi}), and supply @samp{-t @@smallbook} as an argument. Then -other people do not have to change the document source file to format it -differently. - - -@node A4 Paper, Cropmarks and Magnification, smallbook, Format/Print Hardcopy -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Printing on A4 Paper -@cindex A4 paper, printing on -@cindex Paper size, European A4 -@cindex European A4 paper -@findex afourpaper - -You can tell @TeX{} to typeset a document for printing on European size -A4 paper with the @code{@@afourpaper} command. Write the command on a -line by itself between @code{@@iftex} and @code{@@end iftex} lines near -the beginning of the Texinfo file, before the title page:@refill - -For example, this is how you would write the header for this manual:@refill - -@example -@group -\input texinfo @@c -*-texinfo-*- -@@c %**start of header -@@setfilename texinfo -@@settitle Texinfo -@@syncodeindex vr fn -@@iftex -@@afourpaper -@@end iftex -@@c %**end of header -@end group -@end example - -Alternatively, to avoid embedding this physical paper size in your -document, use @code{texi2dvi} to format your document (@pxref{Format -with texi2dvi}), and supply @samp{-t @@afourpaper} as an argument. Then -other people do not have to change the document source file to format it -differently. - -@pindex texinfo.cnf -Another alternative: put the @code{@@afourpaper} command in the file -@file{texinfo.cnf} that @TeX{} will read. (No need for @code{@@iftex} -there.) This will automatically typeset all the Texinfo documents at -your site with that paper size in effect. - - -@node Cropmarks and Magnification, , A4 Paper, Format/Print Hardcopy -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Cropmarks and Magnification - -@findex cropmarks -@cindex Cropmarks for printing -@cindex Printing cropmarks -You can attempt to direct @TeX{} to print cropmarks at the corners of -pages with the @code{@@cropmarks} command. Write the @code{@@cropmarks} -command on a line by itself between @code{@@iftex} and @code{@@end -iftex} lines near the beginning of the Texinfo file, before the title -page, like this:@refill - -@example -@group -@@iftex -@@cropmarks -@@end iftex -@end group -@end example - -This command is mainly for printers that typeset several pages on one -sheet of film; but you can attempt to use it to mark the corners of a -book set to 7 by 9.25 inches with the @code{@@smallbook} command. -(Printers will not produce cropmarks for regular sized output that is -printed on regular sized paper.) Since different printing machines work -in different ways, you should explore the use of this command with a -spirit of adventure. You may have to redefine the command in the -@file{texinfo.tex} definitions file.@refill - -@findex mag @r{(@TeX{} command)} -@cindex Magnified printing -@cindex Larger or smaller pages -You can attempt to direct @TeX{} to typeset pages larger or smaller than -usual with the @code{\mag} @TeX{} command. Everything that is typeset -is scaled proportionally larger or smaller. (@code{\mag} stands for -``magnification''.) This is @emph{not} a Texinfo @@-command, but is a -plain @TeX{} command that is prefixed with a backslash. You have to -write this command between @code{@@tex} and @code{@@end tex} -(@pxref{Raw Formatter Commands}). - -Follow the @code{\mag} command with an @samp{=} and then a number that -is 1000 times the magnification you desire. For example, to print pages -at 1.2 normal size, write the following near the beginning of the -Texinfo file, before the title page:@refill - -@example -@group -@@tex -\mag=1200 -@@end tex -@end group -@end example - -With some printing technologies, you can print normal-sized copies that -look better than usual by using a larger-than-normal master.@refill - -Depending on your system, @code{\mag} may not work or may work only at -certain magnifications. Be prepared to experiment.@refill - -@node Create an Info File, Install an Info File, Format/Print Hardcopy, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@chapter Creating an Info File -@cindex Creating an Info file -@cindex Info, creating an on-line file -@cindex Formatting a file for Info - -@code{makeinfo} is a utility that converts a Texinfo file into an Info -file; @code{texinfo-format-region} and @code{texinfo-format-buffer} are -GNU Emacs functions that do the same.@refill - -A Texinfo file must contain an @code{@@setfilename} line near its -beginning, otherwise the Info formatting commands will fail. - -For information on installing the Info file in the Info system, see -@ref{Install an Info File}.@refill - -@menu -* makeinfo advantages:: @code{makeinfo} provides better error checking. -* Invoking makeinfo:: How to run @code{makeinfo} from a shell. -* makeinfo options:: Specify fill-column and other options. -* Pointer Validation:: How to check that pointers point somewhere. -* makeinfo in Emacs:: How to run @code{makeinfo} from Emacs. -* texinfo-format commands:: Two Info formatting commands written - in Emacs Lisp are an alternative - to @code{makeinfo}. -* Batch Formatting:: How to format for Info in Emacs Batch mode. -* Tag and Split Files:: How tagged and split files help Info - to run better. -@end menu - -@node makeinfo advantages, Invoking makeinfo, Create an Info File, Create an Info File -@ifinfo -@heading @code{makeinfo} Preferred -@end ifinfo - -The @code{makeinfo} utility creates an Info file from a Texinfo source -file more quickly than either of the Emacs formatting commands and -provides better error messages. We recommend it. @code{makeinfo} is a -C program that is independent of Emacs. You do not need to run Emacs to -use @code{makeinfo}, which means you can use @code{makeinfo} on machines -that are too small to run Emacs. You can run @code{makeinfo} in -any one of three ways: from an operating system shell, from a shell -inside Emacs, or by typing a key command in Texinfo mode in Emacs. -@refill - -The @code{texinfo-format-region} and the @code{texinfo-format-buffer} -commands are useful if you cannot run @code{makeinfo}. Also, in some -circumstances, they format short regions or buffers more quickly than -@code{makeinfo}.@refill - -@node Invoking makeinfo, makeinfo options, makeinfo advantages, Create an Info File -@section Running @code{makeinfo} from a Shell - -To create an Info file from a Texinfo file, type @code{makeinfo} -followed by the name of the Texinfo file. Thus, to create the Info -file for Bison, type the following to the shell: -is the prompt):@refill - -@example -makeinfo bison.texinfo -@end example - -(You can run a shell inside Emacs by typing @kbd{M-x shell}.)@refill - -@ifinfo -Sometimes you will want to specify options. For example, if you wish -to discover which version of @code{makeinfo} you are using, -type:@refill - -@example -makeinfo --version -@end example - -@xref{makeinfo options}, for more information. -@end ifinfo - - -@node makeinfo options, Pointer Validation, Invoking makeinfo, Create an Info File -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Options for @code{makeinfo} -@cindex @code{makeinfo} options -@cindex Options for @code{makeinfo} - -The @code{makeinfo} command takes a number of options. Most often, -options are used to set the value of the fill column and specify the -footnote style. Each command line option is a word preceded by -@samp{--} or a letter preceded by @samp{-}. You can use abbreviations -for the long option names as long as they are unique.@refill - -For example, you could use the following shell command to create an Info -file for @file{bison.texinfo} in which each line is filled to only 68 -columns:@refill - -@example -makeinfo --fill-column=68 bison.texinfo -@end example - -You can write two or more options in sequence, like this:@refill - -@example -makeinfo --no-split --fill-column=70 @dots{} -@end example - -@noindent -This would keep the Info file together as one possibly very long -file and would also set the fill column to 70.@refill - -The options are: - -@table @code - -@item -D @var{var} -@opindex -D @var{var} -Cause the variable @var{var} to be defined. This is equivalent to -@code{@@set @var{var}} in the Texinfo file (@pxref{set clear value}). - -@item --error-limit=@var{limit} -@opindex --error-limit=@var{limit} -Set the maximum number of errors that @code{makeinfo} will report -before exiting (on the assumption that continuing would be useless); -default 100. - -@need 150 -@item --fill-column=@var{width} -@opindex --fill-column=@var{width} -Specify the maximum number of columns in a line; this is the right-hand -edge of a line. Paragraphs that are filled will be filled to this -width. (Filling is the process of breaking up and connecting lines so -that lines are the same length as or shorter than the number specified -as the fill column. Lines are broken between words.) The default value -is 72. - -@item --footnote-style=@var{style} -@opindex --footnote-style=@var{style} -Set the footnote style to @var{style}, either @samp{end} for the end -node style (the default) or @samp{separate} for the separate node style. -The value set by this option overrides the value set in a Texinfo file -by an @code{@@footnotestyle} command (@pxref{Footnotes}). When the -footnote style is @samp{separate}, @code{makeinfo} makes a new node -containing the footnotes found in the current node. When the footnote -style is @samp{end}, @code{makeinfo} places the footnote references at -the end of the current node. - -@item --force -@opindex --force -Ordinarily, if the input file has errors, the output files are not -created. With this option, they are preserved. - -@item --help -@opindex --help -Print a usage message listing all available options, then exit successfully. - -@item -I @var{dir} -@opindex -I @var{dir} -Add @code{dir} to the directory search list for finding files that are -included using the @code{@@include} command. By default, -@code{makeinfo} searches only the current directory. - -@item --no-headers -@opindex --no-headers -Do not include menus or node lines in the output. This results in an -@sc{ascii} file that you cannot read in Info since it does not contain -the requisite nodes or menus. It is primarily useful to extract certain -pieces of a manual into separate files to be included in a distribution, -such as @file{INSTALL} files. - -@item --no-split -@opindex --no-split -Suppress the splitting stage of @code{makeinfo}. By default, large -output files (where the size is greater than 70k bytes) are split into -smaller subfiles, each one approximately 50k bytes. - -@item --no-pointer-validate -@itemx --no-validate -@opindex --no-pointer-validate -@opindex --no-validate -Suppress the pointer-validation phase of @code{makeinfo}. Normally, -after a Texinfo file is processed, some consistency checks are made to -ensure that cross references can be resolved, etc. -@xref{Pointer Validation}.@refill - -@item --no-warn -@opindex --no-warn -Suppress warning messages (but @emph{not} error messages). You might -want this if the file you are creating has examples of Texinfo cross -references within it, and the nodes that are referenced do not actually -exist. - -@item --no-number-footnotes -@opindex --no-number-footnotes -Suppress automatic footnote numbering. By default, @code{makeinfo} -numbers each footnote sequentially in a single node, resetting the -current footnote number to 1 at the start of each node. - -@item --output=@var{file} -@itemx -o @var{file} -@opindex --output=@var{file} -@opindex -o @var{file} -Specify that the output should be directed to @var{file} and not to the -file name specified in the @code{@@setfilename} command found in the -Texinfo source (@pxref{setfilename}). If @var{file} is @samp{-}, output -goes to standard output and @samp{--no-split} is implied. - -@item -P @var{dir} -@opindex -P @var{dir} -Prepend @code{dir} to the directory search list for @code{@@include}. -See @samp{-I} for more details. - -@item --paragraph-indent=@var{indent} -@opindex --paragraph-indent=@var{indent} -Set the paragraph indentation style to @var{indent}. The value set by -this option overrides the value set in a Texinfo file by an -@code{@@paragraphindent} command (@pxref{paragraphindent}). The value -of @var{indent} is interpreted as follows: - -@table @asis -@item @samp{asis} -Preserve any existing indentation at the starts of paragraphs. - -@item @samp{0} or @samp{none} -Delete any existing indentation. - -@item @var{num} -Indent each paragraph by that number of spaces. -@end table - -@item --reference-limit=@var{limit} -@opindex --reference-limit=@var{limit} -Set the value of the number of references to a node that -@code{makeinfo} will make without reporting a warning. If a node has more -than this number of references in it, @code{makeinfo} will make the -references but also report a warning. The default is 1000. - -@item -U @var{var} -Cause @var{var} to be undefined. This is equivalent to -@code{@@clear @var{var}} in the Texinfo file (@pxref{set clear value}). - -@item --verbose -@opindex --verbose -Cause @code{makeinfo} to display messages saying what it is doing. -Normally, @code{makeinfo} only outputs messages if there are errors or -warnings. - -@item --version -@opindex --version -Print the version number, then exit successfully. - -@end table - - -@node Pointer Validation, makeinfo in Emacs, makeinfo options, Create an Info File -@section Pointer Validation -@cindex Pointer validation with @code{makeinfo} -@cindex Validation of pointers - -If you do not suppress pointer-validation, @code{makeinfo} will check -the validity of the final Info file. Mostly, this means ensuring that -nodes you have referenced really exist. Here is a complete list of what -is checked:@refill - -@enumerate -@item -If a `Next', `Previous', or `Up' node reference is a reference to a -node in the current file and is not an external reference such as to -@file{(dir)}, then the referenced node must exist.@refill - -@item -In every node, if the `Previous' node is different from the `Up' node, -then the `Previous' node must also be pointed to by a `Next' node.@refill - -@item -Every node except the `Top' node must have an `Up' pointer.@refill - -@item -The node referenced by an `Up' pointer must contain a reference to the -current node in some manner other than through a `Next' reference. -This includes menu entries and cross references.@refill - -@item -If the `Next' reference of a node is not the same as the `Next' reference -of the `Up' reference, then the node referenced by the `Next' pointer -must have a `Previous' pointer that points back to the current node. -This rule allows the last node in a section to point to the first node -of the next chapter.@refill -@end enumerate - -@node makeinfo in Emacs, texinfo-format commands, Pointer Validation, Create an Info File -@section Running @code{makeinfo} inside Emacs -@cindex Running @code{makeinfo} in Emacs -@cindex @code{makeinfo} inside Emacs -@cindex Shell, running @code{makeinfo} in - -You can run @code{makeinfo} in GNU Emacs Texinfo mode by using either the -@code{makeinfo-region} or the @code{makeinfo-buffer} commands. In -Texinfo mode, the commands are bound to @kbd{C-c C-m C-r} and @kbd{C-c -C-m C-b} by default.@refill - -@table @kbd -@item C-c C-m C-r -@itemx M-x makeinfo-region -Format the current region for Info.@refill -@findex makeinfo-region - -@item C-c C-m C-b -@itemx M-x makeinfo-buffer -Format the current buffer for Info.@refill -@findex makeinfo-buffer -@end table - -When you invoke either @code{makeinfo-region} or -@code{makeinfo-buffer}, Emacs prompts for a file name, offering the -name of the visited file as the default. You can edit the default -file name in the minibuffer if you wish, before pressing @key{RET} to -start the @code{makeinfo} process.@refill - -The Emacs @code{makeinfo-region} and @code{makeinfo-buffer} commands -run the @code{makeinfo} program in a temporary shell buffer. If -@code{makeinfo} finds any errors, Emacs displays the error messages in -the temporary buffer.@refill - -@cindex Errors, parsing -@cindex Parsing errors -@findex next-error -You can parse the error messages by typing @kbd{C-x `} -(@code{next-error}). This causes Emacs to go to and position the -cursor on the line in the Texinfo source that @code{makeinfo} thinks -caused the error. @xref{Compilation, , Running @code{make} or -Compilers Generally, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, for more -information about using the @code{next-error} command.@refill - -In addition, you can kill the shell in which the @code{makeinfo} -command is running or make the shell buffer display its most recent -output.@refill - -@table @kbd -@item C-c C-m C-k -@itemx M-x makeinfo-kill-job -@findex makeinfo-kill-job -Kill the current running @code{makeinfo} job created by -@code{makeinfo-region} or @code{makeinfo-buffer}.@refill - -@item C-c C-m C-l -@itemx M-x makeinfo-recenter-output-buffer -@findex makeinfo-recenter-output-buffer -Redisplay the @code{makeinfo} shell buffer to display its most recent -output.@refill -@end table - -@noindent -(Note that the parallel commands for killing and recentering a @TeX{} -job are @kbd{C-c C-t C-k} and @kbd{C-c C-t C-l}. @xref{Texinfo Mode -Printing}.)@refill - -You can specify options for @code{makeinfo} by setting the -@code{makeinfo-options} variable with either the @kbd{M-x -edit-options} or the @kbd{M-x set-variable} command, or by setting the -variable in your @file{.emacs} initialization file.@refill - -For example, you could write the following in your @file{.emacs} file:@refill - -@example -@group -(setq makeinfo-options - "--paragraph-indent=0 --no-split - --fill-column=70 --verbose") -@end group -@end example - -@c If you write these three cross references using xref, you see -@c three references to the same named manual, which looks strange. -@iftex -For more information, see @ref{makeinfo options, , Options for -@code{makeinfo}}, as well as ``Editing Variable Values,''``Examining and -Setting Variables,'' and ``Init File'' in the @cite{The GNU Emacs -Manual}. -@end iftex -@noindent -@ifinfo -For more information, see@* -@ref{Edit Options, , Editing Variable Values, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual},@* -@ref{Examining, , Examining and Setting Variables, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual},@* -@ref{Init File, , , emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, and@* -@ref{makeinfo options, , Options for @code{makeinfo}}. -@end ifinfo - -@node texinfo-format commands, Batch Formatting, makeinfo in Emacs, Create an Info File -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section The @code{texinfo-format@dots{}} Commands -@findex texinfo-format-region -@findex texinfo-format-buffer - -In GNU Emacs in Texinfo mode, you can format part or all of a Texinfo -file with the @code{texinfo-format-region} command. This formats the -current region and displays the formatted text in a temporary buffer -called @samp{*Info Region*}.@refill - -Similarly, you can format a buffer with the -@code{texinfo-format-buffer} command. This command creates a new -buffer and generates the Info file in it. Typing @kbd{C-x C-s} will -save the Info file under the name specified by the -@code{@@setfilename} line which must be near the beginning of the -Texinfo file.@refill - -@table @kbd -@item C-c C-e C-r -@itemx @code{texinfo-format-region} -Format the current region for Info. -@findex texinfo-format-region - -@item C-c C-e C-b -@itemx @code{texinfo-format-buffer} -Format the current buffer for Info. -@findex texinfo-format-buffer -@end table - -The @code{texinfo-format-region} and @code{texinfo-format-buffer} -commands provide you with some error checking, and other functions can -provide you with further help in finding formatting errors. These -procedures are described in an appendix; see @ref{Catching Mistakes}. -However, the @code{makeinfo} program is often faster and -provides better error checking (@pxref{makeinfo in Emacs}).@refill - -@node Batch Formatting, Tag and Split Files, texinfo-format commands, Create an Info File -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Batch Formatting -@cindex Batch formatting for Info -@cindex Info batch formatting - -You can format Texinfo files for Info using @code{batch-texinfo-format} -and Emacs Batch mode. You can run Emacs in Batch mode from any shell, -including a shell inside of Emacs. (@xref{Command Switches, , Command -Line Switches and Arguments, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.)@refill - -Here is a shell command to format all the files that end in -@file{.texinfo} in the current directory: - -@example -emacs -batch -funcall batch-texinfo-format *.texinfo -@end example - -@noindent -Emacs processes all the files listed on the command line, even if an -error occurs while attempting to format some of them.@refill - -Run @code{batch-texinfo-format} only with Emacs in Batch mode as shown; -it is not interactive. It kills the Batch mode Emacs on completion.@refill - -@code{batch-texinfo-format} is convenient if you lack @code{makeinfo} -and want to format several Texinfo files at once. When you use Batch -mode, you create a new Emacs process. This frees your current Emacs, so -you can continue working in it. (When you run -@code{texinfo-format-region} or @code{texinfo-format-buffer}, you cannot -use that Emacs for anything else until the command finishes.)@refill - -@node Tag and Split Files, , Batch Formatting, Create an Info File -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Tag Files and Split Files -@cindex Making a tag table automatically -@cindex Tag table, making automatically - -If a Texinfo file has more than 30,000 bytes, -@code{texinfo-format-buffer} automatically creates a tag table -for its Info file; @code{makeinfo} always creates a tag table. With -a @dfn{tag table}, Info can jump to new nodes more quickly than it can -otherwise.@refill - -@cindex Indirect subfiles -In addition, if the Texinfo file contains more than about 70,000 -bytes, @code{texinfo-format-buffer} and @code{makeinfo} split the -large Info file into shorter @dfn{indirect} subfiles of about 50,000 -bytes each. Big files are split into smaller files so that Emacs does -not need to make a large buffer to hold the whole of a large Info -file; instead, Emacs allocates just enough memory for the small, split -off file that is needed at the time. This way, Emacs avoids wasting -memory when you run Info. (Before splitting was implemented, Info -files were always kept short and @dfn{include files} were designed as -a way to create a single, large printed manual out of the smaller Info -files. @xref{Include Files}, for more information. Include files are -still used for very large documents, such as @cite{The Emacs Lisp -Reference Manual}, in which each chapter is a separate file.)@refill - -When a file is split, Info itself makes use of a shortened version of -the original file that contains just the tag table and references to -the files that were split off. The split off files are called -@dfn{indirect} files.@refill - -The split off files have names that are created by appending @w{@samp{-1}}, -@w{@samp{-2}}, @w{@samp{-3}} and so on to the file name specified by the -@code{@@setfilename} command. The shortened version of the original file -continues to have the name specified by @code{@@setfilename}.@refill - -At one stage in writing this document, for example, the Info file was saved -as @file{test-texinfo} and that file looked like this:@refill - -@example -@group -Info file: test-texinfo, -*-Text-*- -produced by texinfo-format-buffer -from file: new-texinfo-manual.texinfo - -^_ -Indirect: -test-texinfo-1: 102 -test-texinfo-2: 50422 -@end group -@group -test-texinfo-3: 101300 -^_^L -Tag table: -(Indirect) -Node: overview^?104 -Node: info file^?1271 -@end group -@group -Node: printed manual^?4853 -Node: conventions^?6855 -@dots{} -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -(But @file{test-texinfo} had far more nodes than are shown here.) Each of -the split off, indirect files, @file{test-texinfo-1}, -@file{test-texinfo-2}, and @file{test-texinfo-3}, is listed in this file -after the line that says @samp{Indirect:}. The tag table is listed after -the line that says @samp{Tag table:}. @refill - -In the list of indirect files, the number following the file name -records the cumulative number of bytes in the preceding indirect files, -not counting the file list itself, the tag table, or the permissions -text in each file. In the tag table, the number following the node name -records the location of the beginning of the node, in bytes from the -beginning.@refill - -If you are using @code{texinfo-format-buffer} to create Info files, -you may want to run the @code{Info-validate} command. (The -@code{makeinfo} command does such a good job on its own, you do not -need @code{Info-validate}.) However, you cannot run the @kbd{M-x -Info-validate} node-checking command on indirect files. For -information on how to prevent files from being split and how to -validate the structure of the nodes, see @ref{Using -Info-validate}.@refill - - -@node Install an Info File, Command List, Create an Info File, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@chapter Installing an Info File -@cindex Installing an Info file -@cindex Info file installation -@cindex @file{dir} directory for Info installation - -Info files are usually kept in the @file{info} directory. You can read -Info files using the standalone Info program or the Info reader built -into Emacs. (@inforef{Top, info, info}, for an introduction to Info.) - -@menu -* Directory file:: The top level menu for all Info files. -* New Info File:: Listing a new info file. -* Other Info Directories:: How to specify Info files that are - located in other directories. -* Installing Dir Entries:: How to specify what menu entry to add - to the Info directory. -* Invoking install-info:: @code{install-info} options. -@end menu - -@node Directory file, New Info File, Install an Info File, Install an Info File -@ifinfo -@heading The @file{dir} File -@end ifinfo - -For Info to work, the @file{info} directory must contain a file that -serves as a top level directory for the Info system. By convention, -this file is called @file{dir}. (You can find the location of this file -within Emacs by typing @kbd{C-h i} to enter Info and then typing -@kbd{C-x C-f} to see the pathname to the @file{info} directory.) - -The @file{dir} file is itself an Info file. It contains the top level -menu for all the Info files in the system. The menu looks like -this:@refill - -@example -@group -* Menu: - -* Info: (info). Documentation browsing system. -* Emacs: (emacs). The extensible, self-documenting - text editor. -* Texinfo: (texinfo). With one source file, make - either a printed manual using - TeX or an Info file. -@dots{} -@end group -@end example - -Each of these menu entries points to the `Top' node of the Info file -that is named in parentheses. (The menu entry does not need to -specify the `Top' node, since Info goes to the `Top' node if no node -name is mentioned. @xref{Other Info Files, , Nodes in Other Info -Files}.)@refill - -Thus, the @samp{Info} entry points to the `Top' node of the -@file{info} file and the @samp{Emacs} entry points to the `Top' node -of the @file{emacs} file.@refill - -In each of the Info files, the `Up' pointer of the `Top' node refers -back to the @code{dir} file. For example, the line for the `Top' -node of the Emacs manual looks like this in Info:@refill - -@example -File: emacs Node: Top, Up: (DIR), Next: Distrib -@end example - -@noindent -(Note that in this case, the @file{dir} file name is written in upper -case letters---it can be written in either upper or lower case. Info -has a feature that it will change the case of the file name to lower -case if it cannot find the name as written.)@refill -@c !!! Can any file name be written in upper or lower case, -@c or is dir a special case? -@c Yes, apparently so, at least with Gillespie's Info. --rjc 24mar92 - - -@node New Info File, Other Info Directories, Directory file, Install an Info File -@section Listing a New Info File -@cindex Adding a new info file -@cindex Listing a new info file -@cindex New info file, listing it in @file{dir} file -@cindex Info file, listing new one -@cindex @file{dir} file listing - -To add a new Info file to your system, you must write a menu entry to -add to the menu in the @file{dir} file in the @file{info} directory. -For example, if you were adding documentation for GDB, you would write -the following new entry:@refill - -@example -* GDB: (gdb). The source-level C debugger. -@end example - -@noindent -The first part of the menu entry is the menu entry name, followed by a -colon. The second part is the name of the Info file, in parentheses, -followed by a period. The third part is the description. - -The name of an Info file often has a @file{.info} extension. Thus, the -Info file for GDB might be called either @file{gdb} or @file{gdb.info}. -The Info reader programs automatically try the file name both with and -without @file{.info}; so it is better to avoid clutter and not to write -@samp{.info} explicitly in the menu entry. For example, the GDB menu -entry should use just @samp{gdb} for the file name, not @samp{gdb.info}. - - -@node Other Info Directories, Installing Dir Entries, New Info File, Install an Info File -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@section Info Files in Other Directories -@cindex Installing Info in another directory -@cindex Info installed in another directory -@cindex Another Info directory - -If an Info file is not in the @file{info} directory, there are three -ways to specify its location:@refill - -@itemize @bullet -@item -Write the pathname in the @file{dir} file as the second part of the -menu.@refill - -@item -If you are using Emacs, list the name of the file in a second @file{dir} -file, in its directory; and then add the name of that directory to the -@code{Info-directory-list} variable in your personal or site -initialization file. - -This tells Emacs where to look for @file{dir} files. Emacs merges the -files named @file{dir} from each of the listed directories. (In Emacs -version 18, you can set the @code{Info-directory} variable to the name -of only one directory.)@refill - -@item -Specify the Info directory name in the @code{INFOPATH} environment -variable in your @file{.profile} or @file{.cshrc} initialization file. -(Only you and others who set this environment variable will be able to -find Info files whose location is specified this way.)@refill -@end itemize - -For example, to reach a test file in the @file{/home/bob/manuals} -directory, you could add an entry like this to the menu in the -@file{dir} file:@refill - -@example -* Test: (/home/bob/manuals/info-test). Bob's own test file. -@end example - -@noindent -In this case, the absolute file name of the @file{info-test} file is -written as the second part of the menu entry.@refill - -@vindex Info-directory-list -Alternatively, you could write the following in your @file{.emacs} -file:@refill - -@example -@group -(setq Info-directory-list - '("/home/bob/manuals" - "/usr/local/info")) -@end group -@end example - -@c reworded to avoid overfill hbox -This tells Emacs to merge the @file{dir} file from the -@file{/home/bob/manuals} directory with the @file{dir} file from the -@file{/usr/local/info} directory. Info will list the -@file{/home/bob/manuals/info-test} file as a menu entry in the -@file{/home/bob/manuals/dir} file.@refill - -@vindex INFOPATH -Finally, you can tell Info where to look by setting the @code{INFOPATH} -environment variable in your @file{.cshrc} or @file{.profile} file. If -you use a Bourne-compatible shell such as @code{sh} or @code{bash} for -your shell command interpreter, you set the @code{INFOPATH} environment -variable in the @file{.profile} initialization file; but if you use -@code{csh} or @code{tcsh}, you must set the variable in the -@file{.cshrc} initialization file. The two types of shells use -different syntax. - -@itemize @bullet -@item -In a @file{.cshrc} file, you could set the @code{INFOPATH} -variable as follows:@refill - -@smallexample -setenv INFOPATH .:~/manuals:/usr/local/emacs/info -@end smallexample - -@item -In a @file{.profile} file, you would achieve the same effect by -writing:@refill - -@smallexample -INFOPATH=.:$HOME/manuals:/usr/local/emacs/info -export INFOPATH -@end smallexample -@end itemize - -@noindent -The @samp{.} indicates the current directory as usual. Emacs uses the -@code{INFOPATH} environment variable to initialize the value of Emacs's -own @code{Info-directory-list} variable. - -@cindex @samp{:} @r{last in @code{INFOPATH}} -However you set @code{INFOPATH}, if its last character is a colon, this -is replaced by the default (compiled-in) path. This gives you a way to -augment the default path with new directories without having to list all -the standard places. For example (using @code{sh} syntax: - -@example -INFOPATH=/local/info: -export INFOPATH -@end example - -@noindent -will search @file{/local/info} first, then the standard directories. -Leading or doubled colons are not treated specially. - - -@node Installing Dir Entries, Invoking install-info, Other Info Directories, Install an Info File -@section Installing Info Directory Files - -When you install an Info file onto your system, you can use the program -@code{install-info} to update the Info directory file @file{dir}. -Normally the makefile for the package runs @code{install-info}, just -after copying the Info file into its proper installed location. - -@findex dircategory -@findex direntry -In order for the Info file to work with @code{install-info}, you should -use the commands @code{@@dircategory} and @code{@@direntry} in the -Texinfo source file. Use @code{@@direntry} to specify the menu entry to -add to the Info directory file, and use @code{@@dircategory} to specify -which part of the Info directory to put it in. Here is how these -commands are used in this manual: - -@smallexample -@@dircategory Texinfo documentation system -@@direntry -* Texinfo: (texinfo). The GNU documentation format. -* install-info: (texinfo)Invoking install-info. @dots{} -@dots{} -@@end direntry -@end smallexample - -Here's what this produces in the Info file: - -@smallexample -INFO-DIR-SECTION Texinfo documentation system -START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY -* Texinfo: (texinfo). The GNU documentation format. -* install-info: (texinfo)Invoking install-info. @dots{} -@dots{} -END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY -@end smallexample - -@noindent -The @code{install-info} program sees these lines in the Info file, and -that is how it knows what to do. - -Always use the @code{@@direntry} and @code{@@dircategory} commands near -the beginning of the Texinfo input, before the first @code{@@node} -command. If you use them later on in the input, @code{install-info} -will not notice them. - -If you use @code{@@dircategory} more than once in the Texinfo source, -each usage specifies one category; the new menu entry is added to the -Info directory file in each of the categories you specify. If you use -@code{@@direntry} more than once, each usage specifies one menu entry; -each of these menu entries is added to the directory in each of the -specified categories. - - -@node Invoking install-info, , Installing Dir Entries, Install an Info File -@section Invoking install-info - -@pindex install-info - -@code{install-info} inserts menu entries from an Info file into the -top-level @file{dir} file in the Info system (see the previous sections -for an explanation of how the @file{dir} file works). It's most often -run as part of software installation, or when constructing a dir file -for all manuals on a system. Synopsis: - -@example -install-info [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{info-file} [@var{dir-file}]] -@end example - -If @var{info-file} or @var{dir-file} are not specified, the various -options (described below) that define them must be. There are no -compile-time defaults, and standard input is never used. -@code{install-info} can read only one info file and write only one dir -file per invocation. - -@cindex @file{dir}, created by @code{install-info} -If @var{dir-file} (however specified) does not exist, -@code{install-info} creates it if possible (with no entries). - -Options: - -@table @code -@item --delete -@opindex --delete -Delete the entries in @var{info-file} from @var{dir-file}. The file -name in the entry in @var{dir-file} must be @var{info-file} (except for -an optional @samp{.info} in either one). Don't insert any new entries. - -@item --dir-file=@var{name} -@opindex --dir-file=@var{name} -Specify file name of the Info directory file. This is equivalent to -using the @var{dir-file} argument. - -@item --entry=@var{text} -@opindex --entry=@var{text} -Insert @var{text} as an Info directory entry; @var{text} should have the -form of an Info menu item line plus zero or more extra lines starting -with whitespace. If you specify more than one entry, they are all -added. If you don't specify any entries, they are determined from -information in the Info file itself. - -@item --help -@opindex --help -Display a usage message listing basic usage and all available options, -then exit successfully. - -@item --info-file=@var{file} -@opindex --info-file=@var{file} -Specify Info file to install in the directory. -This is equivalent to using the @var{info-file} argument. - -@item --info-dir=@var{dir} -@opindex --info-dir=@var{dir} -Equivalent to @samp{--dir-file=@var{dir}/dir}. - -@item --item=@var{text} -@opindex --item=@var{text} -Same as @samp{--entry=@var{text}}. An Info directory entry is actually -a menu item. - -@item --quiet -@opindex --quiet -Suppress warnings. - -@item --remove -@opindex --remove -Same as @samp{--delete}. - -@item --section=@var{sec} -@opindex --section=@var{sec} -Put this file's entries in section @var{sec} of the directory. If you -specify more than one section, all the entries are added in each of the -sections. If you don't specify any sections, they are determined from -information in the Info file itself. - -@item --version -@opindex --version -@cindex version number, finding -Display version information and exit successfully. - -@end table - - -@node Command List, Tips, Install an Info File, Top -@appendix @@-Command List -@cindex Alphabetical @@-command list -@cindex List of @@-commands -@cindex @@-command list - -Here is an alphabetical list of the @@-commands in Texinfo. Square -brackets, @t{[}@w{ }@t{]}, indicate optional arguments; an ellipsis, -@samp{@dots{}}, indicates repeated text.@refill - -@sp 1 -@table @code -@item @@@var{whitespace} -An @code{@@} followed by a space, tab, or newline produces a normal, -stretchable, interword space. @xref{Multiple Spaces}. - -@item @@! -Generate an exclamation point that really does end a sentence (usually -after an end-of-sentence capital letter). @xref{Ending a Sentence}. - -@item @@" -@itemx @@' -Generate an umlaut or acute accent, respectively, over the next -character, as in @"o and @'o. @xref{Inserting Accents}. - -@item @@* -Force a line break. Do not end a paragraph that uses @code{@@*} with -an @code{@@refill} command. @xref{Line Breaks}.@refill - -@item @@,@{@var{c}@} -Generate a cedilla accent under @var{c}, as in @,{c}. @xref{Inserting -Accents}. - -@item @@- -Insert a discretionary hyphenation point. @xref{- and hyphenation}. - -@item @@. -Produce a period that really does end a sentence (usually after an -end-of-sentence capital letter). @xref{Ending a Sentence}. - -@item @@: -Indicate to @TeX{} that an immediately preceding period, question -mark, exclamation mark, or colon does not end a sentence. Prevent -@TeX{} from inserting extra whitespace as it does at the end of a -sentence. The command has no effect on the Info file output. -@xref{Not Ending a Sentence}.@refill - -@item @@= -Generate a macro (bar) accent over the next character, as in @=o. -@xref{Inserting Accents}. - -@item @@? -Generate a question mark that really does end a sentence (usually after -an end-of-sentence capital letter). @xref{Ending a Sentence}. - -@item @@@@ -Stands for an at sign, @samp{@@}. -@xref{Braces Atsigns, , Inserting @@ and braces}. - -@item @@^ -@itemx @@` -Generate a circumflex (hat) or grave accent, respectively, over the next -character, as in @^o. -@xref{Inserting Accents}. - -@item @@@{ -Stands for a left brace, @samp{@{}. -@xref{Braces Atsigns, , Inserting @@ and braces}. - -@item @@@} -Stands for a right-hand brace, @samp{@}}.@* -@xref{Braces Atsigns, , Inserting @@ and braces}. - -@item @@= -Generate a tilde accent over the next character, as in @~N. -@xref{Inserting Accents}. - -@item @@AA@{@} -@itemx @@aa@{@} -Generate the uppercase and lowercase Scandinavian A-ring letters, -respectively: @AA{}, @aa{}. @xref{Inserting Accents}. - -@item @@AE@{@} -@itemx @@ae@{@} -Generate the uppercase and lowercase AE ligatures, respectively: -@AE{}, @ae{}. @xref{Inserting Accents}. - -@item @@afourpaper -Change page dimensions for the A4 paper size. -Only allowed inside @code{@@iftex} @dots{} @code{@@end iftex}. -@xref{A4 Paper}. - -@item @@appendix @var{title} -Begin an appendix. The title appears in the table -of contents of a printed manual. In Info, the title is -underlined with asterisks. @xref{unnumbered & appendix, , The -@code{@@unnumbered} and @code{@@appendix} Commands}.@refill - -@item @@appendixsec @var{title} -@itemx @@appendixsection @var{title} -Begin an appendix section within an appendix. The section title appears -in the table of contents of a printed manual. In Info, the title is -underlined with equal signs. @code{@@appendixsection} is a longer -spelling of the @code{@@appendixsec} command. @xref{unnumberedsec -appendixsec heading, , Section Commands}.@refill - -@item @@appendixsubsec @var{title} -Begin an appendix subsection within an appendix. The title appears -in the table of contents of a printed manual. In Info, the title is -underlined with hyphens. @xref{unnumberedsubsec appendixsubsec -subheading, , Subsection Commands}.@refill - -@item @@appendixsubsubsec @var{title} -Begin an appendix subsubsection within an appendix subsection. The -title appears in the table of contents of a printed manual. In Info, -the title is underlined with periods. @xref{subsubsection,, The -`subsub' Commands}.@refill - -@item @@asis -Used following @code{@@table}, @code{@@ftable}, and @code{@@vtable} to -print the table's first column without highlighting (``as is''). -@xref{Two-column Tables, , Making a Two-column Table}.@refill - -@item @@author @var{author} -Typeset @var{author} flushleft and underline it. @xref{title -subtitle author, , The @code{@@title} and @code{@@author} -Commands}.@refill - -@item @@b@{@var{text}@} -Print @var{text} in @b{bold} font. No effect in Info. @xref{Fonts}.@refill - -@ignore -@item @@br -Force a paragraph break. If used within a line, follow @code{@@br} -with braces. @xref{br, , @code{@@br}}.@refill -@end ignore - -@item @@bullet@{@} -Generate a large round dot, or the closest possible -thing to one. @xref{bullet, , @code{@@bullet}}.@refill - -@item @@bye -Stop formatting a file. The formatters do not see the contents of a -file following an @code{@@bye} command. @xref{Ending a File}.@refill - -@item @@c @var{comment} -Begin a comment in Texinfo. The rest of the line does not appear in -either the Info file or the printed manual. A synonym for -@code{@@comment}. @xref{Comments, , Comments}.@refill - -@item @@cartouche -Highlight an example or quotation by drawing a box with rounded -corners around it. Pair with @code{@@end cartouche}. No effect in -Info. @xref{cartouche, , Drawing Cartouches Around Examples}.)@refill - -@item @@center @var{line-of-text} -Center the line of text following the command. -@xref{titlefont center sp, , @code{@@center}}.@refill - -@item @@centerchap @var{line-of-text} -Like @code{@@chapter}, but centers the chapter title. @xref{chapter,, -@code{@@chapter}}. - -@item @@chapheading @var{title} -Print a chapter-like heading in the text, but not in the table of -contents of a printed manual. In Info, the title is underlined with -asterisks. @xref{majorheading & chapheading, , @code{@@majorheading} -and @code{@@chapheading}}.@refill - -@item @@chapter @var{title} -Begin a chapter. The chapter title appears in the table of -contents of a printed manual. In Info, the title is underlined with -asterisks. @xref{chapter, , @code{@@chapter}}.@refill - -@item @@cindex @var{entry} -Add @var{entry} to the index of concepts. @xref{Index Entries, , -Defining the Entries of an Index}.@refill - -@item @@cite@{@var{reference}@} -Highlight the name of a book or other reference that lacks a -companion Info file. @xref{cite, , @code{@@cite}}.@refill - -@item @@clear @var{flag} -Unset @var{flag}, preventing the Texinfo formatting commands from -formatting text between subsequent pairs of @code{@@ifset @var{flag}} -and @code{@@end ifset} commands, and preventing -@code{@@value@{@var{flag}@}} from expanding to the value to which -@var{flag} is set. -@xref{set clear value, , @code{@@set} @code{@@clear} @code{@@value}}.@refill - -@item @@code@{@var{sample-code}@} -Highlight text that is an expression, a syntactically complete token -of a program, or a program name. @xref{code, , @code{@@code}}.@refill - -@item @@comment @var{comment} -Begin a comment in Texinfo. The rest of the line does not appear in -either the Info file or the printed manual. A synonym for @code{@@c}. -@xref{Comments, , Comments}.@refill - -@item @@contents -Print a complete table of contents. Has no effect in Info, which uses -menus instead. @xref{Contents, , Generating a Table of -Contents}.@refill - -@item @@copyright@{@} -Generate a copyright symbol. @xref{copyright symbol, , -@code{@@copyright}}.@refill - -@ignore -@item @@ctrl@{@var{ctrl-char}@} -Describe an @sc{ascii} control character. Insert actual control character -into Info file. @xref{ctrl, , @code{@@ctrl}}.@refill -@end ignore - -@item @@defcodeindex @var{index-name} -Define a new index and its indexing command. Print entries in an -@code{@@code} font. @xref{New Indices, , Defining New -Indices}.@refill - -@item @@defcv @var{category} @var{class} @var{name} -@itemx @@defcvx @var{category} @var{class} @var{name} -Format a description for a variable associated with a class in -object-oriented programming. Takes three arguments: the category of -thing being defined, the class to which it belongs, and its name. -@xref{Definition Commands}, and @ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. - -@item @@deffn @var{category} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -@itemx @@deffnx @var{category} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -Format a description for a function, interactive command, or similar -entity that may take arguments. @code{@@deffn} takes as arguments the -category of entity being described, the name of this particular -entity, and its arguments, if any. @xref{Definition Commands}.@refill - -@item @@defindex @var{index-name} -Define a new index and its indexing command. Print entries in a roman -font. @xref{New Indices, , Defining New Indices}.@refill - -@c Unused so far as I can see and unsupported by makeinfo -- karl, 15sep96. -@item @@definfoenclose @var{new-command}, @var{before}, @var{after}, -Create new @@-command for Info that marks text by enclosing it in -strings that precede and follow the text. Write definition inside of -@code{@@ifinfo} @dots{} @code{@@end ifinfo}. @xref{Customized -Highlighting}.@refill - -@item @@defivar @var{class} @var{instance-variable-name} -@itemx @@defivarx @var{class} @var{instance-variable-name} -This command formats a description for an instance variable in -object-oriented programming. The command is equivalent to @samp{@@defcv -@{Instance Variable@} @dots{}}. @xref{Definition Commands}, and -@ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. - -@item @@defmac @var{macro-name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -@itemx @@defmacx @var{macro-name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -Format a description for a macro. The command is equivalent to -@samp{@@deffn Macro @dots{}}. @xref{Definition Commands}, and -@ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. - -@item @@defmethod @var{class} @var{method-name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -@itemx @@defmethodx @var{class} @var{method-name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -Format a description for a method in object-oriented programming. The -command is equivalent to @samp{@@defop Method @dots{}}. Takes as -arguments the name of the class of the method, the name of the -method, and its arguments, if any. @xref{Definition Commands}, and -@ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. - -@item @@defop @var{category} @var{class} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -@itemx @@defopx @var{category} @var{class} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -Format a description for an operation in object-oriented programming. -@code{@@defop} takes as arguments the overall name of the category of -operation, the name of the class of the operation, the name of the -operation, and its arguments, if any. @xref{Definition -Commands}, and @ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. - -@item @@defopt @var{option-name} -@itemx @@defoptx @var{option-name} -Format a description for a user option. The command is equivalent to -@samp{@@defvr @{User Option@} @dots{}}. @xref{Definition Commands}, and -@ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. - -@item @@defspec @var{special-form-name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -@itemx @@defspecx @var{special-form-name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -Format a description for a special form. The command is equivalent to -@samp{@@deffn @{Special Form@} @dots{}}. @xref{Definition Commands}, -and @ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. - -@item @@deftp @var{category} @var{name-of-type} @var{attributes}@dots{} -@itemx @@deftpx @var{category} @var{name-of-type} @var{attributes}@dots{} -Format a description for a data type. @code{@@deftp} takes as arguments -the category, the name of the type (which is a word like @samp{int} or -@samp{float}), and then the names of attributes of objects of that type. -@xref{Definition Commands}, and @ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. - -@item @@deftypefn @var{classification} @var{data-type} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -@itemx @@deftypefnx @var{classification} @var{data-type} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -Format a description for a function or similar entity that may take -arguments and that is typed. @code{@@deftypefn} takes as arguments the -classification of entity being described, the type, the name of the -entity, and its arguments, if any. @xref{Definition Commands}, and -@ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. - -@item @@deftypefun @var{data-type} @var{function-name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -@itemx @@deftypefunx @var{data-type} @var{function-name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -Format a description for a function in a typed language. -The command is equivalent to @samp{@@deftypefn Function @dots{}}. -@xref{Definition Commands}, -and @ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. - -@item @@deftypemethod @var{class} @var{data-type} @var{method-name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -@itemx @@deftypemethodx @var{class} @var{data-type} @var{method-name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -Format a description for a typed method in object-oriented programming. -Takes as arguments the name of the class of the method, the return type -of the method, the name of the method, and its arguments, if any. -@xref{Definition Commands}, and @ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. - -@item @@deftypevr @var{classification} @var{data-type} @var{name} -@itemx @@deftypevrx @var{classification} @var{data-type} @var{name} -Format a description for something like a variable in a typed -language---an entity that records a value. Takes as arguments the -classification of entity being described, the type, and the name of the -entity. @xref{Definition Commands}, and @ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in -Detail}. - -@item @@deftypevar @var{data-type} @var{variable-name} -@itemx @@deftypevarx @var{data-type} @var{variable-name} -Format a description for a variable in a typed language. The command is -equivalent to @samp{@@deftypevr Variable @dots{}}. @xref{Definition -Commands}, and @ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. - -@item @@defun @var{function-name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -@itemx @@defunx @var{function-name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -Format a description for functions. The command is equivalent to -@samp{@@deffn Function @dots{}}. @xref{Definition Commands}, and -@ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. - -@item @@defvar @var{variable-name} -@itemx @@defvarx @var{variable-name} -Format a description for variables. The command is equivalent to -@samp{@@defvr Variable @dots{}}. @xref{Definition Commands}, and -@ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. - -@item @@defvr @var{category} @var{name} -@itemx @@defvrx @var{category} @var{name} -Format a description for any kind of variable. @code{@@defvr} takes -as arguments the category of the entity and the name of the entity. -@xref{Definition Commands}, -and @ref{deffnx,, Def Cmds in Detail}. - -@item @@detailmenu@{@} -Avoid @code{makeinfo} confusion stemming from the detailed node listing -in a master menu. @xref{Master Menu Parts}. - -@item @@dfn@{@var{term}@} -Highlight the introductory or defining use of a term. -@xref{dfn, , @code{@@dfn}}.@refill - -@item @@dircategory @var{dirpart} -Specify a part of the Info directory menu where this file's entry should -go. @xref{Installing Dir Entries}. - -@item @@direntry -Begin the Info directory menu entry for this file. -@xref{Installing Dir Entries}. - -@need 100 -@item @@display -Begin a kind of example. Indent text, do not fill, do not select a -new font. Pair with @code{@@end display}. @xref{display, , -@code{@@display}}.@refill - -@item @@dmn@{@var{dimension}@} -Format a unit of measure, as in 12@dmn{pt}. Causes @TeX{} to insert a -thin space before @var{dimension}. No effect in Info. -@xref{dmn, , @code{@@dmn}}.@refill - -@item @@dotaccent@{@var{c}@} -Generate a dot accent over the character @var{c}, as in @dotaccent{oo}. -@xref{Inserting Accents}. - -@item @@dots@{@} -Insert an ellipsis: @samp{@dots{}}. -@xref{dots, , @code{@@dots}}.@refill - -@item @@email@{@var{address}[, @var{displayed-text}]@} -Indicate an electronic mail address. -@xref{email, , @code{@@email}}.@refill - -@need 100 -@item @@emph@{@var{text}@} -Highlight @var{text}; text is displayed in @emph{italics} in printed -output, and surrounded by asterisks in Info. @xref{Emphasis, , -Emphasizing Text}. - -@item @@end @var{environment} -Ends @var{environment}, as in @samp{@@end example}. @xref{Formatting -Commands,,@@-commands}. - -@item @@enddots@{@} -Generate an end-of-sentence of ellipsis, like this @enddots{} -@xref{dots,,@code{@@dots@{@}}}. - -@need 100 -@item @@enumerate [@var{number-or-letter}] -Begin a numbered list, using @code{@@item} for each entry. -Optionally, start list with @var{number-or-letter}. Pair with -@code{@@end enumerate}. @xref{enumerate, , -@code{@@enumerate}}.@refill - -@need 100 -@item @@equiv@{@} -Indicate to the reader the exact equivalence of two forms with a -glyph: @samp{@equiv{}}. @xref{Equivalence}.@refill - -@item @@error@{@} -Indicate to the reader with a glyph that the following text is -an error message: @samp{@error{}}. @xref{Error Glyph}.@refill - -@item @@evenfooting [@var{left}] @@| [@var{center}] @@| [@var{right}] -@itemx @@evenheading [@var{left}] @@| [@var{center}] @@| [@var{right}] -Specify page footings resp.@: headings for even-numbered (left-hand) -pages. Only allowed inside @code{@@iftex}. @xref{Custom Headings, , -How to Make Your Own Headings}.@refill - -@item @@everyfooting [@var{left}] @@| [@var{center}] @@| [@var{right}] -@itemx @@everyheading [@var{left}] @@| [@var{center}] @@| [@var{right}] -Specify page footings resp.@: headings for every page. Not relevant to -Info. @xref{Custom Headings, , How to Make Your Own Headings}.@refill - -@item @@example -Begin an example. Indent text, do not fill, and select fixed-width font. -Pair with @code{@@end example}. @xref{example, , -@code{@@example}}.@refill - -@item @@exclamdown@{@} -Produce an upside-down exclamation point. @xref{Inserting Accents}. - -@item @@exdent @var{line-of-text} -Remove any indentation a line might have. @xref{exdent, , -Undoing the Indentation of a Line}.@refill - -@item @@expansion@{@} -Indicate the result of a macro expansion to the reader with a special -glyph: @samp{@expansion{}}. -@xref{expansion, , @expansion{} Indicating an Expansion}.@refill - -@item @@file@{@var{filename}@} -Highlight the name of a file, buffer, node, or directory. @xref{file, , -@code{@@file}}.@refill - -@item @@finalout -Prevent @TeX{} from printing large black warning rectangles beside -over-wide lines. @xref{Overfull hboxes}.@refill - -@need 100 -@item @@findex @var{entry} -Add @var{entry} to the index of functions. @xref{Index Entries, , -Defining the Entries of an Index}.@refill - -@need 200 -@item @@flushleft -@itemx @@flushright -Left justify every line but leave the right end ragged. -Leave font as is. Pair with @code{@@end flushleft}. -@code{@@flushright} analogous. -@xref{flushleft & flushright, , @code{@@flushleft} and -@code{@@flushright}}.@refill - -@need 200 -@item @@footnote@{@var{text-of-footnote}@} -Enter a footnote. Footnote text is printed at the bottom of the page -by @TeX{}; Info may format in either `End' node or `Separate' node style. -@xref{Footnotes}.@refill - -@item @@footnotestyle @var{style} -Specify an Info file's footnote style, either @samp{end} for the end -node style or @samp{separate} for the separate node style. -@xref{Footnotes}.@refill - -@item @@format -Begin a kind of example. Like @code{@@example} or @code{@@display}, -but do not narrow the margins and do not select the fixed-width font. -Pair with @code{@@end format}. @xref{example, , -@code{@@example}}.@refill - -@item @@ftable @var{formatting-command} -Begin a two-column table, using @code{@@item} for each entry. -Automatically enter each of the items in the first column into the -index of functions. Pair with @code{@@end ftable}. The same as -@code{@@table}, except for indexing. @xref{ftable vtable, , -@code{@@ftable} and @code{@@vtable}}.@refill - -@item @@group -Hold text together that must appear on one printed page. Pair with -@code{@@end group}. Not relevant to Info. @xref{group, , -@code{@@group}}.@refill - -@item @@H@{@var{c}@} -Generate the long Hungarian umlaut accent over @var{c}, as in @H{o}. - -@item @@heading @var{title} -Print an unnumbered section-like heading in the text, but not in the -table of contents of a printed manual. In Info, the title is -underlined with equal signs. @xref{unnumberedsec appendixsec heading, -, Section Commands}.@refill - -@item @@headings @var{on-off-single-double} -Turn page headings on or off, and/or specify single-sided or double-sided -page headings for printing. @xref{headings on off, , The -@code{@@headings} Command}. - -@item @@html -Enter HTML completely. Pair with @code{@@end html}. @xref{Raw -Formatter Commands}. - -@item @@hyphenation@{@var{hy-phen-a-ted words}@} -Explicitly define hyphenation points. @xref{- and hyphenation,, -@code{@@-} and @code{@@hyphenation}}. - -@item @@i@{@var{text}@} -Print @var{text} in @i{italic} font. No effect in Info. -@xref{Fonts}.@refill - -@item @@ifclear @var{flag} -If @var{flag} is cleared, the Texinfo formatting commands format text -between @code{@@ifclear @var{flag}} and the following @code{@@end -ifclear} command. -@xref{set clear value, , @code{@@set} @code{@@clear} @code{@@value}}.@refill - -@item @@ifhtml -@itemx @@ifinfo -Begin a stretch of text that will be ignored by @TeX{} when it typesets -the printed manual. The text appears only in the HTML resp.@: Info -file. Pair with @code{@@end ifhtml} resp.@: @code{@@end ifinfo}. -@xref{Conditionals}. - -@item @@ifnothtml -@itemx @@ifnotinfo -@itemx @@ifnottex -Begin a stretch of text that will be ignored in one output format but -not the others. The text appears only in the format not specified. -Pair with @code{@@end ifnothtml} resp.@: @code{@@end ifnotinfo} resp.@: -@code{@@end ifnotinfo}. @xref{Conditionals}. - -@item @@ifset @var{flag} -If @var{flag} is set, the Texinfo formatting commands format text -between @code{@@ifset @var{flag}} and the following @code{@@end ifset} -command. -@xref{set clear value, , @code{@@set} @code{@@clear} @code{@@value}}.@refill - -@item @@iftex -Begin a stretch of text that will not appear in the Info file, but -will be processed only by @TeX{}. Pair with @code{@@end iftex}. -@xref{Conditionals, , Conditionally Visible Text}.@refill - -@item @@ignore -Begin a stretch of text that will not appear in either the Info file -or the printed output. Pair with @code{@@end ignore}. -@xref{Comments, , Comments and Ignored Text}.@refill - -@item @@image@{@var{filename}, [@var{width}], [@var{height}]@} -Include graphics image in external @var{filename} scaled to the given -@var{width} and/or @var{height}. @xref{Images}. - -@item @@include @var{filename} -Incorporate the contents of the file @var{filename} into the Info file -or printed document. @xref{Include Files}.@refill - -@item @@inforef@{@var{node-name}, [@var{entry-name}], @var{info-file-name}@} -Make a cross reference to an Info file for which there is no printed -manual. @xref{inforef, , Cross references using -@code{@@inforef}}.@refill - -@item \input @var{macro-definitions-file} -Use the specified macro definitions file. This command is used only -in the first line of a Texinfo file to cause @TeX{} to make use of the -@file{texinfo} macro definitions file. The backslash in @code{\input} -is used instead of an @code{@@} because @TeX{} does not -recognize @code{@@} until after it has read the definitions file. -@xref{Header, , The Texinfo File Header}.@refill - -@item @@item -Indicate the beginning of a marked paragraph for @code{@@itemize} and -@code{@@enumerate}; indicate the beginning of the text of a first column -entry for @code{@@table}, @code{@@ftable}, and @code{@@vtable}. -@xref{Lists and Tables}.@refill - -@item @@itemize @var{mark-generating-character-or-command} -Produce a sequence of indented paragraphs, with a mark inside the left -margin at the beginning of each paragraph. Pair with @code{@@end -itemize}. @xref{itemize, , @code{@@itemize}}.@refill - -@item @@itemx -Like @code{@@item} but do not generate extra vertical space above the -item text. @xref{itemx, , @code{@@itemx}}.@refill - -@item @@kbd@{@var{keyboard-characters}@} -Indicate text that is characters of input to be typed by -users. @xref{kbd, , @code{@@kbd}}.@refill - -@item @@kbdinputstyle @var{style} -Specify when @code{@@kbd} should use a font distinct from @code{@@code}. -@xref{kbd, , @code{@@kbd}}.@refill - -@item @@key@{@var{key-name}@} -Indicate a name for a key on a keyboard. -@xref{key, , @code{@@key}}.@refill - -@item @@kindex @var{entry} -Add @var{entry} to the index of keys. -@xref{Index Entries, , Defining the Entries of an Index}.@refill - -@item @@L@{@} -@itemx @@l@{@} -Generate the uppercase and lowercase Polish suppressed-L letters, -respectively: @L{}, @l{}. - -@c Possibly this can be tossed now that we have macros. --karl, 16sep96. -@c Yes, let's toss it, it's pretty weird. --karl, 15jun97. -@c @item @@global@@let@var{new-command}=@var{existing-command} -@c Equate a new highlighting command with an existing one. Only for -@c @TeX{}. Write definition inside of @code{@@iftex} @dots{} @code{@@end -@c iftex}. @xref{Customized Highlighting}.@refill - -@item @@lisp -Begin an example of Lisp code. Indent text, do not fill, and select -fixed-width font. Pair with @code{@@end lisp}. @xref{Lisp Example, , -@code{@@lisp}}.@refill - -@item @@lowersections -Change subsequent chapters to sections, sections to subsections, and so -on. @xref{Raise/lower sections, , @code{@@raisesections} and -@code{@@lowersections}}.@refill - -@item @@macro @var{macro-name} @{@var{params}@} -Define a new Texinfo command @code{@@@var{macro-name}@{@var{params}@}}. -Only supported by @code{makeinfo} and @code{texi2dvi}. @xref{Defining -Macros}. - -@item @@majorheading @var{title} -Print a chapter-like heading in the text, but not in the table of -contents of a printed manual. Generate more vertical whitespace before -the heading than the @code{@@chapheading} command. In Info, the chapter -heading line is underlined with asterisks. @xref{majorheading & -chapheading, , @code{@@majorheading} and @code{@@chapheading}}.@refill - -@item @@math@{@var{mathematical-expression}@} -Format a mathematical expression. -@xref{math, , @code{@@math}: Inserting Mathematical Expressions}. - -@item @@menu -Mark the beginning of a menu of nodes in Info. No effect in a printed -manual. Pair with @code{@@end menu}. @xref{Menus}.@refill - -@item @@minus@{@} -Generate a minus sign, `@minus{}'. @xref{minus, , @code{@@minus}}.@refill - -@item @@multitable @var{column-width-spec} -Begin a multi-column table. Pair with @code{@@end multitable}. -@xref{Multitable Column Widths}. - -@item @@need @var{n} -Start a new page in a printed manual if fewer than @var{n} mils -(thousandths of an inch) remain on the current page. @xref{need, , -@code{@@need}}.@refill - -@item @@node @var{name, next, previous, up} -Define the beginning of a new node in Info, and serve as a locator for -references for @TeX{}. @xref{node, , @code{@@node}}.@refill - -@item @@noindent -Prevent text from being indented as if it were a new paragraph. -@xref{noindent, , @code{@@noindent}}.@refill - -@item @@O@{@} -@itemx @@o@{@} -Generate the uppercase and lowercase O-with-slash letters, respectively: -@O{}, @o{}. - -@item @@oddfooting [@var{left}] @@| [@var{center}] @@| [@var{right}] -@itemx @@oddheading [@var{left}] @@| [@var{center}] @@| [@var{right}] -Specify page footings resp.@: headings for odd-numbered (right-hand) -pages. Only allowed inside @code{@@iftex}. @xref{Custom Headings, , -How to Make Your Own Headings}.@refill - -@item @@OE@{@} -@itemx @@oe@{@} -Generate the uppercase and lowercase OE ligatures, respectively: -@OE{}, @oe{}. @xref{Inserting Accents}. - -@item @@page -Start a new page in a printed manual. No effect in Info. -@xref{page, , @code{@@page}}.@refill - -@item @@paragraphindent @var{indent} -Indent paragraphs by @var{indent} number of spaces; delete indentation -if the value of @var{indent} is 0; and do not change indentation if -@var{indent} is @code{asis}. @xref{paragraphindent, , Paragraph -Indenting}.@refill - -@item @@pindex @var{entry} -Add @var{entry} to the index of programs. @xref{Index Entries, , Defining -the Entries of an Index}.@refill - -@item @@point@{@} -Indicate the position of point in a buffer to the reader with a -glyph: @samp{@point{}}. @xref{Point Glyph, , Indicating -Point in a Buffer}.@refill - -@item @@pounds@{@} -Generate the pounds sterling currency sign. -@xref{pounds,,@code{@@pounds@{@}}}. - -@item @@print@{@} -Indicate printed output to the reader with a glyph: -@samp{@print{}}. @xref{Print Glyph}.@refill - -@item @@printindex @var{index-name} -Print an alphabetized two-column index in a printed manual or generate -an alphabetized menu of index entries for Info. @xref{Printing -Indices & Menus}.@refill - -@item @@pxref@{@var{node-name}, [@var{entry}], [@var{topic-or-title}], [@var{info-file}], [@var{manual}]@} -Make a reference that starts with a lower case `see' in a printed -manual. Use within parentheses only. Do not follow command with a -punctuation mark---the Info formatting commands automatically insert -terminating punctuation as needed. Only the first argument is mandatory. -@xref{pxref, , @code{@@pxref}}.@refill - -@item @@questiondown@{@} -Generate an upside-down question mark. @xref{Inserting Accents}. - -@item @@quotation -Narrow the margins to indicate text that is quoted from another real -or imaginary work. Write command on a line of its own. Pair with -@code{@@end quotation}. @xref{quotation, , -@code{@@quotation}}.@refill - -@need 100 -@item @@r@{@var{text}@} -Print @var{text} in @r{roman} font. No effect in Info. -@xref{Fonts}.@refill - -@item @@raisesections -Change subsequent sections to chapters, subsections to sections, and so -on. @xref{Raise/lower sections, , @code{@@raisesections} and -@code{@@lowersections}}.@refill - -@need 300 -@item @@ref@{@var{node-name}, [@var{entry}], [@var{topic-or-title}], [@var{info-file}], [@var{manual}]@} -Make a reference. In a printed manual, the reference does not start -with a `See'. Follow command with a punctuation mark. Only the first -argument is mandatory. @xref{ref, , @code{@@ref}}.@refill - -@need 300 -@item @@refill -In Info, refill and indent the paragraph after all the other processing -has been done. No effect on @TeX{}, which always refills. This command -is no longer needed, since all formatters now automatically refill. -@xref{Refilling Paragraphs}.@refill - -@need 300 -@item @@result@{@} -Indicate the result of an expression to the reader with a special -glyph: @samp{@result{}}. @xref{result, , @code{@@result}}.@refill - -@item @@ringaccent@{@var{c}@} -Generate a ring accent over the next character, as in @ringaccent{o}. -@xref{Inserting Accents}. - -@item @@samp@{@var{text}@} -Highlight @var{text} that is a literal example of a sequence of -characters. Used for single characters, for statements, and often for -entire shell commands. @xref{samp, , @code{@@samp}}.@refill - -@item @@sc@{@var{text}@} -Set @var{text} in a printed output in @sc{the small caps font} and -set text in the Info file in uppercase letters. -@xref{Smallcaps}.@refill - -@item @@section @var{title} -Begin a section within a chapter. In a printed manual, the section -title is numbered and appears in the table of contents. In Info, the -title is underlined with equal signs. @xref{section, , -@code{@@section}}.@refill - -@item @@set @var{flag} [@var{string}] -Make @var{flag} active, causing the Texinfo formatting commands to -format text between subsequent pairs of @code{@@ifset @var{flag}} and -@code{@@end ifset} commands. Optionally, set value of @var{flag} to -@var{string}. -@xref{set clear value, , @code{@@set} @code{@@clear} @code{@@value}}.@refill - -@item @@setchapternewpage @var{on-off-odd} -Specify whether chapters start on new pages, and if so, whether on -odd-numbered (right-hand) new pages. @xref{setchapternewpage, , -@code{@@setchapternewpage}}.@refill - -@item @@setfilename @var{info-file-name} -Provide a name to be used by the Info file. This command is essential -for @TeX{} formatting as well, even though it produces no output. -@xref{setfilename, , @code{@@setfilename}}.@refill - -@item @@settitle @var{title} -Provide a title for page headers in a printed manual. -@xref{settitle, , @code{@@settitle}}.@refill - -@item @@shortcontents -Print a short table of contents. Not relevant to Info, which uses -menus rather than tables of contents. A synonym for -@code{@@summarycontents}. @xref{Contents, , Generating a Table of -Contents}.@refill - -@item @@shorttitlepage@{@var{title}@} -Generate a minimal title page. @xref{titlepage,,@code{@@titlepage}}. - -@need 400 -@item @@smallbook -Cause @TeX{} to produce a printed manual in a 7 by 9.25 inch format -rather than the regular 8.5 by 11 inch format. @xref{smallbook, , -Printing Small Books}. Also, see @ref{smallexample & smalllisp, , -@code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp}}.@refill - -@need 400 -@item @@smallexample -Indent text to indicate an example. Do not fill, select fixed-width -font. In @code{@@smallbook} format, print text in a smaller font than -with @code{@@example}. Pair with @code{@@end smallexample}. -@xref{smallexample & smalllisp, , @code{@@smallexample} and -@code{@@smalllisp}}.@refill - -@need 400 -@item @@smalllisp -Begin an example of Lisp code. Indent text, do not fill, select -fixed-width font. In @code{@@smallbook} format, print text in a -smaller font. Pair with @code{@@end smalllisp}. @xref{smallexample & -smalllisp, , @code{@@smallexample} and @code{@@smalllisp}}.@refill - -@need 700 -@item @@sp @var{n} -Skip @var{n} blank lines. @xref{sp, , @code{@@sp}}.@refill - -@item @@ss@{@} -Generate the German sharp-S es-zet letter, @ss{}. @xref{Inserting Accents}. - -@need 700 -@item @@strong @var{text} -Emphasize @var{text} by typesetting it in a @strong{bold} font for the -printed manual and by surrounding it with asterisks for Info. -@xref{emph & strong, , Emphasizing Text}.@refill - -@item @@subheading @var{title} -Print an unnumbered subsection-like heading in the text, but not in -the table of contents of a printed manual. In Info, the title is -underlined with hyphens. @xref{unnumberedsubsec appendixsubsec -subheading, , @code{@@unnumberedsubsec} @code{@@appendixsubsec} -@code{@@subheading}}.@refill - -@item @@subsection @var{title} -Begin a subsection within a section. In a printed manual, the -subsection title is numbered and appears in the table of contents. In -Info, the title is underlined with hyphens. @xref{subsection, , -@code{@@subsection}}.@refill - -@item @@subsubheading @var{title} -Print an unnumbered subsubsection-like heading in the text, but not in -the table of contents of a printed manual. In Info, the title is -underlined with periods. @xref{subsubsection, , The `subsub' -Commands}.@refill - -@item @@subsubsection @var{title} -Begin a subsubsection within a subsection. In a printed manual, -the subsubsection title is numbered and appears in the table of -contents. In Info, the title is underlined with periods. -@xref{subsubsection, , The `subsub' Commands}.@refill - -@item @@subtitle @var{title} -In a printed manual, set a subtitle in a normal sized font flush to -the right-hand side of the page. Not relevant to Info, which does not -have title pages. @xref{title subtitle author, , @code{@@title} -@code{@@subtitle} and @code{@@author} Commands}.@refill - -@item @@summarycontents -Print a short table of contents. Not relevant to Info, which uses -menus rather than tables of contents. A synonym for -@code{@@shortcontents}. @xref{Contents, , Generating a Table of -Contents}.@refill - -@need 300 -@item @@syncodeindex @var{from-index} @var{into-index} -Merge the index named in the first argument into the index named in -the second argument, printing the entries from the first index in -@code{@@code} font. @xref{Combining Indices}.@refill - -@need 300 -@item @@synindex @var{from-index} @var{into-index} -Merge the index named in the first argument into the index named in -the second argument. Do not change the font of @var{from-index} -entries. @xref{Combining Indices}.@refill - -@need 100 -@item @@t@{@var{text}@} -Print @var{text} in a @t{fixed-width}, typewriter-like font. -No effect in Info. @xref{Fonts}.@refill - -@item @@tab -Separate columns in a multitable. @xref{Multitable Rows}. - -@need 400 -@item @@table @var{formatting-command} -Begin a two-column table, using @code{@@item} for each entry. Write -each first column entry on the same line as @code{@@item}. First -column entries are printed in the font resulting from -@var{formatting-command}. Pair with @code{@@end table}. -@xref{Two-column Tables, , Making a Two-column Table}. -Also see @ref{ftable vtable, , @code{@@ftable} and @code{@@vtable}}, -and @ref{itemx, , @code{@@itemx}}.@refill - -@item @@TeX@{@} -Insert the logo @TeX{}. @xref{TeX and copyright, , Inserting @TeX{} -and @copyright{}}.@refill - -@item @@tex -Enter @TeX{} completely. Pair with @code{@@end tex}. @xref{Raw -Formatter Commands}. - -@item @@thischapter -@itemx @@thischaptername -@itemx @@thisfile -@itemx @@thispage -@itemx @@thistitle -Only allowed in a heading or footing. Stands for the number and name of -the current chapter (in the format `Chapter 1: Title'), the chapter name -only, the filename, the current page number, and the title of the -document, respectively. @xref{Custom Headings, , How to Make Your Own -Headings}.@refill - -@item @@tieaccent@{@var{cc}@} -Generate a tie-after accent over the next two characters @var{cc}, as in -`@tieaccent{oo}'. @xref{Inserting Accents}. - -@item @@tindex @var{entry} -Add @var{entry} to the index of data types. @xref{Index Entries, , -Defining the Entries of an Index}.@refill - -@item @@title @var{title} -In a printed manual, set a title flush to the left-hand side of the -page in a larger than normal font and underline it with a black rule. -Not relevant to Info, which does not have title pages. @xref{title -subtitle author, , The @code{@@title} @code{@@subtitle} and -@code{@@author} Commands}.@refill - -@need 400 -@item @@titlefont@{@var{text}@} -In a printed manual, print @var{text} in a larger than normal font. -Not relevant to Info, which does not have title pages. -@xref{titlefont center sp, , The @code{@@titlefont} @code{@@center} -and @code{@@sp} Commands}.@refill - -@need 300 -@item @@titlepage -Indicate to Texinfo the beginning of the title page. Write command on -a line of its own. Pair with @code{@@end titlepage}. Nothing between -@code{@@titlepage} and @code{@@end titlepage} appears in Info. -@xref{titlepage, , @code{@@titlepage}}.@refill - -@need 150 -@item @@today@{@} -Insert the current date, in `1 Jan 1900' style. @xref{Custom -Headings, , How to Make Your Own Headings}.@refill - -@item @@top @var{title} -In a Texinfo file to be formatted with @code{makeinfo}, identify the -topmost @code{@@node} line in the file, which must be written on the line -immediately preceding the @code{@@top} command. Used for -@code{makeinfo}'s node pointer insertion feature. The title is -underlined with asterisks. Both the @code{@@node} line and the @code{@@top} -line normally should be enclosed by @code{@@ifinfo} and @code{@@end -ifinfo}. In @TeX{} and @code{texinfo-format-buffer}, the @code{@@top} -command is merely a synonym for @code{@@unnumbered}. @xref{makeinfo -Pointer Creation, , Creating Pointers with @code{makeinfo}}. - -@item @@u@{@var{c}@} -@itemx @@ubaraccent@{@var{c}@} -@itemx @@udotaccent@{@var{c}@} -Generate a breve, underbar, or underdot accent, respectively, over or -under the character @var{c}, as in @u{o}, @ubaraccent{o}, -@udotaccent{o}. @xref{Inserting Accents}. - -@item @@unnumbered @var{title} -In a printed manual, begin a chapter that appears without chapter -numbers of any kind. The title appears in the table of contents of a -printed manual. In Info, the title is underlined with asterisks. -@xref{unnumbered & appendix, , @code{@@unnumbered} and -@code{@@appendix}}.@refill - -@item @@unnumberedsec @var{title} -In a printed manual, begin a section that appears without section -numbers of any kind. The title appears in the table of contents of a -printed manual. In Info, the title is underlined with equal signs. -@xref{unnumberedsec appendixsec heading, , Section Commands}.@refill - -@item @@unnumberedsubsec @var{title} -In a printed manual, begin an unnumbered subsection within a -chapter. The title appears in the table of contents of a printed -manual. In Info, the title is underlined with hyphens. -@xref{unnumberedsubsec appendixsubsec subheading, , -@code{@@unnumberedsubsec} @code{@@appendixsubsec} -@code{@@subheading}}.@refill - -@item @@unnumberedsubsubsec @var{title} -In a printed manual, begin an unnumbered subsubsection within a -chapter. The title appears in the table of contents of a printed -manual. In Info, the title is underlined with periods. -@xref{subsubsection, , The `subsub' Commands}.@refill - -@item @@uref@{@var{url}[, @var{displayed-text}@} -Define a cross reference to an external uniform resource locator for the -World Wide Web. @xref{url, , @code{@@url}}.@refill - -@item @@url@{@var{url}@} -Indicate text that is a uniform resource locator for the World Wide -Web. @xref{url, , @code{@@url}}.@refill - -@item @@v@{@var{c}@} -Generate check accent over the character @var{c}, as in @v{o}. -@xref{Inserting Accents}. - -@item @@value@{@var{flag}@} -Replace @var{flag} with the value to which it is set by @code{@@set -@var{flag}}. -@xref{set clear value, , @code{@@set} @code{@@clear} @code{@@value}}.@refill - -@item @@var@{@var{metasyntactic-variable}@} -Highlight a metasyntactic variable, which is something that stands for -another piece of text. @xref{var, , Indicating Metasyntactic -Variables}.@refill - -@need 400 -@item @@vindex @var{entry} -Add @var{entry} to the index of variables. @xref{Index Entries, , -Defining the Entries of an Index}.@refill - -@need 400 -@item @@vskip @var{amount} -In a printed manual, insert whitespace so as to push text on the -remainder of the page towards the bottom of the page. Used in -formatting the copyright page with the argument @samp{0pt plus -1filll}. (Note spelling of @samp{filll}.) @code{@@vskip} may be used -only in contexts ignored for Info. @xref{Copyright & Permissions, , -The Copyright Page and Printed Permissions}.@refill - -@need 400 -@item @@vtable @var{formatting-command} -Begin a two-column table, using @code{@@item} for each entry. -Automatically enter each of the items in the first column into the -index of variables. Pair with @code{@@end vtable}. The same as -@code{@@table}, except for indexing. @xref{ftable vtable, , -@code{@@ftable} and @code{@@vtable}}.@refill - -@need 400 -@item @@w@{@var{text}@} -Prevent @var{text} from being split across two lines. Do not end a -paragraph that uses @code{@@w} with an @code{@@refill} command. -@xref{w, , @code{@@w}}.@refill - -@need 400 -@item @@xref@{@var{node-name}, [@var{entry}], [@var{topic-or-title}], [@var{info-file}], [@var{manual}]@} -Make a reference that starts with `See' in a printed manual. Follow -command with a punctuation mark. Only the first argument is -mandatory. @xref{xref, , @code{@@xref}}.@refill -@end table - - -@node Tips, Sample Texinfo File, Command List, Top -@appendix Tips and Hints - -Here are some tips for writing Texinfo documentation:@refill - -@cindex Tips -@cindex Usage tips -@cindex Hints -@itemize @bullet -@item -Write in the present tense, not in the past or the future. - -@item -Write actively! For example, write ``We recommend that @dots{}'' rather -than ``It is recommended that @dots{}''. - -@item -Use 70 or 72 as your fill column. Longer lines are hard to read. - -@item -Include a copyright notice and copying permissions. -@end itemize - -@subsubheading Index, Index, Index! - -Write many index entries, in different ways. -Readers like indices; they are helpful and convenient. - -Although it is easiest to write index entries as you write the body of -the text, some people prefer to write entries afterwards. In either -case, write an entry before the paragraph to which it applies. This -way, an index entry points to the first page of a paragraph that is -split across pages. - -Here are more hints we have found valuable: - -@itemize @bullet -@item -Write each index entry differently, so each entry refers to a different -place in the document. - -@item -Write index entries only where a topic is discussed significantly. For -example, it is not useful to index ``debugging information'' in a -chapter on reporting bugs. Someone who wants to know about debugging -information will certainly not find it in that chapter. - -@item -Consistently capitalize the first word of every concept index entry, -or else consistently use lower case. Terse entries often call for -lower case; longer entries for capitalization. Whichever case -convention you use, please use one or the other consistently! Mixing -the two styles looks bad. - -@item -Always capitalize or use upper case for those words in an index for -which this is proper, such as names of countries or acronyms. Always -use the appropriate case for case-sensitive names, such as those in C or -Lisp. - -@item -Write the indexing commands that refer to a whole section immediately -after the section command, and write the indexing commands that refer to -the paragraph before the paragraph. - -@need 1000 -In the example that follows, a blank line comes after the index -entry for ``Leaping'': - -@example -@group -@@section The Dog and the Fox -@@cindex Jumping, in general -@@cindex Leaping - -@@cindex Dog, lazy, jumped over -@@cindex Lazy dog jumped over -@@cindex Fox, jumps over dog -@@cindex Quick fox jumps over dog -The quick brown fox jumps over the lazy dog. -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -(Note that the example shows entries for the same concept that are -written in different ways---@samp{Lazy dog}, and @samp{Dog, lazy}---so -readers can look up the concept in different ways.) -@end itemize - -@subsubheading Blank Lines - -@itemize @bullet -@item -Insert a blank line between a sectioning command and the first following -sentence or paragraph, or between the indexing commands associated with -the sectioning command and the first following sentence or paragraph, as -shown in the tip on indexing. Otherwise, a formatter may fold title and -paragraph together. - -@item -Always insert a blank line before an @code{@@table} command and after an -@code{@@end table} command; but never insert a blank line after an -@code{@@table} command or before an @code{@@end table} command. - -@need 1000 -For example, - -@example -@group -Types of fox: - -@@table @@samp -@@item Quick -Jump over lazy dogs. -@end group - -@group -@@item Brown -Also jump over lazy dogs. -@@end table - -@end group -@group -@@noindent -On the other hand, @dots{} -@end group -@end example - -Insert blank lines before and after @code{@@itemize} @dots{} @code{@@end -itemize} and @code{@@enumerate} @dots{} @code{@@end enumerate} in the -same way. -@end itemize - -@subsubheading Complete Phrases - -Complete phrases are easier to read than @dots{} - -@itemize @bullet -@item -Write entries in an itemized list as complete sentences; or at least, as -complete phrases. Incomplete expressions @dots{} awkward @dots{} like -this. - -@item -Write the prefatory sentence or phrase for a multi-item list or table as -a complete expression. Do not write ``You can set:''; instead, write -``You can set these variables:''. The former expression sounds cut off. -@end itemize - -@subsubheading Editions, Dates and Versions - -Write the edition and version numbers and date in three places in every -manual: - -@enumerate -@item -In the first @code{@@ifinfo} section, for people reading the Texinfo file. - -@item -In the @code{@@titlepage} section, for people reading the printed manual. - -@item -In the `Top' node, for people reading the Info file. -@end enumerate - -@noindent -Also, it helps to write a note before the first @code{@@ifinfo} -section to explain what you are doing. - -@need 800 -@noindent -For example: - -@example -@group -@@c ===> NOTE! <== -@@c Specify the edition and version numbers and date -@@c in *three* places: -@@c 1. First ifinfo section 2. title page 3. top node -@@c To find the locations, search for !!set -@end group - -@group -@@ifinfo -@@c !!set edition, date, version -This is Edition 4.03, January 1992, -of the @@cite@{GDB Manual@} for GDB Version 4.3. -@dots{} -@end group -@end example - -@noindent ----or use @code{@@set} and @code{@@value} -(@pxref{value Example, , @code{@@value} Example}). - -@subsubheading Definition Commands - -Definition commands are @code{@@deffn}, @code{@@defun}, -@code{@@defmac}, and the like, and enable you to write descriptions in -a uniform format.@refill - -@itemize @bullet -@item -Write just one definition command for each entity you define with a -definition command. The automatic indexing feature creates an index -entry that leads the reader to the definition. - -@item -Use @code{@@table} @dots{} @code{@@end table} in an appendix that -contains a summary of functions, not @code{@@deffn} or other definition -commands. -@end itemize - -@subsubheading Capitalization - -@itemize @bullet -@item -Capitalize ``Texinfo''; it is a name. Do not write the @samp{x} or -@samp{i} in upper case. - -@item -Capitalize ``Info''; it is a name. - -@item -Write @TeX{} using the @code{@@TeX@{@}} command. Note the uppercase -@samp{T} and @samp{X}. This command causes the formatters to -typeset the name according to the wishes of Donald Knuth, who wrote -@TeX{}. -@end itemize - -@subsubheading Spaces - -Do not use spaces to format a Texinfo file, except inside of -@code{@@example} @dots{} @code{@@end example} and similar commands. - -@need 700 -For example, @TeX{} fills the following: - -@example -@group - @@kbd@{C-x v@} - @@kbd@{M-x vc-next-action@} - Perform the next logical operation - on the version-controlled file - corresponding to the current buffer. -@end group -@end example - -@need 950 -@noindent -so it looks like this: - -@iftex -@quotation - @kbd{C-x v} - @kbd{M-x vc-next-action} - Perform the next logical operation on the version-controlled file - corresponding to the current buffer. -@end quotation -@end iftex -@ifinfo -@quotation -`C-x v' `M-x vc-next-action' Perform the next logical operation on the -version-controlled file corresponding to the current buffer. -@end quotation -@end ifinfo - -@noindent -In this case, the text should be formatted with -@code{@@table}, @code{@@item}, and @code{@@itemx}, to create a table. - -@subsubheading @@code, @@samp, @@var, and @samp{---} - -@itemize @bullet -@item -Use @code{@@code} around Lisp symbols, including command names. -For example, - -@example -The main function is @@code@{vc-next-action@}, @dots{} -@end example - -@item -Avoid putting letters such as @samp{s} immediately after an -@samp{@@code}. Such letters look bad. - -@item -Use @code{@@var} around meta-variables. Do not write angle brackets -around them. - -@item -Use three hyphens in a row, @samp{---}, to indicate a long dash. @TeX{} -typesets these as a long dash and the Info formatters reduce three -hyphens to two. -@end itemize - -@subsubheading Periods Outside of Quotes - -Place periods and other punctuation marks @emph{outside} of quotations, -unless the punctuation is part of the quotation. This practice goes -against publishing conventions in the United States, but enables the -reader to distinguish between the contents of the quotation and the -whole passage. - -For example, you should write the following sentence with the period -outside the end quotation marks: - -@example -Evidently, @samp{au} is an abbreviation for ``author''. -@end example - -@noindent -since @samp{au} does @emph{not} serve as an abbreviation for -@samp{author.} (with a period following the word). - -@subsubheading Introducing New Terms - -@itemize @bullet -@item -Introduce new terms so that a reader who does not know them can -understand them from context; or write a definition for the term. - -For example, in the following, the terms ``check in'', ``register'' and -``delta'' are all appearing for the first time; the example sentence should be -rewritten so they are understandable. - -@quotation -The major function assists you in checking in a file to your -version control system and registering successive sets of changes to -it as deltas. -@end quotation - -@item -Use the @code{@@dfn} command around a word being introduced, to indicate -that the reader should not expect to know the meaning already, and -should expect to learn the meaning from this passage. -@end itemize - -@subsubheading @@pxref - -@c !!! maybe include this in the tips on pxref -@ignore -By the way, it is okay to use pxref with something else in front of -it within the parens, as long as the pxref is followed by the close -paren, and the material inside the parens is not part of a larger -sentence. Also, you can use xref inside parens as part of a complete -sentence so long as you terminate the cross reference with punctuation. -@end ignore -Absolutely never use @code{@@pxref} except in the special context for -which it is designed: inside parentheses, with the closing parenthesis -following immediately after the closing brace. One formatter -automatically inserts closing punctuation and the other does not. This -means that the output looks right both in printed output and in an Info -file, but only when the command is used inside parentheses. - -@subsubheading Invoking from a Shell - -You can invoke programs such as Emacs, GCC, and @code{gawk} from a -shell. The documentation for each program should contain a section that -describes this. Unfortunately, if the node names and titles for these -sections are all different, readers find it hard to search for the -section.@refill - -Name such sections with a phrase beginning with the word -@w{`Invoking @dots{}'}, as in `Invoking Emacs'; this way -users can find the section easily. - -@subsubheading ANSI C Syntax - -When you use @code{@@example} to describe a C function's calling -conventions, use the ANSI C syntax, like this:@refill - -@example -void dld_init (char *@@var@{path@}); -@end example - -@noindent -And in the subsequent discussion, refer to the argument values by -writing the same argument names, again highlighted with -@code{@@var}.@refill - -@need 800 -Avoid the obsolete style that looks like this:@refill - -@example -#include <dld.h> - -dld_init (path) -char *path; -@end example - -Also, it is best to avoid writing @code{#include} above the -declaration just to indicate that the function is declared in a -header file. The practice may give the misimpression that the -@code{#include} belongs near the declaration of the function. Either -state explicitly which header file holds the declaration or, better -yet, name the header file used for a group of functions at the -beginning of the section that describes the functions.@refill - -@subsubheading Bad Examples - -Here are several examples of bad writing to avoid: - -In this example, say, `` @dots{} you must @code{@@dfn}@{check -in@} the new version.'' That flows better. - -@quotation -When you are done editing the file, you must perform a -@code{@@dfn}@{check in@}. -@end quotation - -In the following example, say, ``@dots{} makes a unified interface such as VC -mode possible.'' - -@quotation -SCCS, RCS and other version-control systems all perform similar -functions in broadly similar ways (it is this resemblance which makes -a unified control mode like this possible). -@end quotation - -And in this example, you should specify what `it' refers to: - -@quotation -If you are working with other people, it assists in coordinating -everyone's changes so they do not step on each other. -@end quotation - -@subsubheading And Finally @dots{} - -@itemize @bullet -@item -Pronounce @TeX{} as if the @samp{X} were a Greek `chi', as the last -sound in the name `Bach'. But pronounce Texinfo as in `speck': -``teckinfo''. - -@item -Write notes for yourself at the very end of a Texinfo file after the -@code{@@bye}. None of the formatters process text after the -@code{@@bye}; it is as if the text were within @code{@@ignore} @dots{} -@code{@@end ignore}. -@end itemize - - -@node Sample Texinfo File, Sample Permissions, Tips, Top -@appendix A Sample Texinfo File -@cindex Sample Texinfo file, no comments - -Here is a complete, short sample Texinfo file, without any commentary. -You can see this file, with comments, in the first chapter. -@xref{Short Sample, , A Short Sample Texinfo File}. - -@sp 1 -@example -\input texinfo @@c -*-texinfo-*- -@@c %**start of header -@@setfilename sample.info -@@settitle Sample Document -@@c %**end of header - -@@setchapternewpage odd - -@@ifinfo -This is a short example of a complete Texinfo file. - -Copyright 1990 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -@@end ifinfo - -@@titlepage -@@sp 10 -@@comment The title is printed in a large font. -@@center @@titlefont@{Sample Title@} - -@@c The following two commands start the copyright page. -@@page -@@vskip 0pt plus 1filll -Copyright @@copyright@{@} 1990 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -@@end titlepage - -@@node Top, First Chapter, , (dir) -@@comment node-name, next, previous, up - -@@menu -* First Chapter:: The first chapter is the - only chapter in this sample. -* Concept Index:: This index has two entries. -@@end menu - -@@node First Chapter, Concept Index, Top, Top -@@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@@chapter First Chapter -@@cindex Sample index entry - -This is the contents of the first chapter. -@@cindex Another sample index entry - -Here is a numbered list. - -@@enumerate -@@item -This is the first item. - -@@item -This is the second item. -@@end enumerate - -The @@code@{makeinfo@} and @@code@{texinfo-format-buffer@} -commands transform a Texinfo file such as this into -an Info file; and @@TeX@{@} typesets it for a printed -manual. - -@@node Concept Index, , First Chapter, Top -@@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@@unnumbered Concept Index - -@@printindex cp - -@@contents -@@bye -@end example - - -@node Sample Permissions, Include Files, Sample Texinfo File, Top -@appendix Sample Permissions -@cindex Permissions -@cindex Copying permissions - -Texinfo files should contain sections that tell the readers that they -have the right to copy and distribute the Texinfo file, the Info file, -and the printed manual.@refill - -Also, if you are writing a manual about software, you should explain -that the software is free and either include the GNU General Public -License (GPL) or provide a reference to it. @xref{Distrib, , -Distribution, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, for an example of the text -that could be used in the software ``Distribution'', ``General Public -License'', and ``NO WARRANTY'' sections of a document. @xref{Copying, -, Texinfo Copying Conditions}, for an example of a brief explanation -of how the copying conditions provide you with rights. @refill - -@menu -* Inserting Permissions:: How to put permissions in your document. -* ifinfo Permissions:: Sample @samp{ifinfo} copying permissions. -* Titlepage Permissions:: Sample Titlepage copying permissions. -@end menu - -@node Inserting Permissions, ifinfo Permissions, Sample Permissions, Sample Permissions -@ifinfo -@appendixsec Inserting Permissions -@end ifinfo - -In a Texinfo file, the first @code{@@ifinfo} section usually begins -with a line that says what the file documents. This is what a person -reading the unprocessed Texinfo file or using the advanced Info -command @kbd{g *} sees first. @inforef{Expert, Advanced Info -commands, info}, for more information. (A reader using the regular -Info commands usually starts reading at the first node and skips -this first section, which is not in a node.)@refill - -In the @code{@@ifinfo} section, the summary sentence is followed by a -copyright notice and then by the copying permission notice. One of -the copying permission paragraphs is enclosed in @code{@@ignore} and -@code{@@end ignore} commands. This paragraph states that the Texinfo -file can be processed through @TeX{} and printed, provided the printed -manual carries the proper copying permission notice. This paragraph -is not made part of the Info file since it is not relevant to the Info -file; but it is a mandatory part of the Texinfo file since it permits -people to process the Texinfo file in @TeX{} and print the -results.@refill - -In the printed manual, the Free Software Foundation copying permission -notice follows the copyright notice and publishing information and is -located within the region delineated by the @code{@@titlepage} and -@code{@@end titlepage} commands. The copying permission notice is exactly -the same as the notice in the @code{@@ifinfo} section except that the -paragraph enclosed in @code{@@ignore} and @code{@@end ignore} commands is -not part of the notice.@refill - -To make it simple to insert a permission notice into each section of -the Texinfo file, sample permission notices for each section are -reproduced in full below.@refill - -Note that you may need to specify the correct name of a section -mentioned in the permission notice. For example, in @cite{The GDB -Manual}, the name of the section referring to the General Public -License is called the ``GDB General Public License'', but in the -sample shown below, that section is referred to generically as the -``GNU General Public License''. If the Texinfo file does not carry a -copy of the General Public License, leave out the reference to it, but -be sure to include the rest of the sentence.@refill - -@node ifinfo Permissions, Titlepage Permissions, Inserting Permissions, Sample Permissions -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsec @samp{ifinfo} Copying Permissions -@cindex @samp{ifinfo} permissions - -In the @code{@@ifinfo} section of a Texinfo file, the standard Free -Software Foundation permission notice reads as follows:@refill - -@example -This file documents @dots{} - -Copyright 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc. - -Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim -copies of this manual provided the copyright notice and -this permission notice are preserved on all copies. - -@@ignore -Permission is granted to process this file through TeX -and print the results, provided the printed document -carries a copying permission notice identical to this -one except for the removal of this paragraph (this -paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual). - -@@end ignore -Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified -versions of this manual under the conditions for -verbatim copying, provided also that the sections -entitled ``Copying'' and ``GNU General Public License'' -are included exactly as in the original, and provided -that the entire resulting derived work is distributed -under the terms of a permission notice identical to this -one. - -Permission is granted to copy and distribute -translations of this manual into another language, -under the above conditions for modified versions, -except that this permission notice may be stated in a -translation approved by the Free Software Foundation. -@end example - -@node Titlepage Permissions, , ifinfo Permissions, Sample Permissions -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsec Titlepage Copying Permissions -@cindex Titlepage permissions - -In the @code{@@titlepage} section of a Texinfo file, the standard Free -Software Foundation copying permission notice follows the copyright -notice and publishing information. The standard phrasing is as -follows:@refill - -@example -Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim -copies of this manual provided the copyright notice and -this permission notice are preserved on all copies. - -Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified -versions of this manual under the conditions for -verbatim copying, provided also that the sections -entitled ``Copying'' and ``GNU General Public License'' -are included exactly as in the original, and provided -that the entire resulting derived work is distributed -under the terms of a permission notice identical to this -one. - -Permission is granted to copy and distribute -translations of this manual into another language, -under the above conditions for modified versions, -except that this permission notice may be stated in a -translation approved by the Free Software Foundation. -@end example - - -@node Include Files, Headings, Sample Permissions, Top -@appendix Include Files -@cindex Include files - -When @TeX{} or an Info formatting command sees an @code{@@include} -command in a Texinfo file, it processes the contents of the file named -by the command and incorporates them into the DVI or Info file being -created. Index entries from the included file are incorporated into -the indices of the output file.@refill - -Include files let you keep a single large document as a collection of -conveniently small parts.@refill - -@menu -* Using Include Files:: How to use the @code{@@include} command. -* texinfo-multiple-files-update:: How to create and update nodes and - menus when using included files. -* Include File Requirements:: What @code{texinfo-multiple-files-update} expects. -* Sample Include File:: A sample outer file with included files - within it; and a sample included file. -* Include Files Evolution:: How use of the @code{@@include} command - has changed over time. -@end menu - -@node Using Include Files, texinfo-multiple-files-update, Include Files, Include Files -@appendixsec How to Use Include Files -@findex include - -To include another file within a Texinfo file, write the -@code{@@include} command at the beginning of a line and follow it on -the same line by the name of a file to be included. For -example:@refill - -@example -@@include buffers.texi -@end example - -An included file should simply be a segment of text that you expect to -be included as is into the overall or @dfn{outer} Texinfo file; it -should not contain the standard beginning and end parts of a Texinfo -file. In particular, you should not start an included file with a -line saying @samp{\input texinfo}; if you do, that phrase is inserted -into the output file as is. Likewise, you should not end an included -file with an @code{@@bye} command; nothing after @code{@@bye} is -formatted.@refill - -In the past, you were required to write an @code{@@setfilename} line at the -beginning of an included file, but no longer. Now, it does not matter -whether you write such a line. If an @code{@@setfilename} line exists -in an included file, it is ignored.@refill - -Conventionally, an included file begins with an @code{@@node} line that -is followed by an @code{@@chapter} line. Each included file is one -chapter. This makes it easy to use the regular node and menu creating -and updating commands to create the node pointers and menus within the -included file. However, the simple Emacs node and menu creating and -updating commands do not work with multiple Texinfo files. Thus you -cannot use these commands to fill in the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' -pointers of the @code{@@node} line that begins the included file. Also, -you cannot use the regular commands to create a master menu for the -whole file. Either you must insert the menus and the `Next', -`Previous', and `Up' pointers by hand, or you must use the GNU Emacs -Texinfo mode command, @code{texinfo-multiple-files-update}, that is -designed for @code{@@include} files.@refill - -@node texinfo-multiple-files-update, Include File Requirements, Using Include Files, Include Files -@appendixsec @code{texinfo-multiple-files-update} -@findex texinfo-multiple-files-update - -GNU Emacs Texinfo mode provides the @code{texinfo-multiple-files-update} -command. This command creates or updates `Next', `Previous', and `Up' -pointers of included files as well as those in the outer or overall -Texinfo file, and it creates or updates a main menu in the outer file. -Depending whether you call it with optional arguments, the command -updates only the pointers in the first @code{@@node} line of the -included files or all of them:@refill - -@table @kbd -@item M-x texinfo-multiple-files-update -Called without any arguments:@refill - -@itemize @minus -@item -Create or update the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers of the -first @code{@@node} line in each file included in an outer or overall -Texinfo file.@refill - -@item -Create or update the `Top' level node pointers of the outer or -overall file.@refill - -@item -Create or update a main menu in the outer file.@refill -@end itemize - -@item C-u M-x texinfo-multiple-files-update -Called with @kbd{C-u} as a prefix argument: - -@itemize @minus{} -@item -Create or update pointers in the first @code{@@node} line in each -included file. - -@item -Create or update the `Top' level node pointers of the outer file. - -@item -Create and insert a master menu in the outer file. The master menu -is made from all the menus in all the included files.@refill -@end itemize - -@item C-u 8 M-x texinfo-multiple-files-update -Called with a numeric prefix argument, such as @kbd{C-u 8}: - -@itemize @minus -@item -Create or update @strong{all} the `Next', `Previous', and `Up' pointers -of all the included files.@refill - -@item -Create or update @strong{all} the menus of all the included -files.@refill - -@item -Create or update the `Top' level node pointers of the outer or -overall file.@refill - -@item -And then create a master menu in the outer file. This is similar to -invoking @code{texinfo-master-menu} with an argument when you are -working with just one file.@refill -@end itemize -@end table - -Note the use of the prefix argument in interactive use: with a regular -prefix argument, just @w{@kbd{C-u}}, the -@code{texinfo-multiple-files-update} command inserts a master menu; -with a numeric prefix argument, such as @kbd{C-u 8}, the command -updates @strong{every} pointer and menu in @strong{all} the files and then inserts a -master menu.@refill - -@node Include File Requirements, Sample Include File, texinfo-multiple-files-update, Include Files -@appendixsec Include File Requirements -@cindex Include file requirements -@cindex Requirements for include files - -If you plan to use the @code{texinfo-multiple-files-update} command, -the outer Texinfo file that lists included files within it should -contain nothing but the beginning and end parts of a Texinfo file, and -a number of @code{@@include} commands listing the included files. It -should not even include indices, which should be listed in an included -file of their own.@refill - -Moreover, each of the included files must contain exactly one highest -level node (conventionally, @code{@@chapter} or equivalent), -and this node must be the first node in the included file. -Furthermore, each of these highest level nodes in each included file -must be at the same hierarchical level in the file structure. -Usually, each is an @code{@@chapter}, an @code{@@appendix}, or an -@code{@@unnumbered} node. Thus, normally, each included file contains -one, and only one, chapter or equivalent-level node.@refill - -The outer file should contain only @emph{one} node, the `Top' node. It -should @emph{not} contain any nodes besides the single `Top' node. The -@code{texinfo-multiple-files-update} command will not process -them.@refill - -@node Sample Include File, Include Files Evolution, Include File Requirements, Include Files -@appendixsec Sample File with @code{@@include} -@cindex Sample @code{@@include} file -@cindex Include file sample -@cindex @code{@@include} file sample - -Here is an example of a complete outer Texinfo file with @code{@@include} files -within it before running @code{texinfo-multiple-files-update}, which -would insert a main or master menu:@refill - -@example -@group -\input texinfo @@c -*-texinfo-*- -@c %**start of header -@@setfilename include-example.info -@@settitle Include Example -@c %**end of header -@end group - -@group -@@setchapternewpage odd -@@titlepage -@@sp 12 -@@center @@titlefont@{Include Example@} -@@sp 2 -@@center by Whom Ever -@end group - -@group -@@page -@@vskip 0pt plus 1filll -Copyright @@copyright@{@} 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc. -@@end titlepage -@end group - -@group -@@ifinfo -@@node Top, First, , (dir) -@@top Master Menu -@@end ifinfo -@end group - -@group -@@include foo.texinfo -@@include bar.texinfo -@@include concept-index.texinfo -@end group - -@group -@@summarycontents -@@contents - -@@bye -@end group -@end example - -An included file, such as @file{foo.texinfo}, might look like -this:@refill - -@example -@group -@@node First, Second, , Top -@@chapter First Chapter - -Contents of first chapter @dots{} -@end group -@end example - -The full contents of @file{concept-index.texinfo} might be as simple as this: - -@example -@group -@@node Concept Index, , Second, Top -@@unnumbered Concept Index - -@@printindex cp -@end group -@end example - -The outer Texinfo source file for @cite{The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference -Manual} is named @file{elisp.texi}. This outer file contains a master -menu with 417 entries and a list of 41 @code{@@include} -files.@refill - -@node Include Files Evolution, , Sample Include File, Include Files -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsec Evolution of Include Files - -When Info was first created, it was customary to create many small -Info files on one subject. Each Info file was formatted from its own -Texinfo source file. This custom meant that Emacs did not need to -make a large buffer to hold the whole of a large Info file when -someone wanted information; instead, Emacs allocated just enough -memory for the small Info file that contained the particular -information sought. This way, Emacs could avoid wasting memory.@refill - -References from one file to another were made by referring to the file -name as well as the node name. (@xref{Other Info Files, , Referring to -Other Info Files}. Also, see @ref{Four and Five Arguments, , -@code{@@xref} with Four and Five Arguments}.)@refill - -Include files were designed primarily as a way to create a single, -large printed manual out of several smaller Info files. In a printed -manual, all the references were within the same document, so @TeX{} -could automatically determine the references' page numbers. The Info -formatting commands used include files only for creating joint -indices; each of the individual Texinfo files had to be formatted for -Info individually. (Each, therefore, required its own -@code{@@setfilename} line.)@refill - -However, because large Info files are now split automatically, it is -no longer necessary to keep them small.@refill - -Nowadays, multiple Texinfo files are used mostly for large documents, -such as @cite{The GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, and for projects -in which several different people write different sections of a -document simultaneously.@refill - -In addition, the Info formatting commands have been extended to work -with the @code{@@include} command so as to create a single large Info -file that is split into smaller files if necessary. This means that -you can write menus and cross references without naming the different -Texinfo files.@refill - - -@node Headings, Catching Mistakes, Include Files, Top -@appendix Page Headings -@cindex Headings -@cindex Footings -@cindex Page numbering -@cindex Page headings -@cindex Formatting headings and footings - -Most printed manuals contain headings along the top of every page -except the title and copyright pages. Some manuals also contain -footings. (Headings and footings have no meaning to Info, which is -not paginated.)@refill - -@menu -* Headings Introduced:: Conventions for using page headings. -* Heading Format:: Standard page heading formats. -* Heading Choice:: How to specify the type of page heading. -* Custom Headings:: How to create your own headings and footings. -@end menu - -@node Headings Introduced, Heading Format, Headings, Headings -@ifinfo -@heading Headings Introduced -@end ifinfo - -Texinfo provides standard page heading formats for manuals that are -printed on one side of each sheet of paper and for manuals that are -printed on both sides of the paper. Typically, you will use these -formats, but you can specify your own format if you wish.@refill - -In addition, you can specify whether chapters should begin on a new -page, or merely continue the same page as the previous chapter; and if -chapters begin on new pages, you can specify whether they must be -odd-numbered pages.@refill - -By convention, a book is printed on both sides of each sheet of paper. -When you open a book, the right-hand page is odd-numbered, and -chapters begin on right-hand pages---a preceding left-hand page is -left blank if necessary. Reports, however, are often printed on just -one side of paper, and chapters begin on a fresh page immediately -following the end of the preceding chapter. In short or informal -reports, chapters often do not begin on a new page at all, but are -separated from the preceding text by a small amount of whitespace.@refill - -The @code{@@setchapternewpage} command controls whether chapters begin -on new pages, and whether one of the standard heading formats is used. -In addition, Texinfo has several heading and footing commands that you -can use to generate your own heading and footing formats.@refill - -In Texinfo, headings and footings are single lines at the tops and -bottoms of pages; you cannot create multiline headings or footings. -Each header or footer line is divided into three parts: a left part, a -middle part, and a right part. Any part, or a whole line, may be left -blank. Text for the left part of a header or footer line is set -flushleft; text for the middle part is centered; and, text for the -right part is set flushright.@refill - -@node Heading Format, Heading Choice, Headings Introduced, Headings -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsec Standard Heading Formats - -Texinfo provides two standard heading formats, one for manuals printed -on one side of each sheet of paper, and the other for manuals printed -on both sides of the paper. - -By default, nothing is specified for the footing of a Texinfo file, -so the footing remains blank.@refill - -The standard format for single-sided printing consists of a header -line in which the left-hand part contains the name of the chapter, the -central part is blank, and the right-hand part contains the page -number.@refill - -@need 950 -A single-sided page looks like this: - -@example -@group - _______________________ - | | - | chapter page number | - | | - | Start of text ... | - | ... | - | | - -@end group -@end example - -The standard format for two-sided printing depends on whether the page -number is even or odd. By convention, even-numbered pages are on the -left- and odd-numbered pages are on the right. (@TeX{} will adjust the -widths of the left- and right-hand margins. Usually, widths are -correct, but during double-sided printing, it is wise to check that -pages will bind properly---sometimes a printer will produce output in -which the even-numbered pages have a larger right-hand margin than the -odd-numbered pages.)@refill - -In the standard double-sided format, the left part of the left-hand -(even-numbered) page contains the page number, the central part is -blank, and the right part contains the title (specified by the -@code{@@settitle} command). The left part of the right-hand -(odd-numbered) page contains the name of the chapter, the central part -is blank, and the right part contains the page number.@refill - -@need 750 -Two pages, side by side as in an open book, look like this:@refill - -@example -@group - _______________________ _______________________ - | | | | - | page number title | | chapter page number | - | | | | - | Start of text ... | | More text ... | - | ... | | ... | - | | | | - -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -The chapter name is preceded by the word ``Chapter'', the chapter number -and a colon. This makes it easier to keep track of where you are in the -manual.@refill - -@node Heading Choice, Custom Headings, Heading Format, Headings -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsec Specifying the Type of Heading - -@TeX{} does not begin to generate page headings for a standard Texinfo -file until it reaches the @code{@@end titlepage} command. Thus, the -title and copyright pages are not numbered. The @code{@@end -titlepage} command causes @TeX{} to begin to generate page headings -according to a standard format specified by the -@code{@@setchapternewpage} command that precedes the -@code{@@titlepage} section.@refill - -@need 1000 -There are four possibilities:@refill - -@table @asis -@item No @code{@@setchapternewpage} command -Cause @TeX{} to specify the single-sided heading format, with chapters -on new pages. This is the same as @code{@@setchapternewpage on}.@refill - -@item @code{@@setchapternewpage on} -Specify the single-sided heading format, with chapters on new pages.@refill - -@item @code{@@setchapternewpage off} -Cause @TeX{} to start a new chapter on the same page as the last page of -the preceding chapter, after skipping some vertical whitespace. Also -cause @TeX{} to typeset for single-sided printing. (You can override -the headers format with the @code{@@headings double} command; see -@ref{headings on off, , The @code{@@headings} Command}.)@refill - -@item @code{@@setchapternewpage odd} -Specify the double-sided heading format, with chapters on new pages.@refill -@end table - -@noindent -Texinfo lacks an @code{@@setchapternewpage even} command.@refill - -@node Custom Headings, , Heading Choice, Headings -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsec How to Make Your Own Headings - -You can use the standard headings provided with Texinfo or specify -your own. By default, Texinfo has no footers, so if you specify them, -the available page size for the main text will be slightly reduced. - -@c Following paragraph is verbose to prevent overfull hboxes. -Texinfo provides six commands for specifying headings and -footings. The @code{@@everyheading} command and -@code{@@everyfooting} command generate page headers and footers -that are the same for both even- and odd-numbered pages. -The @code{@@evenheading} command and @code{@@evenfooting} -command generate headers and footers for even-numbered -(left-hand) pages; and the @code{@@oddheading} command and -@code{@@oddfooting} command generate headers and footers for -odd-numbered (right-hand) pages.@refill - -Write custom heading specifications in the Texinfo file immediately -after the @code{@@end titlepage} command. Enclose your specifications -between @code{@@iftex} and @code{@@end iftex} commands since the -@code{texinfo-format-buffer} command may not recognize them. Also, -you must cancel the predefined heading commands with the -@code{@@headings off} command before defining your own -specifications.@refill - -@need 1000 -Here is how to tell @TeX{} to place the chapter name at the left, the -page number in the center, and the date at the right of every header -for both even- and odd-numbered pages:@refill - -@example -@group -@@iftex -@@headings off -@@everyheading @@thischapter @@| @@thispage @@| @@today@{@} -@@end iftex -@end group -@end example - -@noindent -You need to divide the left part from the central part and the central -part from the right part by inserting @samp{@@|} between parts. -Otherwise, the specification command will not be able to tell where -the text for one part ends and the next part begins.@refill - -Each part can contain text or @@-commands. The text -is printed as if the part were within an ordinary paragraph in the -body of the page. The @@-commands replace -themselves with the page number, date, chapter name, or -whatever.@refill - -@need 950 -Here are the six heading and footing commands:@refill - -@findex everyheading -@findex everyfooting -@table @code -@item @@everyheading @var{left} @@| @var{center} @@| @var{right} -@itemx @@everyfooting @var{left} @@| @var{center} @@| @var{right} - -The `every' commands specify the format for both even- and odd-numbered -pages. These commands are for documents that are printed on one side -of each sheet of paper, or for documents in which you want symmetrical -headers or footers.@refill - -@findex evenheading -@findex evenfooting -@findex oddheading -@findex oddfooting -@item @@evenheading @var{left} @@| @var{center} @@| @var{right} -@itemx @@oddheading @var{left} @@| @var{center} @@| @var{right} - -@itemx @@evenfooting @var{left} @@| @var{center} @@| @var{right} -@itemx @@oddfooting @var{left} @@| @var{center} @@| @var{right} - -The `even' and `odd' commands specify the format for even-numbered -pages and odd-numbered pages. These commands are for books and -manuals that are printed on both sides of each sheet of paper. -@end table - -Use the @samp{@@this@dots{}} series of @@-commands to -provide the names of chapters -and sections and the page number. You can use the -@samp{@@this@dots{}} commands in the left, center, or right portions -of headers and footers, or anywhere else in a Texinfo file so long as -they are between @code{@@iftex} and @code{@@end iftex} commands.@refill - -@need 1000 -Here are the @samp{@@this@dots{}} commands:@refill - -@table @code -@findex thispage -@item @@thispage -Expands to the current page number.@refill -@c !!! Karl Berry says that `thissection' can fail on page breaks. -@ignore -@item @@thissection -Expands to the name of the current section.@refill -@end ignore - -@findex thischaptername -@item @@thischaptername -Expands to the name of the current chapter.@refill - -@findex thischapter -@item @@thischapter -Expands to the number and name of the current -chapter, in the format `Chapter 1: Title'.@refill - -@findex thistitle -@item @@thistitle -Expands to the name of the document, as specified by the -@code{@@settitle} command.@refill - -@findex thisfile -@item @@thisfile -For @code{@@include} files only: expands to the name of the current -@code{@@include} file. If the current Texinfo source file is not an -@code{@@include} file, this command has no effect. This command does -@emph{not} provide the name of the current Texinfo source file unless -it is an @code{@@include} file. (@xref{Include Files}, for more -information about @code{@@include} files.)@refill -@end table - -@noindent -You can also use the @code{@@today@{@}} command, which expands to the -current date, in `1 Jan 1900' format.@refill -@findex today - -Other @@-commands and text are printed in a header or footer just as -if they were in the body of a page. It is useful to incorporate text, -particularly when you are writing drafts:@refill - -@example -@group -@@iftex -@@headings off -@@everyheading @@emph@{Draft!@} @@| @@thispage @@| @@thischapter -@@everyfooting @@| @@| Version: 0.27: @@today@{@} -@@end iftex -@end group -@end example - -Beware of overlong titles: they may overlap another part of the -header or footer and blot it out.@refill - - -@node Catching Mistakes, Refilling Paragraphs, Headings, Top -@appendix Formatting Mistakes -@cindex Structure, catching mistakes in -@cindex Nodes, catching mistakes -@cindex Catching mistakes -@cindex Correcting mistakes -@cindex Mistakes, catching -@cindex Problems, catching -@cindex Debugging the Texinfo structure - -Besides mistakes in the content of your documentation, there -are two kinds of mistake you can make with Texinfo: you can make mistakes -with @@-commands, and you can make mistakes with the structure of the -nodes and chapters.@refill - -Emacs has two tools for catching the @@-command mistakes and two for -catching structuring mistakes.@refill - -For finding problems with @@-commands, you can run @TeX{} or a region -formatting command on the region that has a problem; indeed, you can -run these commands on each region as you write it.@refill - -For finding problems with the structure of nodes and chapters, you can use -@kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{texinfo-show-structure}) and the related @code{occur} -command and you can use the @kbd{M-x Info-validate} command.@refill - -@menu -* makeinfo Preferred:: @code{makeinfo} finds errors. -* Debugging with Info:: How to catch errors with Info formatting. -* Debugging with TeX:: How to catch errors with @TeX{} formatting. -* Using texinfo-show-structure:: How to use @code{texinfo-show-structure}. -* Using occur:: How to list all lines containing a pattern. -* Running Info-Validate:: How to find badly referenced nodes. -@end menu - -@node makeinfo Preferred, Debugging with Info, Catching Mistakes, Catching Mistakes -@ifinfo -@heading @code{makeinfo} Find Errors -@end ifinfo - -The @code{makeinfo} program does an excellent job of catching errors -and reporting them---far better than @code{texinfo-format-region} or -@code{texinfo-format-buffer}. In addition, the various functions for -automatically creating and updating node pointers and menus remove -many opportunities for human error.@refill - -If you can, use the updating commands to create and insert pointers -and menus. These prevent many errors. Then use @code{makeinfo} (or -its Texinfo mode manifestations, @code{makeinfo-region} and -@code{makeinfo-buffer}) to format your file and check for other -errors. This is the best way to work with Texinfo. But if you -cannot use @code{makeinfo}, or your problem is very puzzling, then you -may want to use the tools described in this appendix.@refill - -@node Debugging with Info, Debugging with TeX, makeinfo Preferred, Catching Mistakes -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsec Catching Errors with Info Formatting -@cindex Catching errors with Info formatting -@cindex Debugging with Info formatting - -After you have written part of a Texinfo file, you can use the -@code{texinfo-format-region} or the @code{makeinfo-region} command to -see whether the region formats properly.@refill - -Most likely, however, you are reading this section because for some -reason you cannot use the @code{makeinfo-region} command; therefore, the -rest of this section presumes that you are using -@code{texinfo-format-region}.@refill - -If you have made a mistake with an @@-command, -@code{texinfo-format-region} will stop processing at or after the -error and display an error message. To see where in the buffer the -error occurred, switch to the @samp{*Info Region*} buffer; the cursor -will be in a position that is after the location of the error. Also, -the text will not be formatted after the place where the error -occurred (or more precisely, where it was detected).@refill - -For example, if you accidentally end a menu with the command @code{@@end -menus} with an `s' on the end, instead of with @code{@@end menu}, you -will see an error message that says:@refill - -@example -@@end menus is not handled by texinfo -@end example - -@noindent -The cursor will stop at the point in the buffer where the error -occurs, or not long after it. The buffer will look like this:@refill - -@example -@group ----------- Buffer: *Info Region* ---------- -* Menu: - -* Using texinfo-show-structure:: How to use - `texinfo-show-structure' - to catch mistakes. -* Running Info-Validate:: How to check for - unreferenced nodes. -@@end menus -@point{} ----------- Buffer: *Info Region* ---------- -@end group -@end example - -The @code{texinfo-format-region} command sometimes provides slightly -odd error messages. For example, the following cross reference fails to format:@refill - -@example -(@@xref@{Catching Mistakes, for more info.) -@end example - -@noindent -In this case, @code{texinfo-format-region} detects the missing closing -brace but displays a message that says @samp{Unbalanced parentheses} -rather than @samp{Unbalanced braces}. This is because the formatting -command looks for mismatches between braces as if they were -parentheses.@refill - -Sometimes @code{texinfo-format-region} fails to detect mistakes. For -example, in the following, the closing brace is swapped with the -closing parenthesis:@refill - -@example -(@@xref@{Catching Mistakes), for more info.@} -@end example - -@noindent -Formatting produces: -@example -(*Note for more info.: Catching Mistakes) -@end example - -The only way for you to detect this error is to realize that the -reference should have looked like this:@refill - -@example -(*Note Catching Mistakes::, for more info.) -@end example - -Incidentally, if you are reading this node in Info and type @kbd{f -@key{RET}} (@code{Info-follow-reference}), you will generate an error -message that says: - -@example -No such node: "Catching Mistakes) The only way @dots{} -@end example - -@noindent -This is because Info perceives the example of the error as the first -cross reference in this node and if you type a @key{RET} immediately -after typing the Info @kbd{f} command, Info will attempt to go to the -referenced node. If you type @kbd{f catch @key{TAB} @key{RET}}, Info -will complete the node name of the correctly written example and take -you to the `Catching Mistakes' node. (If you try this, you can return -from the `Catching Mistakes' node by typing @kbd{l} -(@code{Info-last}).) - -@c !!! section on using Elisp debugger ignored. -@ignore -Sometimes @code{texinfo-format-region} will stop long after the -original error; this is because it does not discover the problem until -then. In this case, you will need to backtrack.@refill - -@c menu -@c * Using the Emacs Lisp Debugger:: How to use the Emacs Lisp debugger. -@c end menu - -@c node Using the Emacs Lisp Debugger -@c appendixsubsec Using the Emacs Lisp Debugger -@c index Using the Emacs Lisp debugger -@c index Emacs Lisp debugger -@c index Debugger, using the Emacs Lisp - -If an error is especially elusive, you can turn on the Emacs Lisp -debugger and look at the backtrace; this tells you where in the -@code{texinfo-format-region} function the problem occurred. You can -turn on the debugger with the command:@refill - -@example -M-x set-variable @key{RET} debug-on-error @key{RET} t @key{RET} -@end example - -@noindent -and turn it off with - -@example -M-x set-variable @key{RET} debug-on-error @key{RET} nil @key{RET} -@end example - -Often, when you are using the debugger, it is easier to follow what is -going on if you use the Emacs Lisp files that are not byte-compiled. -The byte-compiled sources send octal numbers to the debugger that may -look mysterious. To use the uncompiled source files, load -@file{texinfmt.el} and @file{texinfo.el} with the @kbd{M-x load-file} -command.@refill - -The debugger will not catch an error if @code{texinfo-format-region} -does not detect one. In the example shown above, -@code{texinfo-format-region} did not find the error when the whole -list was formatted, but only when part of the list was formatted. -When @code{texinfo-format-region} did not find an error, the debugger -did not find one either. @refill - -However, when @code{texinfo-format-region} did report an error, it -invoked the debugger. This is the backtrace it produced:@refill - -@example ----------- Buffer: *Backtrace* ---------- -Signalling: (search-failed "[@},]") - re-search-forward("[@},]") - (while ...) - (let ...) - texinfo-format-parse-args() - (let ...) - texinfo-format-xref() - funcall(texinfo-format-xref) - (if ...) - (let ...) - (if ...) - (while ...) - texinfo-format-scan() - (save-excursion ...) - (let ...) - texinfo-format-region(103370 103631) -* call-interactively(texinfo-format-region) ----------- Buffer: *Backtrace* ---------- -@end example - -The backtrace is read from the bottom up. -@code{texinfo-format-region} was called interactively; and it, in -turn, called various functions, including @code{texinfo-format-scan}, -@code{texinfo-format-xref} and @code{texinfo-format-parse-args}. -Inside the function @code{texinfo-format-parse-args}, the function -@code{re-search-forward} was called; it was this function that could -not find the missing right-hand brace.@refill - -@xref{Lisp Debug, , Debugging Emacs Lisp, emacs, The GNU Emacs -Manual}, for more information.@refill -@end ignore - -@node Debugging with TeX, Using texinfo-show-structure, Debugging with Info, Catching Mistakes -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsec Catching Errors with @TeX{} Formatting -@cindex Catching errors with @TeX{} formatting -@cindex Debugging with @TeX{} formatting - -You can also catch mistakes when you format a file with @TeX{}.@refill - -Usually, you will want to do this after you have run -@code{texinfo-format-buffer} (or, better, @code{makeinfo-buffer}) on -the same file, because @code{texinfo-format-buffer} sometimes displays -error messages that make more sense than @TeX{}. (@xref{Debugging -with Info}, for more information.)@refill - -For example, @TeX{} was run on a Texinfo file, part of which is shown -here:@refill - -@example ----------- Buffer: texinfo.texi ---------- -name of the Texinfo file as an extension. The -@@samp@{??@} are `wildcards' that cause the shell to -substitute all the raw index files. (@@xref@{sorting -indices, for more information about sorting -indices.)@@refill ----------- Buffer: texinfo.texi ---------- -@end example - -@noindent -(The cross reference lacks a closing brace.) -@TeX{} produced the following output, after which it stopped:@refill - -@example ----------- Buffer: *tex-shell* ---------- -Runaway argument? -@{sorting indices, for more information about sorting -indices.) @@refill @@ETC. -! Paragraph ended before @@xref was complete. -<to be read again> - @@par -l.27 - -? ----------- Buffer: *tex-shell* ---------- -@end example - -In this case, @TeX{} produced an accurate and -understandable error message: - -@example -Paragraph ended before @@xref was complete. -@end example - -@noindent -@samp{@@par} is an internal @TeX{} command of no relevance to Texinfo. -@samp{l.27} means that @TeX{} detected the problem on line 27 of the -Texinfo file. The @samp{?} is the prompt @TeX{} uses in this -circumstance.@refill - -Unfortunately, @TeX{} is not always so helpful, and sometimes you must -truly be a Sherlock Holmes to discover what went wrong.@refill - -In any case, if you run into a problem like this, you can do one of three -things.@refill - -@enumerate -@item -You can tell @TeX{} to continue running and ignore just this error by -typing @key{RET} at the @samp{?} prompt.@refill - -@item -You can tell @TeX{} to continue running and to ignore all errors as best -it can by typing @kbd{r @key{RET}} at the @samp{?} prompt.@refill - -This is often the best thing to do. However, beware: the one error -may produce a cascade of additional error messages as its consequences -are felt through the rest of the file. To stop @TeX{} when it is -producing such an avalanche of error messages, type @kbd{C-c} (or -@kbd{C-c C-c}, if you are running a shell inside Emacs). - -@item -You can tell @TeX{} to stop this run by typing @kbd{x @key{RET}} -at the @samp{?} prompt.@refill -@end enumerate - -Please note that if you are running @TeX{} inside Emacs, you need to -switch to the shell buffer and line at which @TeX{} offers the @samp{?} -prompt.@refill - -Sometimes @TeX{} will format a file without producing error messages even -though there is a problem. This usually occurs if a command is not ended -but @TeX{} is able to continue processing anyhow. For example, if you fail -to end an itemized list with the @code{@@end itemize} command, @TeX{} will -write a DVI file that you can print out. The only error message that -@TeX{} will give you is the somewhat mysterious comment that@refill - -@example -(@@end occurred inside a group at level 1) -@end example - -@noindent -However, if you print the DVI file, you will find that the text -of the file that follows the itemized list is entirely indented as if -it were part of the last item in the itemized list. The error message -is the way @TeX{} says that it expected to find an @code{@@end} -command somewhere in the file; but that it could not determine where -it was needed.@refill - -Another source of notoriously hard-to-find errors is a missing -@code{@@end group} command. If you ever are stumped by -incomprehensible errors, look for a missing @code{@@end group} command -first.@refill - -If the Texinfo file lacks header lines, -@TeX{} may stop in the -beginning of its run and display output that looks like the following. -The @samp{*} indicates that @TeX{} is waiting for input.@refill - -@example -This is TeX, Version 3.14159 (Web2c 7.0) -(test.texinfo [1]) -* -@end example - -@noindent -In this case, simply type @kbd{\end @key{RET}} after the asterisk. Then -write the header lines in the Texinfo file and run the @TeX{} command -again. (Note the use of the backslash, @samp{\}. @TeX{} uses @samp{\} -instead of @samp{@@}; and in this circumstance, you are working -directly with @TeX{}, not with Texinfo.)@refill - -@node Using texinfo-show-structure, Using occur, Debugging with TeX, Catching Mistakes -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsec Using @code{texinfo-show-structure} -@cindex Showing the structure of a file -@findex texinfo-show-structure - -It is not always easy to keep track of the nodes, chapters, sections, and -subsections of a Texinfo file. This is especially true if you are revising -or adding to a Texinfo file that someone else has written.@refill - -In GNU Emacs, in Texinfo mode, the @code{texinfo-show-structure} -command lists all the lines that begin with the @@-commands that -specify the structure: @code{@@chapter}, @code{@@section}, -@code{@@appendix}, and so on. With an argument (@w{@kbd{C-u}} -as prefix argument, if interactive), -the command also shows the @code{@@node} lines. The -@code{texinfo-show-structure} command is bound to @kbd{C-c C-s} in -Texinfo mode, by default.@refill - -The lines are displayed in a buffer called the @samp{*Occur*} buffer, -indented by hierarchical level. For example, here is a part of what was -produced by running @code{texinfo-show-structure} on this manual:@refill - -@example -@group - Lines matching "^@@\\(chapter \\|sect\\|subs\\|subh\\| - unnum\\|major\\|chapheading \\|heading \\|appendix\\)" - in buffer texinfo.texi. - @dots{} - 4177:@@chapter Nodes - 4198: @@heading Two Paths - 4231: @@section Node and Menu Illustration - 4337: @@section The @@code@{@@@@node@} Command - 4393: @@subheading Choosing Node and Pointer Names - 4417: @@subsection How to Write an @@code@{@@@@node@} Line - 4469: @@subsection @@code@{@@@@node@} Line Tips - @dots{} -@end group -@end example - -This says that lines 4337, 4393, and 4417 of @file{texinfo.texi} begin -with the @code{@@section}, @code{@@subheading}, and @code{@@subsection} -commands respectively. If you move your cursor into the @samp{*Occur*} -window, you can position the cursor over one of the lines and use the -@kbd{C-c C-c} command (@code{occur-mode-goto-occurrence}), to jump to -the corresponding spot in the Texinfo file. @xref{Other Repeating -Search, , Using Occur, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, for more -information about @code{occur-mode-goto-occurrence}.@refill - -The first line in the @samp{*Occur*} window describes the @dfn{regular -expression} specified by @var{texinfo-heading-pattern}. This regular -expression is the pattern that @code{texinfo-show-structure} looks for. -@xref{Regexps, , Using Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}, -for more information.@refill - -When you invoke the @code{texinfo-show-structure} command, Emacs will -display the structure of the whole buffer. If you want to see the -structure of just a part of the buffer, of one chapter, for example, -use the @kbd{C-x n n} (@code{narrow-to-region}) command to mark the -region. (@xref{Narrowing, , , emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.) This is -how the example used above was generated. (To see the whole buffer -again, use @kbd{C-x n w} (@code{widen}).)@refill - -If you call @code{texinfo-show-structure} with a prefix argument by -typing @w{@kbd{C-u C-c C-s}}, it will list lines beginning with -@code{@@node} as well as the lines beginning with the @@-sign commands -for @code{@@chapter}, @code{@@section}, and the like.@refill - -You can remind yourself of the structure of a Texinfo file by looking at -the list in the @samp{*Occur*} window; and if you have mis-named a node -or left out a section, you can correct the mistake.@refill - -@node Using occur, Running Info-Validate, Using texinfo-show-structure, Catching Mistakes -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsec Using @code{occur} -@cindex Occurrences, listing with @code{@@occur} -@findex occur - -Sometimes the @code{texinfo-show-structure} command produces too much -information. Perhaps you want to remind yourself of the overall structure -of a Texinfo file, and are overwhelmed by the detailed list produced by -@code{texinfo-show-structure}. In this case, you can use the @code{occur} -command directly. To do this, type@refill - -@example -@kbd{M-x occur} -@end example - -@noindent -and then, when prompted, type a @dfn{regexp}, a regular expression for -the pattern you want to match. (@xref{Regexps, , Regular Expressions, -emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.) The @code{occur} command works from -the current location of the cursor in the buffer to the end of the -buffer. If you want to run @code{occur} on the whole buffer, place -the cursor at the beginning of the buffer.@refill - -For example, to see all the lines that contain the word -@samp{@@chapter} in them, just type @samp{@@chapter}. This will -produce a list of the chapters. It will also list all the sentences -with @samp{@@chapter} in the middle of the line.@refill - -If you want to see only those lines that start with the word -@samp{@@chapter}, type @samp{^@@chapter} when prompted by -@code{occur}. If you want to see all the lines that end with a word -or phrase, end the last word with a @samp{$}; for example, -@samp{catching mistakes$}. This can be helpful when you want to see -all the nodes that are part of the same chapter or section and -therefore have the same `Up' pointer.@refill - -@xref{Other Repeating Search, , Using Occur, emacs , The GNU Emacs Manual}, -for more information.@refill - -@node Running Info-Validate, , Using occur, Catching Mistakes -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsec Finding Badly Referenced Nodes -@findex Info-validate -@cindex Nodes, checking for badly referenced -@cindex Checking for badly referenced nodes -@cindex Looking for badly referenced nodes -@cindex Finding badly referenced nodes -@cindex Badly referenced nodes - -You can use the @code{Info-validate} command to check whether any of -the `Next', `Previous', `Up' or other node pointers fail to point to a -node. This command checks that every node pointer points to an -existing node. The @code{Info-validate} command works only on Info -files, not on Texinfo files.@refill - -The @code{makeinfo} program validates pointers automatically, so you -do not need to use the @code{Info-validate} command if you are using -@code{makeinfo}. You only may need to use @code{Info-validate} if you -are unable to run @code{makeinfo} and instead must create an Info file -using @code{texinfo-format-region} or @code{texinfo-format-buffer}, or -if you write an Info file from scratch.@refill - -@menu -* Using Info-validate:: How to run @code{Info-validate}. -* Unsplit:: How to create an unsplit file. -* Tagifying:: How to tagify a file. -* Splitting:: How to split a file manually. -@end menu - -@node Using Info-validate, Unsplit, Running Info-Validate, Running Info-Validate -@appendixsubsec Running @code{Info-validate} -@cindex Running @code{Info-validate} -@cindex Info validating a large file -@cindex Validating a large file - -To use @code{Info-validate}, visit the Info file you wish to check and -type:@refill - -@example -M-x Info-validate -@end example - -@noindent -(Note that the @code{Info-validate} command requires an upper case -`I'. You may also need to create a tag table before running -@code{Info-validate}. @xref{Tagifying}.)@refill - -If your file is valid, you will receive a message that says ``File appears -valid''. However, if you have a pointer that does not point to a node, -error messages will be displayed in a buffer called @samp{*problems in -info file*}.@refill - -For example, @code{Info-validate} was run on a test file that contained -only the first node of this manual. One of the messages said:@refill - -@example -In node "Overview", invalid Next: Texinfo Mode -@end example - -@noindent -This meant that the node called @samp{Overview} had a `Next' pointer that -did not point to anything (which was true in this case, since the test file -had only one node in it).@refill - -Now suppose we add a node named @samp{Texinfo Mode} to our test case -but we do not specify a `Previous' for this node. Then we will get -the following error message:@refill - -@example -In node "Texinfo Mode", should have Previous: Overview -@end example - -@noindent -This is because every `Next' pointer should be matched by a -`Previous' (in the node where the `Next' points) which points back.@refill - -@code{Info-validate} also checks that all menu entries and cross references -point to actual nodes.@refill - -Note that @code{Info-validate} requires a tag table and does not work -with files that have been split. (The @code{texinfo-format-buffer} -command automatically splits large files.) In order to use -@code{Info-validate} on a large file, you must run -@code{texinfo-format-buffer} with an argument so that it does not split -the Info file; and you must create a tag table for the unsplit -file.@refill - -@node Unsplit, Tagifying, Using Info-validate, Running Info-Validate -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsubsec Creating an Unsplit File -@cindex Creating an unsplit file -@cindex Unsplit file creation - -You can run @code{Info-validate} only on a single Info file that has a -tag table. The command will not work on the indirect subfiles that -are generated when a master file is split. If you have a large file -(longer than 70,000 bytes or so), you need to run the -@code{texinfo-format-buffer} or @code{makeinfo-buffer} command in such -a way that it does not create indirect subfiles. You will also need -to create a tag table for the Info file. After you have done this, -you can run @code{Info-validate} and look for badly referenced -nodes.@refill - -The first step is to create an unsplit Info file. To prevent -@code{texinfo-format-buffer} from splitting a Texinfo file into -smaller Info files, give a prefix to the @kbd{M-x -texinfo-format-buffer} command:@refill - -@example -C-u M-x texinfo-format-buffer -@end example - -@noindent -or else - -@example -C-u C-c C-e C-b -@end example - -@noindent -When you do this, Texinfo will not split the file and will not create -a tag table for it. @refill -@cindex Making a tag table manually -@cindex Tag table, making manually - -@node Tagifying, Splitting, Unsplit, Running Info-Validate -@appendixsubsec Tagifying a File - -After creating an unsplit Info file, you must create a tag table for -it. Visit the Info file you wish to tagify and type:@refill - -@example -M-x Info-tagify -@end example - -@noindent -(Note the upper case @samp{I} in @code{Info-tagify}.) This creates an -Info file with a tag table that you can validate.@refill - -The third step is to validate the Info file:@refill - -@example -M-x Info-validate -@end example - -@noindent -(Note the upper case @samp{I} in @code{Info-validate}.) -In brief, the steps are:@refill - -@example -@group -C-u M-x texinfo-format-buffer -M-x Info-tagify -M-x Info-validate -@end group -@end example - -After you have validated the node structure, you can rerun -@code{texinfo-format-buffer} in the normal way so it will construct a -tag table and split the file automatically, or you can make the tag -table and split the file manually.@refill - -@node Splitting, , Tagifying, Running Info-Validate -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendixsubsec Splitting a File Manually -@cindex Splitting an Info file manually -@cindex Info file, splitting manually - -You should split a large file or else let the -@code{texinfo-format-buffer} or @code{makeinfo-buffer} command do it -for you automatically. (Generally you will let one of the formatting -commands do this job for you. @xref{Create an Info File}.)@refill - -The split-off files are called the indirect subfiles.@refill - -Info files are split to save memory. With smaller files, Emacs does not -have make such a large buffer to hold the information.@refill - -If an Info file has more than 30 nodes, you should also make a tag -table for it. @xref{Using Info-validate}, for information -about creating a tag table. (Again, tag tables are usually created -automatically by the formatting command; you only need to create a tag -table yourself if you are doing the job manually. Most likely, you -will do this for a large, unsplit file on which you have run -@code{Info-validate}.)@refill - -@c Info-split is autoloaded in `loaddefs.el' in Emacs 18.51 -@ignore -Before running @code{Info-split}, you need to load the @code{info} library -into Emacs by giving the command @kbd{M-x load-library @key{RET} info -@key{RET}}. -@end ignore - -Visit the Info file you wish to tagify and split and type the two -commands:@refill - -@example -M-x Info-tagify -M-x Info-split -@end example - -@noindent -(Note that the @samp{I} in @samp{Info} is upper case.)@refill - -When you use the @code{Info-split} command, the buffer is modified into a -(small) Info file which lists the indirect subfiles. This file should be -saved in place of the original visited file. The indirect subfiles are -written in the same directory the original file is in, with names generated -by appending @samp{-} and a number to the original file name.@refill - -The primary file still functions as an Info file, but it contains just -the tag table and a directory of subfiles.@refill - - -@node Refilling Paragraphs, Command Syntax, Catching Mistakes, Top -@appendix Refilling Paragraphs -@cindex Refilling paragraphs -@cindex Filling paragraphs -@findex refill - -The @code{@@refill} command refills and, optionally, indents the first -line of a paragraph.@footnote{Perhaps the command should have been -called the @code{@@refillandindent} command, but @code{@@refill} is -shorter and the name was chosen before indenting was possible.} The -@code{@@refill} command is no longer important, but we describe it here -because you once needed it. You will see it in many old Texinfo -files.@refill - -Without refilling, paragraphs containing long @@-constructs may look -bad after formatting because the formatter removes @@-commands and -shortens some lines more than others. In the past, neither the -@code{texinfo-format-region} command nor the -@code{texinfo-format-buffer} command refilled paragraphs -automatically. The @code{@@refill} command had to be written at the -end of every paragraph to cause these formatters to fill them. (Both -@TeX{} and @code{makeinfo} have always refilled paragraphs -automatically.) Now, all the Info formatters automatically fill and -indent those paragraphs that need to be filled and indented.@refill - -The @code{@@refill} command causes @code{texinfo-format-region} and -@code{texinfo-format-buffer} to refill a paragraph in the Info file -@emph{after} all the other processing has been done. For this reason, -you can not use @code{@@refill} with a paragraph containing either -@code{@@*} or @code{@@w@{ @dots{} @}} since the refilling action will -override those two commands.@refill - -The @code{texinfo-format-region} and @code{texinfo-format-buffer} -commands now automatically append @code{@@refill} to the end of each -paragraph that should be filled. They do not append @code{@@refill} to -the ends of paragraphs that contain @code{@@*} or @w{@code{@@w@{ @dots{}@}}} -and therefore do not refill or indent them.@refill - - -@node Command Syntax, Obtaining TeX, Refilling Paragraphs, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@appendix @@-Command Syntax -@cindex @@-command syntax - -The character @samp{@@} is used to start special Texinfo commands. -(It has the same meaning that @samp{\} has in plain @TeX{}.) Texinfo -has four types of @@-command:@refill - -@table @asis -@item 1. Non-alphabetic commands. -These commands consist of an @@ followed by a punctuation mark or other -character that is not part of the alphabet. Non-alphabetic commands are -almost always part of the text within a paragraph, and never take any -argument. The two characters (@@ and the other one) are complete in -themselves; none is followed by braces. The non-alphabetic commands -are: @code{@@.}, @code{@@:}, @code{@@*}, @code{@@@kbd{SPACE}}, -@code{@@@kbd{TAB}}, @code{@@@kbd{NL}}, @code{@@@@}, @code{@@@{}, and -@code{@@@}}.@refill - -@item 2. Alphabetic commands that do not require arguments. -These commands start with @@ followed by a word followed by left- and -right-hand braces. These commands insert special symbols in the -document; they do not require arguments. For example, -@code{@@dots@{@}} @result{} @samp{@dots{}}, @code{@@equiv@{@}} -@result{} @samp{@equiv{}}, @code{@@TeX@{@}} @result{} `@TeX{}', -and @code{@@bullet@{@}} @result{} @samp{@bullet{}}.@refill - -@item 3. Alphabetic commands that require arguments within braces. -These commands start with @@ followed by a letter or a word, followed by an -argument within braces. For example, the command @code{@@dfn} indicates -the introductory or defining use of a term; it is used as follows: @samp{In -Texinfo, @@@@-commands are @@dfn@{mark-up@} commands.}@refill - -@item 4. Alphabetic commands that occupy an entire line. -These commands occupy an entire line. The line starts with @@, -followed by the name of the command (a word); for example, @code{@@center} -or @code{@@cindex}. If no argument is needed, the word is followed by -the end of the line. If there is an argument, it is separated from -the command name by a space. Braces are not used.@refill -@end table - -@cindex Braces and argument syntax -Thus, the alphabetic commands fall into classes that have -different argument syntaxes. You cannot tell to which class a command -belongs by the appearance of its name, but you can tell by the -command's meaning: if the command stands for a glyph, it is in -class 2 and does not require an argument; if it makes sense to use the -command together with other text as part of a paragraph, the command -is in class 3 and must be followed by an argument in braces; -otherwise, it is in class 4 and uses the rest of the line as its -argument.@refill - -The purpose of having a different syntax for commands of classes 3 and -4 is to make Texinfo files easier to read, and also to help the GNU -Emacs paragraph and filling commands work properly. There is only one -exception to this rule: the command @code{@@refill}, which is always -used at the end of a paragraph immediately following the final period -or other punctuation character. @code{@@refill} takes no argument and -does @emph{not} require braces. @code{@@refill} never confuses the -Emacs paragraph commands because it cannot appear at the beginning of -a line.@refill - - -@node Obtaining TeX, Command and Variable Index, Command Syntax, Top -@appendix How to Obtain @TeX{} -@cindex Obtaining @TeX{} -@cindex @TeX{}, how to obtain - -@c !!! Here is information about obtaining TeX. Update it whenever. -@c !!! Also consider updating TeX.README on prep. -@c Updated by RJC on 1 March 1995, conversation with MacKay. -@c Updated by kb@cs.umb.edu on 29 July 1996. -@c Updated by kb@cs.umb.edu on 25 April 1997. -@TeX{} is freely redistributable. You can obtain @TeX{} for Unix -systems via anonymous ftp or on physical media. The core material -consists of the Web2c @TeX{} distribution (@uref{http://www.tug.org/web2c}). - -Instructions for retrieval by anonymous ftp and information on other -available distributions: -@example -@uref{ftp://ftp.tug.org/tex/unixtex.ftp} -@uref{http://www.tug.org/unixtex.ftp} -@end example - -The Free Software Foundation provides a core distribution on its Source -Code CD-ROM suitable for printing Texinfo manuals; the University of -Washington maintains and supports a tape distribution; the @TeX{} Users -Group co-sponsors a complete CD-ROM @TeX{} distribution. - -@itemize @bullet - -@item -For the FSF Source Code CD-ROM, please contact: - -@iftex -@display -@group -Free Software Foundation, Inc. -59 Temple Place Suite 330 -Boston, MA @ @ 02111-1307 -USA -Telephone: @w{@t{+}1--617--542--5942} -Fax: (including Japan) @w{@t{+}1--617--542--2652} -Free Dial Fax (in Japan): -@w{ } @w{ } @w{ } 0031--13--2473 (KDD) -@w{ } @w{ } @w{ } 0066--3382--0158 (IDC) -Electronic mail: @code{gnu@@prep.ai.mit.edu} -@end group -@end display -@end iftex -@ifinfo -@display -@group -Free Software Foundation, Inc. -59 Temple Place Suite 330 -Boston, MA @w{ } 02111-1307 -USA - -Telephone: @w{@t{+}1-617-542-5942} -Fax: (including Japan) @w{@t{+}1-617-542-2652} -Free Dial Fax (in Japan): -@w{ } @w{ } @w{ } 0031-13-2473 (KDD) -@w{ } @w{ } @w{ } 0066-3382-0158 (IDC) -Electronic mail: @code{gnu@@prep.ai.mit.edu} -@end group -@end display -@end ifinfo - -@item -To order a complete distribution on CD-ROM, please see -@uref{http://www.tug.org/tex-live.html}. (This distribution is also -available by FTP; see the URL's above.) - -@item -To order a full distribution from the University of Washington on either -a 1/4@dmn{in} 4-track QIC-24 cartridge or a 4@dmn{mm} DAT cartridge, -send $210 to: - -@display -@group -Pierre A. MacKay -Denny Hall, Mail Stop DH-10 -University of Washington -Seattle, WA @w{ } 98195 -USA -Telephone: @t{+}1--206--543--2268 -Electronic mail: @code{mackay@@cs.washington.edu} -@end group -@end display - -@noindent Please make checks payable to the University of Washington. -Checks must be in U.S.@: dollars, drawn on a U.S.@: bank. Overseas -sites: please add to the base cost, if desired, $20.00 for shipment via -air parcel post, or $30.00 for shipment via courier. - -@end itemize - -Many other @TeX{} distributions are available; see -@uref{http://www.tug.org/}. - - -@c These are no longer ``new'', and the explanations -@c are all given elsewhere anyway, I think. --karl, 25apr97. -@ignore (the entire appendix) -@c node New Features, Command and Variable Index, Obtaining TeX, Top -@c appendix Second Edition Features - -@tex -% Widen the space for the first column so three control-character -% strings fit in the first column. Switched back to default .8in -% value at end of chapter. -\global\tableindent=1.0in -@end tex - -The second edition of the Texinfo manual describes more than 20 new -Texinfo mode commands and more than 50 previously undocumented Texinfo -@@-commands. This edition is more than twice the length of the first -edition.@refill - -Here is a brief description of the new commands.@refill - -@menu -* New Texinfo Mode Commands:: The updating commands are especially useful. -* New Commands:: Many newly described @@-commands. -@end menu - -@c node New Texinfo Mode Commands, New Commands, Obtaining TeX, Obtaining TeX -@c appendixsec New Texinfo Mode Commands - -Texinfo mode provides commands and features especially designed for -working with Texinfo files. More than 20 new commands have been -added, including commands for automatically creating and updating -both nodes and menus. This is a tedious task when done by hand.@refill - -The keybindings are intended to be somewhat mnemonic.@refill - -@c subheading Update all nodes and menus - -The @code{texinfo-master-menu} command is the primary command: - -@table @kbd -@item C-c C-u m -@itemx M-x texinfo-master-menu -Create or update a master menu. -With @kbd{C-u} as a prefix argument, -first create or update all nodes -and regular menus. -@end table - -@c subheading Update Pointers - -@noindent -Create or update `Next', `Previous', and `Up' node pointers.@refill - -@noindent -@xref{Updating Nodes and Menus}. - -@table @kbd -@item C-c C-u C-n -@itemx M-x texinfo-update-node -Update a node. - -@item C-c C-u C-e -@itemx M-x texinfo-every-node-update -Update every node in the buffer. -@end table - -@c subheading Update Menus - -@noindent -Create or update menus.@refill - -@noindent -@xref{Updating Nodes and Menus}. - -@table @kbd -@item C-c C-u C-m -@itemx M-x texinfo-make-menu -Make or update a menu. - -@item C-c C-u C-a -@itemx M-x texinfo-all-menus-update -Make or update all the menus in a buffer. -With @kbd{C-u} as a prefix argument, -first update all the nodes. -@end table - -@c subheading Insert Title as Description - -@noindent -Insert a node's chapter or section title in the space for the -description in a menu entry line; position point so you can edit the -insert. (This command works somewhat differently than the other -insertion commands, which insert only a predefined string.)@refill - -@noindent -@xref{Inserting, Inserting Frequently Used Commands}. - -@table @kbd -@item C-c C-c C-d -Insert title. -@end table - -@c subheading Format for Info - -@noindent -Provide keybindings both for the Info formatting commands that are -written in Emacs Lisp and for @code{makeinfo} that is written in -C.@refill - -@noindent -@xref{Info Formatting}. - -@noindent -Use the Emacs lisp @code{texinfo-format@dots{}} commands: - -@table @kbd -@item C-c C-e C-r -Format the region. - -@item C-c C-e C-b -Format the buffer. -@end table - -@noindent -Use @code{makeinfo}: - -@table @kbd -@item C-c C-m C-r -Format the region. - -@item C-c C-m C-b -Format the buffer. - -@item C-c C-m C-l -Recenter the @code{makeinfo} output buffer. - -@item C-c C-m C-k -Kill the @code{makeinfo} formatting job. -@end table - -@c subheading Typeset and Print - -@noindent -Typeset and print Texinfo documents from within Emacs.@refill - -@ifinfo -@noindent -@xref{Printing}. -@end ifinfo -@iftex -@noindent -@xref{Printing, , Formatting and Printing}. -@end iftex - -@table @kbd -@item C-c C-t C-b -Run @code{texi2dvi} on the buffer. - -@item C-c C-t C-r -Run @TeX{} on the region. - -@item C-c C-t C-i -Run @code{texindex}. - -@item C-c C-t C-p -Print the DVI file. - -@item C-c C-t C-q -Show the print queue. - -@item C-c C-t C-d -Delete a job from the print queue. - -@item C-c C-t C-k -Kill the current @TeX{} formatting job. - -@item C-c C-t C-x -Quit a currently stopped @TeX{} formatting job. - -@item C-c C-t C-l -Recenter the output buffer. -@end table - -@c subheading Other Updating Commands - -@noindent -The ``other updating commands'' do not have standard keybindings because -they are used less frequently.@refill - -@noindent -@xref{Other Updating Commands}. - -@table @kbd -@item M-x texinfo-insert-node-lines -Insert missing @code{@@node} lines using -section titles as node names. - -@item M-x texinfo-multiple-files-update -Update a multi-file document. -With a numeric prefix, such as @kbd{C-u 8}, -update @strong{every} pointer and -menu in @strong{all} the files and -then insert a master menu. - -@item M-x texinfo-indent-menu-description -Indent descriptions in menus. - -@item M-x texinfo-sequential-node-update -Insert node pointers in strict sequence. -@end table - -@c node New Commands, , New Texinfo Mode Commands, Obtaining TeX -@c appendixsec New Texinfo @@-Commands - -The second edition of the Texinfo manual describes more than 50 -commands that were not described in the first edition. A third or so -of these commands existed in Texinfo but were not documented in the -manual; the others are new. Here is a listing, with brief -descriptions of them:@refill - -@c subheading Indexing - -@noindent -Create your own index, and merge indices.@refill - -@noindent -@xref{Indices}. - -@table @kbd -@item @@defindex @var{index-name} -Define a new index and its indexing command. -See also the @code{@@defcodeindex} command. - -@c written verbosely to avoid overfull hbox -@item @@synindex @var{from-index} @var{into-index} -Merge the @var{from-index} index into the @var{into-index} index. -See also the @code{@@syncodeindex} command. -@end table - -@c subheading Definitions - -@noindent -Describe functions, variables, macros, -commands, user options, special forms, and other such artifacts in a -uniform format.@refill - -@noindent -@xref{Definition Commands}. - -@table @kbd -@item @@deffn @var{category} @var{name} @var{arguments}@dots{} -Format a description for functions, interactive -commands, and similar entities. - -@item @@defvr, @@defop, @dots{} -15 other related commands. -@end table - -@c subheading Glyphs - -@noindent -Indicate the results of evaluation, expansion, -printed output, an error message, equivalence of expressions, and the -location of point.@refill - -@noindent -@xref{Glyphs}. - -@table @kbd -@item @@equiv@{@} -@itemx @equiv{} -Equivalence: - -@item @@error@{@} -@itemx @error{} -Error message - -@item @@expansion@{@} -@itemx @expansion{} -Macro expansion - -@item @@point@{@} -@itemx @point{} -Position of point - -@item @@print@{@} -@itemx @print{} -Printed output - -@item @@result@{@} -@itemx @result{} -Result of an expression -@end table - -@c subheading Page Headings - -@noindent -Customize page headings. - -@noindent -@xref{Headings}. - -@table @kbd -@item @@headings @var{on-off-single-double} -Headings on or off, single, or double-sided. - -@item @@evenfooting [@var{left}] @@| [@var{center}] @@| [@var{right}] -Footings for even-numbered (left-hand) pages. - -@item @@evenheading, @@everyheading, @@oddheading, @dots{} -Five other related commands. - -@item @@thischapter -Insert name of chapter and chapter number. - -@item @@thischaptername, @@thisfile, @@thistitle, @@thispage -Related commands. -@end table - -@c subheading Formatting - -@noindent -Format blocks of text. - -@noindent -@xref{Quotations and Examples}, and@* -@ref{Lists and Tables, , Making Lists and Tables}. - -@table @kbd -@item @@cartouche -Draw rounded box surrounding text (not in Info). - -@item @@enumerate @var{optional-arg} -Enumerate a list with letters or numbers. - -@item @@exdent @var{line-of-text} -Remove indentation. - -@item @@flushleft -Left justify. - -@item @@flushright -Right justify. - -@item @@format -Do not narrow nor change font. - -@item @@ftable @var{formatting-command} -@itemx @@vtable @var{formatting-command} -Two-column table with indexing. - -@item @@lisp -For an example of Lisp code. - -@item @@smallexample -@itemx @@smalllisp -Like @@table and @@lisp @r{but for} @@smallbook. -@end table - -@c subheading Conditionals - -@noindent -Conditionally format text. - -@noindent -@xref{set clear value, , @code{@@set} @code{@@clear} @code{@@value}}.@refill - -@table @kbd -@item @@set @var{flag} [@var{string}] -Set a flag. Optionally, set value -of @var{flag} to @var{string}. - -@item @@clear @var{flag} -Clear a flag. - -@item @@value@{@var{flag}@} -Replace with value to which @var{flag} is set. - -@item @@ifset @var{flag} -Format, if @var{flag} is set. - -@item @@ifclear @var{flag} -Ignore, if @var{flag} is set. -@end table - -@c subheading @@heading series for Titles - -@noindent -Produce unnumbered headings that do not appear in a table of contents. - -@noindent -@xref{Structuring}. - -@table @kbd -@item @@heading @var{title} -Unnumbered section-like heading not listed -in the table of contents of a printed manual. - -@item @@chapheading, @@majorheading, @@c subheading, @@subsubheading -Related commands. -@end table - -@need 1000 -@c subheading Font commands - -@need 1000 -@noindent -@xref{Smallcaps}, and @* -@ref{Fonts}. - -@table @kbd -@item @@r@{@var{text}@} -Print in roman font. - -@item @@sc@{@var{text}@} -Print in @sc{small caps} font. -@end table - -@c subheading Miscellaneous - -@noindent -See @ref{title subtitle author, , @code{@@title} @code{@@subtitle} and @code{@@author} Commands},@* -see @ref{Customized Highlighting},@* -see @ref{Overfull hboxes},@* -see @ref{Footnotes},@* -see @ref{dmn, , Format a Dimension},@* -see @ref{Raise/lower sections, , @code{@@raisesections} and @code{@@lowersections}},@* -see @ref{math, , @code{@@math}: Inserting Mathematical Expressions}.@* -see @ref{minus, , Inserting a Minus Sign},@* -see @ref{paragraphindent, , Paragraph Indenting},@* -see @ref{Cross Reference Commands},@* -see @ref{title subtitle author, , @code{@@title} @code{@@subtitle} and @code{@@author}}, and@* -see @ref{Custom Headings, , How to Make Your Own Headings}. - -@table @kbd -@item @@author @var{author} -Typeset author's name. - -@c @item @@definfoenclose @var{new-command}, @var{before}, @var{after}, -@c Define a highlighting command for Info. (Info only.) - -@item @@finalout -Produce cleaner printed output. - -@item @@footnotestyle @var{end-or-separate} -Specify footnote style. - -@item @@dmn@{@var{dimension}@} -Format a dimension. - -@item @@global@@let@var{new-cmd}=@var{existing-cmd} -Define a highlighting command for @TeX{}. (@TeX{} only.) - -@item @@lowersections -Reduce hierarchical level of sectioning commands. - -@item @@math@{@var{mathematical-expression}@} -Format a mathematical expression. - -@item @@minus@{@} -Generate a minus sign. - -@item @@paragraphindent @var{asis-or-number} -Specify paragraph indentation. - -@item @@raisesections -Raise hierarchical level of sectioning commands. - -@item @@ref@{@var{node-name}, @r{[}@var{entry}@r{]}, @r{[}@var{topic-or-title}@r{]}, @r{[}@var{info-file}@r{]}, @r{[}@var{manual}@r{]}@} -Make a reference. In the printed manual, the -reference does not start with the word `see'. - -@item @@title @var{title} -Typeset @var{title} in the alternative -title page format. - -@item @@subtitle @var{subtitle} -Typeset @var{subtitle} in the alternative -title page format. - -@item @@today@{@} -Insert the current date. -@end table -@tex -% Switch width of first column of tables back to default value -\global\tableindent=.8in -@end tex -@end ignore - -@node Command and Variable Index, Concept Index, Obtaining TeX, Top -@comment node-name, next, previous, up -@unnumbered Command and Variable Index - -This is an alphabetical list of all the @@-commands, assorted Emacs Lisp -functions, and several variables. To make the list easier to use, the -commands are listed without their preceding @samp{@@}.@refill - -@printindex fn - - -@node Concept Index, , Command and Variable Index, Top -@unnumbered Concept Index - -@printindex cp - - -@summarycontents -@contents -@bye |